Home
  By Author [ A  B  C  D  E  F  G  H  I  J  K  L  M  N  O  P  Q  R  S  T  U  V  W  X  Y  Z |  Other Symbols ]
  By Title [ A  B  C  D  E  F  G  H  I  J  K  L  M  N  O  P  Q  R  S  T  U  V  W  X  Y  Z |  Other Symbols ]
  By Language
all Classics books content using ISYS

Download this book: [ ASCII ]

Look for this book on Amazon


We have new books nearly every day.
If you would like a news letter once a week or once a month
fill out this form and we will give you a summary of the books for that week or month by email.

Title: Buried Cities and Bible Countries
Author: Clair, George St.
Language: English
As this book started as an ASCII text book there are no pictures available.


*** Start of this LibraryBlog Digital Book "Buried Cities and Bible Countries" ***

This book is indexed by ISYS Web Indexing system to allow the reader find any word or number within the document.

COUNTRIES***


available by Internet Archive (https://archive.org)



      Images of the original pages are available through
      Internet Archive. See
      https://archive.org/details/buriedcitiesbibl00stcl


      Some characters might not display properly in this UTF-8
      text file (e.g., empty squares). If so, the reader should
      consult the html version or the original page images noted
      above.


Transcriber’s note:

      Text enclosed by underscores is in italics (_italics_).

      A caret character is used to denote superscription. A
      single character following the caret is superscripted
      (example: Edwr^d).



BURIED CITIES AND BIBLE COUNTRIES.


  [Illustration:

      _Frontispiece._

      RUINS OF A GALILEAN SYNAGOGUE (KEFR BIRIM).
      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]


BURIED CITIES AND BIBLE COUNTRIES

by

GEORGE ST CLAIR, F.G.S.

Member of the Society of Biblical Archæology;
Member of the Anthropological Institute, and Ten Years Lecturer
for the Palestine Exploration Fund.

Second Edition



London
Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co. Ltd.

Imported by
Thomas Whittaker
2 & 3 Bible House
New York



                               CONTENTS.


    CHAP.                                                           PAGE

       PREFACE                                                         9

    I. EGYPT AND THE BIBLE--

        1. The Rosetta Stone. Decipherment of the Egyptian
            Hieroglyphs                                               11

        2. Kings and Dynasties of Egypt                               16

        3. The Finding of the Mummies                                 19

        4. Egyptians in Palestine before the Exodus. Wars with
             the Hittites                                             27

        5. Semites in Egypt before the Oppression. The
            _Tell-el-Amarna_ Tablets                                  40

        6. Israel in Egypt                                            47

        7. Buried Cities                                              54

        8. Biblical Sites in Egypt                                    57

        9. The Route of the Exodus                                    76

       10. The Wilderness Wanderings                                  81

    II. PALESTINE EXPLORATION--

        1. Palestine generally                                        86

        2. Physical Features of Palestine                             88

        3. The Dead Sea                                               99

        4. The Cities of the Plain                                   104

        5. “Lot’s Wife”                                              112

        6. The Natural History of Palestine, as dependent on its
             Physical Geography                                      114

        7. The Topographical Survey of Western Palestine             121

        8. Israel’s Wars and Worship considered in connection with
           the Physical Features of the Country--The Conquest and
           Wars                                                      125

        9. The Sacred Sites                                          161

       10. The Method of the Survey, and Incidents of the Work       171

       11. The East of Jordan                                        183


    III. JERUSALEM--                                                 203

        1. The City as it is                                         204

        2. The Sieges of the City and Fortunes of its Walls          220

        3. Excavations in Jerusalem                                  227

        4. Jerusalem as it Was: The Hills and Valleys                249

        5. Jerusalem as it Was: The Walls and Gates of the City      259

        6. Incidents of the History better realized now              277

        7. Sieges of the City understood through improved
             Knowledge of the Topography                             293

    IV. GOSPEL HISTORY IN THE LIGHT OF PALESTINE EXPLORATION--

        1. Christ in the Provinces                                   300

        2. Christ in the Capital                                     325

    V. MESOPOTAMIA AND THE BIBLE--

        1. Assyria                                                   340

        2. Babylonia                                                 357

        3. How the Writings were Read                                370

       THE VANDALISM OF ORIENTALS                                    375



                        LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS.


                                                                    PAGE

    Ruins of Synagogue                                   _Frontispiece._

    Mummies of Seti I. and Rameses II.                                25

    Hittite Portraits                                                 32

    Hittite Inscription                                               37

    Map of Nile Delta and Sinai Desert                      _To face_ 57

    Meridional Section through Palestine                              90

    Geological Sketch-Map                                             95

    Generalised Geological Section                                    97

    Map of Palestine                                       _To face_ 125

    Site of Gath                                                     154

    Plan of Jerusalem                                                205

    Plan of Noble Sanctuary                                _To face_ 212

    Robinson’s Arch--the Spring Stone                                228

    Robinson’s Arch--Section                                         230

    Wilson’s Arch                                                    232

    South Wall of Noble Sanctuary                                    234

    Deep Shaft at south-east Angle                                   235

    Ancient Pottery--Jar Handles                                     236

    Ancient Pottery--Vase                                            236

    Masons’ Marks                                                    237

    East Wall of Noble Sanctuary                                     239

    Plan of Siloam Tunnel                                            242

    Shafts at Virgin’s Fountain                                      245

    Rock-Site of Jerusalem                                           251

    Schick’s Line of Second Wall                                     263

    Nehemiah’s South Wall (St Clair)                                 268

    Outline Plan of Jerusalem                                        334

    Map of Mesopotamia                                     _To face_ 340

    Assyrian Winged Bull                                             347

    Black Obelisk                                                    348

    Sennacherib before Lachish                                       350

    Behistun Rock Inscription                                        371



                               PREFACE.


This book contains a description of some of the most important
modern discoveries bearing upon the Bible, the selection being made
to meet the wants of those who have no time to follow the course of
exploration, and no taste for technical details. The preparation of
such a volume has often been urged upon me by those who have listened
to my lectures on Palestine Exploration.

In such a work accuracy is of more value than originality; and
therefore I have not hesitated to gather information from the best
sources, and to use it freely. The authorities and sources will be
found in a list at the end of each chapter; and thus, while due
acknowledgment is made, the reader will know where to go to for further
information.

In one chapter, indeed--that relating to the topography of Jerusalem
in Scripture times--I do venture to state my own views, and give my
own map of localities; but it is only because my special study of the
subject seems to justify my confidence, and compels me to differ from
other writers.

I desire to express my special obligation to the Committee of the
Palestine Exploration Fund for allowing the use of their plates for the
illustrations of this volume; to Herr Schick of Jerusalem, for leave
to use his plan of the Second Wall, to Wilfrid H. Hudleston, M.A.,
F.R.S., for the geological sketch-map and section, and to W. Harry
Rylands, F.S.A., Secretary to the Society of Biblical Archæology, for
the special favour of an original drawing from one of the Hamath stones.

                                                        GEORGE ST CLAIR.

  [Illustration:

      To face p. 72

  SKETCH MAP

  shewing position of Land and Sea during the PLUVIAL period.

      _By permission of the Committee of the Palestine Exploration
         Fund._      Edwr^d Weller lith.

  _London, Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co._]



                  BURIED CITIES AND BIBLE COUNTRIES.



                              CHAPTER I.

                         EGYPT AND THE BIBLE.


   I. _The Rosetta Stone: Decipherment of the Egyptian Hieroglyphs._

To all who are interested in the ancient history of mankind, the
decipherment of the Egyptian hieroglyphs is a fact of the highest
importance. As early as the fourth dynasty, and probably as early
as the first, the Egyptians possessed the art of writing; but for
thousands of years before the present century the hieroglyphs had
become a dead language, which nobody could read. Temples and tombs in
the valley of the Nile contained records which might be of surpassing
interest; but the clue to them was lost, and the riddle remained
unguessed. At length a discovery was made which began to open the
way, and has proved to be one of the most remarkable events in the
intellectual history of Europe.

In the year 1799, when Napoleon’s army was in Egypt, a French artillery
officer, by name Boussard, while engaged in certain works on the
redoubt of St Julian, at Rosetta, discovered a large slab of black
granite, bearing a triple inscription. The first or upper part was in
hieroglyphs, the middle one was in the enchorial or popular character,
and the lower one in Greek. The hieroglyphic text was partly broken
away and lost, but the other two were nearly complete. The Greek text
showed that the monument was designed by the priests of Memphis, in
honour of the Pharaohs, and particularly of Ptolemy Epiphanes, who was
reigning at the time when the decree was made (198 B.C.). The
monument stood originally in the temple of Tum, the god of the setting
sun; and there were to be copies of it in other places.

Among other things, the priests say of Ptolemy that “he was pious
towards the gods, he ameliorated the life of man, he was full of
generous piety, he showed forth with all his might his sentiments of
humanity.” He lightened taxation, so that the people might have plenty;
he released prisoners and the defendants in law suits; he ordered
that the revenues of the temples, whether in provisions or money,
should remain what they had been. As to the priests, he commanded
that they should pay no new promotion fees, that those who had been
obliged to make an annual voyage to Alexandria should be free from
the obligation; and that what had been neglected in temple services
should be re-established. Naturally the priests were grateful, and they
ordered this testimonial of recognition to be engraved upon stone, in
the sacred characters of Egypt, in the vernacular, and in Greek.

All this was speedily made out from the Greek text, and it was thus
clear that the other two forms of the inscription must be of the same
purport. Here then at last was a key to the long-lost language of the
hieroglyphs. The value of the monument was at once perceived, and after
having been copied it was set apart and packed up. The victory of the
English at Alexandria, and the surrender of the city in 1801, placed
the Rosetta Stone in the hands of Mr W. R. Hamilton, the British
Commissioner, one of the most distinguished and zealous scholars of the
day. The treasure was despatched to England, and has found a fitting
resting-place in the British Museum.

This seemingly insignificant stone (says Baron Bunsen) shares, with
the great and splendid work, “La Description de l’Egypte,” the honour
of being the only result of vital importance to universal history,
accruing from a vast expedition, a brilliant conquest, and a bloody
combat for the possession of Egypt. The men of science and letters who
accompanied Napoleon’s army in Egypt, employed themselves actively
in collecting the precious materials for that great work on the
antiquities, the topography, natural history, &c., of that wonderful
country. When the work appeared, the monuments that it contained, and
the learned commentaries by which they were accompanied, aroused the
general attention of the European public to Egyptian research, which
had been previously all but abandoned. This collection comprised
not only the most important monuments of Egypt, but also the great
funereal papyrus, and other Egyptian records of the highest value.
But the monuments were mute, the hieroglyphics could not be read, and
the riddle of the sphinx still remained unsolved. Attempts had been
made, but without much success, and it was the Rosetta Stone which,
in reality, unloosed the tongue of both monuments and records, and
rendered them accessible to historical investigation. This stone was
the mighty agency which, by the light it shed on the mysteries of the
Egyptian language and writing, was to enable science to penetrate
through the darkness of thousands of years, extend the limits of
history, and even open up a possibility of unfolding the primeval
secrets of the human race.

As engraved copies of the Rosetta Stone became common in
Europe--for which object the English scholars had provided without
delay--confidence was entertained that the hieroglyphs would be
deciphered. One of the earliest workers was Dr Thomas Young.

However (says Mariette), we must not imagine that the deciphering of
hieroglyphs by means of the Rosetta Stone was accomplished at the first
trial, and without groping in the dark. On the contrary, the savants
tried for twenty years without much success. At last Champollion
appeared. Prior to him people thought each of the letters that compose
hieroglyphic writing was a _symbol_; that is, that in every single
one of these letters a complete _idea_ was expressed. The merit of
Champollion consisted in proving that Egyptian writing contains signs
which express _sounds_; in other words, that it is _alphabetic_. He
noticed that wherever in the Greek text the proper name _Ptolemy_ is
met with, there may be found, at a corresponding place of the Egyptian
text, a certain number of signs enclosed within an elliptic ring.
From this he concluded (1) that the names of kings were indicated,
in the hieroglyphic system, in a sort of escutcheon, which he styled
a _cartouche_; (2) that the signs contained in the cartouche must be
letter for letter the name of Ptolemy (Ptolemaios).

Even supposing the vowels omitted, Champollion was already in
possession of five letters--P.T.L.M.S. Again, Champollion knew,
according to a second Greek inscription, engraved on an obelisk of
Philae, that on this obelisk a hieroglyphic cartouche is visible which
must be that of Cleopatra. If his first reading was correct, the P,
the L, and the T of Ptolemy must be found again in the second proper
name; while, at the same time, this second proper name would furnish K
and R. Although very imperfect as yet, the alphabet thus revealed to
Champollion, when applied to other cartouches, put him in possession of
nearly all the other consonants.

Thenceforth he had no need to hesitate concerning the _pronunciation_
of signs; for, from the day this proof was furnished, he could certify
that he possessed the Egyptian alphabet. But now remained the language;
for pronouncing words is nothing, if we know not what they mean. Here
Champollion’s genius could soar. He perceived that his alphabet,
drawn from proper names and applied to words of the language, simply
furnished _Coptic_. Now Coptic, in its turn, is a language which,
without being so well explored as Greek, had for a long time been
not less accessible. (It was a spoken language until the sixteenth
century, and three spoken dialects remained, sufficiently resembling
the old Egyptian to enable all the grammatical forms and structure to
be examined.) Therefore the veil was completely removed. The Egyptian
language was only Coptic written in hieroglyphs; or, to speak more
correctly, Coptic is only the language of the ancient Pharaohs,
written in Greek letters. The rest may be inferred. From sign to sign
Champollion really proceeded from the known to the unknown, and soon
the illustrious father of Egyptology could lay the foundations of this
beautiful science, which has for its object the interpretation of the
hieroglyphs.

Further, as remarked by Dr Birch, Egyptologists have patiently traced
word after word, through several thousands of texts and inscriptions,
until they have found its correct meaning. It was ascertained at
length that almost every word consists of two portions--hieroglyphs to
represent the sound, followed by hieroglyphs expressing its general or
specific meaning. Provided with these materials the enquiry advanced.
The result is that we are gradually recovering a knowledge of the
history of Egypt and the religion of its people, from a time long
anterior to the birth of Moses down to the latest period of the empire.
The hieroglyphs reveal a rich literature, including not only the annals
of the empire, but books on ethics, romances, works on mathematics,
medicine, morals, legal and other reports; while the great religious
work is the Book of the Dead.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Egypt’s Place in Universal
   History.” By Christian C. J. Bunsen. “The Monuments of Upper
   Egypt.” By Auguste Mariette-Bey. “The Monumental History of
   Egypt.” Rede Lecture. By S. Birch, LL.D.]


                  2. _Kings and Dynasties of Egypt._

It will be useful to give here a table of Egyptian Dynasties, so that
when we come to speak of Israel in Egypt the reader may have some
idea of the long antecedent history of the Empire, and the political
circumstances of the time. Unfortunately we must be content at present
with approximate dates, for the records of the Egyptians are not dated,
and the chronology is but very imperfectly known.


                 _Table of the Egyptian Dynasties._[1]

 +---------------------+-------------+-------------+---------+---------+
 |                     |             |             |Approx-  |Approx-  |
 |                     |             |             |imate    |imate    |
 |                     |             |             |Date,    |Date,    |
 |       Dynasty.      |   Capital.  |   Modern    |according|according|
 |                     |             |   Name.     |to       |to       |
 |                     |             |             |Mariette.|Wiede-   |
 |                     |             |             |         |mann.    |
 +---------------------+-------------+-------------+---------+---------+
 |                          THE OLD EMPIRE.                            |
 |                                                                     |
 |    I. Thinite       |This         | Girgeh      |  5004   |  5650   |
 |   II. Thinite       |This         | Girgeh      |  4751   |  5400   |
 |  III. Memphite      |Memphis      | Mitrahenny  |  4449   |  5100   |
 |   IV. Memphite      |Memphis      | Mitrahenny  |  4235   |  4875   |
 |    V. Memphite      |Memphis      | Mitrahenny  |  3951   |  4600   |
 |   VI. Elephantine   |Elephantinê  | Geziret-    |         |         |
 |                     |             | Assouan     |  3703   |  4450   |
 |  VII. Memphite      |Memphis      | Mitrahenny  |  3500   |  4250   |
 | VIII. Memphite      |Memphis      | Mitrahenny  |  3500   |  4250   |
 |   IX. Heracleopolite|Heracleopolis| Ahnas el-   |         |         |
 |                     |             | Medineh     |  3358   |  4000   |
 |    X. Heracleopolite|Heracleopolis| Ahnas el-   |         |         |
 |                     |             | Medineh     |  3249   |  3700   |
 |   XI. Diospolitan   |Thebes       | Luxor, &c.  |  3064   |  3510   |
 |                                                                     |
 |                       THE MIDDLE EMPIRE.                            |
 |                                                                     |
 |   XII. Diospolitan  |Thebes       | Luxor, &c.  |  2851   |  3450   |
 |  XIII. Diospolitan  |Thebes       | Luxor, &c.  |   ...   |  3250   |
 |   XIV. Xoite        |Xois         | Sakha       |  2398   |  2800   |
 |                                                                     |
 |                                                                     |
 |                       THE SHEPHERD KINGS.                           |
 |                                                                     |
 |    XV. Hyksos       |Tanis (Zoan) | San         |  2214   |  2325   |
 |   XVI. {Hyksos      |Tanis        | San         |   ...   |  2050   |
 |        {Diospolitan |Thebes       | Luxor, &c.  |   ...   |   ...   |
 |  XVII. {Hyksos      |Tanis        | San         |   ...   |  1800   |
 |        {Diospolitan |Thebes       | Luxor, &c.  |   ...   |   ...   |
 |                                                                     |
 |                                                                     |
 |                       THE NEW EMPIRE.                               |
 |                                                                     |
 | XVIII. Diospolitan  |Thebes       | Luxor, &c.  |  1700   |  1750   |
 |   XIX. Diospolitan  |Thebes       | Luxor, &c.  |  1400   |  1490   |
 |    XX. Diospolitan  |Thebes       | Luxor, &c.  |  1200   |  1280   |
 |   XXI. Tanite       |Tanis        | San         |  1100   |  1100   |
 |  XXII. Bubastite    |Bubastis     | Tel Bast    |   960   |   975   |
 | XXIII. Tanite       |Tanis        | San         |   766   |   810   |
 |  XXIV. Saite        |Sais         | Sa el-Hagar |   753   |   720   |
 |   XXV. Ethiopian    |Napata       | Mount Barkal|   700   |   715   |
 |  XXVI. Saite        |Sais         | Sa el-Hagar |   666   |   664   |
 | XXVII. Persian      |Persepolis   |     ...     |   527   |   525   |
 |XXVIII. Saite        |Sais         | Sa el-Hagar |   ...   |   415   |
 |  XXIX. Mendesian    |Mendes       | Eshmun er-  |         |         |
 |                     |             | Român       |   399   |   408   |
 |   XXX. Sebennyte    |Sebennytos   | Semenhûd    |   378   |   387   |
 +---------------------+-------------+-------------+---------+---------+

In the time of Moses the Egyptian power had already passed its zenith
and begun to decay. There had been an Old Empire, with the City of
_This_ for its first capital and Menes as its first king. Dynasty had
succeeded dynasty, during perhaps two thousand years, and the capital
had been changed several times, when the Middle Empire came in, and the
kings ruled from Thebes and afterwards from Xois. There had now been
fourteen dynasties altogether; and the power of the kingdom was so
far weakened that it was unable to keep out the invader. The Shepherd
Kings, coming from Midian, or perhaps from Mesopotamia, established
themselves in the Delta, and held possession for several centuries.
Their conquest, however, did not extend to Upper Egypt, and so the
native dynasties reigned contemporaneously, enthroned at Thebes, while
the Hyksos kings were seated at Zoan.

It was probably towards the close of the Hyksos period that Joseph was
made governor of Egypt, under the latest of the Shepherd Kings. The
seventeenth dynasty saw the last of these foreigners, and after their
expulsion the New Empire began, near the end of the eighteenth century
before Christ. The eighteenth and nineteenth dynasties included several
monarchs of great renown; and as the Israelitish sojourn falls chiefly
within this period, it will be useful to give here a chronological list.


_Monarchs of the Eighteenth and Nineteenth Dynasties, with approximate
dates, according to Brugsch._

                     Eighteenth Dynasty.            B. C.

    Aahmes, Amosis; its founder                     1700
    Amenhotep I. (Amenophis)                        1666
    Thothmes I. (Thotmosis)                         1633
    Thothmes II. and his sister-wife Hatshepsu      1600
    Thothmes III.
    Amenhotep II., Son of Thothmes III.             1566
    Thothmes IV.                                    1533
    Amenhotep III., Son of Queen Mutemna            1500
    Amenhotep IV., afterwards called Khuenaten      1466

                      Nineteenth Dynasty.

    Rameses I.                                      1400
    Seti I. (Sethos) Menephtah                      1366
    Rameses II. (Sesostris) Miamun                  1333
    Menephtah II. (Menepthes)                       1300
    Seti II. Menephtah III., son of Menephtah II.   1266
    Setnakht-Merer-Miamun II.                       1233

Rameses II. was the Pharaoh of the Oppression; and the Israelites left
Egypt in the reign of his successor, Menephtah.


                   3. _The Finding of the Mummies._

In 1878 the Khedive Said Pasha authorised Professor Maspero to found
a Museum at Boulak (a suburb of Cairo), for the reception of all the
antiquities found in the country and calculated to throw light on
Egyptian history. Under the successive direction of Professor Maspero
and Professor Grébaut the collection has become one of the most
valuable and most instructive in the world.

In 1881 the museum was enriched by the most important archæological
discovery of modern times. On the 5th of July of that year a cave in
the plain of Deir el-Bahari, near Thebes, was explored, and its rich
contents were bodily removed to Boulak. They consisted of mummies of
kings, queens, and princesses, and other persons of distinction, with
numerous articles of clothing, papyri, vases, &c. Hieratic inscriptions
on the coffins of several of the kings gave the date of the transfer
of the bodies from their original sepulchres in the valley of Bab el
Malook, near Luxor, to this pit or tomb, and also of the periodical
inspection to which the depôt was subjected. The cave is proved to be
the tomb of the Priest-Kings of Amen, the usurpers of the throne of the
Ramessides, from Her-Hor to Pinotem III.

The reason for bringing so many kings of different dynasties into this
tomb is not accurately known; but the following circumstances afford
ground for reasonable conjecture.

“After Rameses II., the last great warrior of Egypt, had laid aside
his javelin and bow, in the fourteenth century before Christ, luxury
and indolence were followed by their usual concomitants, poverty and
discontent. The artizans and labourers, instead of joining in one
common effort to improve the condition of the country, had recourse
to violence and robbery. The pillage of the tombs for the sake of
their precious contents became a common practice, and in the reign
of Rameses IX., of the twentieth dynasty, about the eleventh century
before the birth of Christ, an inquiry was instituted to ascertain the
extent of the depredations. The robbers were arrested and arraigned,
and several of them were condemned to die by their own hands--a common
mode of punishment in ancient Egypt. It was discovered likewise that
the tombs of the Pharaohs, which had hitherto been respected, were,
like the rest, subjected to danger.”

The preservers, however, were at work as well as the robbers; the
priests of the Egyptian Church appear to have shielded the remains of
many of the great kings, by hiding them so effectually that they were
never found again until the third quarter of the present century.

“It was an extraordinary discovery, not only for Egyptian archæology,
but likewise for Egyptian history, and the fortunate discoverer was
Professor Maspero, chief conservator of the Egyptian Museum at Boulak.
The discovery came about in the following manner. For some years past,
so far back as the time of Mariette, it had been observed that objects
of value and interest, tablets, papyri, &c., had found their way into
the museums of Europe, and some into private hands. There exists a law
in Egypt, that tombs and cemeteries are not to be explored except by
direct permission of the Khedive, and all traffic in objects of archaic
interest is strictly forbidden. Nevertheless a kind of contraband
was in existence, the actual source of which was unknown. Another
observation had also been made, namely, that the large majority of the
objects were of about the same period, and seemed to have a common
origin. When His Royal Highness, the Prince of Wales, was in Egypt,
he was presented by a certain Mustapha Aga of Thebes, with a valuable
papyrus, which the Prince has very generously deposited in the British
Museum. It was subsequently ascertained that the document in question
is only half a papyrus (this curious discovery is due to the acute
research of Miss Amelia B. Edwards, one of the Honorary Secretaries of
the Egypt Exploration Fund), the other, the hinder half, being in the
possession of the Museum of the Louvre at Paris. The Prince of Wales’
papyrus was written for a queen, Notem Maut, related to the great
priest-king of the twenty-first dynasty, Her-Hor--possibly his wife,
but more probably his mother. Another, and a remarkably fine papyrus,
was bought by Colonel Campbell in 1876, for the large sum of £400. The
latter had evidently been obtained from the mummy of the High Priest
Pinotem, descendant of Her-Hor. The coincidence was striking, and led
Professor Maspero to the conclusion that a tomb of the priest-kings
was in the possession of the Arabs of the district of Thebes, a class
of persons who live in the tombs, and gain a living out of the produce
of their search. Suspicion quickly pointed to the parties implicated.
The chief, Ahmed Ab-der-Rassoul, one of five brothers engaged in the
traffic of antikas (antiques), was arrested, and shortly afterwards
another of the brothers made a confession and conducted the authorities
to the hiding-place in which all these treasures were concealed.

“Near the site of an old temple, known as Deir el-Bahari, at the foot
of a rugged mass of precipitous rock, so hidden from view that it might
be passed by a hundred times without being seen, was a perpendicular
shaft, 35 feet deep, and 6 feet in diameter. At the bottom of the
shaft, in its western corner, was an opening a little more than 2 feet
high and 5 feet wide, the entrance of a narrow passage tunnelled in
the rock. This passage or tunnel led due west for 25 feet, and then
turned abruptly to the north for 200 feet, ending in an oblong chamber
260 feet long, the entire length of the tunnel being nearly 500 feet.
Throughout the whole of this extensive area the floor was encumbered
with coffins and funereal gear, packed together so closely that for
some distance it was necessary to crawl upon hands and feet to make
any progress. The collection within this strange hiding-place consisted
of sarcophagi, coffins, mummies, funereal furniture, and funereal
ornaments, the gathered fragments of four or five dynasties, more
particularly the seventeenth, eighteenth, nineteenth and twenty-first,
comprehending a period of more than five hundred years, and ranging
between the eighteenth and twelfth centuries before Christ....

“It was a hot forty-eight hours’ work, under the burning sun of Egypt,
to bring all those objects to the surface, and a toilsome labour,
enlisting the services of three hundred Arabs, to convey them to Luxor,
and subsequently to pile them on the deck of the Museum steamer which
had journeyed up the river to receive them. The passage down the river
partook of the character of a funeral ovation: women with dishevelled
hair ran along the banks uttering shrieks and funereal chants, others
threw dust upon their heads, men discharged guns, and the funeral of a
defunct monarch of to-day could not have excited more apparent emotion.”

The coffins and mummies included the following:--

RASKENEN, king of Upper Egypt, a descendant of the old Theban
royal race, but at this time tributary to the Hyksos or Shepherd kings.
According to the Sallier papyrus in the British Museum, he quarrelled
with the Hyksos monarch Apopi, in reference to the cession of an
important well. This brought about the overthrow and expulsion of the
Hyksos, who had ruled the country for five centuries. According to the
same authority, Joseph arrived in Egypt during the reign of the Pharaoh
Nub (B.C. 1730), and rose to honour under Apopi.

AAHMES I., founder of the eighteenth dynasty.

AMENHOTEP I. (_Amenophis_), coffin and mummy.

THOTHMES I.--The coffin was occupied by the mummy of a priest-king,
Pinotem, of the twenty-first dynasty. The mummy of Thothmes was not
found.

The first known representation of a horse occurs on a monument of this
reign; and it is supposed that the horse was introduced into Egypt from
Asia about this time.

THOTHMES II.--The coffin and mummy were both found. Thothmes
II. reigned but a short time.

THOTHMES III., one of the most famous of Egyptian kings. He
continued his predecessors’ offensive movements against the Hyksos
and their allies, and extended his conquests as far as the Tigris.
In his reign Egypt was at the pinnacle of its greatness. The walls
of his magnificent temple at Karnak are covered with inscriptions
recounting his triumphs, and giving a list of the countries and peoples
conquered by him. A stela of black granite found at Karnac, and now in
the Egyptian National Museum, contains a poem in celebration of the
victories of this king. The coffin and mummy found were broken.

HATSHEPSU, the great woman-king, sister and wife of Thothmes
II. Becoming regent for her younger brother, Thothmes III., she assumed
a king’s dress and masculine style. Neither the coffin nor the mummy
were found. But it was the practice of the Egyptians in embalming to
take out the intestines and preserve them separately; and the liver of
Hatshepsu was discovered enclosed in a cabinet of wood, inlaid with
ivory, which was marked with her name.

RAMESES I., founder of the nineteenth dynasty, was found
placed in a coffin of the fashion of the twenty-first dynasty, from
which the name of the original owner had been carefully scraped off.

SETI I., his successor (coffin and mummy). The superb alabaster
sarcophagus of this monarch was already in the Soane Museum, in
Lincoln’s Inn Fields. When Belzoni discovered it in 1817, in the
original sepulchre in the valley of the kings at Thebes, he was
astonished to find the mummy and coffin gone. When the mummy of this
Pharaoh was unrolled it was found that the body was long, fleshless,
of a yellow-black colour, and had the arms crossed upon the breast.
The head was covered with a mask of fine linen, blackened with bitumen,
which it was necessary to remove with scissors. This operation brought
to view the most beautiful mummy-head ever seen in the museum. The
sculptors of Thebes and Abydos did not flatter this Pharaoh when they
gave him that delicate, sweet, smiling profile which is known to
travellers. After a lapse of thirty-two centuries the mummy retains
the same expression which characterised the features of the living
man. Seti I. must have died at an advanced age. The head is shaven,
the eyebrows are white, the condition of the body points to more
than three-score years of life; thus confirming the opinion of the
learned, who have attributed a long reign to this king. Seti I. built
the Hall of Columns in the Great Temple of Ammon, at Karnac. There
exist numerous remains also at Koorneh, Abydos, and elsewhere, of the
extensive and magnificent buildings which he erected with the aid of
the conquered Semites, among whom the Israelites must probably be
included. During his reign a great canal, the first of its kind, was
completed, connecting the Nile with the Red Sea.

  [Illustration: SETI I.]

RAMESES II., the renowned soldier, son of Seti I., known to
the Greeks as Sesostris. The oppression of the Israelites, probably
begun by Seti I., was continued under Rameses II. In the sixth year
of his reign, however, Moses was born. The mummy of Rameses II. was
found deposited in a coffin of the twenty-first dynasty, like that of
Rameses I. This gave rise to doubts as to which particular Rameses
was enclosed, but on unwrapping the mummy an inscription was found,
explaining that the original coffin had been accidentally broken, and
leaving no doubt that this was Rameses II. Most striking, when compared
with the mummy of Seti I., is the astonishing resemblance between
father and son. The nose, mouth, chin, all the features are the same,
but in the father they are more refined than in the son. Rameses II.
was over six feet in height, and we see by the breadth of his chest
and the squareness of his shoulders that he must have been a man of
great bodily strength. Professor Maspero, in his official report,
describes the body as that of a vigorous and robust old man, with white
and well-preserved teeth, white hair and eyebrows, long and slender
hands and feet, stained with henna, and ears pierced for the reception
of ear-rings. Rameses II. reigned sixty-six years, and was nearly a
hundred years old at the time of his death. He exhibited great zeal as
a builder, and was a patron of science and art. It was he who built the
Ramesseum at Thebes, and presented it with a library. He also built the
Pylons and Hall of Columns of the Temple of Luxor, and a score of minor
temples in Egypt and Nubia, and made the marvellous rock-cut temples at
Abousimbel.

  [Illustration: RAMESES II.]

Rameses II. was succeeded by his thirteenth son, Meneptah II., who
continued the oppression of the Israelites, and pursued them when they
were escaping.

Besides all these monarchs, there were found in the strange repository
at Deir el-Bahari, coffins and mummies of Rameses III. (of the
twentieth dynasty), the last of the great warrior kings of Egypt,
Pinotem I., and Pinotem II., priest-kings of the twenty-first dynasty,
and several queens, princes, and notabilities of the same periods. An
affecting story, which brings home to us very vividly the universal
kinship of humanity, is revealed by the contents of the coffin of
Makara, wife of King Pinotem, of the priest-king dynasty. A little
coiled-up bundle lay at the feet of the Queen, her infant daughter,
in giving birth to whom she gave likewise her life. Thus, and so
touchingly, are we led to participate in the affliction of the sick
chamber of three thousand years ago. Already had the still-born babe of
a queen received a name, Mautemhat, the firstling of the goddess Maut,
wife of Amen; and not a name alone, for she is born to a title strange
to our ears, namely, “principal royal spouse.”

   [_Sources and Authorities_:--The _Times_ newspaper, 4th
   August 1881. The _Times_ newspaper, 25th June 1886. “Egyptian
   Mummies,” lecture by Sir Erasmus Wilson; Kegan Paul, Trench &
   Co., 1883.]


            4. _Egyptians in Palestine before the Exodus._

When the tribes of Israel were preparing to pass over Jordan, they were
told that they were going to possess nations greater and mightier than
themselves, a people great and tall, whose cities were fenced up to
heaven (Deut. ix. 1; i. 28). Of these early inhabitants of Palestine,
the spies had reported that Amalek dwelt in the land of the South; the
Hittite, the Jebusite, and the Amorite dwelt in the mountains, and
the Canaanite dwelt by the sea and along by the side of Jordan (Num.
xiii. 29). We have indeed an enumeration of seven nations dwelling in
Palestine at this time, and a testimony to their might:--“The Hittite,
the Girgashite, the Amorite, and the Canaanite, the Perizzite, the
Hivite, and the Jebusite, seven nations greater and mightier than
thou.” (Deut. vii. 1). In these passages it is plainly implied that the
peoples who occupied Palestine before the Israelitish invasion were in
an advanced state of civilisation. Until lately we have known little
or nothing about them, beyond the information which these Scripture
passages afforded; but now at last the veil is beginning to lift.


                            _The Hittites._

As there were seven “nations” in Canaan, and the land itself is no
larger than Wales, it was long supposed that each of the “nations”
was but a small tribe, and was too insignificant to make any figure
in history. But we have lately learned that if this was the rule,
the Hittites were an exception to it. They were a great people, or
perhaps a great confederacy or empire, spread over a vast region in
northern Syria and some of the adjacent countries. Their dominion
extended more or less over Asia Minor, and the influence of their art
and culture reached even into Greece. Their capital was Carchemish,
on the Euphrates, the site of which city was discovered a few years
ago by Mr Skene, English Consul at Aleppo, and again, two years later,
by Mr George Smith, as he was returning from Assyria. The place is
now called Jerablus. Another centre of Hittite power was Kadesh, on
the Orontes, a city which appears to be referred to in the Bible, for
it has been maintained that where Joab and the captains “came to the
land of Tahtim-hodshi” (2 Sam. xxiv. 6), it should be rendered “the
land of Kadesh of the Hittites,” this being the northern border of
David’s kingdom at that time. A list of places in Palestine conquered
by Thothmes III., and engraved on the walls of his temple at Karnac,
includes the name of Kadesh. It is situated where the Orontes flows
into the lake of Homs (still called the lake of Kadesh) and had been
a sacred city of the Amorites before it was conquered by the Hittites
about 1400 B.C. [Rev. H. G. Tomkins, in “Records of the Past.”
New Series, vol. v.] The Hittites were thus seated in a region north of
Palestine proper; but they appear to have had colonies in the country,
and it is these isolated settlements which are classed with the small
nations of Canaan by the Bible writer. When Abraham, at Hebron,
required a parcel of earth in which to bury his wife Sarah, he bought
it of Ephron the Hittite; whence it is clear that there were Hittites
owning land in the south. From the mention of Hebron in association
with Zoan in Numbers xiii. 22, it is even suspected that the Shepherd
Kings who reigned in Zoan were a dynasty of Hittites. At any rate the
Hittites were a powerful people, able to hold their own both against
the Egyptians and against the Assyrians, and did so in the region of
Carchemish for a thousand years.

Thothmes III., “the Egyptian Alexander,” who accomplished thirteen
campaigns in twenty years, and made Egypt the centre of history,
invaded Palestine and gained a victory at Megiddo over the king of
Kadesh and his allies. “They fled, head over heels, to Megiddo, with
terror in their countenances, and left behind their horses and their
gold and silver chariots, and were drawn up, with ropes to their
clothes, into this town, since the people had closed the gates of the
said town on account of the deeds of the king.” “The miserable king
of Kadesh” and the miserable king of Megiddo would not have escaped
in this way, only that the Egyptian warriors relaxed the pursuit and
engaged in plunder. The Pharaoh was beside himself. However, the
warriors captured the tent of the miserable king, in which his son was
found. Then they raised a shout of joy and gave honour to Amon, the
lord of Thebes, who had given to his son Thothmes the victory. After
this the neighbouring kings came together to worship before Pharaoh,
“and to implore breath for their nostrils.” And then came the children
of the kings and presented gifts of silver, gold, blue-stone, and
green-stone; they brought also wheat, and wine in skins, and fruits
for the warriors of the king, since each of the Kitti [Hittites] had
taken care to have such provisions for his return home. Then the king
pardoned the foreign princes.

A catalogue of the booty includes 3401 living prisoners, 83 hands, 2041
mares, 191 foals, 6 bulls, one chariot, covered with plates of gold, of
the king of ..., 892 chariots of his miserable warriors, one beautiful
iron armour of the hostile king, one beautiful iron armour of the king
of Megiddo, 200 accoutrements of his miserable warriors, 602 bows, 7
tent-poles covered with plates of gold from the tent of the hostile
king. Pharaoh’s warriors had also taken as booty ... bulls, ... cows,
2000 kids, and 20,500 white goats.

A catalogue is also given of persons and things which Pharaoh
afterwards carried off as his property, including 39 noble persons, 87
children of the hostile king and the kings allied with him, 5 marina
(lords), 1596 men and maid-servants, 105 persons who gave themselves up
because of famine. Besides these prisoners there were taken precious
stones, golden dishes, and many utensils of this sort, a large jug with
a double handle, 97 swords, 1784 lbs. of gold rings which were found
in the hands of the artists, 969 lbs. of silver rings, one statue with
head of gold, 6 chairs and footstools of ivory and cedar wood, 6 large
tables of cedar wood inlaid with gold and precious stones, one staff
of the king worked as a kind of sceptre entirely of gold, one plough
inlaid with gold, many garments of the enemy, &c., &c.

These catalogues enable us to form some estimate of the degree of
perfection in art and refinement which had been arrived at in Northern
Palestine and Syria before the Israelitish invasion. Lists are also
given of the towns conquered and the peoples made to submit. Remarking
upon these, Brugsch justly says that what gives the highest importance
to the catalogue is the undisputed fact that more than three hundred
years before the entrance of the Jews into the land of Canaan, a great
league of peoples of the same race existed in Palestine under little
kings, who dwelt in the same towns and fortresses as we find stated on
the monuments, and who for the greater part fell by conquest into the
hands of the Jewish immigrants. Among these the King of Kadesh, on the
Orontes, in the land of the Amorites--as the inscriptions expressly
state--played the first part, since there obeyed him, as their chief
leader, all the kings and their peoples from the water of Egypt (which
is the same as the Biblical brook which flowed as the boundary of
Egypt) to the rivers of Naharain, afterwards called Mesopotamia.

After the death of Thothmes III. the Hittites recovered their
independence, and their importance grew from year to year, in such a
way that even the Egyptian inscriptions mention the names of their
kings in a conspicuous manner, and speak of their gods with reverence.
Seti I. came to the throne of Egypt about two centuries after the
death of Thothmes, and with him the martial spirit of Egypt revived.
Seti drove back the Syrians who had invaded his frontier, and pursued
them as far as Phœnicia, where he overthrew with great slaughter “the
kings of the land of Phœnicia.” He probably suspected the Hittites
of abetting his enemies, for, from the overthrow of the Phœnicians,
he advanced against Kadesh, professedly as “the avenger of broken
treaties.” The battle scene is represented on the north side of the
great temple of Karnak, where Pharaoh is shown as having thrown to the
ground the Hittites, and slain their princes.

Rameses II. was first associated with his father on the throne, and
afterwards succeeded him. The great battle of his reign was fought
against the Hittites at Kadesh, and was an event of first-class
importance. The King of the Hittites had brought together his forces
from the remotest parts of his empire, and was aided by allies and
satraps from Mesopotamia to Mysia, and from Arvad in the sea. The
Egyptian advance followed the coast line, through Joppa, Tyre,
Sidon, and Beyrout. On the cliff by the Dog River, Rameses cut his
bas-reliefs, and then appears to have advanced up the valley of the
Eleutherus. Bringing his army before Kadesh, a great battle was fought,
in which the Egyptians claim to be the victors; but at one point of the
struggle the Pharaoh was surrounded and in the greatest danger, and at
the close of the fighting a treaty was signed as between equals.

On the great temple at Ibsamboul there is a picture of the battle
of Kadesh, nineteen yards long by more than eight yards deep. In
this great battle scene there are eleven hundred figures, and among
these there is no difficulty in recognizing the slim Egyptians and
their Sardonian allies, with horned and crested helmets, and long
swords, shields, and spears. “The hosts also of the Hittites and of
their allies are represented” (says Brugsch) “with a lively pictorial
expression, for the artist has been guided by the intention of bringing
before the eyes of the beholder the orderly masses of the Hittite
warriors, and the less regular and warlike troops of the allied
peoples, according to their costume and arms. The Canaanites are
distinguished in the most striking manner from the allies, of races
unknown to us, who are attired with turban-like coverings for the
head, or with high caps, such as are worn at the present day by the
Persians.” Conder also remarks that the one race is bearded, the other
beardless, and that this battle picture gives us most lively portraits
of the Hittite warriors in their chariots, and of their walled and
tower-crowned city, with its name written over it, and its bridges over
the Orontes. The Hittites have long pigtails, and their Chinese-like
appearance is very remarkable.

  [Illustration: HITTITES (ABOU-SIMBEL). (_By permission of
  Messrs C. Philip & Son._)]

Pentaur of Thebes, the poet-laureate of Egypt, had accompanied Rameses
in this expedition, and he celebrated the achievements of the day in a
poem which has come down to us in several editions. It is found on a
papyrus roll, and again in conjunction with splendid battle scenes, on
the walls of temples at Abydos, Luxor, Karnak, and Ibsamboul.

This prize poem of Pentaur’s was written three thousand two hundred
years ago, and is the oldest heroic poem in the world. “It may be
relied upon,” says Dr Wright, “as the earliest specimen of special war
correspondence.” Besides this narration there is a simple prose account
of the same battle, and this is followed by a copy of the treaty of
peace which established an offensive and defensive alliance between the
empire of the Hittites and Egypt.

I here insert a few incidents from the prize poem of Pentaur, written
two years after the battle of Kadesh. Reading between the lines of
the boastful hieroglyphs, it is clear that the Hittites must have
maintained their ground in the battle, for their king, who, at the
beginning of the fight, is “the _vile_ king of the Hittites,” and “the
_miserable_ king of the Hittites,” towards the close of the battle
becomes “the _great_ king of the Hittites.”

According to Pentaur, the Hittites and their allies covered mountains
and valleys like grasshoppers, and no such multitude had ever been
seen before.... Pharaoh was young and bold, he seized his arms, he
armed his people and his chariots, and marched towards the land of the
Hittites.... Arab spies were caught, who told Pharaoh that the Hittite
army was in the neighbourhood of Aleppo; but “the miserable king of the
Hittites” was all the time lying in ambush with his allies north-west
of Kadesh. They rose up and surprised the Egyptians. Pharaoh’s retreat
was cut off. In this crisis he prayed to his god and father, Amon, and
was assisted to perform prodigies of valour. He hurled darts with his
right hand and fought with his left; the two thousand three hundred
horses were dashed to pieces, and the hearts of the Hittites sank
within them. The King of the Hittites sent eight of his brother kings
with armed chariots against Pharaoh; but six times he charged the
unclean wretches, who did not acknowledge his god; he killed them, none
escaped. Pharaoh upbraided his worthless warriors, who had left him to
fight the battle single-handed, and promised that on his return to
Egypt he would see the fodder given to his pair of horses which did not
leave him in the lurch.

The battle was renewed the following morning and went sore against the
Hittites. Then the hostile king sent a messenger to ask for peace,
and to say that the Egyptians and the Hittites ought to be brothers.
Pharaoh assembled his warriors to hear the message of “the great king
of the Hittites,” and by their advice he made peace, and returned to
Egypt in serene humour.

On the outer wall of the temple of Karnak we find inscribed the treaty
of peace which was made on this or a later occasion, and the terms of
the offensive and defensive alliance entered into. It is related that
Kheta-sira, King of the Hittites, sent two heralds, bearing a plate of
silver, upon which the treaty was engraved. The treaty is between the
Grand-Duke of Kheta, Kheta-sira, the puissant, and Rameses, the great
ruler of Egypt, the puissant. The arrangement is sanctioned by the Sun
and by Sutekh, the chief gods respectively of Egypt and Kheta. There
is to be peace and good brotherhood for ever--he shall fraternize with
me and I will fraternize with him. The Grand-Duke of Kheta shall not
invade the land of Egypt for ever, to carry away anything from it, nor
shall Ramessu-Meriamen, the great ruler of Egypt, invade the land of
Kheta for ever, to carry away anything from it. If Egypt is invaded by
some other enemy, and Pharaoh sends to Kheta for help, the Grand-Duke
is to go, or at least to send his infantry and cavalry; and he is, of
course, to look for reciprocal aid. If emigrants or fugitives pass
from one country to the other they are not to find service and favour,
but to be given up; nevertheless, when taken back, they are not to be
punished as criminals. In support of the provisions of the treaty the
parties thereunto invoke “the thousand gods of the land of Kheta, in
concert with the thousand gods of the land of Egypt.” Whosoever shall
not observe the provisions of the treaty, the gods shall be against
his house and family and servants; but to whomsoever shall observe them
the gods shall give health and life--to his family, himself, and his
servants.

“In such a form,” says Brugsch, “were peace and friendship made at
Ramses, the city in Lower Egypt, between the two most powerful nations
of the world at that time--Kheta in the east, and Kemi (Egypt) in the
west.”

Following upon the conclusion of this treaty we have a happy dynastic
alliance. Kheta-sira, the great king of the Hittites, appeared in
Egypt in Hittite costume, accompanied by his beautiful daughter, and
Pharaoh made this princess his queen. A memorial tablet at Ibsamboul
speaks of this as a great, inconceivable wonder--“she herself knew not
the impression which her beauty made on thy heart”--and we may fairly
infer that her influence contributed to the international friendship
which lasted as long as Rameses lived. We do not know the native name
of the Hittite princess, but the name given her on her marriage was
Ur-Maa-Noferu Ra.

Since it has become evident that the Hittites were a great people,
and not a petty local tribe like the Hivites or the Perizzites,
scholars have naturally turned again to the Bible references to see
what they really imply. On careful examination the Bible passages are
seen to be all consistent with the idea that the Hebrew writers were
well acquainted with the power and greatness of the Hittites. Their
greatness is nowhere denied; on the contrary there are some passages
which seem plainly to imply it. When Solomon imported horses and
chariots from Egypt, he sold them to the kings of Syria and to “all the
kings of the Hittites” (2 Chron. i. 16). Again, when Ben-hadad, king of
Syria, was besieging Samaria, and the Syrians were smitten with panic,
believing that they heard “a noise of chariots, and a noise of horses,
even the noise of a great host,” what nations did they suppose were
alone able to send great hosts into the field with horses and chariots?
They said one to another, “Lo, the King of Israel has hired against
us the kings of the Hittites and the kings of the Egyptians” (2 Kings
vii. 6). Further--to take an instance nearer to the age of Rameses
II.--when the future wide inheritance of Israel is promised to Moses
and to Joshua, the description runs thus:--“From the wilderness and
this Lebanon, even unto the great river, the river Euphrates, all the
land of the Hittites, and unto the great sea toward the going down of
the sun”--words which had been regarded as a pictorial exaggeration,
but which may now be looked upon as literally accurate (Deut. xi. 24;
Josh. i. 4).

Exploration and research are now making us acquainted with Hittite
works of art and with inscriptions in the Hittite character and
language; while, as already stated, we have Egyptian portraits of their
soldiers on the Temple wall at Ibsamboul.

Burckhardt the traveller was perhaps the first to discover and describe
a Hittite inscription. He gives an account of a stone which he saw
in a wall in the city of Hamath, which was covered with hieroglyphs
differing from those of Egypt. The discovery was without result at
the time; but when the stone had been seen again, with four others,
in 1870, by the American visitor, Mr J. A. Johnson, interest began to
be aroused. Similar stones have been found at Carchemish, at Aleppo,
and in various parts of Asia Minor. Some have been removed to the
Museum at Constantinople, some are in the British Museum, and some
inscriptions remain on rock faces irremovable. A very good collection
of illustrative plates will be found appended to Dr Wm. Wright’s
“Empire of the Hittites.” The Hittite hieroglyphs cannot yet be
deciphered, although Dr A. H. Sayce and Major Conder may be said to
have made a promising beginning. The inquiry has been aided a little by
a short inscription in Hittite and Cuneiform characters, engraved on
a convex silver plate, which looked like the knob of a staff or dagger,
and is known as the boss of Tarkondêmos. We shall probably have to wait
for the discovery of some longer bi-lingual inscription before much
progress can be made. Meanwhile Major Conder finds much reason to think
that the affinities of the Hittites and their language were Mongolian.
The inscriptions of course are quite a mystery to the Asiatic folk in
whose districts they are found, and they attribute magical virtues to
some of them. The particular stone figured above was very efficacious
in cases of lumbago: a man had only to lean his back against it and he
was effectually cured.

  [Illustration:

  HAMATH INSCRIPTION (HITTITE). (_Specially drawn by W. Harry Rylands,
    F.S.A._)]

We know something of the religion of the Hittites from their invocation
of the gods in their treaty with Rameses II. They adored the sun and
moon, the mountains, rivers, clouds, and the sea. But their chief
deity was Sutekh, “king of heaven, protector of this treaty,” supposed
by Brugsch to be a form of Baal, but who is more likely to have been
allied to Set or to Dagon. We cannot suppose that their worship was
purer than that of the nations round about them; but it may not have
been less pure, nor their life less moral. The appeal to the King of
Heaven to protect a treaty is admirable so far as it goes. To what
height they could sometimes rise in their conceptions of duty is
pleasantly shown if, as seems possible, that beautiful passage in Micah
vi. 8 is to be attributed to them--“What doth the Lord require of thee
but to do justly, to love mercy, and to walk humbly with thy God.” The
prophet quotes the sentiment from Balaam, and gives it as Balaam’s
answer to the question of Balak, king of Moab, who had sent for him
to curse Israel. A conversation took place which may be set forth as
follows:--

_King_--Wherewithal shall I come before the Lord, and bow myself before
the high God? Shall I come before him with burnt offerings, with calves
of a year old?

_Prophet_--Will the Lord be pleased with thousands of rams, or with ten
thousands of rivers of oil?

_King_--Shall I give my first-born for my transgression, the fruit of
my body for the sin of my soul?

_Prophet_--He hath shewed thee, O man, what is good; and what doth the
Lord require of thee, but to do justly, and to love mercy, and to walk
humbly with thy God?[2]

In the Book of Numbers we find that Balaam had been sent for from
another country, and came from the city of Pethor. Now, in the temple
of Karnak, Thothmes III. gives a list of two hundred and eighteen towns
in Syria and Aram, which he claims to have conquered, and among them
we find Pethor. It was a city on the Upper Euphrates, not far from
Carchemish, and so was well within the circle of the Hittite dominion.
Balaam, then, may be regarded as a Hittite, or as belonging to the
Hittite confederacy,[3] and since the text quoted shows his idea of the
Divine requirements, it indicates the standard of duty which had been
arrived at by some among that people.

The rock inscriptions prove that the Hittites possessed a written
language, and this is further shown by their engraved treaty sent to
Rameses II. They appear even to have possessed a literature, for the
Egyptian records mention a certain Khilp-sira as a writer of books
among the Hittites. One of their cities in the south of Palestine was
called Kirjath-Sepher, or Book-Town, so that the place must have been
noted for writings of some kind.

The fact that the copy of the treaty sent to Rameses was engraved
upon a silver plate, with a figure of the god Sutekh in the middle,
shows that the Hittites were an artistic people also. In fact their
civilisation was far advanced. “They had walled towns, chased metal
work, chariots and horses, skilled artificers. They could carve in
stone, and could write in hieroglyphic character. All this wonderful
cultivation they possessed while Israel as yet was hardly a nation.
Thus the Bible account of the Canaan overrun by Joshua is fully
confirmed by monumental evidence.”[4]

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“A History of Egypt under the
   Pharaohs.” By Henry Brugsch-Bey. “The Empire of the Hittites.”
   By William Wright, D.D. “The Hittites: the Story of a
   forgotten Empire.” By A. H. Sayce, LL.D. “Transactions of the
   Society of Biblical Archæology.”]


             5. _Semites in Egypt before the Oppression._

If, as seems probable, the Pharaoh of Joseph was Apepi, the last of the
Shepherd Kings, and the Pharaoh of the Oppression was Rameses II., the
third king of the nineteenth dynasty, we have a period of nearly three
centuries between Joseph and the “new king who knew not Joseph.” The
period appears to be much too long to make the expression “new king”
seem natural, while at the same time a shorter period would hardly
leave room for the descendants of Jacob to multiply and become a danger
to Egypt. This perplexity is removed by the recent discovery of ancient
writings under the extensive ruins existing at Tell-el-Amarna in Upper
Egypt--a site about midway between Minieh and Siout, and on the eastern
bank of the Nile. From these documents it appears that Semites were
in great favour with Amenhotep IV. (Amenôphis), the last king of the
eighteenth dynasty, whereas the new dynasty that succeeded abominated
this foreign influence.

In the latter part of the eighteenth dynasty friendly relations
prevailed between Egypt and Mitanni or Nahrina (Aram Naharaim, Judges
iii. 8), a Mesopotamian district which lay opposite to the Hittite
city of Carchemish. Amenôphis III. married a wife from the royal house
of Mitanni; and the offspring of this marriage--Amenôphis IV.--in his
turn married Tadukhepa, daughter of Duisratta, the Mitannian king.
He was thus doubly drawn to look favourably upon the Mitannian form
of faith, which, like that of the Semites, included the adoration of
the winged solar disk. Meantime the Egyptian conquest of Palestine,
whose petty kings and governors now ruled as satraps for the Egyptian
monarch, had paved the way for strangers from Canaan and Syria to rise
into favour at Pharaoh’s court. Amenôphis IV. surrounded himself with
Semitic officers and courtiers, thus offending the nobles of Egypt;
and by forsaking the ancient religion of his country, brought about a
rupture with the powerful priesthood of Thebes. Forced to go forth,
the “heretic king” built a new capital on the edge of the desert to
the north. Here he assumed the name of Khu-en-Aten, “the glory of the
solar disk,” while his architects and sculptors consecrated a new
and peculiar style of art to the new religion, and even the potters
decorated the vases they modelled with new colours and patterns.

“The archives of the empire were transferred from Thebes to the new
residence of the king, and there stored in the royal palace, which
stood among its gardens at the northern extremity of the city. But
the existence and prosperity of Khu-en-Aten’s capital were of short
duration. When the king died he left only daughters behind him, whose
husbands assumed in succession the royal power. Their reigns lasted
but a short time, and it is even possible that more than one of them
had to share his power with another prince. At any rate it was not
long before rulers and people alike returned to the old paths. The
faith which Khu-en-Aten had endeavoured to introduce was left without
worshippers, the Asiatic strangers whom he and his father had promoted
to high offices of State were driven from power, and the new capital
was deserted never to be inhabited again. The great temple of the
solar disk fell into decay, like the royal palace, and the archives of
Khu-en-Aten were buried under the ruins of the chamber wherein they had
been kept.”

It is these archives which have now come to light, and which furnish
such extraordinary information concerning the state of Egypt and
Palestine in the century before the Oppression. In the winter of 1887
the fellahin of Egypt, searching for nitrous earth with which to
manure their fields, discovered some three hundred ancient tablets
inscribed with Babylonian cuneiform writing. The tablets are copies of
letters and despatches from the kings and governors of Babylonia and
Assyria, of Syria, Mesopotamia, and Eastern Cappadocia, of Phœnicia
and Palestine, exchanging information with the Pharaoh of Egypt, or
making reports as to the state of the country they governed. Among
the correspondents of the Egyptian sovereigns were Assurynballidh
of Assyria and Burnaburyas of Babylonia, which thus fix the date of
Khu-en-Aten to about 1430 B.C. This shows incidentally that
the Egyptologists have been quite right in not assigning the Exodus
to an earlier period than 1320 B.C., that is to say, the reign of
Menephtah, the son and successor of Rameses II.

At the date of the despatches Palestine and Phœnicia were garrisoned
by Egyptian troops, and their affairs were more or less directed by
Egyptian governors. But in some cases the native prince was allowed
to retain his title and a portion of his power. Thus Jerusalem (which
was then called Uru-’Salim--the seat or oracle of the god Salim, it
is supposed, whose temple stood on the mountain of Moriah)--was ruled
over by Ebed-tob. He appears to have been a priest rather than a king,
since he tells us that he was appointed by an oracle of the god; and
in that case the state over which he presided would be a Theocracy. Dr
Sayce considers that an unexpected light is thus thrown on the person
and position of Melchizedek. He was priest of El-Elyon, the “Most
High God,” and king only in virtue of his priestly office. His father
therefore is not named. [“Records of the Past.” New Series, vol. v.]
There were as yet no signs of the Israelites coming into the land. But
the Canaanite population was already threatened by an enemy from the
north. These were the Hittites, to whom references are made in several
of the despatches from Syria and Phœnicia. After the weakening of the
Egyptian power, in consequence of the religious troubles which followed
the death of Khu-en-Aten, the Hittites were enabled to complete their
conquests in the south, and to drive a wedge between the Semites of
the East and the West. With the revival of the Egyptian empire under
the rulers of the nineteenth dynasty the southward course of Hittite
conquest was checked; but the wars of Rameses II. against the Hittites
of Kadesh on Orontes desolated and exhausted Canaan and prepared the
way for the Israelitish invasion. Phœnicia seems to have been the
furthest point to the north to which the direct government of Egypt
extended. At any rate the letters which came to the Egyptian monarch
from Syria and Mesopotamia were sent to him by princes who called
themselves his “brothers,” and not by officials who were the “servants”
of the king.

It is wonderful to find that in the fifteenth century before our era,
active literary intercourse was carried on throughout the civilised
world of Western Asia, between Babylonia and Egypt and the smaller
states of Palestine, of Syria, of Mesopotamia, and even of Eastern
Cappadocia. And this intercourse was carried on by means of the
Babylonian language and the complicated Babylonian script. It implies
that all over the civilised East there were libraries and schools,
where the Babylonian language and literature were taught and learned.
Babylonian in fact was as much the language of diplomacy and cultivated
society as French has been in modern times, with the difference that
whereas it does not take long to read French, the cuneiform syllabary
required years of hard labour and attention before it could be
acquired. There must surely have been a Babylonian conquest. In fact,
Mr Theo. G. Pinches now finds, from a text of about B.C. 2115
to 2090, that Animisutana, king of Babylon at that time, was also king
of Phœnicia among other places. [“Records of the Past” New Series, vol.
v.]

One of the facts which result most clearly from a study of the tablets
is that, not only was a Semitic language the medium of literary
intercourse between the Pharaoh of Egypt and his officers abroad, but
that Semites held high and responsible posts in the Egyptian Court
itself. Thus we find Dudu, or David, addressed by his son as “my
lord,” and ranking apparently next to the monarch; and there are in
the Egyptian National Collection not only letters written by officials
with Egyptian names, like Khapi or Hapi (Apis), but with such Semitic
names as Rib-Addu, Samu-Addu, Bu-Dadu (the Biblical Bedad) and Milkili
(the Biblical Malchiel). A flood of light is thus poured upon a period
of Egyptian history which is of high interest for the student of the
Old Testament. In spite of the reticence of the Egyptian monuments, we
can now see what was the meaning of the attempt of Amenophis IV. to
supersede the ancestral religion of Egypt. The king was in all respects
an Asiatic. His mother, who seems to have been a woman of strong
character,--able to govern not only her son, but even her less pliable
husband,--came from the region of the Euphrates, and brought with her
Asiatic followers, Asiatic ideas, and an Asiatic form of faith. The
court became Semitised. The favourites and officials of the Pharaoh,
his officers in the field, his correspondents abroad, bore names which
showed them to be of Canaanite and even of Israelitish origin. If
Joseph and his brethren had found favour among the Hyksos princes of an
earlier day, their descendants were likely to find equal favour at the
court of “the heretic king.”

We need not wonder, therefore, if Amenophis IV. found himself compelled
to quit Thebes. The old aristocracy might have condoned his religious
heresy, but they could not condone his supplanting them with foreign
favourites. The rise of the nineteenth dynasty marks the successful
reaction of the native Egyptian against the predominance of the Semite
in the closing days of the eighteenth dynasty. It was not the founder
of the eighteenth dynasty (Aahmes, who drove out the Hyksos) but the
founder of the nineteenth dynasty that was “the new king who knew not
Joseph.” Ever since the progress of Egyptology had made it clear that
Rameses II. was the Pharaoh of the Oppression, it was difficult to
understand how so long an interval of time as the whole period of the
eighteenth dynasty could lie between him and that “new king,” whose
rise seems to have been followed almost immediately by the servitude
and oppression of the Hebrews. If Aahmes began the Oppression, how was
it that a whole dynasty passed away before the Israelites cried out?
The tablets of Tell-el-Amarna now show that the difficulty does not
exist. Up to the death of Khu-en-Aten the Semite had greater influence
than the native in the land of Mizraim.

How highly educated this old world was we are but just beginning to
learn. But we have already learned enough to discover how important
a bearing it has on the criticism of the Old Testament. It has long
been tacitly assumed by the critical school that the art of writing
was practically unknown in Palestine before the age of David. Little
historical credence, it has been urged, can be placed in the earlier
records of the Hebrew people, because they could not have been
committed to writing until a period when the history of the past had
become traditional and mythical. But this assumption can no longer be
maintained. Long before the Exodus Canaan had its libraries and its
scribes, its schools and literary men. The annals of the country, it
is true, were not inscribed in the letters of the Phœnician alphabet
on perishable papyrus; the writing material was imperishable clay, the
characters were those of the cuneiform syllabary. Though Kirjath-Sepher
(_i.e._, Book-Town) was destroyed by the Israelites, other cities
mentioned in the Tell-el-Amarna tablets, like Gaza, or Gath, or Tyre,
remained independent, and we cannot imagine that the old traditions of
culture and writing were forgotten in any of them. In what is asserted
by the critical school to be the oldest relic of Hebrew literature,
the Song of Deborah, reference is made to the scribes of Zebulon “that
handle the pen of the writer” (Judges v. 14); and we have now no longer
any reason to interpret the words in a non-natural sense, and transform
the scribe into a military commander (an officer who arranges men in a
row instead of arranging letters and words). Only it is probable that
the scribes still made use of the cuneiform syllabary, and not yet of
the Phœnician alphabet. At all events the Tell-el-Amarna tablets have
overthrown the primary foundation on which much of this criticism was
built, and have proved that the populations of Palestine, among whom
the Israelites settled, and whose culture they inherited, were as
literary as the inhabitants of Egypt or Babylonia.

But apart from such side-lights as these upon ancient history, the
discovery of the Tell-el-Amarna tablets has a lesson for us of
momentous interest. The collection cannot be the only one of its
kind. Elsewhere, in Palestine and Syria as well as in Egypt, similar
collections must still be lying under the soil. Burnt clay is not
injured by rain and moisture, and even the climate of Palestine will
have preserved uninjured its libraries of clay. Such libraries must
still be awaiting the spade of the excavator on the sites of places
like Gaza, or others whose remains are buried under the lofty mounds
of Southern Judea. Kirjath-Sepher must have been the seat of a famous
library, consisting mainly, if not altogether, of clay tablets
inscribed with cuneiform characters. As the city also bore the name of
Debir, or “Sanctuary,” we may conclude that the tablets were stored in
its chief temple, like the libraries of Assyria and Babylonia. When
such relics of the past have been disinterred--as they will be if they
are properly searched for--we shall know how the people of Canaan
lived in the days of the Patriarchs, and how their Hebrew conquerors
established themselves among them in the days when, as yet, there was
no king in Israel.

   [The information contained in this section is derived almost
   exclusively from the writings of Dr A. H. Sayce, who has
   taken a chief part in England in the decipherment of the
   Tell-el-Amarna inscriptions. See “Proc. Soc. Bib. Arch.”
   “Records of the Past.” New Series, vols, ii., iii., iv., and
   v.; “Victoria Institute Annual Address, 1889.” See additional
   facts in the _Contemporary Review_, Dec. 1890, and opinions in
   Naville’s _Bubastis_. For later excavations at Tell-el-Amarna,
   by Mr Flinders Petrie, see the _Academy_, 9th April 1892. For
   a suggestion by Conder that the tablets are in the Phœnician
   or Amorite language and writing of that time, see _Quarterly
   Statement_, July 1891.]


                         6. _Israel in Egypt._

We have seen how well the general political circumstances in Egypt
and Palestine, in the centuries before the Exodus, supplement the
Bible narrative, explaining on the one hand why the Israelites were
oppressed, and showing on the other how Canaan was prepared for their
easy conquest. But while the fact that Rameses II. was the Pharaoh for
whom Israel built “treasure cities” is demonstrated beyond reasonable
contradiction, it is remarkable that the inscriptions do not say
anything about the Israelites. We must suppose, with Brugsch, that the
captives were included in the general name of foreigners, of whom the
documents make very frequent mention. It would be satisfactory, no
doubt, to find upon some contemporary Egyptian monument, a record of
the arrival of Jacob, or the tasks imposed upon the Israelites, or the
destruction of Pharaoh’s host in the Red Sea. But the Egyptians were
not accustomed to record their defeats, and as to the labours imposed
upon the Israelites, they were but a matter of course in the case of
captives.

But short of direct mention, the Egyptian monuments and records
afford ample confirmation to the Biblical account of the Sojourn.
The Scripture references to Egyptian manners and customs are, in all
respects, accurate; and this absolute accuracy could only result from
actual contact and intimate acquaintance.

The Bible history of Abraham implies that when he visited Egypt, driven
thither by famine, that country was already under a settled government,
having a king, and princes who acted as the king’s subordinates. It
requires us to believe that the king was called Pharaoh, or by some
name or title which conveyed that sound to Hebrew ears. And further,
it assumes that Egypt was so fruitful and so prosperous, as to be a
granary for surrounding nations in years of famine. On all these points
the Bible is in harmony with what we learn from other sources.

Again, according to Genesis xii. 12, Abram feared for Sarai his wife,
lest the Egyptians should take her from him, and should kill him in
order to make the proceeding safer. The possibility of such a thing
being done by a people so civilised and cultured as the Egyptians has
sometimes been doubted: but M. Chabas has called attention to a papyrus
which actually states that the wife and children of a foreigner are
by right the lawful property of the king. In the “Tale of the Two
Brothers” also--an Egyptian romance of the days of Seti II.--we are
told that the king of Egypt sent two armies to bring a beautiful woman
to him, and to murder her husband.

In this same tale of The Two Brothers the wife of the elder solicits
the love of the younger in almost exactly the same way that the wife
of Potiphar tempts Joseph. The whole story of Joseph agrees minutely
with what we learn of Egypt from her own records. The outward details
of life, the officers of the court, the traffic in slaves, the visits
for corn, are all pictured on temple walls and stone slabs. No feature
in the Bible narrative is out of harmony with what we know of the
country from other sources. “Potiphar” appears to be a good Egyptian
name, and Egyptologists have pointed out that its probable equivalent
in hieroglyphs signifies “Devoted to the Sun-god.” Joseph’s new name,
Zaphnath-paaneah, means “Storehouse of the house of Life,” and was
given to him when he entered Pharaoh’s service, just as a new name
was given to the Hittite princess when she became Pharaoh’s wife. The
king’s absolute authority appears abundantly from Herodotus, Diodorus
and others. He enacted laws, imposed taxes, administered justice,
executed and pardoned offenders at his pleasure. He had a bodyguard,
which is constantly seen on the sculptures, in close attendance on
his person. He was assisted in the management of state affairs by the
advice of a council, consisting of the most able and distinguished
members of the priestly order. His court was magnificent and comprised
various grand functionaries, whose tombs are among the most splendid
of the early remains of Egyptian art. When he left his palace for any
purpose, he invariably rode in a chariot. His subjects, wherever he
appeared, bowed down or prostrated themselves.[5] The civilisation of
the Egyptians, even at a period long before the Israelitish Sojourn,
comprised the practice of writing, the distinction into classes or
castes, the peculiar dignity of the priests, the practice of embalming
and of burying in wooden coffins or mummy cases, the manufacture and
use of linen garments, the wearing of gold chains, and almost all the
other points which may be noted in the Bible description.

In Genesis xl. 20, Pharaoh held a feast on his birthday, and the chief
butler being restored to favour, gave the cup into Pharaoh’s hand.
We know from the Rosetta Stone that as late as the reign of Ptolemy
Epiphanes it was customary to make great rejoicing on the king’s
birthday, to consider it holy, and to do no work on it. That it should
be a day on which pardons were granted as an act of grace, is more
than probable. Cups such as the king would have taken his wine from
are portrayed on the monuments; baskets such as the baker would have
carried his bakemeats in are used even unto this day, and may be seen
in the British Museum. Before Joseph entered the royal presence he
shaved himself and changed his raiment: and here, again, the monuments
and profane history offer us illustrations. The Egyptians only allowed
their hair to grow during the times of mourning, and to neglect the
hair was considered very slovenly and dirty. When a man of low station
had to be represented, the artist always drew him with a beard. The
British Museum possesses Egyptian razors of various shapes; and in a
tomb at Beni-Hassan the act of shaving is actually represented.

With regard to the seven years of famine, it is true that Egypt was
less likely to suffer in this way than the countries round about; yet
still, when the inundation of the Nile fell below the average, it was
liable to this scourge. History tells of numerous cases in which the
inhabitants have suffered terribly from want, and several famines are
even mentioned on the monuments. Professor Rawlinson refers us to
a case which furnishes a near parallel to the famine of Joseph. In
A.D. 1064 a famine began in Egypt which lasted seven years,
and was so severe that dogs and cats, and even human flesh, were eaten;
nearly all the horses of the Caliph perished, and his family had to fly
into Syria.

When Jacob goes down into Egypt, he is advised to tell Pharaoh that he
and his sons are keepers of cattle, so that the land of Goshen may be
assigned to them, shepherds being an abomination unto the Egyptians.
The Egyptian contempt for herdsmen appears plainly on the monuments,
where they are commonly represented as dirty and unshaven, and are
sometimes even caricatured as a deformed and unseemly race. When Jacob
dies, his body is embalmed by the physicians, forty days being taken
up with the processes, and seventy days being spent in mourning. The
methods of embalming are described by Herodotus and Diodorus, and it
is stated that in preparing the body according to the first method the
operators commenced by extracting the brain and pouring in certain
drugs. Then they made an incision in the side of the body with a sharp
Ethiopian stone, and drew out the intestines, filling the cavity with
powder of pure myrrh, cassia, and other fragrant substances, and sewing
up the aperture. This being done, they salted the body, “keeping it in
natron during seventy days,” after which they washed it and wrapped
it up in bands of fine linen smeared on their inner side with gum.
Remarking upon the number of days, seventy or seventy-two, mentioned
by the two historians, Sir Gardner Wilkinson says there is reason to
believe it comprehended the whole period of the mourning, and that the
embalming process only occupied a portion of it.

Subsequently to the burial of his father, Joseph himself died, and
his body also was embalmed. At some later period there arose a king
who knew not Joseph. This monarch is generally supposed to be Rameses
II., and if the identification were correct, the indications of his
character afforded by the Book of Exodus agree exactly with what the
monuments reveal concerning that haughty oppressor; but, as already
stated, the reference is probably to Rameses I. The slavery of the
Israelites was of a kind to which all hostile or conquered people were
reduced by the Egyptians. Thothmes III., during his many campaigns,
brought to Egypt unnumbered prisoners of every race, and made them
labour like convicts on the public works, under the superintendence of
architects and overseers. On the walls of a chamber in a tomb at Thebes
there is a very instructive pictorial representation of such forced
labour, and the Asiatic countenances of the workers strongly resemble
those of the Hebrew race. The date is too early, and we may suppose
them to belong to some other nation of the Semitic family; but the
picture none the less shows the method of working under taskmasters.
Some carry water in jugs from the tank hard by; others knead and cut
up the loamy earth; others, again, by the help of a wooden form, make
the bricks, or place them carefully in long rows to dry; while the more
intelligent among them carry out the work of building the walls. The
hieroglyphic explanations inform as that the labourers are captives
whom Thothmes III. has carried away to build the temple of his father
Amon. They explain that the baking of the bricks is a work for the
new building of the provision house of the god Amon of Apet (the east
side of Thebes), and they finally declare the strict superintendence
of the steward over the foreigners. The words are--(Here are seen)
the prisoners which have been carried away as living prisoners in
very great numbers; they work at the building with active fingers;
their overseers show themselves in sight, these insist with vehemence,
obeying the orders of the great skilled lord [the head architect] who
prescribes to them the works, and gives directions to the masters;
(they are rewarded), with wine and all kinds of good dishes; they
perform their service with a mind full of love for the king; they build
for Thothmes III. a holy of holies for (the gods), may it be rewarded
to him through a range of many years.

The overseer speaks thus to the labourers at the building: “The stick
is in my hand, be not idle.”

Some of the captives thus set to labour by Thothmes belonged to
a people called the Aperiu; and in the days of Rameses II. they
are mentioned as still in a condition of servitude, quarrying and
transporting stone for the great fortress of the city of Paramessu or
Tanis.

Diodorus tells us that Rameses II. put up an inscription in each of his
buildings, saying that it had been erected by captives, and that not
a single native Egyptian was employed on the work. Again, this king
manufactured bricks for sale, and, by employing the labour of captives,
was enabled to under-sell other makers. The use of crude bricks baked
in the sun was universal throughout the country for private and for
many public buildings, and the dry climate of Egypt was peculiarly
suited to those simple materials. They had the recommendation of
cheapness, and those made three thousand years ago, whether with or
without straw, are even now as firm and fit for use as when first put
up. When made of the Nile mud or alluvial deposit they required straw
to prevent their cracking; but those formed of clay taken from the
torrent beds on the edge of the desert held together without straw; and
crude brick walls frequently had the additional security of a layer of
reeds or sticks placed at intervals to act as binders.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--Brugsch’s “Egypt under the
   Pharaohs.” Wilkinson’s “Ancient Egyptians.” Birch’s “Egypt”
   (Series, Ancient History from the Monuments). G. Rawlinson’s
   “Historical Illustrations of the Old Testament.” E. A. Wallis
   Budge, “Dwellers on the Nile.” M. E. Harkness, “Egyptian Life
   and History.”]


             7. _Buried Cities of the East--Preliminary._

If the buried cities of the East had been altogether destroyed and
lost, and we possessed only a brief record of their disappearance, the
subject might not possess much interest for us, and there would be no
material for writing a book. But we are now witnessing a resurrection
of some of them, and are recovering a story of the past, such as
revived Egyptian mummies might be able to tell. Nay, not only Egyptians
who walked about--

    “In Thebes’s streets three thousand years ago,
    When the Memnonium was in all its glory,”

but Chaldean shepherds who watched the stars and were perhaps the
first to give names to the signs of the Zodiac. The ancient relics and
records which are now being recovered from Egypt, Palestine, Assyria,
and Babylonia, revive forgotten stories of human struggle, and furnish
material for new chapters in the history of Art, Science, Laws, and
Language, of Mythology, Morals, and Religion. They also throw frequent
side lights upon the Bible narrative, and enable us to compare the
Israelites more fairly with their contemporaries and predecessors.

The catastrophes which led to the partial destruction, and the eventual
burial of the cities of the East must have seemed nothing less than
pure calamities at the time; but one of the results has been the
providential preservation of the remains for the enlightenment of
the present generation. When a buried city is unearthed, it serves
to confute the scepticism which had been growing up, and to rectify
the errors which had found their place in books of history. We are
familiar with the fact that the cities of Herculaneum and Pompeii
were overwhelmed--the former by streams of lava, the latter by
showers of ashes, pumice, and stones, from the crater of Vesuvius,
in A.D. 79. The existence of those cities had come to be
doubted, and for ages they were spoken of as “the fabulous cities;”
nevertheless, after sixteen centuries, they were brought to light,
and they present us with a picture of Roman life, such as history by
itself could never have supplied. The site of Pompeii had always borne
the name of _Civita_, or the city; and in 1748, a Spanish colonel
of engineers, having heard that the remains of a house had been
discovered, with ancient statues and other objects, obtained leave
to excavate. In a few days his labours met with encouraging reward,
and eventually about one third of the ancient city was uncovered. We
may now walk about in Pompeii, observing how its houses were built,
and how its streets were paved. We see the ruts worn by the wheels
of chariots, we note the public fountains, the temples, the theatre,
which would seat 10,000 people. We notice the corn-mills in the bakers’
shops, the vats in the dyers’ shops, and in private houses we observe
with interest the many articles of domestic use. Excepting that the
upper stories of the houses have been destroyed--either burnt by the
red-hot stones, or broken down by the weight of matter which fell
upon them--“we see a flourishing city in the very state in which it
existed nearly eighteen centuries ago--the buildings as they were
originally designed, not altered and patched to meet the exigencies of
newer fashions; the paintings undimmed by the leaden touch of time;
household furniture left in the confusion of use; articles, even of
intrinsic value, abandoned in the hurry of escape, yet safe from the
robber, or scattered about as they fell from the trembling hand, which
could not pause or stoop for its most valuable possessions: and in some
instances, the bones of the inhabitants, bearing sad testimony to the
suddenness and completeness of the calamity which overwhelmed them.”[6]

Remains of Roman London are found 16 or 17 feet underground, in the
neighbourhood of the Bank of England and the Mansion House, although
London has not been buried in volcanic ashes. Rome itself is a buried
city, for the capital of modern Italy stands upon the ruins of the
city of the Cæsars. In Eastern countries the site of an ancient city
is sometimes occupied by a squalid village, which is its degenerate
successor; in other instances the site is quite deserted, and only
a _tell_ or mound remains to call attention to it. Ancient sites
have also occasionally become submerged beneath the waters of seas
or lakes. Thus the Lake of Aboukir in Egypt was drained lately, in
order to reclaim the area for cultivation, and when the floor was laid
bare from the water, there appeared everywhere traces of streets, of
stone-covered ways, and of fields for tillage marked out by lines of
shells.

Professor Maspero describes the process by which Egyptian temples
become buried. “Just as in Europe during the Middle Ages the population
crowded most densely round about the churches and abbeys, so in Egypt
they swarmed around the temples, profiting by that security which the
terror of his name and the solidity of his ramparts ensured to the
local deity. A clear space was at first reserved round the pylons
and the walls; but in course of time the houses encroached upon this
ground, and were even built up against the boundary wall. Destroyed and
rebuilt, century after century, upon the self-same spot, the _débris_
of these surrounding dwellings so raised the level of the soil that the
temples ended for the most part by being gradually buried in a hollow,
formed by the artificial elevation of the surrounding city. Herodotus
mentions this of Bubastis, and on examination it is seen to have been
the same in many other localities. At last, when the temple had been
thrown down and was forsaken, the rubbish covered it up, and so the
ruins have been preserved to reward the modern explorer.”

  [Illustration: EGYPT & PENINSULA OF SINAI

      _London; Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co._

      _F. S. Weller, F.R.G.S._]


                     8. _Biblical Sites in Egypt._

It is justly remarked by Rev. Greville J. Chester that there is
scarcely a better or more striking commentary upon the prophets of
Israel than the present condition of the ancient Biblical cities of
Lower Egypt. For information regarding these cities--or what remains
of them, buried in the soil--we are largely indebted to the Egypt
Exploration Fund, which was founded in 1883, for the purpose of
promoting historical investigation in Egypt, by means of systematically
conducted explorations. Particular attention is given to sites which
may be expected to throw light upon obscure questions of history and
topography, such as those connected with the mysterious Hyksos period
(the period of the Shepherd Kings), the district of the Hebrew Sojourn,
the route of the Exodus, and the early sources of Greek art. Explorers
have been sent out every season, and each year has been fruitful in
discoveries. The objects of antiquity discovered are first submitted
to the Director and Conservators of the National Egyptian Museum; and
those which can be spared are divided between the British Museum and
the Museum of Fine Arts, Boston, U.S.A.

_Excavations at San._--San, in the north-eastern part of the Delta, is
the Tanis of the Septuagint and the Greek historians, and the Zoan of
the Bible. At the time of the Exodus Zoan was the capital of Egypt, and
the Pharaoh resided there. The wonders wrought by Moses and Aaron are
referred to by the Psalmist as having been manifested in the field of
Zoan (Psalm lxxviii. 43). We are told that Hebron was built only seven
years before Zoan (Num. xiii. 22), and therefore, since Hebron was
flourishing in Abraham’s time, Zoan also must have been a very ancient
city.

The modern village of San is a small collection of mud hovels, situated
on the banks of a canal, which was once the Tanitic branch of the
Nile. Near the village there are huge mounds which contain a ruined
temple and other ancient remains. The place has been to a large extent
explored by Mr W. M. Flinders Petrie, and the Memoir containing his
interesting results is published by the Egypt Exploration Fund.

Rameses II., the Pharaoh of the Oppression, seems to have fixed upon
Zoan and made it a new capital, because by its position it commanded
the northern route to Syria and placed the king, after the conquest
of that country, in easy communication with all his dominions. It was
also close to the very centre of the Hyksos rule, which was only lately
ended.

The Hyksos were the so-called Shepherd Kings, who appear to have come
from the Arabian desert, or perhaps beyond, and established themselves
in Lower Egypt at a period when native rule was weak. “The monuments
of the Hyksos are among the most curious in Egypt; and it is to San
that we owe the greater number of those brought to light. They are all
distinguished by an entirely different type of face from any that can
be found on other Egyptian monuments, a type which cannot be attributed
to any other known period; and it is therefore all the more certain
that they belong to the foreign race. Another peculiarity is that they
are without exception executed in black or grey granite. The Hyksos
only held the Delta, and occasionally more or less of Middle Egypt,
and so they had no command of the red granite quarries of Assouan,
which remained in the power of the native rulers. Whether the black
granite came from Sinai or from the Hammamat district is not certain.”
Mr F. Ll. Griffith, the coadjutor of Mr Flinders Petrie, mentions
several interesting monuments of a kind peculiar to this people. One
is a group of two men, with bushy plaited hair and long beards: they
stand with a tray of offerings in front of them, on which lie fishes,
with papyrus plants hanging round. The details are beautifully worked,
the flowers and buds being most delicately wrought. The black granite
sphinxes made by the Hyksos have been often described. They have the
flat, massive, muscular, lowering face, with short whiskers and beard
around it, the lips being shaven; and the hair is in a mat of thick,
short locks descending over the whole chest, a style copied from the
great sphinxes of the twelfth dynasty. It is a curious fact that
the inscriptions on Hyksos sphinxes, &c., are always in a line down
the right shoulder, never on the left. Mr Petrie suggests that this
honouring of the right shoulder by this Semitic people is analogous to
the particular offering of the right shoulder continually enjoined in
the Jewish law.[7] The Egyptians missed this idea, and inscribed either
side indifferently, showing no preference for the left, although that
was their side of honour.

Here at San, or Tanis, was discovered the famous Stone of San or Decree
of Canopus, which is now preserved in the National Museum of Egypt. It
bears the text of a decree made by the priests of Egypt, assembled at
Canopus (which was at that time the religious capital of the country)
in the ninth year of Ptolemy Euergetes (B.C. 254). It ordains
the deification of Berenice, a daughter of Ptolemy’s just dead, and
creates a fifth order of priests, to be called Euergetæ, for the
better paying of divine honours to the king and queen. The chief value
of the monument consists in the circumstance that the inscription is
tri-lingual, the characters being hieroglyphic (sacred), demotic (those
of everyday business), and Greek (the chief language of foreigners in
Egypt); so that, like the Rosetta Stone, it is of great use in helping
scholars to decipher the Egyptian monuments. There is a plaster cast
of this stone in the British Museum.

Mr Griffith finds that the early monuments of Tanis are suggestive of
having been brought by Rameses II. to adorn his new capital. The truth
about the age of Tanis can only be ascertained when deep excavations
are made in the mound itself, or a sufficient examination of the
extensive cemeteries has been carried out. But while the explorer is
waiting, the cemeteries are in danger of being worked out by the Arabs,
and the tombs are being destroyed for the sake of amulets to sell to
dealers and travellers.

_Tell Nebesheh_--About eight miles S.E. of Tanis (modern San) is the
low mound of Tell Nebesheh, originally known as Tell Farun--_i.e._,
the mound of Pharaoh, because of the great monolith shrine called Ras
Farun, or Pharaoh’s Head. Here Mr Petrie found, among other things,
the remains of a temple, the altar of which contained important
inscriptions. They were engraved by a certain “chief of the chancellors
and royal seal-bearer,” whose name and further titles are effaced. This
person was one of a series of officials whose titles were singularly
parallel to the English Lord High Chancellor and Lord Privy Seal. The
altar appears to belong to the Hyksos period, and it is suggested by
Mr Petrie that these officials--who were so powerful that one of them
actually appropriated for his inscriptions the royal monuments in a
public temple--were native Egyptians, the Hyksos conquerors being
only a military horde, without much civil organization, or organizing
capacity, and taking over as they found it the native bureaucracy, who
managed all the details of the needful administration of the country.
So there appears to have been a series of viziers, men who acted for
the king over the treasury and taxes, and over the royal decrees and
public documents, bearing the king’s seal.

After some further discussion of the position and importance of these
viziers, Mr Petrie says that yet one further document may be quoted
as giving and receiving light on this question: the account of Joseph
in the Book of Genesis undoubtedly refers to the Hyksos period, and
there we read, “Let Pharaoh look out a man discreet and wise, and
set him over the land of Egypt”--not, let Pharaoh give orders to his
own officers. “And Pharaoh said unto Joseph.... Thou shalt be over
my house, and according unto thy word shall all my people be ruled:
only in the throne will I be greater than thou. And Pharaoh said unto
Joseph, See, I have set thee over all the land of Egypt. And Pharaoh
took off his signet-ring from his hand, and put it upon Joseph’s hand,
and arrayed him in vestures of fine linen, and put a gold chain about
his neck; and he made him to ride in the second chariot which he had;
and they cried before him, ‘Abrech;’ and he set him over all the land
of Egypt.” Here we read of the investiture of a vizier under the
Hyksos, creating him royal seal-bearer, and giving him the honour of
the second chariot. This we now see was not an extraordinary act of an
autocrat, but the filling up of a regular office of the head of the
native administration.

_Excavations at Tell Basta_, the ancient Bubastis. A little to the
south of Zagazig, Mr Naville and Mr Griffith have made important
discoveries. Bubastis was the seat of the worship of Bast or Pasht,
the cat-headed goddess, whose temple is described by Herodotus as the
most beautiful in Egypt. It was surrounded, he tells us, by a low wall,
having figures engraved upon it. Here, accordingly, in April 1887, our
explorers began their work, in the rectangular depression surrounded on
all sides by the mounds of houses, which must have been higher than the
temple. In a short time they disclosed the site of a grand hypostyle
hall, strewn with fallen monolithic columns of twelfth dynasty
workmanship, and a hall without columns, but lined, as it should seem,
with elaborate bas-relief sculptures representing a great religious
ceremony, and containing tens of thousands of minutely-executed
hieroglyphic inscriptions. The columns and the architraves of the
hypostyle hall, though of an earlier period, are emblazoned with the
ovals of Rameses II. (nineteenth dynasty). The inscriptions of the
festival hall commemorate Osorkon II., of the twenty-second dynasty,
and his Queen Karoama. Besides the two historical landmarks thus
determined, various blocks bearing the names of Usertesen III. and Pepi
Merira testified to the existence of the edifice not only in the days
of the first great Theban Empire, but in the very remote age of the
Pyramid kings of the sixth dynasty. At the same time a small tentative
excavation at the western extremity of the site yielded the name and
titles of Nectanebo I., of the thirtieth and last native dynasty. Such
being the outcome of but four weeks’ labour at the close of the season,
it seemed reasonable to hope for important results when the excavations
should be resumed. This hope was more than fulfilled in 1888. As the
work in this instance was not carried on in the desert, but quite near
to a busy railway station, many travellers visited the place. The
scene was curiously picturesque. “Here, grouped together on the verge
of the great cemetery of Sacred Cats, are the tents of the officers
of the Fund; yonder, swarming like bees at the bottom of the huge
crater-like depression which marks the area of the temple, are seen
some three to four hundred labourers--diggers in the trenches and pits,
basket-carriers clearing away the soil as it is thrown out, overseers
to keep the diggers at work, ‘pathway-men’ to keep the paths open and
the carriers moving, gangs of brawny ‘Shayalîn,’ or native porters,
harnessed together by stout ropes, and hauling or turning sculptured
blocks which have not seen the light for many centuries; girls
with bowls of water and sponges, to wash down the carved surfaces
preparatory to the process of taking paper ‘squeezes;’ and small boys
to run errands, help with the measuring tapes, and keep guard over the
tents and baggage. With so many hands at work and so many overseers to
keep them going, it is not wonderful that the excavations make rapid
progress. The two large pits which were opened last season are now
thrown into one, and are being enlarged from east to west, following
the axis of the structure. The sides are also being cleared, and
before another month shall have expired the whole temple--of which,
apparently, not one stone remains upon another--will be visible from
end to end. Its entire length is probably about 700 or 800 feet; but
measurements, of course, are as yet purely conjectural.”

Among the discoveries at this second exploration was a third hall,
dating from the reign of Osorkon I., the walls of which were sculptured
with bas-reliefs on a large scale, representing the king in the act of
worshipping Bast and the other deities of the city. It appears that one
great divinity honoured here was Amon; and another was the god Set.

It had not been suspected that Bubastis was the site of an important
Hyksos settlement; but from the type of the statues and other things
which have been found, that turns out to have been the case.

The chronographers have preserved the names of several of the Hyksos
kings, recording them as follows:--Silites (or Salatis), Beon,
Apachnas, Tannas (or Tanras), Asseth, and Apophis (in Egyptian,
Apepi). Mariette, in his very successful excavations at Tanis, found
the name of Apepi written on the arm of a statue, although the statue
was of older date. Mr Naville has found, at Tell Basta, a colossal
statue which he takes to be the statue of Apepi. It is now in the
British Museum. This is particularly interesting, because Syncellus
relates that Apepi was the king in whose reign Joseph rose to the
high position described in Genesis. One remarkable object found at
Tell Basta is part of a seated statue, upon which the royal name reads
“Ian-Ra,” or “Ra-Ian.” The name is new to us, but when Mr Naville
went over to Boulak, where the Museum of Antiquities then was, and
showed a copy to Ahmed Kemal-ed-Deen Effendi, the learned Mohammedan
official, he exclaimed at once--“You have found the Pharaoh of Joseph.
All our Arab books call him Reiyan, the son of El Welid.” European
scholars do not place absolute reliance on Arab chronicles, which
are often fanciful; yet it is remarkable that the statue of Ian-Ra,
Joseph’s king, according to the Arabs, should be found at Tell Basta,
in close proximity to the statue of Apepi, Joseph’s king, according
to Syncellus. Mr Naville distinguishes Ian-Ra from Apepi, and thinks
he is the same as Ianias or Annas, mentioned by Josephus as the fifth
king out of six. Mr Naville has also found at Tell Basta the names
of twenty-five Pharaohs who were known already, including Cheops and
Chephren, the builders of the pyramids, about 3700 B.C.

That Joseph served a Hyksos king has long been accepted by the majority
of Egyptologists as a very probable hypothesis, both chronologically
and from the internal evidence of the Biblical narrative. The Arab
writers represent the Hyksos as Amalekites of Midian. Mr Naville agrees
with those who think they came from Mesopotamia, and already possessed
a high degree of civilisation and culture.

Bubastis seems to have been a favourite place of residence with the
Shepherd Kings; and thus Joseph would be but a short distance from his
brethren in the land of Goshen, where they looked after the king’s
herds of cattle.

_Saft-el-Henneh or Goshen._--In more than one season Mr Naville carried
on operations to discover the locality of Goshen, which had always been
matter of conjecture and controversy. He has come to the conclusion
that Goshen was a city a little to the east of the modern Zagazig,
and situated in a district of the same name. The land of Goshen may
be described as a district roughly triangular in shape, with its apex
to the south; having Zagazig at its north-west angle, Tel-el-Kebir
north-east, and Belbeis at the lower extremity. The town of Goshen
appears to have been at Saft-el-Henneh, nearly half-way between the
eastern and western points of the triangle. Here we find the name Tel
Fakûs, the Phakusa of the Greeks, and apparently the same as Kesem,
Gesem, or Goshen. Saft-el-Henneh itself is a large village, standing in
the midst of a country peculiarly fruitful, corresponding thus to “the
best of the land,” which was given to the Israelites.

“At the first glance,” says Mr Naville, “one sees that Saft-el-Henneh
stands on the site of an ancient city of considerable extent. The whole
village is constructed on the ruins of old houses, many of which are
still to be seen on the south side.”

The monuments discovered at Saft include a colossal statue, in black
granite, of Rameses II., which, probably, belonged to a temple of some
importance; and a shrine of Nectanebo II., with a dedicatory hymn, and
the information that the place where the shrine was erected was called
Kes.

The Book of Genesis tells us that Goshen was a pasture land. We
may thence infer that it was not thickly inhabited, and not yet
organized into a province with its capital, its temples, its priests,
and its governor. Since then the name is absent from the earliest
Egyptian lists of provinces--namely, those of Seti I. and Rameses
II. (the Pharaoh that oppressed Israel)--Mr Naville maintains that
the hieroglyphic records which simply omit the name, and the Bible
narrative which incidentally shows us the reason why, are remarkably in
accord.

_Heliopolis._--No excavations have yet been undertaken at Heliopolis,
the City of the Sun, which is situated some nine miles from Cairo
in a north-easterly direction. It was a very ancient city, of great
celebrity as a seat of the worship of the sun god _Ra_, whose symbol
in the form of the living bull Mnevis, was there kept and cared for
and reverenced. In the Bible the city is called On or Beth Shemesh.
Joseph probably served Potiphar in this city; and Pharaoh afterwards
gave him to wife Asenath, daughter of Potiphera, a priest of On. There
can be little doubt, either, that Moses, who was learned in all the
wisdom of the Egyptians, was educated at this seat of learning. We
must believe, therefore, that he often looked upon the six obelisks
which stood in front of the temple of Ra--one of which remains to this
day--for they had been erected centuries before his birth. Four of them
were set up by Thothmes III. and his family, about 1600 years before
the Christian era, and the other two by Usertesen I. upwards of 3000
years B.C. Two of the Thothmes obelisks were at a later period
transferred to Alexandria, to adorn the approach of a magnificent
temple erected in honour of the Cæsars; and it is one of these two
which has become known as Cleopatra’s Needle and now stands on the
Thames Embankment. The one obelisk which remains at Heliopolis is the
oldest object of the kind in the world.

Scarcely anything is now to be seen of the city itself. It no doubt
served as a handy quarry to the builders of Cairo; but since the
surviving obelisk is buried 3 or 4 feet in Nile mud, it is not
improbable that many small objects of antiquarian interest are buried
also. Moreover, the sides of the vast enclosure in which the temple was
situated are still marked by mounds or walls of crude brick, and these,
on the north side, have their continuation in the ruins of the ancient
town. Here are frequently found scarabæi or images of the sacred
beetle, with other sacred images, emblems in porcelain, and other
antiquities, so that apparently the place would repay a systematic
search.

_Tell Defenneh_, the Biblical Tahpanhes.--In June 1886 Mr Flinders
Petrie had the felicity to discover “Pharaoh’s House,” to which
Jeremiah was brought, after the calamities in Judea, and where he hid
the great stones, as a symbolical act, in the mortar of the brickwork.
It lies in the sandy desert bordering on Lake Menzaleh, about two
days’ journey from San, some hours distant on the one hand from the
cultivated Delta, and on the other hand from the Suez Canal. Here in
the midst of the plain are the brick ruins of a large building; and on
the first evening of his arrival in the district Mr Petrie heard to his
surprise that the building was known as the _Kasr el Bint el Yehudi_,
or the Palace of the Jew’s daughter. Obviously this might refer to
the daughter of King Zedekiah who accompanied Jeremiah in his exile;
and there could now be no doubt that Defenneh represented the ancient
Daphnai and Tahpanhes. It was a frontier fortress or advanced post, to
guard the great highway into Syria.

By the associations of Tahpanhes we are at once carried to Scripture.
“The children of Noph and Tahpanhes have broken the crown of thy head”
(Jer. ii. 16). This was after the slaying of Josiah, the deposition
of Jehoahaz, the setting up of the tributary Jehoiakim, and the
removal of Jehoahaz into Egypt--events which marked the first period
of intercourse between Jews and Greeks. “This intercourse, however,
was soon to be increased; three years later, Nebuchadnezzar invaded
Judea, and all who fled from the war would arrive at Tahpanhes in
their flight into Egypt, and most likely stop there. In short, during
all the troubles and continual invasions and sieges of Jerusalem, in
B.C. 607, B.C. 603, and B.C. 599 (in which a wholesale deportation of
the people took place), and, above all, in the final long siege and
destruction of 590-588 B.C., when “the city was broken up,” and all the
men of war fled, every one who sought to avoid the miseries of war, or
who was politically obnoxious, would naturally flee down into Egypt.
Such refugees would necessarily reach the frontier fort on the caravan
road, and would there find a mixed and mainly foreign population,
Greek, Phœnician, and Egyptian, among whom their presence would not be
resented, as it would be by the still strictly protectionist Egyptians
further in the country. That they should largely, or perhaps mainly
settle there would be the most natural course; they would be tolerated,
they would find a constant communication with their own countrymen, and
they would be as near to Judea as they could in safety remain, while
they awaited a chance of returning.

“The last and greatest migration to Tahpanhes is that fully recorded
by Jeremiah, which gives us the pattern of what doubtless had been
going on long before. After Nebuchadnezzar had retired with his spoils,
Gedaliah, the governor whom he set up, was quickly slain, the country
fell into anarchy, and all the responsible inhabitants who were left
fled into Egypt to avoid the vengeance of Nebuchadnezzar. ‘Johanan the
son of Kareah, and all the captains of the forces, took all the remnant
of Judah, that were returned (from all nations, whither they had been
driven), to sojourn in the land of Judah; the men, and the women, and
the children, and the king’s daughters [Zedekiah’s], and every person
that Nebuzaradan, the captain of the guard, had left with Gedaliah
the son of Ahikam the son of Shaphan, and Jeremiah the prophet, and
Baruch the son of Neriah; and they came into the land of Egypt; for
they obeyed not the voice of the Lord: and they came even to Tahpanhes’
(Jer. xliii. 5-7).” This migration was undertaken in spite of the
warnings of Jeremiah.

Pharaoh Hophra, the reigning monarch in Egypt, had been an ally of King
Zedekiah’s, and so he placed at the disposal of his friend’s daughter
the palace in this frontier fortress of Tahpanhes, which had been a
royal residence sometimes. Here we may suppose the fugitives would
have been comparatively contented, and thought themselves safe, only
that Jeremiah vehemently prophesied that Nebuchadnezzar would come and
destroy the place. This, according to Josephus, he did--“He fell upon
Egypt, ... and took those Jews that were there captives, and led them
away to Babylon; and such was the end of the nation of the Hebrews”
(Ant. ix. 7). Josephus is not always believed, and it has even been
denied in recent years that Nebuchadnezzar was ever in Egypt at all.
But a recently discovered inscription tells us that he was in the
country, and penetrated as far south as Assouan;[8] and now at last Mr
Petrie discovers the palace to have been plundered, dismantled, and
burnt, apparently in fulfilment of Jeremiah’s prediction.

The existing remains of Tahpanhes are extensive, and show that the
ancient city was a large one. Under the corners of the chief buildings
were found _plaques_ of metal and of stone, engraved with the cartouche
of Psammetichus I.; and under the south-east corner the teeth and bones
of an ox, sacrificed at the ceremony when the building was founded.
Among the antiquities found are beautiful painted Greek vases, plaques,
&c., of gold, silver, lead, and copper, articles of carnelian, jaspar,
and lapis lazuli.

A most interesting thing is the finding of the brickwork or pavement
spoken of in Jeremiah xliii. 8. “Then came the word of the Lord unto
Jeremiah in Tahpanhes, saying, Take great stones in thine hand, and
hide them in mortar in the brickwork which is at the entry of Pharaoh’s
house in Tahpanhes, in the sight of the men of Judah; and say unto
them, Thus saith the Lord of Hosts, the God of Israel: Behold I will
send and take Nebuchadnezzar the King of Babylon, my servant, and will
set his throne upon these stones that I have hid; and he shall spread
his royal pavilion over them, &c.” This brickwork or pavement at the
entry of Pharaoh’s house has always been misunderstood, and served as a
puzzle to translators. “But” (says Mr Petrie) “as soon as the plan of
the palace began to be recovered, the exactness of the description was
manifest. On the north-west of the fort was a great open air platform
of brickwork, such as is now seen outside all great houses, and most
small ones, in Egypt. A space is reserved outside the door, generally
along the side of the house, covered with hard beaten mud, edged with
a ridge of bricks if not much raised from the ground, and kept swept
clean. On this platform the inhabitants sit when they wish to converse
with their neighbours or the passers-by. A great man will settle
himself to receive his friends and drink coffee, and public business
is generally transacted there. Such seems to have been the object of
this large platform--a place to meet persons who would not be admitted
to the palace or fort, to assemble guards, to hold large _levées_,
to receive tribute and stores, to unlade goods, and to transact the
multifarious business which in such a climate is best done in the open
air. At the same time the actual way into the palace was along a raised
causeway which rose at the back of this platform.

“This platform” (continues Mr Petrie) “is therefore unmistakably
‘the brickwork or pavement which is at the entry of Pharaoh’s house
in Tahpanhes.’ Here the ceremony described by Jeremiah took place
before the chiefs of the fugitives assembled on the platform, and here
Nebuchadnezzar ‘spread his royal pavilion.’ The very nature of the
site is precisely applicable to all the events. Unhappily, the great
denudation which has gone on has swept away most of this platform, and
we could not expect to find the stones whose hiding is described by
Jeremiah.”

Another discovery, made some years ago, looks like evidence that
Nebuchadnezzar actually came to Tahpanhes. A native sold to the
Boulak Museum three cylinders of terra cotta, such as would be used
for foundation memorials, the text on them being an inscription of
Nebuchadnezzar’s referring to his constructions in Babylon. These
cylinders were said to come from the Isthmus of Suez, but it is
strongly suspected that they were found at Defenneh, after the platform
had become denuded.

_Tell-el-Yahoudeh_, the Mound of the Jew.--This place should be
interesting to us, if only from the fact that a temple was built here,
which some have fancied would be the counterpart of the Temple at
Jerusalem. If any considerable remains of the temple can be found, they
may assist materially the right understanding of the descriptions which
have come down to us of the more important structure on Mount Moriah.

Tell-el-Yahoudeh is about twenty miles from Cairo, on the way to
Ismailia, near the Moslem village of Shibeen-el-Kanater, and is
supposed to be the city of Onias. Josephus tells us that at the time of
the conquest of Judea by Antiochus Epiphanes, Onias, son of the high
priest, fled from the persecution, and took refuge in Egypt (B.
C. 182). Onias, feeling encouraged by a prophecy of Isaiah’s that
a time should come when there would be “an altar to the Lord in the
midst of the land of Egypt” (Isaiah xix. 19), begged the Egyptian king,
Ptolemy Philometor, to grant him permission to build a temple, on the
site of a deserted shrine or fortress. The request was granted, and
Onias built a small city, after the model of Jerusalem, and a temple,
after the pattern of the temple of Solomon.

The mound now existing measures about half a mile from east to west,
and a quarter of a mile from north to south, and has the appearance
of a fortress. It has been more or less ransacked at various times;
but would probably still repay a thorough exploration. In the absence
of a full investigation there remains a little doubt about the
genuineness of the site; but Professor Sayce, on one occasion, found
here a fragment of stone, bearing two ancient Hebrew letters; and the
decisive proof that it was a Jewish settlement has been furnished by
the discovery of a Jewish cemetery, about one mile further east in the
desert. The ground there, for the length of more than half a mile,
is quite honeycombed with tombs. Here and there a body was found _in
situ_, and there were no traces of embalming, nor any ornament of any
kind, but invariably a brick under the head, which was a distinctive
mark of Jewish burials. A few tablets had escaped the general
destruction, and the names which they contained fully confirmed the
conclusion suggested by the mode of burial: “Eleazar” was one name
and is purely Jewish: some others were Jewish with a Greek ending, as
Salamis, Nethaneus, Barchias; and others still were Greek names of
frequent use among the Jews, as Aristobulos, Onesimas, Tryphania.

_Tell-el-Maskhuta_ or Pithom-Succoth.--The Pharaoh who enslaved the
Israelites appears to have been Rameses II., son of Seti I., of the
nineteenth dynasty. This dynasty only began with Rameses I., the
grandfather of Rameses II. The store cities built by the Israelites
were called Raamses and Pithom; and when the Exodus took place the
starting point was Rameses and the first resting-place Succoth (Ex.
i. 11; xii. 37). None of these places were known, and it had hardly
been suspected that Pithom and Succoth were so closely associated
as they are now found to be. But the site of Pithom has lately been
discovered. We all remember Kassassin, where Sir Garnet Wolseley halted
the British troops, in the campaign of 1882, just before that silent
midnight march to storm Arabi’s entrenchments. It is twelve miles west
of Ismailia on the Suez Canal. Close by Kassassin is a low mound called
_Tell-el-Maskhuta_, the Mound of the Statue. Here, at the end of the
last century, was found a red granite monolith, representing Rameses
II. sitting between the two solar gods Ra and Tum. In 1860 M. Paponot’s
men came across another monolith, and it is probable that the pair
stood symmetrically at the entrance of some edifice. Further excavation
brought to light two sphinxes in black granite, placed also on each
side of the avenue; and then, farther on, a shrine or _naos_ in red
sandstone, and a large _stele_ in red granite, lying flat. All these
monuments had been dedicated to the god Tum.

The excavations recently made by M. Edouard Naville, of Geneva, are
described in his Memoir written for the Egypt Exploration Fund, from
which Memoir we glean the following interesting information. The city
was called Pi Tum, which means the house or abode of Tum (the god of
the setting sun), and the surrounding district was called Thuku or
Thukut, which is equivalent to Succoth. It is a mere philological
accident that the Hebrew language has a word succoth, signifying
_tents_. The inscriptions appear to show that it was Rameses II. who
caused the city to be built; and in this they do but confirm the view
previously entertained by Egyptologists. Pithom was both a store city
and a fortress, and so was surrounded by very thick walls, part of
which are yet preserved. The civil city of Thuku extended all round the
sacred buildings of Pithom. We have first of all a square area enclosed
by enormous brick walls, the space within being equal to 55,000 square
yards. In the south-west angle is a small temple. The wall enclosure
is honeycombed with rectangular chambers, well built, the bricks being
of Nile mud, and united by mortar. It is a curious fact that some of
the bricks contain straw, while others are without. These chambers M.
Naville believes to be the granaries into which Pharaoh gathered the
provisions necessary for armies about to cross the desert, and perhaps
for caravans and travellers, who were on the road to Syria.

Pithom, according to the Coptic version of the Scriptures, was the
place where Joseph went up to meet Jacob--“near Pithom, the city in the
land of Rameses” (Gen. xlvi. 28). It is true that the LXX., supported
by Josephus, make Heroopolis to be the meeting-place; but it is not
unlikely that Heroopolis was a later name for Pithom itself. The Greeks
were succeeded by the Romans, traces of whose habitations are to be
seen on all sides.

When the Romans levelled the ground for their camp, they destroyed
without mercy an immense number of inscriptions, which would have
been most precious to us now. Of those which remain, by far the most
important is the great tablet of Philadelphus, measuring 4 feet 3
inches, by 3 feet 2 inches, which was found near the _naos_. It is
stated in the inscription that the king ordered it to be erected
_before his father Tum, the great god of Succoth_. It records what
was done for Pithom by the king, and his queen and sister Arsinoe. We
learn from it that Pithom and the neighbouring city of Arsinoe, which
the king founded in honour of his sister, were the starting points of
commercial expeditions to the Red Sea; and that from thence one of
Ptolemy’s generals went to the land of the Troglodytes, and founded
the city of Ptolemais Θηριῶν, for the special purpose of
facilitating the chase of elephants. And it was to Heroopolis that the
ships brought the animals (so that if Heroopolis was Pithom, and Pithom
was Maskhuta, the navigable water must have extended farther northward
than it does at present). We learn also that close to Pithom there was
a city called Pikerehat, or Pikeheret, apparently the Pi-ha-hiroth
mentioned in the narrative of the Exodus.

It was suggested by the late Dr Birch that the Israelites, besides
building store cities, were compelled, like convicts or captives of
war, to labour on the forts of Tanis, and on the line of the great wall
which protected Egypt on the north-east. This long wall extended from
Pelusium southwards, and had been built to keep out the tribes of the
desert and other invaders from the Asiatic side. From the “Adventures
of Sinuhit,” a narrative dating from the twelfth dynasty, it appears
to have been of very early construction; for the fugitive there says,
“I reached the walls of the prince, which he has constructed to repel
the Sittiu and to destroy the Nomiu-Shaiu; I remained in a crouching
posture among the bushes, for fear of being seen by the guard,
relieved each day, which keeps watch from the summit of the fortress:
I proceeded on my way at nightfall.”[9] The wall appears to have been
renovated by Seti I. and Rameses II., and strengthened by forts, built
after the Canaanite models which the Pharaohs had seen in the course
of their campaigns. The Egyptians, not content with appropriating the
thing, appropriated also the name, and called these frontier towers by
the Semitic name of _Magdilu_ or Migdols. In a later reign, an officer
who had been sent to recapture two runaway slaves, reports that he did
not overtake them until he had got beyond the region of the wall, to
the north of the Migdol of King Seti Menephtah.[10]

      [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Biblical Sites in Lower Egypt.”
   By Greville J. Chester, B.A., in the Survey Memoirs, P. E.
   Fund. “Tel-el-Yahoudeh.” By Prof. T. Hayter Lewis, F.S.A.,
   in Trans. Soc. Bib. Archæol., vol. vii. “The Store-City of
   Pithom.” By M. Naville, Egypt Exploration Fund. “Goshen.” By
   M. Naville, E. E. Fund. “Daphnae.” By W. M. Flinders Petrie,
   E. E. Fund. “Tanis.” By W. M. Flinders Petrie, E. E. Fund.
   Murray’s Handbook, “Egypt.”]


                     9. _The Route of the Exodus._

As Succoth was the first station of the Israelites in leaving Egypt,
and we now know the locality, we begin to be able to trace their
route. Starting from Rameses--a city not yet identified, but perhaps
near the present Zagazig[11]--two courses were open to them. They
might go northward, past the city of Zoan, and then skirt the coast
of Philistia--the route generally taken by the great conquerors, and
by much the nearer way. But there were objections against taking it,
for “it came to pass in the course of those many days that the king
of Egypt died” (Exod. ii. 23), and the new Pharaoh, Menephtah, son
and successor of Rameses II., was holding his Court at Zoan at this
time,[12] and had his chariots and his horsemen about him. Nor must we
forget the great wall and its fortresses, which in that direction would
bar the way. “It was a wall,” says Mr Poole, “carefully constructed,
with scarp and counter-scarp, ditch and glacis, well manned by the
best troops, the sentinel on the ramparts day and night.” Prudence
would seem to say that this route should not be attempted. The course
actually taken appears to have been from Rameses eastward, along
the valley Tumilat and the line of the canal which had been made by
Seti I. They then encamped at Succoth, probably for the same reason
that the British encamped there in 1882, namely, that there was
abundance of forage and water, and a defensible position. The next
station was “Etham, in the edge of the wilderness,” northward from
Pithom-Succoth, we may suppose, for they seem to have been marching
(perhaps for a feint) as though they would take the short route through
the Philistine country. But then they received the command to “turn
back and encamp before Pi-ha-hiroth, between the Migdol and the sea,
before Baal-Zephon, over against it by the sea.” They obeyed, and to
understand the course they actually pursued, we must take into account
some recent geological discoveries. It is not the aim of the present
writer to put forth original views of his own, but rather to explain
the conclusions arrived at by the ablest investigators. In accordance
with this design, it will be desirable here to introduce a paragraph
from Major Henry Spencer Palmer, who shared with Colonel Sir Charles
Wilson the command of the Sinai Survey Expedition.

“The character and scene of the Red Sea passage--the greatest event
which ancient history records--have in all ages been the subject of
controversy, according to the variously proposed systems of topography,
and the extent to which men have admitted or denied the operation of
miraculous agency. Some, holding to the strict interpretation of such
passages as, ‘The waters were a wall unto them on their right hand and
their left’ (Exod. xiv. 20), ‘The floods stood upright as an heap’ (Ps.
xv. 8), ‘He made the waters to stand as an heap’ (Ps. lxxvii. 15), have
inferred that the deep sea must have been literally parted asunder,
and that through the chasm thus formed the Israelites passed, with a
sheer wall of water on either side of them. By such, the scene of the
passage has been fixed at six, ten, fifty, and even sixty miles below
Suez, and the position of the city of Rameses has been varied to meet
the several theories as to the crossing place. The advocates of these
views, apparently anxious to aggrandise the miracle to the utmost, and
discarding from fair consideration the physical agency which Scripture
expressly mentions as the direct means by which the passage was made
practicable, have, however, overlooked or evaded the difficulty of
explaining how the fugitives, with their flocks and herds, could have
travelled over the sharp coral rocks, and vast quantities of seaweed
which cover the sea-bottom at these points. The obvious difficulty
also, that a short way below Suez, the breadth of the sea becomes too
great for the passage to have been effected within the limits of time
given in the narrative, without some preternatural acceleration of
speed, of which Scripture gives no hint or mention, has never been met
satisfactorily. There is the yet greater difficulty that a wind strong
enough to have produced upon deep water the extraordinary effect which
is supposed, would have been much too violent for any man or body
of men to have stood up against it. Lastly, there is the impossible
supposition that Pharaoh and his host would have been mad enough to
rush to their doom in this fearful chasm.”

Of late years, however, the theory of a deep-water passage has
been practically abandoned. Modern critics prefer an intelligent
interpretation, according to known natural laws, of the words of Exodus
xiv. 21, 22, which lay stress upon the _east wind_ as the direct
natural agent by which the sea bottom was for the time made dry land.

Major Palmer mentions the presence of marine shells in the Bitter Lake
as showing that it was formerly filled with salt water from the Gulf
of Suez. He says further:--“This communication subsequently became
broken by the gradual elevation of the neck of land eleven miles long
which now separates the lakes from the head of the gulf--an interesting
fulfilment of the prophecy in Isaiah xi. 15--‘and the Lord shall
utterly destroy the tongue of the Egyptian sea.’ Darius, about B.C.
500, restored the connection by cutting a canal through the isthmus,
which after a period of disuse was reopened by Ptolemy Philadelphus,
about B.C. 250. Traces of Darius’s canal are still seen, in
a very perfect state, though its bed has since risen above the level
of high water in the gulf. If, as can hardly be doubted, there was a
connection, at least tidal, between the lakes and the gulf at the time
of the Exodus, the only course eastward from Egypt which would have
been ordinarily practicable for the march of hosts, must have passed
to the north of the Great Bitter Lake, crossing the belt of dry ground
which, interrupted only by the Timsah and Ballah Lakes, extends between
it and the Menzaleh Lake, and the Children of Israel must have been
following one such route when, at Etham, they were directed to turn and
encamp before Pi-ha-horoth.”

These views of Major Palmer’s are shared by M. Naville, by Sir
Wm. Dawson, and others, and have been decisively confirmed by the
geological survey of the region. In 1883 the Committee of the Palestine
Exploration Fund sent out Professor Hull, the eminent geologist,
accompanied by Major Kitchener, R.E., and other competent men, and
this party investigated the geology of Lower Egypt, of the Desert of
Sinai, the Valley of the Arabah, and the southern portion of Palestine.
The results were very remarkable. It appears, for instance, that at a
distant period of the past the waters of the seas, lakes, and gulfs
of all this region stood some two hundred feet higher than they do
now--the proof being found in the fact that at the height of two
hundred feet the limestone rocks have been bored into by the well-known
“shell-fish,” the pholas, while the sands and gravels at that height
contain shells and corals and crinoids, of the same species as those
which still inhabit the waters of the Gulf of Suez. With the waters at
that height the whole of Lower Egypt would be submerged, together with
extensive tracts on either side of the Gulf of Suez. But this occurred
in the distant past, probably many ages before mankind dwelt in these
regions at all. There was, however, a more recent period, as the land
slowly rose out of the waters--and Professor Hull thinks it may have
coincided with the time of the Exodus--when the waters were just 26
feet higher than they are at present, and then, although Lower Egypt
would not be submerged, the Gulf of Suez must have extended northward
as far as the Bitter Lakes, making an arm of the sea about a mile wide
and 20 or 30 feet deep.

It is suggested by M. Naville that the Israelites, when they turned
back from Etham, came down on the western side of this arm of the sea,
and got into a defile, so that they appeared to be caught in a trap.
Pharaoh thought so, and said, “They are entangled in the land, the
wilderness hath shut them in;” and so he pursued them, and thought to
obtain an easy victory. But Moses had clear knowledge of what he was
to do. Although the waters of the gulf were for the most part 20 or 30
feet deep, and quite impassable, there was one place (near the present
Châluf) where they were quite shallow, where the land now is 26 feet
higher than the waters, and where, at that time, reeds were growing.
This part of the gulf was a shallow sea of reeds: and what the Hebrew
Bible really says is that the Israelites crossed the sea of reeds--_yam
Souph_[13]--which was the former extension of the Red Sea northwards.
This place was so shallow that when the north-east wind blew,
co-operating with a retreating tide, it was liable to be rendered dry;
and because the tribes of the Desert used then to rush in, through this
temporary gateway, and carry off the cattle, and plunder the fertile
district around Pithom, the Pharaohs had established a watch-tower
here--one of their Migdols. The Israelites “encamped between the Migdol
and the sea:” then the north-east wind arose and made the passage dry,
so that they were able to pass over. Their God had made a way for them.
If this explanation, which is now very generally received, should be
finally established, it must for ever silence all objections as to the
credibility of this part of the Scripture narrative.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“The Store-City of Pithom.” By
   M. Naville, Egypt Exploration Fund. “Sinai.” By Major H.
   Spencer Palmer, R.E. “The Desert of the Exodus.” By Prof. E.
   H. Palmer. “Sinai and Palestine.” By Dean Stanley. “Egypt and
   Sinai.” By Sir J. Wm. Dawson.]


                   10. _The Wilderness Wanderings._

All questions regarding the actual route of the Israelites and the
true Mount Sinai were carefully studied during the Ordnance Survey
of the Sinai Desert in 1868-9. The expedition was conducted by Major
Henry Spencer Palmer, R.E., and Colonel Sir Charles Wilson, R.E., and
the results were published in 1872, by authority of the Treasury, in
five massive folio volumes. It may be fairly said that this expedition
vindicated the accuracy of the Bible narrative; for the late Prof. E.
H. Palmer, who was one of the party, and kept his own daily journal as
they went along, assures us that the Bible narrative reads exactly like
a daily journal kept by a member of a travelling party. A traveller
begins by setting down his first impressions, which are often corrected
in his later notes as the result of further experience; and Palmer
pointed to such evidences of authenticity in the Bible story.

The results of the Survey of Sinai only concern us here so far as they
relate to discoveries of ruins and relics of the past.

The mining district of the peninsula of Sinai became subject to
Egyptian rule at a very early time--probably some 3200 years before the
Christian era--and the sculptured records of their occupation spread
over a period of some 2000 years. On tablets at the mouth of one of the
caves at Maghárah, King Senefru and his successor Cheops (who built the
Great Pyramid) are represented, the one conquering a shepherd of the
East, the other striking to the earth an Asiatic foe. “On the opposite
cliffs” (says Major Palmer) “are the remains of the ancient settlement,
comprising the dwellings of the miners, who probably were prisoners
of war, and the barracks of their military guards. Flint and stone
implements, such as arrow-heads and spear-heads, flint chisels and
knives, and rude hammer-heads of green-stone, are found amongst these
ruins.”

At Sarábit el Khádim, ten or twelve miles further inland, where a new
field of mining was discovered about the time that Maghárah began to
show signs of exhaustion, there are ruins of two temples, built of
well-cut stone, without mortar, the walls and vestibule being covered
with Egyptian scenes.

But we are chiefly concerned to know whether any traces eremain of
the Israelitish Sojourn, and especially any of a character to throw
additional light on Scripture. Of course a wandering people, dwelling
in tents, would not leave evidence of their passage in buried cities;
and what we have rather to look for is deserted camps. One such camp
at least is reasonably identified now as Kibroth Hattaavah, where the
people were fed with quails (Num. xi. 33). The Scripture narrative
says that they journeyed thence to Hazeroth, and abode there. About
thirty miles north-east of Jebel Musa, at a spot called _Erweis el
Ebeirig_, are some old stone remains to which a legend attaches
which very strikingly recalls the Scripture statement, and may very
possibly contain some grain of truth. “These ruins” (say the Arabs)
“are the remains of a large pilgrim or Hajj caravan, which in remote
ages stopped here on the way to Hazeroth, and was afterwards lost
in the Tih, and never again heard of.” Hazeroth, the name of which
still survives in ’Ain Hudherah, is fifteen miles further on towards
’Akabah. The Bádiet et Tih is by interpretation the wilderness of the
wanderings, and is a sort of peninsula of higher ground which projects
down into the Sinai desert from the north. Major Palmer tells us that
the ruins at Erweis el Ebeirig form a class by themselves, differing
from all other ancient remains hitherto found in the peninsula. Though
there are a few stone houses, the remains consist chiefly of a great
number of small enclosures of stone, mostly circular, and extending
over several square miles of country. The stones are not set on end;
their arrangement is not unlike that which may be seen on spots where
an Arab encampment has been, though they certainly cannot be taken for
Arab remains. The large enclosures intended for important personages,
and the hearths or fire-places, can still be distinctly traced, showing
conclusively that it is a large deserted camp. In the neighbourhood,
but beyond the camp area, are a number of stone heaps, which, from
their shape and position, are probably burial places without the camp,
though none have yet been examined.

Between the Tih wilderness and Judea, is the Negeb or “South Country”
of Scripture, now a deserted and barren wilderness, but shown by
Professor E. H. Palmer to be full of the most interesting traces of
former inhabitants and cultivation. In the Scripture narrative of the
wanderings we read about Kadesh Barnea, where Miriam died, and whence
the spies went up to Eshkol and obtained the grapes. The identification
of Kadesh Barnea had long been difficult and disputed, until it was
discovered, in the year 1840, by Dr Rowlands to be _’Ain Gadis_ (or
_Qades_) in Jebel Magráh, on the south-west frontier of the Negeb. The
name _Gadis_ is identical in meaning and etymology with the Kadesh
of the Bible, while the word _’Ain_ means a fountain; so that Kadesh
Barnea can scarcely be said to have changed its name. The place is a
picturesque oasis, and from under a ragged spur of solid rock, regarded
by Rowlands as “the cliff” smitten by Moses, there issues an abundant
stream. Professor Palmer, visiting the district some thirty years
after, failed to find this great spring, but it was discovered again by
Rev. F. W. Holland in 1878, and by Dr Clay Trumbull of America in 1881;
and Dr Trumbull’s book on Kadesh Barnea is now the fullest source of
information.

Mr Holland’s record of the Sinai Survey Expedition is printed at the
end of the volume on the “Recovery of Jerusalem,” published by the
Palestine Exploration Fund. Mr Holland endeavours to trace the route
of the Israelites, to fix the stations, to identify the spot where the
battle of Rephidim was fought, and to make more intelligible the entire
story. Traditions of the passage of the children of Israel through
the country are common enough, he says. The physical conditions of
the country are such as to render it quite possible that the events
recorded in the Book of Exodus occurred there. The route of the
Israelites has not indeed been laid down with absolute certainty, but
much light has undoubtedly been thrown upon it by the explorations that
have been made. Mr Holland concludes by declaring that “not a single
member of the expedition returned home without feeling more firmly
convinced than ever of the truth of that sacred history which he found
illustrated and confirmed by the natural features of the desert. The
mountains and valleys, the very rocks, barren and sun-scorched as they
now are, seem to furnish evidences, which none who behold them can
gainsay, that this was that ‘great and terrible wilderness’ through
which Moses, under God’s direction, led His people.”

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Explorations in the Peninsula
   of Sinai.” By Rev. F. W. Holland (in volume on the “Recovery
   of Jerusalem”). “Sinai.” By Major H. S. Palmer. “The Desert
   of the Exodus.” By Professor E. H. Palmer. “The Desert of the
   Tih.” By Prof. E. H. Palmer (in the volume of Special Papers,
   P. E. Fund.)]

   [Nothing is said in this section about the Sinaitic
   Inscriptions, because it has long ago been settled by scholars
   that they are Nabathean pilgrim texts of the third and fourth
   centuries, A.D., written by travellers who were then
   visiting the Sinai convent and the hermitage of Wâdy Feirân,
   and the traders who passed from Petra on the way to Egypt.
   They were first read by Beer in 1840, and the authoritative
   work upon them is that of Levy in 1860. In 1868-9, Prof. E.
   H. Palmer confirmed their results. For further references see
   Major Conder in _Quarterly Statement_, Jan. 1892.]



                              CHAPTER II.

                              PALESTINE.


                       1. _Palestine generally._

It will be a useful preliminary to our study of Palestine if we give
here a short list of the expeditions sent out by the Committee of the
Palestine Exploration Fund.

We were already greatly indebted to many explorers--Dr Robinson,
Burckhardt, Van de Velde, &c., for the geography, and M. Lartet for the
geology, but there had never been any organised party in Palestine,
properly equipped for a scientific survey. In 1864 Jerusalem was
properly surveyed by Captain Wilson, R.E., at the expense of Lady
Burdett Coutts, and an excellent map of the city was published. Then
the happy idea occurred to Mr George Grove, at that time Secretary
of the Crystal Palace Company, but also known for his topographical
articles in Dr Smith’s “Dictionary of the Bible,” that the time was
ripe for a systematic survey of the entire country. His energy brought
together an influential company at a public meeting in Willis’s
Rooms, on the 22nd June 1865, the Archbishop of York being in the
chair, and a Society was at once formed. The Archbishop of York was
elected President, Mr George Grove, Hon. Secretary, and the first
Committee included the names of the Duke of Argyll, the Earl of
Shaftesbury, A. H. Layard, M.P., Walter Morrison, M.P., Dean Stanley,
Sir Henry Rawlinson, Rev. H. B. Tristram, F.R.S., and others equally
distinguished. The Archbishop, in his opening address, laid down the
principles on which the work of the Society should be based--namely,
that it should be a scientific society, carrying out its work in
a scientific way, and should abstain from controversy. To these
principles the Society has steadily adhered, and it has been (as it has
called itself) “A Society for the accurate and systematic investigation
of the archæology, topography, geology, and physical geography,
natural history, manners, and customs of the Holy Land, for Biblical
illustration.”

The first expedition was sent out in 1866, under Captain Wilson, R.E.,
and Lieutenant Anderson, R.E., and landed at Beyrout. During six months
this party carefully probed the country from Damascus to Hebron,
and finally made its report in favour of commencing excavations at
Jerusalem.

In 1867 Lieutenant Warren, R.E., was despatched to Jerusalem, with a
party of non-commissioned officers, to commence the excavations. This
work was continued until 1870. In 1868 the Moabite Stone was discovered
by Rev. F. Klein, and in 1870 M. Clermont Ganneau, an archæologist
employed by the Society, found an inscribed stone belonging to Herod’s
temple.

To the same year 1870 belongs the Survey of Sinai, conducted by Major
H. S. Palmer and Captain Wilson, and to 1871 Professor E. H. Palmer’s
journey through the Desert of the Tih (or Wilderness of the Wanderings).

The Survey of Western Palestine was begun in 1872; and when, in a
short time, Captain Stewart came home invalided, his place was taken
by Lieutenant Conder, who continued the work during a series of
years. Meantime, in 1874, M. Clermont Ganneau went out on another
archæological mission.

In 1877 the Survey, which had been interrupted by an attack on the
party, at Safed, was resumed by Lieutenant Kitchener, who had been
Conder’s chief helper, and was completed satisfactorily.

In 1880 the great map of Western Palestine was published; and in 1881
Conder commenced the Survey of Eastern Palestine, which, however, the
Turks did not allow to be completed.

A geological expedition left England in October 1883, under Professor
Edward Hull, F.R.S., Director of the Geological Survey of Ireland.
Lieutenant-Colonel Kitchener, who accompanied him, surveyed the Wady
Arabah.

In 1885 and later years, extensive tracts of country have been surveyed
by Herr Schumacher, especially in the Jaulan.

Following upon these various explorations, the Society has poured out
an incessant stream of publications, maps, and photographs, and its
officers have published important books on their own account.


                 2. _Physical Features of Palestine._

“The main object of the Survey of Palestine may be said to have been
to collect materials in illustration of the Bible. Few stronger
confirmations of the historic and authentic character of the sacred
volume can be imagined than that furnished by a comparison of the ‘Land
and the Book,’ which shows clearly that they tally in every respect.
Mistaken ideas and preconceived notions may be corrected; but the
truth of the Bible is certainly established on a firm basis, by the
criticisms of those who, familiar with the people and the country,
are able to read it, not as a dead record of a former world or of
an extinct race, but as a living picture of manners and of a land
which can still be studied by any who will devote themselves to the
task.”--_Major Conder._

Let us begin our present study of the Holy Land by fixing in our
minds a clear notion of its general physiography. Two ranges of hills,
running from north to south, one on either side of the river Jordan,
stand out as a principal feature of the country. The western range
is between 2000 and 3000 feet high, and the eastern range about 1000
feet higher. The Jordan, gathering its waters from three sources,
but chiefly from a spring issuing from a cave at Banias, at the base
of the Anti-Lebanon, about 1000 feet above the ocean level, descends
rapidly, and at a distance of 12 miles passes through the marshy swamp
called Lake Huleh, generally identified with the Scriptural Waters of
Merom. “Lake Huleh” is 4 miles long, and is very nearly at the same
level with the Mediterranean. The Jordan was not known to pass through
this swamp as an actual stream until Mr J. Macgregor, in his _Rob Roy_
canoe, navigated his way through the reeds. Descending with the stream
(“Jordan” means _the Descender_), we come, at a further distance of
10½ miles, to the Lake of Galilee, and here we are 682 feet below the
Mediterranean. The lake is 12½ miles long, and nearly 8 miles wide at
its broadest part. Between the Lake of Galilee and the Dead Sea the
distance, as the crow flies, is 65 miles; but the stream is so tortuous
that Lieutenant Lynch found it, in navigation, to be 200 miles. In
the course of this distance Lynch passed down twenty-seven rapids
which he considered “threatening,” besides a great many more of lesser
magnitude. The Dead Sea itself is 1292 feet below the Mediterranean,
though the level varies by a few feet according as Jordan overflows or
runs low. Its length is 47 miles and its breadth about 10 miles. It has
no outlet to the south, but gets rid, by evaporation from the surface,
of all the water poured into it. Thus the Jordan occupies a gorge which
is deep as well as wide, and is, together with its lake basins, the
most remarkable depression of the kind on the face of the earth. As
remarked by Mr Ffoulkes, it is a river that has never been navigable,
flowing into a sea that has never known a port--has never been a
highway to more hospitable coasts--has never possessed a fishery--a
river that has never boasted of a single town of eminence upon its
banks.

  [Illustration: MERIDIONAL SECTION, WESTERN PALESTINE.

  (_Reduced from Mr Trelawney Saunders’ Section by W. H. Hudleston._)

      _Lower Galilee_        _Upper Galilee_
      _Hills of Samaria_
      _Mountains of Judæa_]

North of the Dead Sea the Valley of the Jordan widens out into an
extensive flat called the Kikkar or the Round, the Plain of the Jordan.
Northwards of this again, the low ground of the Jordan Valley extends
for several miles on either side of the stream, the hills now drawing
closer, now opening wider. Following the low ground northward, we
by-and-bye find an opening to the left, the western range of hills
being broken in two by the Valley of Jezreel and the Great Plain
of Esdraelon. We may continue our journey westward, and round the
promontory of Mount Carmel, where the road is close to the sea, and
then southward through the Plain of Sharon into the Plain of Philistia,
and onward to the desert of Sinai. Thus it is possible to travel all
round without once climbing the hills: so that this central region is
like an island, with plains around it instead of the ocean. It was, in
fact, still more isolated, by having a second separating ring around
the first; for on the west was the Mediterranean Sea, navigated by the
Phœnicians, who were peaceably disposed; on the south and east were
extensive deserts, and on the north were the mountains of Lebanon,
sending down their roots to the sea-coast. There was, however, a way
through Canaan, from Egypt to Mesopotamia, by the coast route and
through the passes of the Lebanon.

The hills of Western Palestine do not afford much level table-land,
for the torrents running off on either side, into the sea westward
and into the river eastward, cut the ground into deep gorges; these,
over-lapping at their sources, leave a central wavy ridge, and if we
travel from north to south anywhere but along this ridge we may have
to cross torrent-beds 1000 feet deep. The eastern range is cut by
gorges even more formidable, of which the principal are the Arnon, the
Jabbok, and the Hieromax.

The hills of Western Palestine consisted of grey rock, and were
comparatively bare and infertile; the plains were gorgeous with
flowers, and rich with corn-fields. Beyond the plain of Esdraelon was
wild scenery of mountain and forest. The eastern hills were green with
forest and pasture; in the central region were the forests of Gilead;
north of Gilead was rich pasturage for wild herds of cattle--the “bulls
of Bashan;” in the south was rich pasturage too, and the king of Moab
at one time was a sheep-master, paying as tribute the wool of 100,000
lambs and 100,000 rams (2 Kings iii. 4).

From Dan in the north to Beersheba in the south, the country measured
only 140 miles, and from the Jordan to the sea only some forty or
fifty: a small country, even when we include the eastern hills,
yet sufficient for the tribes of Israel at that time; and in parts
extremely fruitful, a land of milk and honey.

Dan was a natural point for a northern limit, since there the ascent
of Mount Hermon begins, and there we have one of the sources of the
Jordan. The city was situated on an isolated cone, and the modern name
of it is Banias. On the north side of it there rises a cliff 100 feet
in height, and at the foot of this is a cave, which was a sanctuary
of the god Pan. Two niches in the cliff side contain inscriptions in
honour of Pan. From the worship of this deity the city was called
Panias or Panium. Its Biblical name was probably Baal Gad. In the time
of Josephus the waters of the Jordan burst forth from the cave itself,
but now they issue at the foot of a heap of rubbish in front of the
cavern, in numerous tiny rills, which soon unite and form a river. The
Castle of Banias is one of the most splendid ruins in Syria. It was
surveyed and planned by Colonel Kitchener in 1877. Remains of columns
occur in the village of Banias, and Major Conder suspects that the
Crusaders who fortified the place may very probably have destroyed the
heathen temple and used the pillars in their masonry.

About an hour’s distance south of Banias is a mound called _Tell el
Kady_ (the heap of Dan), and here we have another source of the Jordan.
Tell el Kady is one of the most romantic and picturesque spots in the
country, abundantly watered, and overlooking the broad valley of the
Upper Jordan, with mountain peaks and ridges to north, east, and west.
A group of dolmens recently discovered at this spot may be thought to
have some connection with the ancient worship.

Beersheba (the _well of swearing_, or the _well of the seven_) was
one of the oldest places in Palestine, and is about as far south as
a place can be without actually being in the desert. There are at
present on the spot two principal wells and five smaller ones, and
they are among the first objects encountered on entering Palestine
from the south. Conder found the principal well to be 12 feet 3 inches
in diameter, and over 45 feet deep, lined with a ring of masonry to a
depth of 28 feet. The sides of all the wells are furrowed by the ropes
of the water-drawers; but one discovery was made which was rather
disappointing, namely, that the masonry is not very ancient. Fifteen
courses down, on the south side of the large well, there is a stone
with an inscription in Arabic, on a tablet dated, as well as could be
made out, 505 A.H., that is 1117 A.D. The wells have no parapets, and
a traveller might easily walk into them unaware. Round the two which
contain water there are some rude stone water troughs, which may be of
any age.

These being the limits of the country, let us return again to a
consideration of its physical aspects.

The physical features of the country naturally depend upon its
geological formation. The ranges of hills, east and west of Jordan,
are formed almost entirely of beds of cretaceous limestone, which were
once continuous. The Jordan Valley coincides with a line of fault; that
is to say, the rocky strata cracked in an irregular line from north to
south, and the country west of this fault sank down bodily, so that the
higher strata of rocks on that side abut now against the lower strata
on the eastern side. With this depression to begin with, the rains and
torrents have gradually sculptured the valley into its present form.

The maritime district of Palestine, stretching from the base of Carmel
southwards by Joppa and Gaza to the Desert of Beersheba, consists of
a series of low hills from 300 feet to 400 feet high, separated by
valleys and alluvial plains extending inland to a varying distance.
The coast line is bordered by a line of sand-hills, which, when
unrestrained by some physical barrier, are ever moving inland with
disastrous effect. The district is largely composed of beds of sand and
gravel, which have once been the bed of the outer sea; while along the
line of many of the rivers and streams a deposit of rich loam of a deep
brown colour covers considerable areas, and yields abundant crops of
wheat and maize to the cultivators.

Professor Edward Hull, the eminent geologist, who was commissioned by
the Palestine Exploration Society to investigate the geology of the
Desert and the Holy Land, reported the results to the Committee, in
an elaborate Memoir, in which he treats of the maritime district, the
table-land of Western Palestine and the Tih Desert, the depression of
the Jordan Valley and its continuation southward to the Gulf of Akabah,
the elevated plateau east of Jordan, and the mountainous tract of
the peninsula of Sinai. Utilising the labours of his predecessors,
Russeger, Fraas, Lartet, Vignes, &c., he sometimes confirms their
results, and sometimes adds to our knowledge.

  [Illustration: GEOLOGICAL SKETCH MAP
  of
  SINAI & PALESTINE

  (_based chiefly upon the Maps of M.M. Lartet, Hull & Zittel_.)

   _The figures represent deviations above the sea level in English
   feet; those with a minus mark represent depressions
   below sea level._]

By the kindness of Mr W. H. Hudleston, F.R.S., and Secretary of
the Geological Society, I am able to illustrate this chapter with a
geological map based chiefly on the maps of Lartet, Hull, and Zittel.
To a great extent it tells its own story regarding the features of
the country, and the rocks and formations of which the region is
constructed. The oldest rocks occupy the greater portion of the
Sinaitic peninsula, as well as the mountains bordering the Gulf of
Akabah, and extending northward along the eastern side of the Wady
el Arabah. They consist of granitic, gneissose and schistose rocks,
amongst which have been intruded great masses of red porphyry, dark
green-stone, and other igneous rocks in the form of dykes, veins,
and bosses. These rocks are probably among the oldest in the world.
After these ancient rocks had been consolidated they were subjected
to a vast amount of erosion, and were worn into very uneven surfaces,
over which the more recent formations were spread; first filling up
the hollows with the lower strata, and ultimately covering even the
higher elevations as the process of deposition of strata went on. The
oldest of these formations is the Red Sandstone and Conglomerate,
which Professor Edward Hull calls the “Desert Sandstone” formation.
It forms a narrow strip along the margin of the old crystalline
rocks. It is capped with the fossiliferous limestone of the Wady
Nash, which shows it to belong to the Carboniferous period--in fact
to be the representative of the Carboniferous Limestone of Europe and
the British Isles. It is also found east of the Arabah Valley and
amongst the mountains of Moab east of the Ghor. This is succeeded by
another Sandstone formation, more extensively distributed than the
former. It belongs to a much more recent geological period, namely,
the Cretaceous; and is the representative of the “Nubian Sandstone” of
Roziere, so largely developed in Africa, especially in Nubia and Upper
Egypt. This is succeeded by the Cretaceous and Nummulitic Limestone
formations, which occupy the greater part of the map, forming the great
table-land of the Tih, from its western escarpment to the borders of
the Arabah Valley, and stretching northward throughout the hill country
of Judea and Samaria into Syria and the Lebanon.

On the east of the Jordan Valley the Cretaceous Limestone forms the
table-lands of Edom and Moab: as far north as the Hauran and Jaulan,
where the limestone passes below great sheets of basaltic lava. The
Cretaceous Limestone represents the Chalk formation of Europe and the
British Isles.

Although the Cretaceous Limestone belongs to the Secondary period,
and the Nummulitic Limestone to the Tertiary, they are very closely
connected in Palestine, as far as their mineral characters are
concerned; and they both contain beds or bands of flint and chert.

  [Illustration: GENERALISED GEOLOGICAL SECTION ACROSS PALESTINE.

  _o_, Level of the Mediterranean: _a_, bed of the maritime plains;
  _m_, old lacustrine deposits of the Dead Sea basin; _n_, deposits
  now forming beneath the Dead Sea; _p_, tufaceous deposits of hot
  springs; _h_, basalt.]

The Cretaceous Limestone underlies nearly the whole of the Jordan and
Arabah Valleys, although concealed by more recent deposits, and is
broken off along the line of the great Jordan Valley fault against
older formations. In other words, on the west we have strata of the
age of the English chalk, which dip down very suddenly towards the
centre of the valley. On the east we have the Nubian Sandstone, with
hard limestone above it geologically coeval with our greensand. It
is entirely owing to the presence of this leading line of fracture
and displacement, and the subsequent denudation of strata, that this
great valley exists, and that the eastern side is so mountainous and
characterised by such grand features of hill and dale.

These limestones pass under a newer formation of Calcareous Sandstone
in the direction of the Mediterranean, a formation probably of Upper
Eocene age, and called by Hull the “Calcareous Sandstone of Philistia.”

The formations next in order consist of raised beaches and sea-beds
along the coast, and of lake-beds in the Ghor and Jordan Valley; and
these bring us, geologically, much nearer to our own time.

Not only do the physical features of a country depend upon its
geological formation, but it cannot be questioned that the character
and mode of life of the inhabitants are moulded or modified by the
physical features. It is remarked by Professor Edward Hull that the
mild patient character of the Egyptian cultivator befits the nature of
that wide alluvial tract of fertile land which is watered by the Nile.
The mountainous tracts of the Sinaitic peninsula, formed of the oldest
crystalline rocks of that part of the world, have become the abode of
the Bedouin Arab, the hardy child of nature, who has adapted himself
to a life in keeping with his wild surroundings. The great table-land
of the Tih, less rugged and inhospitable than the mountainous parts
of Sinai and Serbal, supports roving tribes, partly pastoral, and
gradually assimilating their habits to the Fellahin of Philistia and
of Palestine, who cultivate the ground and rear large flocks and herds.

    [_Authorities and Sources_:--Smith’s “Dictionary of the
    Bible.” Survey of Western Palestine, Memoir on the
    Geology. Dr Edward Hull. “The Geology of Palestine.”
    Wilfred H. Hudleston, F.R.S. “_Rob-Roy_ on the Jordan.”
    John Macgregor.]


              3. _The Dead Sea, Salt Sea, or Sea of Lot._

It is pointed out by Sir George Grove that the name “Dead Sea” never
occurs in the Bible, and appears not to have existed until the second
century after Christ. It originated in an erroneous opinion, and
there can be little doubt that to the name are due in a great measure
the mistakes and misrepresentations which were for so long prevalent
regarding this lake, and which have not indeed yet wholly ceased to
exist. In the Old Testament it is called the Salt Sea, and the Sea of
the Plain (Arabah). By the Arabs it is called El Bahr Lut (the Sea of
Lot).

The Salt Sea lies in the deepest part of the great Jordan-Arabah
depression, and the ground rises to the south of it, as well as in all
other directions. It was shown, in fact, by Colonel Kitchener’s survey
of the Arabah that the bed of the valley, for the most part, is raised
above the level of the Gulf of Akabah. From the border of the Dead Sea
southward the ground rises but little for 10 miles, but then begins to
rise rapidly, so that at a distance of about 40 miles it is as high
as the sea level at Akabah; and 29 miles further south it is 660 feet
above that level.

The Jordan Valley, as already stated, coincides with a great fault
in the strata. This had been recognised by Lartet, Tristram, Wilson,
and others; and Professor Hull has traced the continuation of this
fracture, at the base of the Edomite mountains along the Arabah Valley.
He agrees with Lartet in thinking that the waters of the Jordan Valley
have not flowed down into the Gulf of Akabah since the land emerged
from the ocean. The disconnection of the inner waters from the outer is
a very ancient event, dating back to Miocene times.

The River Jordan, throughout its course, from the Sea of Tiberias to
the Salt Sea, cuts its channel through alluvial terraces, consisting
of sand, gravel, and calcareous marl, which sometimes contain shells,
semi-fossilised, but of species still living in the lakes of Tiberias
and Huleh. These terraces are continuous round the shores of the
Salt Sea, and between the base of the cliffs of Jebel Karantul, near
Jericho, and the fords of the Jordan, three of them may be observed,

    the first being at a level of 650 to 600 feet,
    the second       "     "      520 to 250  " ,
    the third        "     "      200 to 130  "

and below the last named is the alluvial flat, liable to be flooded on
the rise of the waters. The upper surfaces and outer margins of these
terraces indicate successive stages, at which the waters have rested in
sinking down to their present level. Originally they reached a level
somewhat over that of the Mediterranean, and at that time a great
inland lake extended from Lake Huleh southwards into the Arabah Valley,
its length being about 200 miles.

In the Jordan Valley, the upper terrace, at the foot of the hills, is
called the Ghor, and it is to be distinguished from the Zor, or bottom
of the valley, in which the channel of the river, cut still deeper,
meanders.

The Salt Sea itself is enclosed on all sides by terraced hills, except
towards the north, where it receives the waters of the Jordan. In
rising gradually out of the ocean, the region appears to have rested
several times at successive levels, and the sea left its mark in
deposits of marl, gravel, and silt. Beyond the southern end of the
Salt Sea the banks of the Ghor rise in the form of a great white
sloping wall, to a height of about 600 feet above the plain, and are
formed of horizontal courses of sand and gravel, resting on white marl
and loam. This mural wall sweeps round in a semicircular form from side
to side of the Ghor. The upper surface is nearly level (except where
broken into by river channels), and from its base stretches a plain
covered partly, over the western side, by a forest of small trees and
shrubs, and partly by vegetation affording pasturage to the numerous
flocks of the Arabs, who settle down here during the cooler months of
the year. It is impossible to doubt that at no remote period the waters
of the Salt Sea, though now distant some 10 miles, washed the base of
these cliffs, and a rise of a few feet would submerge this verdant
plain, and bring back the sea to its former more extended limits.

From this position also, the white terrace of Jebel Usdum--“the salt
mountain” where the Crusaders wrongly placed Sodom--is seen projecting
from the sides of the loftier limestone terraces of the Judæan hills.
Towards the east, similar terraces of whitish alluvial deposits are
seen clinging to the sides of the Moabite hills, or running far up the
deep glens which penetrate the sides of the great table-land. In these
terraces, the upper surfaces of which reach a level of about 600 feet
above the waters of the Salt Sea, we behold but the remnants of an
ancient sea-bed, which must originally have stretched from side to side.

Eight hundred feet higher than these terraces there are others
composed of marl, gravel, and silt, through which the ravines of
existing streams have been cut; and this indicates that the level of
the Salt Sea stood at one time 100 feet higher than the waters of the
Mediterranean stand now.

_Origin of the saltness of the Dead Sea._--It has been generally
recognised that the waters of lakes which have no outlet ultimately
become more or less saline. Of these the most important in the old
world are the Caspian, the Sea of Aral, Lakes Balkash, Van, Urumiah,
and, lastly, the Dead Sea, or as it was originally called, “the Salt
Sea.” “The Caspian,” says Professor Hull, “owing to its great extent
and other causes, is but slightly saline; but that with which we have
here to deal is the most saline of all. It is probable that the water
of the ocean itself has become salt owing to the same cause which has
produced saltness in the inland lakes, as it may be regarded as a mass
of water without an outlet. The cause of the saltness in such lakes I
now proceed to explain.

“It has been found that the waters of rivers contain, besides matter
which is in a state of mechanical suspension, carbonates of lime and
magnesia, and saline ingredients in a state of solution; and as those
lakes which have an outlet, such as the Sea of Galilee, part with their
waters and saline ingredients as fast as they receive them, the waters
of such lakes remain fresh. It is otherwise, however, with regard to
lakes which have no outlet. In such cases the water is evaporated as
fast as it is received; and as the vapour is in a condition of purity,
the saline ingredients remain behind. Thus the waters of such a lake
tend constantly to increase in saltness, until a state of saturation
is attained, when the excess of salt is precipitated, and forms beds
at the bottom of the lake. The contrast presented by the waters of the
Sea of Galilee on the one hand, and those of the Dead Sea on the other,
though both are fed by the same river, is a striking illustration of
the effects resulting from opposite physical conditions. In the former
case, the waters are fresh, and abound in fishes and molluscs; in the
latter, they are so intensely salt that all animal life is absent.

“The increase of saltness in the waters of the Dead Sea has probably
been very slow, and dates back from its earliest condition, when its
waters stretched for a distance of about 200 miles from north to
south....

“The excessive salinity of the waters of the Dead Sea will be
recognised from a comparison with those of the Atlantic Ocean. Thus,
while the waters of the ocean give six pounds of salt, &c., in a
hundred pounds of water, those of the Dead Sea give 24·57 pounds in the
same quantity; but in both cases the degree of salinity varies with the
depth, the waters at the surface being less saline than those near the
bottom....

“_As to the depth of the waters_:--The floor of the Dead Sea has been
sounded on two occasions: first, by the Expedition under Lieutenant
Lynch in 1848, and secondly, by that under the Duc de Luynes. In the
former case the maximum depth was found to be 1278 feet; in the latter
1217 feet, being close approximations to each other. We may therefore
affirm that the floor of the lake descends to nearly as great a
depth below its surface as the surface itself below the level of the
Mediterranean Sea.

“The section given by Lynch indicates that the place of greatest depth
lies much nearer the Moabite than the Judæan shore, and the descent
from the base of the Moabite escarpment below Jebel Attarus and between
the outlets of the Wâdies Mojeb and Zerka Maïn, is very steep indeed.
The deepest part of the trough seems to lie in a direction running
north and south, at a distance of about 2 miles from the eastern bank;
and while the ascent towards this bank is rapid, that towards the
Judæan shore on the west is comparatively gentle. The line of this deep
trough seems exactly to coincide with that of the great Jordan Valley
fault. From the bottom of the deeper part, the sounding line brought up
specimens of crystals of salt (sodium-chloride), and it can scarcely be
doubted that a bed of this mineral, together with gypsum, is in course
of formation over the central portions of the Dead Sea.”

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Memoirs of the Survey:
   Geology”, Dr E. Hull. Smith’s “Dict. of Bible.” “Tent Work in
   Palestine.” By Major Conder, R.E.]


                     4. _The Cities of the Plain._

There is now a general consent that Sodom and Gomorrah, Admah and
Zeboim were situated north of the Dead Sea, in the Kikkar or Plain of
the Jordan. There are old maps which represent these cities as situated
at the bottom of the Dead Sea waters, and yet enveloped in flames!
Popular ignorance imagines that the bitumen which rises to the surface
of the waters is a relic of the agency which effected the destruction.
And until recently even the best scholars supposed the cities to lie
beneath the shallow part of the sea, south of the Lisan peninsula.
All such theories are disproved by the geological investigation,
which shows that the Dead Sea is much older than any date which can
be assigned to the destruction of the cities, and that the surface of
the water has been constantly diminishing in area and sinking to lower
levels.

There is nothing in the Bible which should lead us to look for the
cities south of the Dead Sea, where the Crusaders placed them, or east
of it, or anywhere but north and in the Kikkar. When Abraham and Lot
talked together concerning the disputes between their herdsmen, and
decided to go different ways with their flocks, “Lot lifted up his eyes
and beheld all the Plain of the Jordan, that it was well watered ...
until thou comest unto Zoar.” It was clearly shown by Sir George Grove,
in Smith’s “Dictionary of the Bible,” that the Plain of the Jordan
here spoken of is not the Arabah, in which the Dead Sea reposes, but
the Kikkar or “Round” of country north of it. The position of Abraham
and Lot at the time was on a mount east of Bethel; and as the site of
Bethel is known, it was not difficult to find the mount east of it. It
was reasonably identified by Rev. Canon Williams, and his conclusions
were confirmed in 1865 by Colonel Sir C. Wilson. It has been shown that
if the cities had been south of the Dead Sea, human vision could not
possibly have extended so far, to distinguish anything. But north of
the sea, in the Round or Plain, Lot would be able to perceive them.
Accordingly, when the friendly conference ended, he journeyed eastward
from the mount near Bethel, in order to reach his new home in Sodom.

The vision of Lot had extended across the plain, to Zoar and no
farther, because the plain was bounded by the high mountains of Moab.
Dr Tristram believes that he has identified Zoar, the fifth city of
the Plain, the “little city” to which Lot fled after the convulsion.
Standing on Mount Nebo, he detected the ruins a little in front of him,
almost in a line with Jericho. The ruins were on a low brow of ground,
and thus correspond to the description that Lot rested in this city
on his way to the mountains, and afterwards went up into the mountain
and dwelt in a cave. The ruins are still called Ziara, which does not
differ much from the Greek spelling Ζωαρα, nor very widely
from the Hebrew.

Is it possible to discover any relics of the four larger cities?
Although destroyed by fire, they may not have been utterly annihilated,
any more than Pompeii; but if their remains are hiding beneath the
dust, the dust keeps its secret well. Major Conder rode day by day
over almost every acre of ground between Jericho and the Dead Sea, and
could not detect any mound or sign of a buried city. The whole was a
white desert, except near the hills, where rich herbage grows after
the rains. The time of year was most favourable for such exploration,
because no long grass existed to hide any ruins. But in all that plain
he found no ruin, except the old monastery of St John and a little
hermit’s cave.

This description leaves out of account a remarkable group of _tells_,
or mounds of earth and rubbish, strewn over with ruins, existing in
the neighbourhood of Jericho. They are seven in number, and one of
them is not far from Elisha’s Fountain, now called _Ain es Sultan_.
One would imagine that the exploration of these mounds might yield
valuable results; but nobody undertakes the work. It is true that some
excavations made by Sir Charles Warren only proved the existence of
sun-dried bricks; and because the mounds occur generally where the
soil is alluvial, Conder regards them as piles of refuse bricks, and
nothing more; but Sir J. W. Dawson, on visiting the place, noticed
numerous flint chips in the mound, and Sir C. Warren, when presiding at
my Guildford lecture, publicly expressed the opinion that many small
objects of great interest would probably be found if the stuff were
sifted.

But if the ruins of the Cities of the Plain are not discoverable, their
names appear to linger in the district, slightly disguised as Arabic
words, and applying to portions of the ground.

Conder justly remarks that the cities would probably be situated near
fresh-water springs, and the great spring of ’Ain Feshkhah, on the
north-west of the Dead Sea, is a probable site for one of them. The
great bluff not far south of the spring is called Tubk ’Amriyeh by
the Bedawin, and the neighbouring valley Wady ’Amriyeh. This word is
radically identical with the Hebrew Gomorrah, or Amorah as it is spelt
in one passage (Gen. x. 19), meaning, according to some authorities,
“depression,” according to others, “cultivation.”

Admah means “red earth,” a description which would hardly apply to the
ground near the Dead Sea. But there is no reason why all the four
cities should be close to the Dead Sea. A convulsion overthrowing
cities near the Sea would probably be felt a long way up the Jordan
Valley, owing to the line of fault. Conder has pointed out, too, that
the term Kikkar is applied in the Bible to the Jordan Valley as far
north as Succoth. A “city Adam” is noticed in the Book of Joshua as
being beside Zaretan; the name Ed Damieh applies to the neighbourhood
of the Jordan ford east of Kurn Surtabeh, about 23 miles up the valley;
and it has always seemed possible to Conder that Adam and Admah were
one and the same. I would add a suggestion of my own in support of the
view that Admah was some distance up the Jordan Valley. The passage
Gen. x. 19 describes the boundary of Canaan, beginning at Sidon,
following the coast line to Gaza, striking thence eastward to the Plain
of the Jordan, and then proceeding up the Jordan Valley to Dan or
Lasha--and the passage may be freely rendered thus,--“And the border
of the Canaanite was from Sidon; thence you go towards Gerar, as far
as Gaza; thence you go toward Sodom; then by Gomorrah and Admah and
Zeboim, unto Dan.”[14] As Gerar was beyond Gaza southward, the boundary
only went toward it; and as Sodom was beyond Jordan eastward, the
boundary only went toward Sodom; there was no need to say it stopped
at the river, for that was obvious. It then follows the course of the
river from the Dead Sea to the source of the stream. And then the
northern boundary is known without description. If this rendering holds
good, then Gomorrah was north-west of the Dead Sea, on a line joining
Gaza with Sodom; and the boundary of the Canaanites, after reaching
Gomorrah, touched Admah and Zeboim, and continued northward to the
grotto at Banias.

_Zeboim_ means “hyenas,” and is identical with the Arabic Dub’a. For
this reason Conder asks whether it may not have been situated at the
cliff just above the plain, near the site of Roman Jericho, for that
is now called Shakh ed Dub’a, “lair of the Hyena.” If I am right in
my reading of Gen. x. 19, Zeboim should be northward of Admah--unless
two names so often coupled together may have their order transposed.
Grove reminds us that the Valley of Zeboim (the name spelt a little
differently) was a ravine or gorge apparently east of Michmas,
described in 1 Sam. xiii. 18. It appears to be overlooked in the
discussion that Zeboim is mentioned in Nehemiah xi. 34, in the same
group with Hadid, Lod, and Ono, among the places occupied by the
children of Benjamin, while in Neh. vii. 37, these three places are
named between Jericho and Senaah. But if the Lod in this passage is to
be regarded as Lydda in the Plain of Sharon, the grouping of the places
affords us no guidance.

_Sodom_ alone, as Conder goes on to say, remains without a suggestion,
and he finds no trace of it west of the Jordan. He notes, however, that
the word Siddim is apparently the same with the Arabic _Sidd_, which is
used in a peculiar sense by the Arabs of the Jordan Valley as meaning
“cliffs” or banks of marl, such as exist along the southern edge of the
plains of Jericho, the ordinary meaning being “dam” or obstruction.
Thus the Vale of Siddim might well, so far as its name is concerned,
have been situated in the vicinity of the northern shores of the Dead
Sea.

Dr Selah Merrill, in his “East of the Jordan,” also discusses the site
of the Cities of the Plain. He says:--“Since Zoar was one of them, a
hint as to their situation may be derived from Gen. xiii. 10, where
Lot and Abraham are represented as standing on a hill near Bethel, and
looking down the Jordan Valley towards the Dead Sea. As this verse
is rendered in our English Bible, the meaning is not clear; but it
will become so when all the middle portion of the verse is read as a
parenthesis, as follows: ‘And Lot lifted up his eyes and beheld all the
Plain of Jordan (that it was well watered everywhere, before the Lord
destroyed Sodom and Gomorrah, even as the garden of the Lord, like the
land of Egypt), until thou comest to Zoar.’ The last clause qualifies
the first. Lot saw all the Plain of Jordan as far as Zoar, or ‘until
you come to Zoar.’ Zoar was both the limit of the plain and the limit
of vision in that direction, so far as the land was concerned.”

Dr Merrill then shows that nothing could have been distinguished at the
southern end of the Dead Sea; and quotes early writers to show that
Zoar existed near the northern end.

Regarding the destruction of Sodom and Gomorrah, it is not sufficient
to say briefly that it was a miracle, and assume that no further
explanation can be given. A rain of brimstone and fire is spoken of,
and it is legitimate to look for the source of it. With the instance
of Pompeii in our minds it is natural to suggest volcanic agency,
especially as the region north-east of the Dead Sea affords evidence
of volcanic action. But Sir J. W. Dawson (a well-known American
geologist), in his volume on “Egypt and Syria,” ingeniously argues
for a petroleum explosion. The “slime pits” spoken of as abounding in
the Vale of Siddim (Gen. xiv. 10), he regards as petroleum wells, and
then traces a parallel as follows:--“Regions of bitumen, like that of
the Dead Sea, are liable to eruptions of a most destructive character.
Of these we have had examples in the oil regions of America. In a
narrative of one of these now before me, and which occurred a few
years ago, in the oil district of Petrolia, in Canada, I read that a
borehole struck a reservoir of gas, which rushed upward with explosive
force, carrying before it a large quantity of petroleum. The gas almost
immediately took fire, and formed a tall column of flame, while the
burning petroleum spread over the ground and ignited tanks of the
substance in the vicinity. In this way a space of about fifteen acres
was enveloped in fire, a village was burned, and several persons lost
their lives. The air flowing toward the eruption caused a whirlwind,
which carried the dense smoke high into the air, and threw down burning
bitumen all round.

“Now, if we suppose that at the time referred to, accumulations of
inflammable gas and petroleum existed below the Plain of Siddim, the
escape of these through the opening of a fissure along the old line of
fault might produce the effects described--namely, a pillar of smoke
rising up to heaven, burning bitumen and sulphur raining on the doomed
cities, and fire spreading over the ground. The attendant phenomenon
of the evolution of saline waters, implied in the destruction of Lot’s
wife, would be a natural accompaniment, as water is always discharged
in such eruptions; and in this case it would be a brine thick with mud,
and fitted to encrust and cover any object reached by it.”

An important note, with reference to the destruction of the Cities of
the Plain, appears in the statement in Gen. xiv., that the Vale of
Siddim had bitumen pits or wells, and that these were so abundant or
important as to furnish a place of retreat to, or to impede the flight
of, the defeated kings of Sodom and Gomorrah. These bitumen pits have
disappeared, unless their remains are represented by the singular pits
described by Dr Merrill as occurring near Wady Nimrim. Their existence
in the times of Abraham would bespeak a much greater abundance of
bituminous matter than that now remaining; and it is possible that the
eruption which destroyed the Cities of the Plain may have, to a great
extent, exhausted the supply of petroleum.

“There is no reason to think” (adds Dr Dawson) “that the destruction
of Sodom and Gomorrah was connected with any important change in
the limits of the Dead Sea, though it is highly probable that some
subsidence of the valley took place, and may have slightly affected
its levels relatively to the Jordan and the sea; but it would appear
from Deut. xxix. 23, that the eruption was followed by a permanent
deterioration of the district by the saline mud with which it was
covered.”

In the _Theological Monthly_ for May 1890, Rev. James Neil declares
that no bitumen pits are to be found anywhere in the neighbourhood of
the Jordan. The pits spoken of by Dr Selah Merrill were connected with
aqueducts, and used for purposes of irrigation. But the asphalt thrown
up from the bottom of the Dead Sea may have been employed to render
such pits watertight, and to that extent they would be slime pits. He
shows that such pits do exist in the Jordan Valley, extending across
it in long lines just north of the supposed site of some of the Cities
of the Plain; and it is a very curious fact that the Bedawin, who are
unacquainted with their nature and purpose, have a legend connecting
them with a great battle.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--Smith’s “Dict. of the Bible.”
   “Tent Work in Palestine.” Major Conder, R.E. “The Land of
   Moab.” Rev. Canon Tristram, F.R.S. “East of Jordan.” Dr Selah
   Merrill. “Egypt and Syria.” Sir J. W. Dawson.]


                          5. “_Lot’s Wife._”

In connection with the destruction of Sodom, the Bible mentions the
fate which overtook Lot’s wife, who “became a pillar of salt.” In the
Book of Wisdom also we read of the waste land that smoketh, and plants
bearing fruit that never come to ripeness, and a standing pillar of
salt--a monument of an unbelieving soul (Wisd. x. 7). Josephus also
says that he had seen it (Ant. i. 11, 4). The Arabs have legends on
the subject; and travellers now and again describe the pillars of salt
which have been pointed out to them, and to which the legends attach.
The stories are by no means modern. Major Conder, in his “Syrian Stone
Lore,” brings into brief compass the notions of the Fathers of the
Church on the subject. From an early period “Lot’s wife” is mentioned
as standing by the western shores of the Dead Sea, and Antoninus Martyr
is careful to combat the idea that the pillar of salt was destroyed
through its being constantly licked by animals. Clemens Romanus had
seen it; Irenæus also (IV. xxxi. 3) mentions “Lot’s wife” as a pillar
still standing. (Quoted by Kitto, Cyclopæd. “Lot.”) So does Benjamin
of Tudela, whose account is more than usually circumstantial; and in
later times Maundrell and others. It seems possibly to be the natural
pinnacle, now called Karnet Sahsul Hameid, to which these writers
refer. The feminine nature of this statue was supposed to be still
perceptible, in spite of petrification.

Perhaps the best account of “Lot’s wife” is to be found in E. H.
Palmer’s “Desert of the Exodus,” where a coloured plate helps the
realisation.

“While with the Ghawárineh” (says Palmer) “we had heard strange rumours
that ‘a statue’ called ‘Lot’s wife’ existed on the eastern shore of
the Dead Sea, but none of them had ever seen it, or could give us a
satisfactory description of it. Making cautious inquiries amongst the
Beni Hamideh, we found that the statement was correct, and after some
little trouble, guides were procured who offered to conduct us to the
spot.... Our path led us to another plateau, about 1000 feet above
the Dead Sea, and on the extreme edge of this was the object of which
we were in search--Bint Sheikh Lot, or ‘Lot’s wife.’ It is a tall
isolated needle of rock, which does really bear a curious resemblance
to an Arab woman with a child upon her shoulder. The Arab legend of
Lot’s wife differs from the Bible account only in the addition of a
few frivolous details. They say that there were seven Cities of the
Plain, and that they were all miraculously overwhelmed by the Dead
Sea as a punishment for their crimes. The prophet Lot and his family
alone escaped the general destruction; he was divinely warned to take
all that he had and flee eastward, a strict injunction being given
that they should not look behind them. Lot’s wife, who had on previous
occasions ridiculed her husband’s prophetic office, disobeyed the
command, and, turning to gaze upon the scene of the disaster, was
changed into this pillar of rock.

“Travellers in all ages have discovered ‘Lot’s wife’ in the pillars
which atmospheric influences are constantly detaching from the great
masses of mineral salt at the southern end of the Dead Sea, but these
are all accidental and transient. The rock discovered by us does not
fulfil the requirements of the Scriptural story, but there can be no
doubt that it is the object which has served to keep alive for so many
ages the local tradition of the event.

“The sun was just setting as we reached the spot; and the reddening
orb sank down behind the western hills, throwing a bridge of sheeny
light across the calm surface of the mysterious lake. As we gazed on
the strange statue-like outline of the rock--at first brought out into
strong relief against the soft yet glowing hues of the surrounding
landscape, and then mingled with the deepening shadows, and lost amid
the general gloom as night came quickly on, we yielded insensibly to
the influence of the wild Arab tale, and could almost believe that
we had seen the form of the prophet’s wife peering sadly after her
perished home in the unknown depths of that accursed sea.”


       6. _The Natural History of Palestine, as dependent on its
                         Physical Geography._

The gradual elevation of the countries of Egypt and Palestine, inferred
by Professor Hull from the geological facts, appears to be borne out
by a comparison of the fishes which inhabit respectively the Lake of
Galilee and the lakes of south-eastern Africa.

Josephus, after describing in glowing language the beauty and
fruitfulness of the country of Gennesaret, says, “For besides the
good temperature of the air, it is also watered from a most fertile
fountain. The people of the country call it Capharnaum. Some have
thought it to be a vein of the Nile, because it produces the Coracin
fish as well as that lake does which is near to Alexandria.”[15] The
truth turns out to be much stranger than Josephus imagined, for the Sea
of Galilee can claim affinity by its fishes with the Victoria Nyanza.
Rev. Canon Tristram, who more than any other traveller has studied
the natural history of the Holy Land, has made the comparison in some
detail, and made out the relationship of the fishes beyond doubt. He
declares that of all the forms of life in Palestine the fishes are the
most interesting. There are no fishes in the Dead Sea; but there are
fishes, chiefly Cyprinidæ, or of the perch tribe, in the little streams
and rivers close to the Dead Sea. “I have seen the date palm absolutely
dipping its fronds into the Dead Sea as it hung over--for on the east
side the date palm is very luxuriant. On the eastern shores there is
as wonderful an exuberance of vegetable life as will be found anywhere
on the face of the earth. The plants are like hot-house plants growing
wild. In the warm waters entering to the sea there are small fishes of
various species. We found thirteen new kinds of fishes in the Jordan
and its affluents. Dr Günther of the British Museum kindly described
them in a paper in the ‘Proceedings of the Zoological Society of
London,’ and certainly such a discovery amply repaid our search.

“I wish now to point out the conclusions come to from these fishes,
for they are really the climax of the physical geography of the Jordan
Valley. The fishes found in the Sea of Galilee not only belong for the
most part to species different from those found in any stream flowing
into the Mediterranean, but they belong frequently to different genera.
Some years before, I brought home the type specimen of a fish, the only
species I could find in some salt lakes of the Sahara, and Dr Günther
declared it to be not only a new species but a new genus. I remember
Sir Charles Lyell observing, ‘You have got there the last living
representative of the Saharan ocean.’ We found in the Sea of Galilee
three more species of the same genus, but each distinct. Speke brought
back two species of the same family from the Nyanza, and Dr Kirk has
described several from the Zambezi and the neighbouring region.

“Now we may see what this amounts to. We have got the same genus of
fishes represented in a variety of specific types from the Sea of
Galilee and the Jordan that are found in the feeders of the Nile,
and in the Central African lakes down to the Zambezi. The conclusion
is natural that all these fishes come from a common origin, and that
during the Tertiary period there was a chain of fresh-water lakes,
extending to the lakes in Africa, similar to the chain of lakes in
North America.

“We find in Palestine forty-three species of fishes, of which only
eight belong to the ordinary ichthyological fauna of the Mediterranean
rivers. But these belong to the rivers of the coast. In the Jordan
system only one species out of thirty-six belongs to the ordinary
Mediterranean fauna, viz., _Blennius lupulus_. Two others, _Chromis
niloticus_ and _Clarias macracanthus_, are Nilotic. Seven other
species occur in other rivers of South-Western Asia, the Tigris,
Euphrates, &c. Ten more are found in other parts of Syria, chiefly in
the Damascus lakes, and the remaining sixteen species of the families
_Chromidæ_, _Cyprinodontidæ_, and _Cyprinidæ_, are peculiar to the
Jordan, its affluents, and its lakes. This analysis points at once to
the close affinity of the Jordan with the rivers of Tropical Africa.
The affinity is not only of species, but of genera, for _Chromis_
and _Hemichromis_ are peculiarly Ethiopian forms, while the other
species are identical with, or very closely allied to, the fishes
from other fresh waters of Syria. But the African forms are a very
large proportion of the whole, and considering the difficulty of
transportation in the case of fresh water fishes, the peculiarities of
this portion of the fauna are of great significance.

“The fluviatile fishes claim special attention, dating, as they
probably do, from the earliest time after the elevation of the country
from the Eocene ocean. In the _Foraminifera_, mentioned above as found
in the Dead Sea sand, such as _Gr. capreolus_, we have the relics of
the inhabitants of that early sea. But of the living inhabitants we
must place the Jordanic fishes as the very earliest, and these, we have
seen, form a group far more distinct and divergent from that of the
surrounding region than in any other class of existing life. During
the epochs subsequent to the Eocene, owing to the unbroken isolation
of the basin, there have been no opportunities for the introduction
of new forms, nor for the further dispersion of the old ones. These
forms, as we have seen, bear a striking affinity to those of the
fresh-water lakes and rivers of Eastern Africa, even as far south as
the Zambezi. But the affinity is in the identity of genera, _Chromis_
and _Hemichromis_ being exclusively African, while the species are
rather representative than identical.

“The solution appears to be that during the Meiocene and Pleiocene
periods the Jordan basin formed the northernmost of a large system of
fresh-water lakes, extending from north to south, of which, in the
earlier part of the epoch, perhaps the Red Sea, and certainly the
Nile Basin, the Nyanza, the Nyassa, and the Tanganyika lakes, and
the feeders of the Zambezi, were members. During that warm period, a
fluviatile ichthyological fauna was developed suitable to its then
conditions, consisting of representative, and perhaps frequently
identical species, throughout the area under consideration.

“The advent of the glacial period was, like its close, gradual.
Many species must have perished under the change of conditions. The
hardiest survived, and some perhaps have been gradually modified to
meet those new conditions. Under this strict isolation it could hardly
be otherwise; and however severe the climate may have been, that of
the Lebanon, with its glaciers probably corresponding with the present
temperature of the Alps at a proportional elevation (regard being had
to the difference of latitude), the fissure of the Jordan being, as we
certainly know, as much depressed below the level of the ocean as it is
at present; there must have been an exceptionally warm temperature in
its waters in which the existing ichthyological fauna could survive.”

Such facts as these tell us that Palestine is not to be regarded as a
European country, but rather as an African outlier, while it has also
strong affinities with Asia, as proved by others of these fishes. In
fact, it stands in the midst between three continents, and is, in a
very important sense, the centre of the world. Dr Tristram, our best
authority in this department, shows us how Palestine contains an
epitome of the life of the world, and does so just because it includes
almost every variety of climate.

Linnæus said that we know more of the botany and zoology of farther
India than we do of those of Palestine. It is pleasant to reflect
that, to some extent, this reproach has been removed. It always
entered into the plans of the Palestine Exploration Society to study
the natural history of the Holy Land; and although they have not been
able to equip and maintain a party of naturalists, charged with this
business alone, some of their officers have gathered interesting facts
incidentally. Other inquirers, like Rev. Wm. Houghton and Mr Thaddeus
Mason, have been usefully engaged on the same work. Mr H. Chichester
Hart, who accompanied Professor E. Hull through the Arabah and Southern
Palestine, has written an interesting volume on “The Animals mentioned
in the Bible.” But it is to Rev. Dr Tristram we are chiefly indebted.
The Memoirs of the Survey include a magnificent volume on the “Fauna
and Flora of Western Palestine,” in which he works out his valuable
series of investigations, and besides giving facts and details, treats
the subject in a large philosophical way, as he does also in his
lectures. “You have on Lebanon and Hermon,” he says, “a climate like
that of the Alps, or two-thirds of the way up Mont Blanc. You have on
the tops of Lebanon and Hermon an almost arctic climate, and you have a
fauna and a flora (animals and plants) corresponding to that climate.
You know that when you descend a coal-pit 1300 feet deep you get into
a very warm temperature indeed. Now the Dead Sea is 1300 feet below
the level of the Mediterranean, and the consequence is that you have
around the Dead Sea a tropical or sub-tropical climate, and you have
sub-tropical products.

“At the northern end of the Holy Land you find yourself at the starting
point of the Jordan, which, being 1000 feet above the Mediterranean at
the grotto of Banias, descends so rapidly that it is only a few feet
above the sea level at Lake Huleh. Mount Hermon rises abruptly from its
base near Lake Huleh (the ancient Waters of Merom). Although Hermon is
only 10,000 feet high, I am not aware of any mountain which rises so
suddenly or so directly from its base. Take, for instance, Chamounix.
If you want to go to the top of Mont Blanc, you know that Chamounix is
many hundred feet above the platform of the Mediterranean. It is true
that Mont Blanc is many thousand feet higher than Mount Hermon, but
from its immediate base it is not so high. When you get up to the Grand
Mulets you are not so far from the summit of Mont Blanc as you are at
Lake Huleh from the summit of Hermon. The consequence of this is that
you have brought together in that spot a greater contrast of produce,
animal and vegetable, than I have found anywhere else. You have the
arctic climate of the north on the tops of the mountains, and a
tropical climate in the Jordan Valley, where, in the month of January,
I have been glad to sleep in the open air, the thermometer never being
below 80° at midnight. At the east and south you have the dry sandy
desert; so that you have four distinct climates within view of each
other. I can stand on any of the hills of Judea and see the snow-capped
tops of Hermon and Lebanon, and look over this vast desert eastward and
down to the seething tropical valley of the Dead Sea.

“Now, with all that, there is nothing in the physical character of that
country which is striking or phenomenal, as people would call it. It
is about the most commonplace and ordinary country in the world that I
have ever seen. There are no startling features, but there is endless
variety in it, and I cannot help thinking that there is something very
providential in the extraordinary variety which is brought together
within a district of the Holy Land, which is not so large as the six
northern counties of England; because I remember that it was chosen
as the country in which was written a Book, which was to be for the
teaching and guidance of all mankind in every country and in every
age; and I know no spot in the world in which there could have been
found brought together so many phenomena of Nature, maritime and
desert, mountain and plain, hill and valley, tropical, temperate, and
arctic, as are brought together there within the space of a few miles.
And when I remember that that Book was to be for the teaching of all
men, for all time, I feel that there is something providential in that
ordering of circumstances which led to the selection of the only spot,
as far as we know, in the whole world, in which there is such a great
variety of objects for the illustration, comparison, and elucidation
of Holy Writ as in that country of the Holy Land. Often, when I have
been in that country, on one of its hills, and have noticed the variety
of scenery brought into my view at one time, I have thought to myself,
‘What would the Bible have been if its pages had been written by men
who had lived only in the monotonous valley of the Nile? What would
they have been able to pen in the way of illustration which would
have come home to the heart of the English peasant?’ Again, if that
Book were written by men who were only familiar with the phenomena of
Arabian deserts, how could it have come home to those who dwell on the
sea? Had it been written by inhabitants of tropical India, how would
it have come home to those who are familiar with ‘snow and frost and
vapour, fulfilling His will?’ In fact, there are illustrations taken
from every kind of natural phenomena, and yet none of them are very
marked or startling.”

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Palestine in its Physical
   Aspects.” Rev. Canon Tristram, F. R. S. Survey Memoirs: “The
   Fauna and Flora.” Rev. Canon Tristram. “The Animals mentioned
   in the Bible.” Henry Chichester Hart, B.A., F.L.S.]


          7. _The Topographical Survey of Western Palestine._

Before we can properly understand the history of any country we must
have before us an accurate map, showing its physical features of
mountain, plain, and river, and the relative positions of its cities
and important places. This is true in an unusual degree in the case of
Palestine, a country peculiar in its physical contrasts, and for more
than a thousand years the home of a peculiar people. The sacred books
of other religions--consisting greatly of rhapsodies, prayers, and
devotions--might have been written as well in one country as another;
but the Bible contains the history of a particular people, occupying
a definite district of country, fighting their battles, making their
journeys, and singing psalms oft suggested by their surroundings. It is
absolutely necessary for the student of Hebrew history to make himself
acquainted with Palestine geography and topography. “The history
assumes everywhere a knowledge of the country, and the writer never
stops to explain where the scene of every episode occurs, except to
name it as a spot already known.” Yet, until lately, no accurate map
of the country could be obtained--because no scientific survey had
been carried out. Bible towns and villages had disappeared, and their
sites were not known. The visitor to Palestine, consulting Murray’s
“Handbook” as his best guide, found long columns of “places mentioned
in Scripture, but not yet identified”--Admah, Adullun, Debir, Edrei,
Gallim, &c., &c. In going up from Jaffa to Jerusalem he was shown a
brook, and told that David there selected the five smooth stones before
his combat with Goliath; but the brook was in the wrong locality.
Down by the Jordan he found the grave of Moses on the wrong side of
the river. In Galilee he was perplexed how to decide between two
rival sites for Cana, especially as the water-pots connected with the
marriage feast were to be seen at both places. General uncertainty
attended his footsteps throughout.

The people who did most to bring about this confusion in regard to the
sacred sites were the Crusaders. Knights and priests of the twelfth
century, arriving in Palestine, were strangers in the country, and
although enthusiastic they were ignorant and illiterate. They used to
land at Athlit, and journey thence to Nazareth or to Jerusalem, fixing
as many places _en route_ as they could. Athlit itself they regarded
as the ancient Tyre! Meon, the home of Nabal, they fixed close by,
because Mount Carmel was not far off, and Abigail came from Carmel.
They did not recognise that the Carmel of Abigail and Nabal was a city
in the south of Judah. Knowing that Capernaum was a fishing town, they
placed it on the Mediterranean coast and identified it with a fortress
of their day, now the village called Kefr Lam. These three places,
which were shown to the religious devotee as soon as he landed, are in
reality many days’ journey apart. Caipha (Haifa) was shown as a place
where Simon Peter used to fish. Shiloh was south of Bethel, and was
in fact the mountain now called Nebi Samwil. Sychar and Shechem were
one and the same place. “The Quarantania or Kuruntul mountain” (says
Conder) “has, from the twelfth century down, been shown as the place
where our Lord retired for the forty days of fasting in the desert.
Near to it the Crusaders also looked for the ‘exceeding high mountain’
whence the Tempter showed our Lord ‘all the kingdoms of the world and
the glory of them’ (Matt. iv. 8). Saewulf tells us that the site of
this mountain was 3 miles from Jericho. Fetellus places it north of
that town and 2 miles from Quarantania. The measurements bring us to
the remarkable cone called the Raven’s Nest. The story is wonderfully
descriptive of the simplicity of men’s minds in the twelfth century,
for the summit of the ‘exceeding high mountain,’ whence all the
kingdoms of the world were to have been seen, is actually lower than
the surface of the Mediterranean, and it is surrounded on every side by
mountains more than double its height.”

Tradition having been shown to be untrustworthy, when unsupported
by other evidence, a general uncertainty prevailed with regard to
Scripture places. No traveller could believe what his guide or guide
book told him, and no student could have confidence in his map. The
labour of investigation was beyond the power of private individuals;
and no Government and no Society had ever sent out an organized
expedition. But now happily this reproach is removed. The Committee
of the Palestine Exploration Fund were able to send out Major Conder,
R.E., and Colonel Kitchener, R.E., and these officers, with their
little party, spent seven years in carrying out a triangulation survey
of the entire country west of the river Jordan. As a result of their
labours, followed up by much patient work at home, we are now presented
with a magnificent map of Western Palestine, on the scale of one inch
to the mile, as beautifully and accurately executed as the ordnance
map of England, with every road and ruin marked, and every conspicuous
object filled in; with the hills and mountains correctly delineated and
shaded, with the rivers and brooks all running in the right directions;
with every vineyard, every spring of water, and almost every clump of
trees set down in its place, and with thousands of names that never
appeared on a Palestine map before. Moreover, while there are six
hundred and twenty-two Scripture names of places west of the Jordan,
and out of these three hundred and sixty were missing, the surveyors
have succeeded in finding one hundred and seventy-two of these. A
reduced map, on the scale of three-eighths of an inch to the mile, has
been prepared, and contains the Old Testament names and New Testament
names conspicuously marked, while other forms of the map show the
watershed and physical features of the country, or give the divisions
of the land and the Arabic names of places in use to-day.

There could be no better aid in studying the Scriptures than to
have such maps by our side; for whether we read of the marching and
counter-marching of armies; of the positions taken up before a battle;
of the direction taken by the retreating foe; the sites selected for
places of worship; the journeys of prophets of the Old Testament, or of
Jesus and his disciples in the New, so much depends upon the relative
positions of places, and their distances one from another, that we
necessarily lose a part of the meaning, and miss a portion of the
enjoyment unless we have a correct map by our side.

The best modern map of the Holy Land, previous to that prepared by the
Palestine Exploration Fund, was the work of Van de Velde, a careful
and scientific traveller and scholar. Van de Velde not only took
observations himself, but laid down on his map all the observations
made by previous travellers. Yet, when at the annual meeting of the
Palestine Exploration Fund in 1886, a portion of Van de Velde’s map
was shown on an enlarged scale, side by side with the same portion
of the Society’s map, similarly enlarged, the contrast was striking.
The first, with its hills roughly sketched in, its valleys laid down
roughly, and its inhabited places, villages, or ruins, gave all that
was known of this piece of country before the Survey. It was on such
a map as this, the best at the time, because the most faithful, that
the geographical student had to work. There was little use, from a
geographical point of view, in consulting previous books of travel,
because Van de Velde had gleaned from them all their geographical
facts. Yet hardly any single place was laid down correctly; none of the
hill shading was accurate; the course of the rivers and valleys was
not to be depended upon; the depression of the Lake of Galilee was
variously stated; distances were estimated by the rough reckoning of
time taken from place to place; and the number of names was only about
eighteen hundred, whereas the large map of the Palestine Exploration
Society contains ten thousand.[16]

  [Illustration: PHYSICAL MAP of PALESTINE]

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Tent Work in Palestine.” Major
   Conder, R. E. “Twenty-one Years’ Work in the Holy Land.” P. E.
   Fund. “Quarterly Statements of the P. E. Fund.”]


        8. _Israel’s Wars and Worship, considered in connection
              with the Physical Features of the Country._


                              _The Wars._

Now that we possess a detailed and accurate map of the Holy Land we are
in a position to study with advantage the conquest of the country by
Joshua, and to appreciate the motives of strategy and policy displayed
in the successive phases of Israel’s wars and worship.

The twelve tribes, coming out of the wilderness, encamped in the Plain
of the Jordan, opposite Jericho. While they rested there, Balak,
king of Moab, alarmed by their numbers, and uncertain as to their
intentions, sent to Mesopotamia for Balaam, to come and curse them.
Balaam ascended Mount Peor (sacred to Baal Peor, _i.e._, Baal the
Opener) and was constrained to bless them, and speak of them as “a
people that dwell alone--not reckoned among the nations” (Num. xxiii.
9).

Under Moses the Israelites conquered the country east of Jordan. The
gorge of the Arnon, 2000 feet deep, and with almost perpendicular
sides, was a natural boundary for the Moabites. Sometimes, indeed,
they possessed territory north of it; but since it would take a
traveller several hours to cross at the easiest parts, it was a natural
boundary. The district between the Arnon and the Jabbok, Moses wrested
from Sihon, king of Heshbon. And then, with the aid of the Ammonites,
he conquered the country north of the Jabbok, from Og, the king of
Bashan. These lands were not divided among all the tribes of Israel,
but were given to Reuben, Gad, and half the tribe of Manasseh as their
portion, for it was planned and intended that the country west of the
Jordan should be conquered and given to the rest.

The country west of Jordan was occupied by the Amorites and the
Canaanites--that is, as some suppose, by the Highlanders of the
central hills, and the Lowlanders of the plains around. But these
peoples appear to have been subdivided, so that, together with the
tribes of the Lebanon, we read of the Jebusite and the Girgashite, the
Hivite, the Arkite, and the Sinite, the Arvadite, the Zemarite and the
Hamathite, as well as Zidon and Heth (Gen. x. 15); and, in another
place, of the Kenite, the Kenizzite, and the Kadmonite, the Hittite,
the Perizzite, and the Rephaim (Gen. xv. 19). Of all these “nations” we
are told by St Paul that seven were eventually destroyed, and Israel
received their land for an inheritance (Acts xiii. 19).

It was not the object of Joshua in the first place to conquer the
“nations” in the plains, but rather those in the hills. It is true
that the hills were comparatively barren and infertile, while the
plains were exceedingly fruitful; but the hill country offered
counter-balancing advantages. Compared with the Egyptians, who
sometimes invaded Syria, the Israelites were small and weak, and their
greatest security would be in the hill fastnesses. More immediately
also, they have to consider that they are but a nation of foot
soldiers, while the Canaanites of the plains possess chariots and
horses. In any case, if they can once gain possession of the hills, it
may be easier thence to conquer the plains at their leisure, than it
would be for them by-and-bye to conquer the hills, with the plains as
their base of operations.

They approach the river opposite Jericho, and prepare to cross. The
spot is very well known, and it is where the pilgrims now go to bathe.
At this part the Jordan is ordinarily a brown, rapid, swirling stream,
some 20 yards across, fringed with a jungle of tamarisk, cane, and
willow, in which the leopard and the wolf find their hiding place. The
stream often runs low and is easily fordable in two or three places
hereabout. When we remember that the spies sent by Joshua had crossed
and recrossed without difficulty a few days before, we might suppose
that Joshua intended to march the entire army over at the fording
places, at low water, were we not told that at this season the Jordan
overflowed all its banks, it being the time of barley harvest. The
Jordan, it is recorded, was divided--“The waters which came down from
above stood and rose up in one heap a great way off from Adam, the
city which is beside Zarethan: and those that went down toward the Sea
of the Arabah, even the Salt Sea, were wholly cut off: and the people
passed over right against Jericho” (Josh. iii. 16). Major Conder has
discovered the name Zarethan, still in use, applied to a district 3
miles west of Bethshan; and on examining the gorge of the Jordan at
this part, a good way north of “Admah” or _Damieh_, he found that the
lower cliffs approach in places so close to one another that a very
little would dam up the river. In that event, in place of a shallow
stream some 20 yards across, a lake would be formed nearly a mile in
width, and the waters would have to rise to a height of 50 feet before
they overflowed the barrier and descended again to the south. But
whether in this way the bed of the Jordan was rendered dry while the
Israelites passed over, is a question upon which, of course, opinions
will differ.

When the tribes are safely across they encamp at a place called Gilgal.

An important success in the way of identifying Scripture sites has been
the recovery of Gilgal. Robinson had heard the name Jiljûlieh, but
had not been able to fix the site. In 1865 a German traveller (Herr
Schokke), more fortunate, was shown the place, at a mound about a
mile east of the modern Jericho; and Major Conder succeeded in fixing
the spot. Just west of the ruins grows a magnificent old tamarisk
tree, conspicuous from a distance. South-east of the tamarisk is an
oblong tank, measuring about 100 feet by 80 feet; and near this about
a dozen small mounds. The mounds are called Telleilât Jiljûlieh (the
little hillocks of Gilgal), and the tank is named Birket Jiljûlieh
(the Pool of Gilgal). “The Bedawin of the district,” says Conder,
“have a well-known tradition regarding the site of Jiljûlieh. Over the
coffee and pipes in the evening, after the day’s work was done, they
related it to us. By the old tamarisk once stood the City of Brass,
which was inhabited by Pagans. When Mohammed’s creed began to spread,
Aly, his son-in-law, ‘the lion of God,’ arrived at the city, and rode
seven times round it on his horse Maimûn. The brazen walls fell down,
destroyed by his breath, and the Pagans fled, pursued by the Faithful
toward Kŭrŭntŭl; but the day drew to a close, and darkness
threatened to shield the infidels. Then Aly, standing on the hill which
lies due east of the Kŭrŭntŭl crag, called out to the sun,
‘Come back, O blessed one!’ And the sun returned in heaven, so that the
hill has ever since been called ‘the Ridge of the return.’ Here stands
the Mukâm, or sacred station of Aly, and here also is the place where
Belâl ibn Rubâh, the Muedhen of the Prophet, called the Faithful to
prayer after the victory.”

Such is the legend, in which we see the fall of Jericho mixed up with
the battle of Aijalon, and assigned to Mohammedan heroes instead of to
Joshua.

Quite apart from the facilities of a ford, there was a good reason why
the Israelites should cross the Jordan where they did. The hill country
of Western Palestine is much broken by gorges, which serve not only as
torrent beds after the rains, but as passes to the central plateau.
The principal pass is by that great gorge, the continuation of the
Wady Kelt, which runs to the north of Jericho and up to Ai and Bethel.
Joshua intends to ascend by this pass. But there is an obstacle in the
way. Just at the foot of the hills--where the springs issue forth and
make a beautiful oasis--is the city of Jericho, “walled up to heaven.”
This is the key to the pass, and it would be bad generalship to rush
past the place and leave it in the rear. So Jericho, “the city of palm
trees,” was besieged and taken.

Modern Jericho is not a city of palm trees, but a very poor village,
of mud huts and black tents, standing amid low vineyards. For the
convenience of travellers, indeed, an excellent hotel has lately been
opened--the “Jordan Hotel”--but the proprietor has been disappointed in
his neighbours; the peasantry will not do a good day’s work for good
wages, he cannot even get fruit and garden stuff from them, and every
requisite has to be brought down from Jerusalem.

The site of Jericho has shifted considerably since Scripture times,
for the Bible city was near the Sultan’s Spring--Elisha’s Fountain--at
the foot of the pass, the only natural position, whereas the present
village is at a distance from the spring. Some Russian excavations in
the neighbourhood have brought to light shafts, columns, and lintels,
lamps, jars, rings, and weapons, some indication of former splendour.

The next city in the way of the invaders was Ai. We learn from the
narrative that Ai had Bethel on the west of it, and a plain in the
front or on the east, while there was a valley on the north side, and
low ground on the west between Ai and Bethel. With these particulars it
should be possible to identify the site. Sir Charles Wilson examined
the district in 1865, and confirmed the opinion of Rev. Canon Williams
that there is only one spot which answers to the description. “The
description applies in a very complete manner” (says Conder) “to the
neighbourhood of the modern village of Deir Diwan, and there are
here remains of a large ancient town, bearing the name Haiyan, which
approaches closely to Aina, the form under which Ai appears in the
writings of Josephus. Rock-cut tombs and ancient cisterns, with three
great reservoirs cut in the hard limestone, are sufficient to show this
to have been a position of importance. To the west is an open valley
called ‘Valley of the City,’ which, gradually curving round eastward,
runs close to the old road from Jericho by which Joshua’s army would
probably advance. To the north of the site there is also a great
valley, and the plain or plateau on which the modern village stands,
close to the old site, expands from a narrow and rugged pass leading up
towards Bethel, which is 2 miles distant on the watershed.”

Ascending from Jericho the path at one point enters upon the plain in
front of Ai, so that no army on its way to Bethel could afford to leave
Ai behind. Joshua took the city by stratagem, and we can see every step
of the proceeding. Marching troops up the northern valley, he placed an
ambush in the depression west of the city. The main body of his troops
attacked in front and presently feigned a retreat, drawing the men of
Ai after them till the city was empty. Then, at a given signal from
Joshua--who had posted himself on the hills to the north and could
be seen by both sections of his army--the ambush rose up and fired
the city, the men retreating turned back to fight, and the men of Ai,
caught “between two fires,” became utterly demoralised.

Bethel itself is now called Beitin. The site is known but with the
exception of a church of crusading date, and a tower, there are no
ruins of any importance. On a hill to the east is a stone circle,
consisting of large and small boulders.

After the victory at Ai a rapid march was made to Shechem, where, upon
the mountains of Ebal and Gerizim, the tribes assembled to hear the
reading of the Law and to pronounce their “amens” after the blessings
and the curses. It has been questioned whether they could hear one
another at the distance apart of these two mountain tops; but they
would hardly be on the mountain summits, for there is a natural
recess in the hills, with natural benches in the limestone rock, an
amphitheatre which might seem to have been formed for the purpose.
Modern travellers have stood in the midst of that valley and heard
their companions on either side reading the Law, and they assure us
that those who were reading could hear one another’s voices with
sufficient distinctness to take up the verse, each where the other left
off.

Shechem is now called Nablous--a corruption of the Roman Neapolis,
by which name it was rebaptized--and is a considerable city. The
Samaritans, now reduced in numbers to about one hundred and sixty
individuals, all told, live in this city, and none are found elsewhere.
In their synagogue they preserve several old copies of the Pentateuch,
and one of them, which is kept in a silver case and jealously guarded,
they declare to have been written by Abishua, the great-grandson
of Aaron. On a stone built into a tower near the synagogue is an
inscription--the oldest known in the Samaritan character--which it
was formerly impossible to read, because the inscription is upside
down in its place, and the investigator had to dangle on a rope and
hold his head downwards. But here we see the advantage of photography:
the picture was obtained in the camera, and the inscription when
turned right way up was seen to be the Samaritan version of the Ten
Commandments.

After the solemn ceremony of reading the Law at Shechem the Israelites
under Joshua returned to the camp at Gilgal. But by this time the
news of their victories had spread, the neighbouring cities became
alarmed, and all the kings throughout an extensive district gathered
together to fight against them. Meantime the wily Gibeonites, wearing
“old shoes and clouted,” and pretending to be ambassadors from a far
country, came to Joshua and succeeded in making a treaty of alliance,
offensive and defensive. After three days the deception was found out;
but it was held that the covenant must be kept, and when the kings of
Jerusalem, Hebron, Jarmuth, Lachish, and Eglon--“the five kings of
the Amorites”--went and encamped against Gibeon, Joshua went up from
Gilgal all the night to raise the siege. He came upon them suddenly,
and a terrible battle took place, which deserves to rank among the
decisive battles of the world. The conflict raged before Gibeon, and
the defeated kings were pursued, with continued slaughter, to higher
ground (the ascent of Beth-horon) and then to lower ground (the going
down of Beth-horon), as they vainly sought to escape down the Valley
of Aijalon into the Plain of Philistia. According to the poetical book
of Jasher,[17] quoted by the historian, “the sun stood still upon
Gibeon and the moon in the valley of Aijalon,” and lengthened out the
day until Joshua had defeated his foes utterly. The five kings were
found hidden in a cave at Makkedah, and were imprisoned there till the
pursuit was over and Joshua had leisure to decide their fate.

Makkedah has been identified by Colonel Sir C. Warren as being _El
Mughar_--“the cave”--a little south-west of Ekron. Conder tells us that
this is a remarkable place, and one of the most conspicuous sites in
the plain. A promontory of brown sandy rock juts out southwards, and at
the end is the village climbing up the hill-side. The huts are of mud,
and stand in many cases in front of caves; and from these caves the
modern name is derived. It is worthy of notice, he says, that this is
the only village in the Philistine plain at which he found such caves.

Joshua made his victory complete, by overthrowing Libnah, Lachish,
Eglon, Hebron, and other cities in succession, “utterly destroying all
that breathed,” until the centre and the south of the hill country were
altogether in his power.

In the spring of 1890, a _firman_ having been obtained, Mr Flinders
Petrie went to excavate at _Umm Lakis_ and _Ajlan_, the supposed sites
of Lachish and Eglon, two of the five strongholds of the Amorites
(Josh. x. 5). As soon as he arrived and could examine the ground, he
saw, from his Egyptian experience, that the two sites named were only
of Roman age and unimportant; while _Tell Hesy_ and _Nejileh_ in the
same neighbourhood promised better results. _Tell Hesy_ is a mound of
ruins 60 feet high and about 200 feet square, and one side of it has
been washed away by the stream, so that a clear section is afforded
from top to base. The generally early age of it was evident from the
fact that nothing later than good Greek pottery was found at the top
of it, while near the middle, and from that to three-quarters of the
height, was found Phœnician ware, which is known in Egypt to date
from 1100 B.C. The foundation seems to date from about 1500
B.C., agreeing nearly with the beginning of the Egyptian raids
under Thothmes I.

The actual remains of _Tell Hesy_ consist of a mound which is formed of
successive towns, one on the ruins of another, and an enclosure taking
in an area to the south and west of it. This enclosure is nearly a
quarter of a mile across in each direction, and is bounded by a clay
rampart still 7 feet high in parts, and in one place by a brick wall.
This area of about 30 acres would suffice to take in a large quantity
of cattle in case of a sudden invasion; and such was probably its
purpose, as no buildings are found in it, and there is but little depth
of soil. The city mound is about 200 feet square, and rests on natural
ground 45 to 58 feet above the stream in the _wady_ below. The earliest
town here was of great strength and importance, the lowest wall of all
being 28 feet 8 inches thick, of clay bricks, unburnt; and over this
are two successive patchings of later rebuilding, altogether 21 feet of
height remaining. “Such massive work” (says Mr Petrie) “was certainly
not that of the oppressed Israelites during the time of the Judges; it
cannot be as late as the Kings, since the pottery of about 1100 B.C.
is found above its level. It must, therefore, be the Amorite city, and
agrees with the account that ‘the cities were walled and very great’
(Num. xiii. 28), ‘great and walled up to heaven’ (Deut. i. 28), and
also with the sculptures of the conquests of Rameses II. at Karnak,
where the Amorite cities are all massively fortified.”

Mr Petrie feels little doubt that _Tell Hesy_ is Lachish and _Tell
Nejileh_, 6 miles south of it, Eglon. There are no sites in the country
around so suited to the importance of Lachish and Eglon as these two
_tells_; they command the only springs and water-course which exist in
the whole district, and it is certain that the positions must have
been of first-rate importance from the time of the earliest settlements.

Above the Amorite wall at _Tell Hesy_ Mr Petrie finds 5 feet of
dust and rolled stones corresponding to the barbaric period of the
Judges; then a wall 13 feet thick, probably belonging to Rehoboam’s
fortifications of Lachish (2 Chron. xi. 9), and above this successive
rebuildings until the city is finally destroyed about 500 B.
C. The mound is full of potsherds, and the good fortune of such a
grand section as that of the east face from top to bottom, affords at
one stroke a series of all the varieties of pottery extending through
a thousand years. “We now know for certain,” Mr Petrie says, “the
characteristics of Amorite pottery, of earlier Jewish, and later Jewish
influenced by Greek trade, and we can trace the importation and the
influence of Phœnician pottery. In future all the _tells_ and ruins of
the country will at once reveal their age by the potsherds which cover
them.”

Lachish, with its wall 28 feet in thickness, is a specimen of the
Amorite cities which Joshua overthrew in the south.

But now the kings of the north are alarmed, and Jabin king of Hazor
gathers together the tribes of the Lebanon. He calls to his assistance
the kings of the Jordan Valley, the kings of the Sharon Plain, with
the Jebusites and all who are willing to come. The battle takes place
near the Waters of Merom. The Canaanites are furnished with chariots
and horses, and the Israelites, being without such helps, are prudently
posted on the hills. We read that Joshua “fell upon” the foe, down the
slopes, and drove them before him, on the west as far as to Zidon,
and on the east to the valley of Mizpeh: he burned their chariots,
hamstrung their horses, and again “left none remaining.” So now the
north as well as the south of the hill country is subdued; Joshua
settles four tribes in these northern districts, and the Sea of Galilee
becomes a Hebrew lake.

There is no need any more to come back all the way to Gilgal, for no
foe is left to dispute their occupation anywhere, and the armies only
return as far as Shiloh, in the centre of the hills, and there set
up “the Tent of Meeting.” Nor is there need any longer to detain the
two and a half tribes from the east of Jordan who have come across to
assist in the conquest. So the soldiers of Reuben, Gad, and Manasseh
are sent back to their homes. “And when they came to the region about
Jordan that is in the land of Canaan” they built there an altar--“a
great altar to see to,” and which was afterwards called “Ed” or
Witness. Their brethren were so indignant at this action--regarding
it as heathen worship, and rebellion against the God of Israel--that
they thought of going to war against them. However, they prudently sent
envoys to demand an explanation, and the explanation was perfectly
satisfactory.

Where was this altar of Ed, so conspicuous from afar? If we stand in
the Jordan Valley near Jericho, and look northwards, we cannot fail to
see, at a distance of 20 miles, a conical peak called _Kurn Surtabeh_,
standing out like a bastion at the eastern end of a chain of blue
hills. This peak is 1500 feet above the level of the Mediterranean,
and 2500 feet above the Jordan, near to it. From the top of it one
may see the Dead Sea to the south, the Sea of Galilee to the north,
the mountains of Ebal and Gerizim in the centre. According to the
Jewish Talmud this mountain was a beacon station, where the fires were
lighted, in connection with fires on the Mount of Olives, to signify
the advent of the new moon. Conder, some years ago, pointed out that
this mountain would be in the path which the two and a half tribes
should naturally take in going from Shiloh to their home in Gilead, the
fords of the Jordan being a little way north of it. On the top of this
almost inaccessible peak he found some huge masonry work of ancient
character, which he was inclined at the time to regard as remnants
of the altar. And when the identification seemed to be thus nearly
complete, it appeared to be confirmed by the discovery that the north
side of the mountain, the only accessible side is called “the Ascent of
Ed.” But the identification was disputed.

It was pointed out that Josephus says the altar was on the east side of
Jordan, and that the Scripture narrative makes the tribes to cross the
river at “the passage of the Children of Israel,” which is supposed to
describe the Jericho ford and not the ford at Damieh. For these reasons
Conder now regards his idea as “only a conjecture.”

It may be reasonably questioned, however, whether the identification
should be given up. We are told in Joshua xxii. 10, that the altar, so
high to look to, was in “the region about Jordan that is in the land
of Canaan”--“in the forefront of the land of Canaan, in the region
about Jordan, on the side that pertaineth to the Children of Israel.”
The historian takes pains to distinguish between the two sides of the
river, and if one side pertained to the Children of Israel more than
the other, it was surely not the eastern side. Moreover, the altar
was in the land of Canaan, and the eastern boundary of Canaan was
the Jordan itself (see Gen. x. 19, and page 107 of this volume). The
altar was “in the forefront of the land of Canaan,” at the extreme
of its eastern side, and therefore close by the Jordan. The Hebrew
faced the rising sun, and spoke of the south as the right hand, the
north as the left, so that his forehead or forefront was to the east.
It was apparently because the supposed idolatrous altar was set up
on territory belonging to the western tribes that those tribes felt
so insulted. The east of Jordan was unclean, but the western country
was “the possession of the Lord.” “Come across”, they said, “into the
Lord’s land, if you will; but if you come, do not build rebel altars”
(v. 19). Further, the object of the two and a half tribes, according
to their apology and explanation, was to have a memorial in that
western land from which the Jordan seemed to cut them off.

Two and a half tribes being settled east of Jordan, three tribes north
of the Plain of Esdraelon, and one in the Plain itself, the remainder
of the country is divided between the remaining five tribes and a half.

In the Book of Joshua the boundaries of the tribes are given with the
greatest minuteness, but it was impossible for us to trace them with
any accuracy before the topographical survey was carried out. Many of
the villages by which the border lines passed were lost, in some cases
the sites were displaced; but as soon as these things were rectified
the boundaries could again be drawn.

The blessing which Jacob pronounced upon his sons, according to
Gen. xlix., was true to the position of the tribes in their several
districts; and their position determined in some degree their conduct
and their fortunes. When Joshua dismissed the two and a half tribes,
they went away to their tents: living on those green hills east of
Jordan, they remained for a long time a pastoral people. Reuben,
bordering on Arabia, and being “unstable as water,” became hardly
distinguishable from an Arab tribe. Gad, of whom Jacob said, “a troop
shall press upon him,” was subject to attacks from troops of Bedouin
plunderers. Divided from their brethren by the great gorge of the
Jordan, the eastern tribes were separated also in their fortunes.
The three northern tribes of Asher, Zebulon, and Naphtali were also
partially cut off by the great plain of Esdraelon. They got into
communication with the northern nations from whom they were less
separated geographically, and they entered into alliance with Phœnicia.
Solomon gave away twenty of their cities to Hiram, king of Tyre,
apparently thinking that the allegiance which was so nearly gone,
might as well be parted with altogether. These northern tribes, like
those east of Jordan, seldom came to the assistance of their brethren
in any great crisis. When Deborah required help from all quarters
she had to complain that Asher “sat still at the haven of the sea,”
and Reuben “sat among the sheep-folds, to hear the pipings for the
flocks.” In the south--in a country half a desert, the lair of wild
beasts--Judah “couched as a lion,” and it was dangerous to rouse him
up. Ephraim, the most powerful of the tribes, secured to himself the
choicest portion of the hill country. Manasseh, with territory on
both sides of the Jordan, was “a fruitful bough by a fountain, whose
branches run over the wall.” Little Benjamin, situated between the
two powerful tribes of Ephraim and Judah, knew not which to be guided
by, and was at last torn asunder in the effort to follow both. Yet
Benjamin, on whose eastern border we still find a valley, called the
Wolf’s Den, was “a wolf that ravineth” and often “devoured the prey.”
Issachar “saw the land that it was pleasant”--namely, the fruitful
plain of Esdraelon,--and “bowed his shoulder to bear, and became a
servant under task-work,” cultivating the ground.

The tribe of Levi had no district of country assigned to it, but in
place thereof forty-eight cities, scattered throughout the tribes. Of
these cities two have been identified by the agents of the Palestine
Exploration Fund.

The recovery of the site of _Gezer_ we owe to M. Clermont Ganneau.
It is in the lowland district, and off the road to the right as one
goes up from Jaffa to Jerusalem, about 8 miles past Ramleh. The modern
name, _Tell Jezer_, represents the Hebrew exactly. Gezer had been a
royal city of the Canaanites; and it was in a position commanding one
of the important passes. The Levitical cities had around them a margin
of 1000 cubits. In 1874 M. Ganneau was shown by the peasantry a rude
inscription deeply cut in the flat surface of the natural rock. It
appears to be in Hebrew letters, and to read “Boundary of Gezer.” He
afterwards found a second, similar to it; and from their position he
judges that the city lay four-square, and had its angles directed to
the cardinal points of the compass. It was this city of Gezer which was
reconquered from the Philistines by Pharaoh, and handed over to Solomon
as a dowry with his daughter.

We owe to Major Conder the discovery of another of these Levitical
cities, namely, the royal city of Debir, south-west of Hebron, together
with the “upper and nether springs of water” (at a distance), which
Caleb gave to his daughter, on the occasion of her marriage (Judges
i. 15). The modern name is Dhâheriyeh, and the place is evidently an
ancient site of importance, to which several old roads lead from all
sides. Another name for this place was Kirjath-Sepher, which means
Book-Town; so that it must have been noted for books or writings of
some kind.

In tracing the boundaries of the tribes the surveyors found reason to
look upon the Book of Joshua as “the Domesday Book of Palestine.” The
towns in a district are all mentioned together, and in such consecutive
topographical order that many Scripture sites could be identified from
this very circumstance. The tribal boundaries are shown to be almost
entirely natural, namely, rivers, ravines, ridges, and the watershed
lines of the country. It is a remarkable fact, however, that while
the descriptions of tribal boundaries and cities are full and minute
in the territory of Judea, and scarcely less so in Galilee, they are
fragmentary and meagre within the bounds of Samaria. There is no
account of the conquest of Samaria, nor does the list of royal cities
include the famous Samaritan towns of Shechem, Thebez, Acrabbi, and
others. No list of the cities of Ephraim and Manasseh is included in
the topographical chapters of the Book of Joshua, nor any description
of the northern limits of Manasseh, and only a very slight one of the
southern border, where that tribe marched with Ephraim.

Thus far, in our description of Joshua’s conquest, we have seen how
his good generalship secured possession of the hills--the central
hills only, and not the plains. The Canaanites still dwelt in the
plains round about. The Philistines held the south-west. The Phœnicians
were secure in the north. The outlying nations of Edom and Moab were
undisturbed. In this condition things remained for a long time; and the
Israelites, occupying the hills only, were not likely to become a race
of sailors. Nor did they desire it, if we may judge from such notices
of the sea as occur in the Bible, for they seem to show the awe with
which the writers regarded its rolling waves. And besides, the coast
was not suited for it. The principal harbour was Tyre; but that was in
Phœnicia, which was hardly to be included in Palestine. South of Tyre
we have Accho, Caipha, and Joppa; but these are by no means good and
convenient as ports. Accho is the best, but has been the least used,
although Napoleon considered it “the key of Palestine.” It was to
Joppa that the Phœnicians brought timber in rafts for the building of
Solomon’s Temple; and thence it was carried by road to Jerusalem. It
was at Joppa that Jonah found a ship going to Tarshish, and took his
passage.

If the sea coast was little available for the Israelites, the Jordan
was still worse: a narrow, shallow, rocky stream, ending in the Dead
Sea, it led to nowhere, and was useless for purposes of commerce.

Naturally the capitals of the country were inland--Jerusalem in the
centre of the hills, and afterwards Shechem. The main road of the
country ran from south to north, along the watershed, the backbone of
highest ground. But since the hills were comparatively unfruitful,
the dwellers there suffered more in times of famine than the dwellers
in the plains. In times of war they had some advantage, and preferred
to fight from the hillsides, as they did not possess chariots and
horses, and could have found no use for them. Their enemies said of
them,--“their God is a God of the hills; He is not a God of the plains!”

Accordingly, the enemies of Israel sought to entice them to fight in
the plains, and sometimes partially succeeded. The Plain of Esdraelon
became a great battle field. The Great Plain, as distinguished from the
Plain of Acre, the Valley of Jezreel, and others which are continuous
with it, measures about 14 miles by 9. It is described by Conder as one
of the richest natural fields of cultivation in Palestine, or perhaps
in all the world. “The elevation,” he says, “is about 200 to 250 feet
above the sea, and a Y-shaped double range of hills bounds it east
and west, with an average elevation of 1500 feet above the plain on
the north-east. On the north-east are the two detached blocks of Neby
Duhy (Little Hermon) and Tabor, and on the north-west a narrow gorge
is formed by the river Kishon, which springs from beneath Tabor, and,
collecting the whole drainage of this large basin, passes from the
Great Plain to that of Acre. On the east of the plain the broad Valley
of Jezreel gradually slopes down towards Jordan, and Jezreel itself
(the modern Zerin) stands on the side of Gilboa above it. On the west
are the scarcely less famous sites of Legis, Taanach, and Joknean,
while the picturesque conical hill of Duhy, just north of the Jezreel
Valley, has Shunem on its south slope, and Nain and Endor on the north.
Thus seven places of interest lie at the foot of the hills east and
west; but no important town was ever situated in the plain itself.”

The first great struggle in this plain was against Sisera, captain of
the host of Jabin, king of Canaan, who came with nine hundred chariots,
and threatened the Israelites near the sources of the Kishon. The
topography of the Scriptural episode of the defeat and death of Sisera
has been hitherto very little understood. The scene of the battle has
often been placed in the south-west of the great Esdraelon plain, and
the defeated general has been supposed to have fled a distance of 35
miles over the high mountains of Upper Galilee. But this is contrary
to what we know of the general character of the Biblical stories, the
scenes of which are always laid in a very confined area. The kings of
Canaan assembled in Taanach and by the waters of Megiddo, but it was
not at either of these places that the battle was fought. Sisera was
drawn to the river Kishon (Judges iv. 7), and the conflict took place
in the plain south-west of Mount Tabor.

The forces of the Israelites were posted on the side of Mount Tabor.
At a signal from Deborah they rushed down the slope and attacked the
foe. At that moment a terrible storm from the east sent sleet and hail
full into the face of the enemy. They turned and fled along a line at
the base of the northern hills, where a chain of pools and springs,
fringed with reeds and rushes, marks, even in the dry season, the
course of the Kishon. The rain converted the volcanic dust of the plain
into mud, and clogged the wheels of the chariots. The water pouring
down from the hills swelled the stream, and “the river of Kishon swept
them away, that ancient river the river Kishon.” The remainder fled
to Harosheth, now only a miserable village (_El Harathiyeh_), named
from the beautiful woods above the Kishon at the point where, through
a narrow gorge, the stream, hidden among oleander bushes, enters the
Plain of Acre.

The flight of Sisera himself was in an opposite direction--to the Plain
of Zaanaim, or rather Bitzaanaim, “the marshes,” _i.e._, the marshy
springs east of Tabor--the neighbourhood of _Bessum_. The Kedesh
of the passage is probably a site so called south of Tiberias; and
the tent of Heber the Kenite would thus have been spread on the open
plateau within 10 miles of the site of the battle.

The next great struggle in this plain was one upon which the Survey
of Palestine has thrown some new light, enabling us to follow the
fugitives in their retreat, and to fix some sites which are named in
the narrative. The fruitfulness of the Great Plain has been, in our
own times and all through the ages, an irresistible attraction to the
Bedouin from the east of Jordan. Pressed by war or famine, they have
crossed the Jordan at the fords near Beisan, poured up the Valley
of Jezreel, and covered the plain with their tents and camels. The
peaceful husbandmen have laboured, only to be periodically plundered
and oppressed. Thus in 1870 only about a sixth part of the beautiful
corn land was tilled, and the plain was black with Arab “houses of
hair.” But the Turks wrought a great and sudden change; they armed
their cavalry with the Remington breech-loading rifle, and the Bedouin
disappeared as if by magic. In 1872 nine-tenths of the plain was
cultivated, nearly half with corn, the rest with millet, sesame,
cotton, tobacco, and the castor-oil plant. It was, of course, to be
expected that when external troubles had weakened the Government,
the lawless Nomads would again encroach and levy toll as before.
Accordingly, in 1877, Fendi el Fais and the Sukr Arabs once more
invaded the plain and levied blackmail on the luckless peasantry.
Thus it has ever been; for the history of Palestine seems constantly
to repeat itself from the earliest period recorded, in a recurring
struggle between the settled population and the Nomads.

Some time after the days of Barak and Deborah, the historian tells
us, “the children of Israel did that which was evil in the sight of
the Lord, and the Lord delivered them into the hand of Midian seven
years.” These marauders from the east came across the Jordan, bringing
their cattle and their camels, and pitching their black tents. They
came as locusts for multitude, eating up the fruitful country and
levying tribute on the villages, all the way round to Gaza. The
Israelites fled in alarm, taking refuge in the mountains, and existing
in dens and caves. No sustenance was left them, either for sheep,
or ox, or ass; and “Israel was brought very low because of Midian.”
Perhaps they might have borne the oppression longer, only that their
lives were not safe from the sword, and they smarted under losses
inflicted on their families. In some petty struggle, perhaps it was,
in which one brother came to the assistance of another, that seven
fine young men, sons of Joash of Abiezer, were put to death by Zeba
and Zalmunna the Chiefs of Midian. But there was one son left, whose
name was Gideon, and he was a man of valour. He felt this oppression
to be insupportable: the spirit of the Lord came upon him, and after
destroying the altar of Baal in his native place, he blew a trumpet,
and raised a revolt. His own tribesmen (the men of Menasseh) gathered
to his standard, and the men of the northern tribes also, even Asher
assisting on this occasion.

Gideon “pitched beside the Spring of Harod, and the camp of Midian was
on the north side of them, in the valley.” The Bible narrative appears
to show that the spring was in the neighbourhood of Gilboa, being
towards the south of the Valley of Jezreel. “It is very striking,” says
Conder, “to find in this position a large spring with the name ’_Ain
el Jem’ain_,’ or ‘fountain of the two troops’ and there seems no valid
objection to the view that this is the Spring of Harod.”

Gideon went down upon the enemy in the midnight darkness, leading
three hundred men, who carried concealed torches, as well as trumpets.
The sudden sounding of trumpets and flashing of lights spread
consternation among the Midianites; they fought suicidally, every
man’s hand was against his brother, and they fled down the Valley of
Jezreel. It was some 10 miles or more to the fords of the Jordan. At
the fords they divided, Zeba and Zalmunna, the sheikhs, passing over,
while Oreb and Zeeb, the lesser chiefs, continued their journey on the
western side. Presumably they were hoping to get across at the great
ford opposite Jericho; but Gideon sent word to the men of Ephraim
to intercept them, and they did so. Gideon himself crossed at the
northern fords, pursuing Zeba and Zalmunna, as far as Karkor, and when
he had captured them he brought them back to Penuel. “Then said he to
them, ‘What manner of men were they whom ye slew at Tabor?’ And they
answered, ‘As thou art, so were they; each one resembled the children
of a king.’ And he said, ‘They were my brethren, the sons of my mother:
as the Lord liveth, if ye had saved them alive, I would not slay you.’”

The men of Ephraim “slew Oreb at the rock of Oreb, and Zeeb at the
winepress of Zeeb.” These two names signify the _Raven_ and the
_Wolf_--not unnatural names for the chiefs of Nomad tribes--and Conder
has discovered these names in the Jordan valley, a little north of
Jericho. There is a curious conical chalk hill called ’_Osh el Ghurab_,
the “Raven’s Peak,” and near to it a lesser hill with a valley, known
as _Tuweil edh Dhiab_, the “Wolf’s Den.” The executions, if they took
place on these elevations, would be in sight of all the people in the
plain; and afterwards the heads were carried across to Gideon, who was
now beyond Jordan.

But victory was not always given to the Israelites in the Plain of
Esdraelon. In the days of King Saul the Philistines, having been twice
beaten in the hills, determined to try their fortune in the plains.
Under the leadership of Achish, king of Gath, they marched northward,
round the promontory of Carmel, and took up their position at Shunem,
under “Little Hermon.”[18] Saul was posted on Mount Gilboa, but had
no confidence in his strength. In his distress, indeed, he actually
paid a night visit to the witch of Endor, although Endor was north of
“Little Hermon,” and he had to go past the Philistine camp to reach
it. The next morning the battle went against him: the Israelites
were positively driven up the slope of Gilboa and slaughtered on the
heights, which should have been their natural battle-ground. David,
when he heard of it, felt the humiliation of it, or at least the depth
of the misfortune, and his dirge for Saul and his son opens with the
words, “Thy glory, O Israel, is slain upon thy high places! How are the
mighty fallen! Tell it not in Gath” (2 Sam. i.).

The head of Saul was sent round to Ashdod, to the temple of Dagon, the
Philistine Fish-god. The armour of Saul was dedicated to the goddess
Ashtoreth, in the city of Bethshan, not very far from the scene of
the battle. We may judge that Bethshan was still in possession of the
Canaanites. The bodies of Saul and his sons were fastened to the wall
of Bethshan. But the men of Jabesh Gilead, east of Jordan, a city
which Saul had once befriended (1 Sam. xi.), came across in the night
and took them away. After burning them in Jabesh, they buried the
bones under a tamarisk tree; and thence, at a later opportunity, David
fetched them away and buried them in the family tomb in Benjamin.

We read in Scripture of “Bethshan and her daughter towns” as belonging
to the tribe of Manasseh (1 Chron. vii. 29). A black mound at the
modern Beisan represents the Bethshan or Bethshean of the text. On
this natural fortress stood the citadel. The ruins have been planned
by Conder; and his drawings will be found in the Memoirs of the
Survey. Not far from Beisan are the ruins of a Roman bridge across the
Jordan--the highway to Gadara. In the plain of Beisan, as we learn from
Mr Trelawney Saunders, are twenty-four _tells_, scattered all over the
upper and lower terraces. They still bear distinctive names; and Mr
Saunders feels no doubt that they are the sites of former habitations,
scenes of domestic happiness and abundant wealth. Moreover, he surmises
that the life and happiness of the district may be restored almost
as rapidly as they were obliterated, when once the civilisation and
power of the West becomes conscious of the connection between Oriental
prosperity and that of its own manufacturing populations. “These
_tells_,” he says, “probably mark the substantial and lordly centres of
villages, the latter more or less extensive, and readily levelled with
the ground. They denote the populous character of the region, when a
strong government restrained the plundering Ishmaelites, and protected
instead of robbed people. The _tells_ are more indicative of a large
population than the remains of such a ‘splendid’ and ‘noble’ city as
Beisan, when it was either Jewish Bethshan or heathen Scythopolis; with
its dominating citadel, temples, hippodrome, theatre, baths, monument,
and bridge.” If there be any truth in this view of the matter we may
expect interesting results from an exploration of these _tells_. Conder
describes the locality as one of the best watered in Palestine, and (in
April) literally streaming with rivulets from some fifty springs.

The death of Saul brought David to the throne. But David had previously
gone through an adventurous experience, the story of which is
intimately connected with localities that are mentioned, and requires
a knowledge of the topography fully to appreciate. “The desert of
Judah,” says Conder, “was no doubt as much a desert in David’s time as
it is now. Here he wandered with his brigand companions as ‘a partridge
on the mountains.’ Here he may have learned that the coney makes its
dwelling in the hard rocks. Here, in earlier days, he tended the sheep,
descending from Bethlehem, as the village shepherds of the present day
still come down, by virtue of a compact with the lawless Nomads, and
just as Nabal’s sheep came down from the highlands under agreement with
the wild followers of the outlaw born to be a king. I do not know any
part of the Old Testament more instinct with life than are the early
chapters of Samuel which recount the wanderings of David. His life
should only be written by one who has followed those wanderings on the
spot; and the critic who would imbue himself with a right understanding
of that ancient chronicle should first with his own eyes gaze on the
‘rocks of the wild goats’ and the ‘junipers’ of the desert.”

Conder declares that we have now so recovered the topography of
David’s wanderings that the various scenes seem as vivid as if they
had occurred only yesterday. First, we have the stronghold of Adullam,
guarding the rich corn valley of Elah; then Keilah, a few miles
south, perched on its steep hill above the same valley. The forest of
Hareth lay close by, on the edge of the mountain chain where Kharas
now stands, surrounded by the “thickets” which properly represent the
Hebrew “Yar”--a word wrongly supposed to mean a woodland of timber
trees.

Driven from all these lairs, David went yet further south to the
neighbourhood of Ziph.... The treachery of the inhabitants of Ziph,
like that of the men of Keilah, appears to have driven David to a yet
more desolate district, that of the Jeshimon, or “Solitude,” by which
is apparently intended the great desert above the western shores of the
Dead Sea, on which the Ziph plateau looks down. As a shepherd-boy at
Bethlehem, David may probably have been already familiar with this part
of the country, and the caves, still used as sheep-cotes by the peasant
herdsmen, extend all along the slopes at the edge of the desert.

East of Ziph is a prominent hill on which is the ruined town called
Cain in the Bible. Hence the eye ranges over the theatre of David’s
wanderings: the whole scenery of the flight of David, and of Saul’s
pursuit, can be viewed from this one hill.

The stronghold chosen by the fugitive was the hill Hachilah, in the
wilderness of Ziph, south of Jeshimon. “This, I would propose” (says
Conder) “to recognise in the long ridge called El Kôlah.... On the
north side of the hill are the ‘Caves of the Dreamers,’ perhaps the
actual scene of David’s descent on Saul’s sleeping guards.”

Pursued even to Hachilah, David descended farther south, to a rock or
cliff in the wilderness of Maon, which was named “Cliff of Division”
(1 Sam. xxiii. 2-8). Here he is represented as being on one side of
the mountain, while Saul was on the other. Now, between the ridge of
El Kôlah and the neighbourhood of Maon there is a great gorge called
“the Valley of Rocks,” a narrow, but deep chasm, impassable except by
a detour of many miles, so that Saul might have stood within sight of
David, yet quite unable to overtake his enemy; and to this “Cliff of
Division” the name _Malâky_ now applies, a word closely approaching the
Hebrew Mahlekoth. The neighbourhood is seamed with many torrent-beds,
but there is no other place near Maon where cliffs, such as are to be
inferred from the word Sela, can be found. “It seems to me pretty
safe, therefore” (says Conder) “to look on this gorge as the scene of
the wonderful escape of David, due to a sudden Philistine invasion,
which terminated the history of his hair-breadth escapes in the South
Country.”

To return to Adullam. The famous hold where David collected “every
one that was in distress and every one that was in debt, and every
one that was discontented,” was, according to Josephus, at the city
called Adullam (Ant. vi. 12, 3). This city was one of the group of
fifteen situated in the Shephelah or Lowlands (Josh. xv. 35). The term
Shephelah is applied to the low hills of soft limestone which form a
distinct district between the maritime plain and the central line of
mountains. M. Clermont Ganneau was the first explorer who found the
name Adullam still in use; but Major Conder also, on finding it among
the names which Corporal Brophy had collected, set out to examine the
site.

The great Valley of Elah (Wâdy es Sunt) is the highway from Philistia
to Hebron; and divides the low hills of the Shephelah from the rocky
mountains of Judah. Eight miles from the valley-head stands Shochoh,
and Wâdy es Sunt is here a quarter of a mile across: just north of
this ruin it turns round westward, and so runs, growing deeper and
deeper, between the rocky hills covered with brushwood, becoming
an open vale of rich corn land, flanked by ancient fortresses, and
finally debouching at the cliff of _Tell es Safi_. About 2½ miles south
of the great angle near Shochoh there is a very large and ancient
terebinth--it is from _elah_ the “terebinth” tree that the valley gets
its name--and near it are two ancient wells, with stone water troughs
round them. South of the ravine is a high rounded hill, almost isolated
by valleys, and covered with ruins, a natural fortress, not unlike the
well-known _tells_ which occur lower down the valley of Elah. “This
site seems to be ancient” (says Conder), “not only because of the
wells, but judging from the caves, the tombs, and the rock quarryings
which exist near it.”

Below the hill, and near the well, there are ruins which are called
_’Aid el Ma_, and this is radically identical with the Hebrew Adullam.
“But if this ruined fortress be, as there seems no good reason to
doubt it is, the royal city of Adullam, where, we should naturally
ask, is the famous cave? The answer is easy, for the cave is on the
hill. We must not look for one of the greater caverns, such as the
Crusaders fixed upon in the romantic gorge east of Bethlehem, for such
caverns are never inhabited in Palestine; we should expect, rather,
a moderate-sized cave, or (considering the strength of the band) a
succession of ‘hollow-places.’ The site of Adullam is ruinous, but not
deserted. The sides of the tributary valley are lined with rows of
caves, and these we found inhabited, and full of flocks and herds. But
still more interesting was the discovery of a separate cave on the hill
itself, a low, smoke-blackened burrow, which was the home of a single
family. We could not but suppose, as we entered this gloomy abode,
that our feet were standing on the very foot-prints of the Shepherd
King, who here, encamped between the Philistines and the Jews, covered
the line of advance on the corn fields of Keilah, and was but 3 miles
distant from the thickets of Hareth.

“The hill is about 500 feet high.... There is ample room to have
accommodated David’s four hundred men in the caves, and they are, as we
have seen, still inhabited.

“It is interesting to observe that the scene of David’s victory over
Goliath is distant only 8 miles from the cave at _’Aid el Ma_.”

When David became king of all Israel, he made it his first great
object to capture Jerusalem. There might be several reasons for this.
In the first place, his capital hitherto had been Hebron, a city
which was not sufficiently central. Secondly, the border line between
Judah and Benjamin ran right through Jerusalem; the city was partly
in the territory of one tribe, partly in the other; Saul was a man of
Benjamin, while David belonged to Judah; so that there were jealousies
between these two tribes, which might be healed if David could make the
city his capital. Thirdly, Jerusalem had proved itself to be a strong
city, well-nigh impregnable. Joshua had not taken it, as he took the
other cities of the Gibeonite league--it has defied the arms of Israel
for four or five centuries--and therefore, if David can capture it,
he will possess a redoubtable stronghold. Jerusalem, therefore, was
besieged and taken. Secure in Jerusalem, David extended his conquests
on every side, subduing Philistines, Moabites, Edomites, Ammonites, and
Midianites; placing garrisons in the towns of Syria, and even extending
his rule as far as the river Euphrates. Of all these countries
Philistia alone comes into the survey of Western Palestine.

Gaza, the capital of Philistia, still exists as an inhabited city, and
is very picturesquely situated, having a fine approach down a broad
avenue from the north. It rises on an isolated hill, about 100 feet
above the plain, and bristles with minarets. The population is given
by Conder as eighteen thousand, including sixty or seventy houses
of Greek Christians. The town is not walled, but the green mounds
traceable round the hill are probably remains of the ancient enclosure.
The new mosque, built some forty or fifty years ago, is full of marble
fragments, from ancient buildings which were principally found near
the sea-shore. East of the Serai is the reputed tomb of Samson; and
south-east of the city is a hill called the Watch-tower, to which
place, according to tradition, Samson carried the gates of Gaza. A
yearly festival of the Moslems is held there.

North-east of Makkedah, Ekron still stands, on low rising ground--a
mud hamlet, with gardens fenced with prickly pears. Conder says there
is nothing ancient here.

  [Illustration: TELL ES SAFI. (Site of Gath?) (_By favour of
  the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

At Azotus, or Ashdod, one of the Philistine cities, is a large mound,
with columns cropping up out of the ground on the outskirts of it.
Mr Trelawney Saunders, the geographer, has described the site in his
“Introduction to the Survey of Western Palestine.” Ashdod, on a hillock
(alt. 140 feet), at the western end of the plain of Zeita, is now
separated from all that remains of its port, by sand-downs 3 miles in
breadth. The site is occupied by the present village of Esdud, with
eighteen hundred people, but the remains of this primeval city, once so
strong and mighty, are so few and insignificant that one is tempted to
suppose the greater part of the city may be buried beneath the sands.
If so, they may be in a superior state of preservation, and would
perhaps repay for digging out.

Gath, the birth-place of Goliath, has long been a lost city, but is now
reasonably identified with _Tell es Sufi_ at the mouth of the _Wady_
or water-course which runs from near Hebron, past Adullam and Shochoh,
and westward towards Ashdod. It is the site of the Crusading fortress
of Blanche Garde, which was built in 1144 A.D. as an outpost
for defence against the people of Ascalon. It is now a mud village with
olives beneath it, standing on a cliff 300 feet high, which is burrowed
with caves. The Rev. Henry George Tomkins takes _Tell es Sufi_ to be
the “mound of Safi,” and regards Safi as a personal name. In a learned
paper in the _Quarterly Statement_, October 1886, he argues that Safi
was a brother of Goliath’s, and if so this is an additional reason for
regarding _Tell es Sufi_ as Gath.

Ascalon, “the bride of Syria,” is still called Askalon. The
fortifications and walls are in ruins, and the site of the city is a
garden planted with fruit trees and vegetables. The walls are the ruins
of battlements, erected by Richard Lionheart in 1191 A.D.,
in place of those destroyed by Saladin, and doubtless with the same
materials. They are half buried by the great dunes of rolling sand
which are ever being blown up by the sea breeze from the southward.
The whole interior of the site is covered with rich soil, to a depth
of about 10 feet, and the natives find fragments of fine masonry,
shafts, capitals, and other remains of the old city, by digging into
it. Of Herod’s beautiful colonnades nothing now remains. The Crusaders
had little respect for antiquities, and the innumerable granite pillar
shafts which are built horizontally into the walls are no doubt those
originally brought to the town by Herod.

Conder says, “We heard a curious tradition at Ascalon. A tomb had been
opened by the peasantry, near the ruin, some thirty years ago. Under a
great slab, in the eastern cemetery, they found a perfectly preserved
body, with a sword by its side, and a ring on its finger. The dead eyes
glared so fiercely on the intruders that they let fall the slab; and as
one of the party soon after died, they came to the conclusion that it
was a _Nebi_ or Prophet whom they had disturbed, and the place has thus
become surrounded with a mysterious sanctity.”

In the days of David’s grandson the kingdom of the Israelites divided
in two, and began the new phase of its existence as the parallel
monarchies of Israel and Judah. The disruption, it may be said, was
owing to the fact that Ephraim envied Judah, and Judah vexed Ephraim.
Naturally, the split, when it came, took place along a line between
these two powerful tribes and right athwart the tribe of Benjamin.
Benjamin was torn asunder--Jericho and Bethel going to the northern
kingdom, while other towns went to the south. Jerusalem continued to be
a capital, but it was now the capital of the kingdom of Judah only; and
Shechem was chosen as the capital of the northern kingdom, which was
called Israel.

But these northern monarchs had their pleasant summer residences as
well, corresponding to Windsor or Versailles. One of these was Samaria,
another was Tirzah, a third was Jezreel.

The Samaria of the present day is a large and flourishing village of
stone and mud houses, standing on the hill of the ancient Samaria.
The most interesting ruins now to be seen there are those of Herod’s
colonnade to the west of the modern village. The colonnade seems to
have surrounded the whole city with a kind of cloister, which was 60
feet wide, and the pillars 16 feet high. The city of Samaria of the Old
Testament has disappeared. But the kings of Israel were buried here,
and the ancient tombs may yet perhaps come to light.

Tirzah, famous for its beauty, is the only Samaritan town mentioned
among the royal cities taken by Joshua. Conder finds it in the present
mud hamlet of Teiasir. It was delightfully situated on a plateau where
the valleys begin to dip suddenly towards Jordan.

Conder found numerous rock-cut sepulchres burrowing under the houses;
and he thinks that some of them are probably those of the early kings
of Israel, before the royal family began to be buried in Samaria.

Jezreel is now called Zerin, and the site of Ahab’s palace is now a
village, surrounded by heaps of rubbish. The position of Zerin is
remarkable. On the south the ground slopes gently upwards towards the
site, and on the west also the place is accessible. But on the north
the ground is extremely rugged and falls rapidly, and on the east
occurs a saddle separating the high point on which the town stands
from the Gilboa chain, the road ascending from the valley and the
neighbourhood of ’Ain Jalud. The top of the hill is 284 feet above
this spring, which is visible beneath. Thus the site is naturally
strong, except on the south-west. It is conspicuous from the plain, and
it commands a view down the valley to Beisan and the trans-Jordanic
ranges. Major Conder, climbing up to the village, was struck by the
absence of any traces of antiquity. But the houses stand on a mound of
rubbish, and in this a great number of ruined cisterns exist.

Ahab from his palace in Jezreel looked down upon Naboth’s vineyard.
There seem to be no vineyards in the neighbourhood now; but on the east
and south-east there are rock-cut wine-presses on the rugged hills,
where no doubt the “portion of the field of Naboth” and his vineyard
are to be placed. The commanding position of the place would also
enable Joram’s watchmen, looking down the Valley of Jezreel, to observe
the two horsemen sent forward by Jehu coming up from Bethshan--the
dust raised, the gleam of their armour--and Jehu himself following and
“driving furiously.” It was by “the fountain which is in Jezreel” that
Saul had pitched before the fatal battle of Gilboa.

Here at Jezreel, with Mount Carmel in the distance, we are reminded
that the sacrifice which Elijah offered did not take place on the point
of Mount Carmel nearest the sea, as commonly imagined, but much nearer
to Jezreel, on a part of the range where our explorers discovered a
perennial spring, that would supply the prophet with water when the
rest of the country was dry. Stationed at this spot, he might see the
palace of Jezebel in the city of Jezreel. From this position he sent
his servant a few minutes’ distance, to the highest point of the range,
where he could overlook the sea and perceive the little cloud rising.
Then said Elijah, “Get thee down, Ahab, there is a sound of abundance
of rain”--get thee down Ahab, or the river of Kishon will sweep thee
away! Elijah himself, amidst the rushing storm, ran before the chariot
of the monarch, down the slope, and as far as the entrance of Jezreel.
And soon thereafter, fearing Jezebel’s threats, he journeyed swiftly by
the north and south road, nor stopped till he got to Beersheba. This is
the extremity of Judah, and here he leaves his servant behind him and
plunges into the wilderness, for he is going to “Horeb, the Mount of
God,” to seek a revelation.

Elijah was commissioned to call Elisha to be his successor; and Elisha
in his turn made frequent resort to Mount Carmel. When the Shunamite
woman came to him there, her journey lay across the plain, and he could
see her approaching (2 Kings iv. 24). Shunem, now called _Sulem_,
stands on the southern slope of _Neby Duhy_ (Little Hermon), and is
only a mud hamlet, with cactus hedges and a spring. West of the houses
there is a beautiful garden, cool and shady, of lemon trees, watered
by a little rivulet, and in the village is a fountain and trough.
Westward the view extends as far as Carmel, 15 miles away. Thus the
whole extent of the ride of the Shunamite woman, under the burning
noon-tide sun of harvest-time, is visible. Conder remarks that if the
houses of that time were no larger than the mud-cabins of the modern
village, it was not a great architectural undertaking to build a little
chamber for the prophet; and the enumeration of the simple furniture
of that chamber--the bed (perhaps only a straw mat), the table, the
stool, and the lamp--seems to indicate that it was only a little hut
that was intended. Another point may be noted: how came it that Elisha
so constantly passed by Shunem? The answer seems simple; he lived
habitually on Carmel, but he was a native of Abel Meholah, “the Meadow
of Circles,” a place now called _’Ain Helweh_, in the Jordan Valley, to
which the direct road led past Shunem down the Valley of Jezreel.

Before we leave the Plain of Esdraelon, which is also called the
Plain of Megiddo--and because of its typical character as the field
of great battles, is used in the Apocalypse as the scene of the great
final struggle, _Ar-Mageddon-_--let us glance at the fruitless effort
of Josiah, king of Judah, to stop the march of Pharaoh Necho. It was
in the last days of the Jewish monarchy, when the northern kingdom
had been already destroyed, that Palestine was first exposed to the
disastrous fate which involved her in so long a series of troubles
from this time forward--that of being the debatable ground between
Egypt and the further East; first under the Pharaohs and the rulers
of Babylon; then under the Ptolemies and Seleucidae. “In the days of
Josiah, Pharaoh Necho, king of Egypt, went up against the king of
Assyria to the river Euphrates” (2 Kings xxiii. 29), possibly landing
his army at Accho (says Dean Stanley), more probably, as the expression
seems to indicate, following the track of his predecessor Psammetichus,
and advancing up the maritime plain till he turned into the plain of
Esdraelon, thence to penetrate into the passes of the Lebanon. King
Josiah, in self-defence, and perhaps as an ally of the Assyrian king,
went against him. Josiah would march by the watershed road, northward
from Jerusalem, and descend into the plain, perhaps by Dothan. The
engagement took place in “the Valley of Megiddo” (2 Chron. xxxv. 22).
The Egyptian archers in their long array, so well known from their
sculptured monuments, shot at King Josiah, as he rode in state in his
royal chariot, and he was sore wounded, and placed in his reserve
chariot, and carried to Jerusalem to die. Dean Stanley remarks that all
other notices of the battle are absorbed in this one tragical event,
and the exact scene of the encounter is not known.

The position of Megiddo is not fixed very definitely in the Bible
narrative. But a broad valley (as we see above) was named from the
city, and the “waters of Megiddo” are also spoken of. Major Conder
believes he has found the place and the name, in the large ruined site
of Mujedda, at the foot of Gilboa--a mound from which fine springs
burst out, with the broad valley of the Jalud river to the north.
Otherwise Megiddo has been located on the _Mukuttà_, near _Lejjun_. Mr
Trelawney Saunders considers it an objection to Conder’s site that it
is separated from the river Kishon and the town of Taanach, and cannot
be made to fit in with the account of Ahaziah’s flight from Jezreel (2
Kings ix. 27). The king, having been smitten at “the going up to Gur,”
near Ibleam, fled to Megiddo, where he died. But if Megiddo were in
the Plain of Bethshean he would hardly be likely to do this, seeing
that Jehu his enemy made his furious advance upon Jezreel through that
plain. Besides, he fled by the way of the “garden house,” En-gannim
(the modern _Jenin_); the garden-like character of which spot is still
preserved--and _Jenin_ would not be on the route between _Zerin_ and
_Mujedda_.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Tent Work in Palestine.” Major
   Conder. “Introduction to the Survey of Western Palestine.” By
   Trelawney Saunders. “Survey of Western Palestine.” P. E. Fund.
   “Twenty-one Years’ Work in the Holy Land.” P. E. Fund.]


                   9. _Sacred Sites of the Hebrews._

In order to pass in review the sites selected by the Israelites for
places of worship, it will be convenient to go back to the time when we
find the tribes encamped at Gilgal, on their first entrance into the
country.

That Mount Sinai should remain sacred after the giving of the Law was
to be expected; and we have just now seen that its sacredness could
attract Elijah after many centuries. The Israelites, when they left
the wilderness, and came to sojourn in the outskirts of Moab, were
attracted by the shrine of Baal-Peor; but they were made to feel that
this was wrong, and the ambassadors of the western tribes refer to it
as a warning when they expostulate with their brethren about the altar
called Ed (Joshua xxii. 17). In passing over into Canaan, they carried
the Lord’s tabernacle with them; where that rested was holy ground, and
it was not intended that any rival site should be tolerated.

The ark of the covenant--the chest which contained the agreement or
treaty between Jehovah and his people--was set down at Gilgal, the
tabernacle or holy tent was erected over it, and Gilgal became a sacred
place. Afterwards, when the hill country had been conquered, the ark
and tabernacle were brought to Shiloh, and then Shiloh became a sacred
place. Shiloh is now called _Seilun_, and here the ruins of a modern
village occupy a sort of _tell_ or mound. The position of the place
is remarkably retired, shut in between high, bare mountains. A deep
valley runs behind the town on the north, and in its sides are many
rock-cut sepulchres. “The site being so certainly known,” says Conder,
“it becomes of interest to speculate as to the exact position of the
tabernacle. Below the top of the hill, on the north of the ruins,
there is a sort of irregular quadrangle, sloping rather to the west,
and perched above terraces made for agricultural purposes. The rock
has here been rudely hewn in two parallel scarps for over 400 feet,
with a court between, 77 feet wide and sunk 5 feet below the outer
surface. Thus there would be sufficient room for the court of the
tabernacle in this area. From the Mishna we learn that the lower part
of the tabernacle erected at Shiloh was of stone, with a tent above.
There are, however, two other places which demand attention as possible
sites, one being, perhaps, a synagogue, the other a little building
called the ‘Mosque of the Servants of God.’”

According to the Jews, the ark and tabernacle remained at Shiloh three
hundred and sixty-nine years--so long that Shiloh was regarded as only
second to Jerusalem in sanctity. In the disastrous days of Eli the ark
was sent into the battlefield and captured by the Philistines, who
carried it to Ashdod, to the temple of Dagon. When Dagon fell down
before it they sent it away again, and it was, after some adventures,
recovered by the men of Kirjath Jearim. Eventually David brought it to
Mount Zion, and then Zion became a sacred place. Solomon said, “the
places are holy whereunto the ark of the Lord hath come” (2 Chron.
viii. 11), and on that account he brought up the daughter of Pharaoh
out of the City of David (which is Zion, 1 Kings viii. 1), unto the
house that he had built for her. The ark never went back to Shiloh
after Eli sent it away. The tabernacle, however, appears to have
remained there for some time, and so Shiloh remained sacred in some
degree.

Soon, however, even the tabernacle would appear to have been removed
from Shiloh, for although we have no direct mention of its removal,
we seem to find it in other places. Samuel, the successor of Eli,
judged the people, and on important occasions called the solemn
assembly and offered sacrifices. He was accustomed to do this at three
different places, which in his day were revered as sacred. One of
these was Gilgal, rendered sacred by the first resting of the ark: and
although the ark and tabernacle had been removed, and sanctity was to
be transferred along with them, yet it is not easy to obliterate the
sanctity of a place from the tradition and practice of the people.
Another of these three places was Bethel, where Jacob had seen his
vision of the ladder with angels ascending and descending, and had
been constrained to say, “This is the house of God and the gate of
Heaven.” The third place at which Samuel called assemblies and offered
sacrifices was not Shiloh, as we might suppose it would be, but one of
the many places called Mizpeh. We do not know where this Mizpeh was.
Conder is inclined to identify it with _Neby Samwil_--the Mount of
the Prophet Samuel, a conspicuous conical hill, 4 or 5 miles north of
Jerusalem; and as Mizpeh means a watch-tower, there is plausibility in
this suggestion. We do not know whether the tabernacle was pitched at
either of these three places in Samuel’s day: we do not know why Samuel
should be content to regard three different places as holy; but it is
not altogether impossible that the tabernacle was carried from one
meeting-place to another, and made each one holy in turn.

A little later we seem to find the tabernacle nearer to Jerusalem.
When David is fleeing from King Saul, and taking the road from Rama in
Benjamin to Gath in the land of the Philistines, he comes to Nob, to
Ahimelech the priest, and is permitted to eat the shewbread (the holy
bread exhibited before the Lord in the sanctuary), and to carry off
the sword of Goliath, which had been laid up as a trophy. So here we
have the priests, the shewbread, and the tabernacle at Nob. As to the
locality of Nob, Dean Stanley follows Mr Thrupp in fixing it on the
northern summit of the Mount of Olives, and Mr Thrupp reminds us that
David brought the head of Goliath to Jerusalem, before the city itself
was captured (1 Sam. xvii. 54). David, in fleeing from Rama to Gath,
could hardly find a shorter or more convenient route than that which
took him past Jerusalem.

This position for Nob is confirmed by Isaiah’s graphic and detailed
description of the advance of the Assyrian invader (Isaiah x. 28):--

    He comes to Ai, passes through Migron,
    At Michmash deposits his baggage;
    They cross the pass, Geba is our night station:
    Terrified is Ramah, Gibeah of Saul flees.
    Shriek with thy voice, daughter of Gallim;
    Listen, O Laish! Ah! poor Anathoth!
    Madmeneh escapes, dwellers in Gebim take flight.
    Yet this day he halts at Nob:
    He shakes his hand against the mount, daughter of Sion,
    The hill of Jerusalem.

“In this passage” (says Sir Charles Wilson), “if it has a meaning--and
I cannot suppose that it has not--the prophet describes, in such detail
that it is difficult to believe he is not describing an actual event,
the march of an Assyrian army upon Jerusalem; and we may be quite
certain that, with his knowledge of the country, and writing as he did
for those who were equally well acquainted with it, he would describe
a line of march, which, under certain conditions, an army would
naturally follow if its special object were the capture of Jerusalem.
The conditions to which I allude are the passage of the great ravine
at Michmash, and encampment for the night at Geba; why this route
was selected in preference to the easier road along the line of
water-parting we have no means of ascertaining, and it does not affect
the question.”

“Of the places mentioned by Isaiah, we know, with a considerable
degree of certainty, the positions of Michmash, Geba, Ramah, Gibeah,
and Anathoth; of the others nothing is known. From Geba to Nob was
evidently a day’s march in the progress of the army; and the order
in which the villages are mentioned leads us in the direction of
Jerusalem. If, as I believe, the passage means that the Assyrian
warrior was leading an army from Geba against Jerusalem, and that his
progress was suddenly arrested at Nob, we must seek a site for Nob on
the road between these two places, and I cannot imagine a more natural
one than some place in the vicinity of that Scopus whence, in later
years, Titus and his legions looked down upon the Holy City.”

Doeg, the Edomite, who happened to be present when Ahimelech gave
David the sword, informed Saul, and Saul, who was mad with suspicion,
slew all the priests and utterly destroyed all the inhabitants of Nob.
But even after the destruction of the sanctuary by his violence the
sanctity of the summit of Olivet was still respected. It was necessary,
however, to remove the tabernacle from the scene of so much bloodshed,
and perhaps it was immediately removed to the high-place of Gibeon,
where we find it in the early part of Solomon’s reign.

The state of things at the beginning of the reign of Solomon is
described in 1 Kings iii.--“The people sacrificed in the high places,
because there was no house built for the name of the Lord until those
days. And the king went to Gibeon to sacrifice there, for that was
the great high place.” We learn from 2 Chron. i. that at Gibeon was
the Tent of Meeting (the tabernacle) which Moses had made in the
wilderness. Moreover, the brazen altar made by the inspired artist in
the wilderness was there before the tabernacle, and Solomon and the
congregation sought unto it, and offered a thousand burnt offerings
upon it.

Thus far, then, we have at least half a dozen sacred places, venerated
in turn, and more or less acknowledged simultaneously,--namely, Gilgal,
Bethel, Shiloh, Mizpeh, Nob, and Gibeon. To these we must add Zion, to
which David brought the ark, setting it up in the tent which he had
prepared for it, though _the_ tent, time-honoured and sacred, was at
Gibeon (2 Sam. vi. 17; 1 Chron. i. 4-6).

The ark, however, did not remain in “the city of David, which is Zion;”
for when the temple was built upon Mount Moriah, the ark was brought
up into the oracle of the house, with much sacrificing of sheep and
oxen, and the Tent of Meeting was brought along with it (1 Kings
viii.). Mount Moriah was now God’s holy mountain, and it was intended
to concentrate all public worship at the Temple. Even previously
it had been the law that the high places of the heathen should be
discarded, and irresponsible sacrifice in the open field should be
discountenanced, and that every man who had sacrifices to offer should
bring them to the tabernacle, wherever the tabernacle might be located
at the time (Levit. xvii. 1-6; Deut. xii. 1-6). So, now that the
permanent temple had superseded the wandering tent, it was ordered, of
course, that all sacrifices and public worship should take place on
Mount Moriah. “For in my holy mountain, in the mountain of the height
of Israel, saith the Lord God, there shall all the house of Israel, all
of them, serve Me in the land: there will I accept them, and there will
I require your offerings, and the first fruits of your oblations, with
all your holy things” (Ezek. xx. 40).

Nevertheless, during the years of David’s reign, and until the temple
was built, the ark resting on Zion conferred sanctity on that mountain.
Psalms of David, and others written at that time, would of course make
reference to Zion and not yet to Moriah.

    “In Salem also is his tabernacle,
    And his dwelling-place in Zion.”
                                   Psalm lxxvi. 2.

And even after the ark had been carried up to the Temple, Mount Zion
would retain its sanctity by tradition; or perhaps the name Zion would
be extended so as to include Moriah, as they may in truth be related as
the slope and the summit of the same hill.[19]

His foundation is in the holy mountains,

    “The Lord loveth the gates of Zion
    More than all the dwellings of Jacob.”
                                       Psalm lxxxvii. 1.

So shall ye know that I am the Lord your God dwelling in Zion, my holy
mountain. (Joel iii. 17 and Zech. viii. 3).

Human nature would not be what it is if theory and practice always
went hand in hand. Laws may be good, but universal obedience to them
cannot always be secured. Solomon himself, who had built the temple,
and by bringing the Tent of Meeting into it, had disestablished Gibeon,
set the example, in his later years, of recognising afresh other
high places and the gods of the heathen. Having married “women of
the Moabites, Ammonites, Edomites, Zidonians, and Hittites,” besides
the daughter of Pharaoh, he doubtless thought it only an enlightened
toleration to let them worship in their own way, and as a logical
consequence he supplied them with the means, and perhaps occasionally
accompanied them to their respective places of worship. “For Solomon
went after Ashtoreth the goddess of the Zidonians,” and “did build a
high place for Chemosh, the abomination of Moab, in the mount that is
before Jerusalem, and for Molech, the abomination of the children of
Ammon. And so did he for all his strange wives, which burnt incense and
sacrificed unto their gods” (1 Kings xi.).

We see in this passage that the site selected as the high place for
Chemosh was on the Mount of Olives--perhaps the place where Nob had
stood, a site which had the tradition of sanctity already.

Many later kings imitated Solomon, and declined to regard Jehovah
as the only God, or the holy mountain at Jerusalem as the only high
place possessing sanctity. It was hardly to be expected that the
people should be more faithful than their kings; and the after history
furnishes many examples of lapses into heathen worship, and periodical
reforms attempted by such kings as Josiah and Hezekiah. It was not
convenient for the more distant tribes north of Esdraelon or east of
Jordan to come up to Jerusalem to worship. Added to this consideration
there was the local shrine, and time-honoured tradition in its favour.
Just as in our own country Ripon cathedral is built over St Wilfrid’s
Saxon church, and St Paul’s cathedral on the site of a heathen temple,
so on the part of the Israelites there was a disposition to keep to the
old spots. What wonder if there was, besides, a frequent adherence to
the old forms of worship?

The tribes east of Jordan worshipped eastern gods--Peor, Chemosh,
Milcom. Gad worshipped the god of Fortune (Isaiah lxv. 11), and was
named after that deity. Josephus spells the name of Reuben as _Reubel_
(Ρουβελος), and Bel was one of the eastern gods. Manasseh had a
sanctuary in the city of Golan. From the east of Jordan came Jephthah,
who made a rash vow like a heathen, and kept it, although it involved
human sacrifice.

Beyond Esdraelon we have Kadesh Naphtali, a heathen sanctuary adopted
by the Israelites as a city of refuge, but apparently without any
entire suppression of the original worship. The place is now called
_Kedes_, and among the ruins found by the explorers are those of a
temple with a figure of an eagle on the lintel, besides richly executed
scroll-work of vine-leaves, bunches of grapes, a stag, and a bust
(possibly of Baal). There were also places called Beth-shemesh (House
of the Sun) scattered up and down the country.

At the disruption of the kingdom, Jeroboam, fearing that his subjects
would be attracted to the religious festivals at Jerusalem, established
two other centres. One of these was Bethel, convenient for the southern
part of his kingdom, and sacred already, because there Abram had
builded an altar, and Jacob had seen his vision, and Samuel had called
solemn assemblies. The other was Dan, convenient for the northern part
of his kingdom, and sacred again, already, for here, in the time of the
Judges some colonists from the tribe of Dan had set up a graven image
and established a priesthood. Besides, it was probably a sanctuary of
the Phœnician inhabitants whom the Danites displaced; and, as we have
seen in a previous chapter, the heathen god Pan came to be worshipped
here. Thus we see that Jeroboam selected religious centres which
combined traditional sanctity with geographical convenience.

When the tribes of the northern kingdom were carried into captivity,
and the Assyrian conquerors brought people from Babylon, from Cuthah,
and from Avva, and from Hamath, and Sepharvaim, and placed them in the
cities of Samaria (2 Kings xvii. 24), the foreigners, or the mixed
population which sprung up, fixed upon Mount Gerizim as their sacred
high place. But Mount Gerizim already possessed a traditional sanctity,
for the ark and tabernacle had accompanied Joshua to Shechem; the
tribes had assembled on the twin mountains to hear the reading of the
Law; and in earlier time Abram had builded an altar hereabout, the
first altar to Jehovah in all the Holy Land.

Thus there were many high places in Palestine, and there was much
disputing as to which should have the pre-eminence, the jealousy
reaching its height in the later centuries in the rival claims of
Gerizim and Jerusalem. No final solution was possible excepting that
which Jesus Christ gave to the woman of Samaria. “The hour cometh, and
now is, when the true worshippers shall worship the Father in spirit
and truth: for such doth the Father seek to be his worshippers. God
is a Spirit: and they that worship Him must worship in spirit and
truth.” (John iv. 23). Local centres lose their special sanctity
because “every place is holy ground.” The Temple at Jerusalem might
be destroyed--probably soon would be--but within a marvellously short
period the spiritual temple would take form. For such true teaching
Jesus Christ was crucified and Stephen stoned.

       *       *       *       *       *

It was a matter of much interest to Major Conder to find out if
possible where the mountain of the scape-goat was situated. According
to the Law of Moses the scape-goat was led to the wilderness, and there
set free. “This was not, however, the practice of the later Jews. A
scape-goat had once come back to Jerusalem, and the omen was thought so
bad that the ordinary custom was modified, to prevent the recurrence of
such a calamity. The man who led the goat arrived at a high mountain
called Sook, and there was at this place a rolling slope, down which he
pushed the unhappy animal, which was shattered to atoms in the fall.”
The district where this was done was called Hidoodim, and the high
mountain Sook. Sook was 6½ English miles from Jerusalem, as reckoned
by the ten tabernacles which divided the messenger’s path into stages
of 2000 cubits. Conder identifies the place in the neighbourhood of
the convent of St Saba. At the required distance from Jerusalem is the
great hill of _El Muntâr_, the highest point of a ridge of mountains
running north and south. The rest of the ridge is called _El Hadeidûn_;
and beside the ancient road from Jerusalem is a well called _Sûk_.
From this high ridge the victim was yearly rolled down into the narrow
valley beneath, at the entrance of the great desert, which first
unfolded itself before the eyes of the messenger as he gained the
summit half a mile beyond the well of Sûk.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--Colonel Warren, Colonel Wilson,
   &c., in the _Quarterly Statements_, P. E. Fund. “Tent Work in
   Palestine.” Major Conder. “Sinai and Palestine.” Dean Stanley.]


      10. _The Method of the Survey, and Incidents of the Work._

At the commencement of the Triangulation Survey a base line was
measured, near Ramleh, on the Jaffa plain, and this was afterwards
checked by a second line measured on the Plain of Esdraelon. The method
of work employed is described by Major Conder, both in his “Tent Work”
and in his volume called “Palestine.” The camp, consisting of three
or four tents, was pitched in some convenient central position, by a
town or village. Thence the surveyors were able to ride 8 or 10 miles
all round, and first visited a few of the highest hill-tops. As each
was found satisfactory, or one near it preferred, they built great
cairns of stones, 8 or 10 feet high, and whitewashed them to make them
more conspicuous. This work took about five days. When the points
were chosen, five more days were consumed in revisiting them with the
theodolite, which travelled in its box bound to the back of a mule,
the muleteer perched behind it; and with it went the saddle bags,
holding lunch, the chisel and hammer for cutting the broad arrow on the
summits of the hills, the hatchet for hewing down trees and copses.
From two to four hours were spent at each point, fixing the position of
every prominent object, tree, village, white dome or minaret visible
within 10 miles. “The names were collected” (says Conder) “from the
peasant who accompanied the party, and as the afternoon shadows began
to lengthen, we slowly wound down the hill-side, a rough-looking
cavalcade, preceded by our Bashi-bazouk in his red boots, armed to
the teeth, and followed by the non-commissioned officers, who had
become well accustomed to their stout little Syrian ponies, whilst the
pack-mule and guide came last. We all wore revolvers and the native
head-dress, the Bedawin _Kufeyeh_ or shawl, a sure protection from
sun-stroke and substitute for an umbrella. Our appearance was therefore
an extraordinary compound of European and Bedawin, which is often,
however, assumed by the Turkish officials in travelling, and thus
attracted less attention.”

The theodolite work over, and the fixed points laid down, the filling
in of the detail followed. The two non-commissioned officers divided
the work between them, and Major Conder took alternate days with each,
to enable him to do the hill sketching and examine the geology. In open
country they found the daily riding pleasant, but when the hills were
precipitous and the valleys deep and stony, the labour was very severe.
Starting at eight, resting at noon, returning at sunset, and sleeping
immediately after dinner, the days sped by with wonderful rapidity, and
the Survey spread gradually over the country.

The old cultivation was traced by the wine-presses, olive-presses,
ruined terraces, and rude garden watch-towers. Ancient sites were
recognised by their tombs, cisterns, and rocky scarps. In seeking to
identify sites the greatest care was exercised: it was laid down that
the site must show traces of antiquity; it must be known to the natives
under its original name, or a modification of that name; its position
must suit the known accounts of the place; and the measured distances
must lend confirmation.

The new map was to include every object that has a name, and the name
itself was to be correctly given. But here was a difficulty. How are
names to be accurately ascertained in Palestine? The natives are
perverse, or they suspect you of designs against their country, and
they purposely mislead you. On the other hand, they are obliging, and
if you express a hope that you have found a Scripture site, which
you name, they will confirm your impression that it is so. Or it may
be that you yourself are deficient in Arabic, and after being at the
greatest pains to inquire the name of a site, find that the name you
have noted down signifies “a heap of stones.” A story is told of
a European traveller who asked his guide the name of a place, and
received the reply--_Mabarafsh_. Carefully marking it on the sketch-map
of his route, he by-and-bye inquired concerning a second site which
he did not recognise, and received the same reply--_Mabarafsh!_ Of
course it is possible that names should be repeated, as in England we
have several Newports, Nortons, and Hamptons; but _Mabarafsh_ actually
means, “I don’t know!” A wise suggestion was made that travellers and
surveyors should always get the sheikh of the village to write down the
name correctly in Arabic; but, unfortunately, only one sheikh in ten
can write at all, and he cannot spell correctly.

The plan adopted by the Survey party was one which guarded as far as
possible against all mistakes. It is described by Major Conder in “Tent
Work,” where he speaks as follows of his inquiries in the neighbourhood
of Hebron. “My party now consisted of three non-commissioned officers;
and Lieutenant Kitchener was expected to join me in about a month. We
had with us eleven natives, including Habib the head man, a scribe, a
second valet, two grooms, the cook (a villain who only sat and watched
his boy cooking), two muleteers, and two Bashi-bazouks; the party
was thus at its full strength composed of only sixteen persons, with
nine horses and seven mules.... By night a guard was provided by the
sheikh of the village. Four guides were hired, who received a shilling
a day, a mule to ride, and breakfast. The information which they gave
the Surveyors was written down from their mouths by the scribe, an
intelligent young Damascene recommended by Mr Wright. Thus correctness,
both of pronunciation and of locality, was ensured, and the names
were checked by every means in our power. Besides obtaining names
from the local guides, inquiry was made of peasants, and generally of
several peasants separately. No leading questions were put, nor were
either guides or peasants allowed to suppose that one name would be
more acceptable than another. Such was the daily routine. The parties
left by eight a.m. and returned by five p.m.; dinner was at sunset,
and from about eight to eleven, or even until midnight, I studied,
after the day’s work, the topography of the district. This labour was
not unrewarded, for one might easily have passed over many places of
interest had one not known the points to which Mr Grove and other
scholars required special attention to be directed.”

Fortunately in Palestine the ancient names retain their hold very
tenaciously, and reassert themselves after all the efforts of
conquerors to displace them. Thus the town of Bethshan (or Bethshean)
which in Greek and Roman times became Scythopolis, is to-day again
known to the natives as _Beisan_. _Tell-el-Kadi_, at the foot of
Mount Hermon, signifies in Arabic the “heap of the Judge;” but in
Hebrew the word for judge is _Dan_, and this is the mound of Dan,
the northern extremity of the land whose length was measured “from
Dan to Beersheba.” Shiloh is now called _Seilun_, and no site is
more certain. Almost every important site retains its Biblical name.
The pretentious titles, Eleutheropolis, Nicopolis, &c., have quite
vanished, and the old native names of these cities, _Beth Gubrin_,
_Emmaus_, &c., are those by which they are now again known. An
important exception, however, is _Nablous_ (corrupted from Neapolis)
for the ancient Shechem--a change which may perhaps be traced to Jewish
hatred of the name of Shechem.

Tradition also is valuable as confirming the identification of sites,
although it might be insufficient if it stood alone. In the case
of Jacob’s Well, near Nablous (Shechem), the Hebrew and Samaritan
traditions, the Mohammedan and Christian traditions, all agree.
There is agreement also about the grotto at Bethlehem, under the
Church of the Nativity, as the place of Christ’s birth. There can be
no question that the cave of the field of Machpelah, which Abraham
bought for a burial place, is that which is now covered by the great
mosque at Hebron. And here again we have that valuable consent of
traditions--Jewish, Christian, and Moslem--which seems to distinguish
the true sites from those less genuine concerning which two or more
discordant traditions have arisen. The Prince of Wales, Dean Stanley,
and a few other Europeans have been admitted into the mosque; but
it seems very doubtful if any living being has ever descended into
the mysterious cavern beneath the floor since the Moslem conquest
of Palestine. The surrounding wall of the mosque is also one of the
mysteries of Palestine, and a monument inferior only to the Temple
Enclosure at Jerusalem, which it resembles in style.

The Temple Area at Jerusalem is still a sanctuary; and the Tower
of Antonia maintains its military character in the present Turkish
barracks. In Palestine we find a Mohammedan mosque where a Christian
church used to be--and built from the same materials. The church in
its time had followed a Jewish synagogue. Throughout the country for
thousands of years the people have gone on living in the same way
and in the same place, and calling the places by the same names. The
name of almost every village is Hebrew, and each stands on the great
dust-heap into which the ancient buildings have crumbled. The Hebrew
names are retained, and are scarcely changed since the days of Abraham,
because the peasantry are really Semitic in descent.

In those parts of the country which are seldom visited by Europeans the
natives were much astonished to see the Survey party at work. At one
place called _Baka_ (in the Sharon district) the great gig umbrella
over the theodolite attracted much attention, and the chief delight
to elderly men was a peep through the theodolite telescope. “What do
you see, O father?” cried the less fortunate who crowded round the
observer. “I see Hammad and his cows, two hours off, as if he were
close here!” replied the delighted elder.

It was a common notion that the English intended to take the country,
the Survey being only preparatory to that step. The land was being
parcelled out, and cairns erected on the high mountains where the chief
men would build their houses. The surveyors were looking for crosses
cut on the ruins, and intended to claim ownership of all such places.
Most of the peasantry believed they were seeking for hid treasure,
which by incantation would be wafted to England. Sometimes they dug
for gold under the cairns; often they pulled them down, and had in
consequence to be imprisoned. A shepherd saw the party levelling, and
had a vague idea they were making a railway, “Will you let the sea
into Jordan?” he asked, “or will the steamships go on wheels?” “The
best idea” (says Conder) “was that we were sent by the Sultan to see
what villages had become ruinous, and to remit their taxes. We were
favourites then!”

The work of the Survey was not carried out without frequent
discomforts. For instance, the Bukei’a plain is good corn land, “but
seems to have a bad natural drainage, and our mules floundered in deep
bogs, sometimes up to their girths. Farther north we began to descend
a long valley, and came on a different kind of country, a basaltic
outbreak appeared, and cliffs tilted in every direction; the valley bed
was strewn with fragments of hard basalt. Passing over a bare ridge we
descended into a most desolate valley where a muddy stream was flowing.
We had ridden 15 miles, and it now began to rain again. We found to our
dismay that this was where we had to camp, as no other supply of water
existed in a position central to the new work. We soon made a still
more unpleasant discovery. The valley was full of clear springs, but
they were all tepid and salt. If the Survey was to be done at all, it
appeared that we should have to drink brackish water for ten days or
more. Here, then, we sat down on the wet grass, in a driving drizzle of
rain, by the brackish stream: not a soul was to be seen, either Bedawi
or peasant, and it was evident that food would have to be brought from
a distance. The mules soon arrived with our tents and beds, which
though soaked with rain, we set up on the bare ground. Of course all
the party were cross, and thought themselves injured. I had a very bad
cold and rheumatism, and Habib had tic-douloureux. The Arabs looked
wretched; but I was glad they should have their share of the hardships,
for, unlike our Abu Nuseir friends at Jericho, they were the most lazy
and good-for-nothing tribe we had come across.”

Again, at the miserable little hamlet of _El B’aineh_--between
Lake Tiberias and the Mediterranean--they found the inhabitants all
fever-stricken from the malarious exhalations of the great swamp,
which even as late as July extended over half the plain. The place
was evidently unhealthy, and they were tortured by armies of huge
mosquitoes, rendering sleep impossible at night. Attacks of fever were
frequent. “Once or twice” (says Conder) “the fit came on while I was
riding, and I can imagine nothing more disagreeable than to be 10 miles
from home on a rough road, with a fever headache.”

One night the Sukr Arabs tried to steal the horses, but the big dog
gave a sharp bark, and the thieves were seen and fired on just as they
reached the tethering rope. In another place, when the dog had been
left behind, a thief came into the tents, ripped up the saddle-bag
containing the provisions and took them all with him, besides the tin
washing-basin, and the plates, bread, chickens, and barley from the
servants’ tents--all being noiselessly and neatly accomplished in about
ten minutes. The next morning the party were without food.

But there were worse things than these to endure. In the district of
David’s wanderings Corporal Brophy was attacked by four cowherds, who
abused him as a “pig,” and threatened to stone him. He had, indeed,
some difficulty in escaping. “The first really serious attack on the
party” (says Conder), “though not the last nor the worst, was made near
Mount Carmel. Sergeant Black was quietly surveying near the village of
_El Harithiyeh_, where, as it appeared afterwards in evidence, a fete
or ‘fantasia’ was being held. The young men were firing at a mark, and
one or more turning at right angles, deliberately fired at the sergeant
on the neighbouring hill. He must have been in no little danger, as he
brought home two bullets which had fallen near him.”

On the 10th July 1875 a very serious attack was made upon the whole
party, and it is a marvel that any of them escaped with their lives.
Fatigued with a long and arduous march, and a final ascent of 2000
feet, they chose a camping ground north of _Safed_, a town which lies
in a saddle of the high mountains of Upper Galilee and looks down
on the lake. The tents were about half way up when Major Conder,
resting on his bed, in shirt-sleeves and slippers, heard angry voices
in altercation. Looking out, he saw to his astonishment a sheikh,
evidently a man of good position, engaged in throwing stones at Habib,
who, with his hands spread out, was calling the bystanders to witness
the treatment he underwent. Conder advanced to demand an explanation;
but the sheikh, who was mad with passion, strode up to him, seized
him by the throat and shook him, meantime pouring out unintelligible
words. Major Conder had been accustomed to be treated with respect,
even by the highest officials in the country; and he felt that if he
submitted to this insult he would lose his influence with the natives
for ever, so he knocked the man down. He got up and returned to the
attack, with one arm behind him. Conder knocked him down a second time,
and as he fell observed in his hand a knife with a blade a foot long.
Conder’s party consisted of five Europeans and ten Maronites, and when
the latter heard news of the insult received by their “Kabtân,” they
came running up, quite beside themselves, and soon seized the sheikh,
took his knife away, and bound his arms behind his back. The sheikh
cried out, “Where are my people?” and the Moslem bystanders began to
throw stones. Conder’s servants were running to the tents for arms,
for they had eight revolvers ready for use, besides three shotguns
and a rifle. Their “captain,” however, was wiser; he had the sheikh
immediately released, and sent Habib at once to the Governor of the
town. But the crowd presently numbered about three hundred, and all
the more violent engaged in hurling stones. Lieutenant Kitchener was
struck more than once, and a muleteer was knocked over. The cries which
Christians in Palestine have good reason to dread, associated as they
are with memories of bloodshed, were now raised by the mob--“Allah!
Allah!” and “Din! Din! Mohammed!” the cry of the Damascus massacres.
Presently a number of fully-armed men came running down the hill-side,
all relatives and retainers of the sheikh, who indeed, it afterwards
appeared, was no less a person than ’Aly Agha ’Allân, a near relative
of ’Abd el Kâder himself. “I advanced at once” (says Conder) “to meet
these assailants, and singled out two men, one a white-bearded elder
with a battle-axe, the other a tall man with a club. They addressed
me with many curses, and the old man thrust the battle-axe against
my ribs; but it was a wonderful instance of the influence which a
European may always possess over Arabs, that they allowed me to take
them by the arms and turn them round, and that on my telling them to
go home, with a slight push in that direction, they actually retreated
some little way. Meantime a most extraordinary figure appeared--a
black man with pistols in his belt, brandishing a scimitar over his
head, and bellowing like a bull. He was the Agha’s slave, and bent on
revenge; seeing him so near, and seeing also a gun pointed at my head,
I retreated to the tents. I could not help laughing, even at so serious
a juncture, when I found myself supported by Sergeant Armstrong, who
stood at ‘the charge’ armed with the legs of the camera-obscura! I now
saw that Lieutenant Kitchener was opposing another group to my right
front, and went forward to him, when I was greeted with a blow on the
forehead from a club with nails in it, which brought the blood in a
stream down my face. The man who wielded it raised it once more, in
order to bring it down on the top of my skull, but luckily I was too
quick for him, and ducked my head close to his chest. The blow fell
short upon my neck, but even then it stunned me for the moment, and I
staggered.”

All the party were wounded, and as they were averse to using fire-arms,
they at last “bolted over thistles and stone-walls to a hill-side some
hundred yards away, and stood there in suspense and anxiety.” They were
much surprised to hear no more the cries of the crowd; but soon learned
that the Governor had sent a body of soldiers, and they were safe, at
least for the moment. They returned to camp, and held their ground for
the night, in spite of the threat of ’Aly Agha that he would come back
and cut their throats. Next morning they marched out in good order,
with four mounted guards, and made for the coast. Arriving at Acre they
laid the affair before the Pacha, and telegraphed to Constantinople;
for it would have been unsafe to attempt to continue their work until
the assailants had been punished. Such was the attack at Safed. It was
due to the insolence of one man, accustomed to overbear and bully the
few Christians who pass through the town, and to the fanaticism of the
Moslem population.

The strain upon the Europeans had been too much for health. Excitement,
fatigue, pain, and anxiety, added to malarious poison imbibed in the
swamps, brought on a severe attack of fever. For twenty-four hours
Major Conder was not expected to recover. Lieutenant Kitchener also
soon succumbed, and the rest followed. They lay in their beds in the
Carmel convent, and Sergeant Armstrong nursed them. Truly, as Conder
remarks, the Survey of Palestine was no holiday work.

The Committee who organized the Survey and the officers who carried it
out deserve our gratitude, for they have conferred a lasting benefit
upon Palestine travellers and upon all students of the Bible. We have
now a map by which a traveller can find his way. Dr Robinson and other
explorers of that day used to describe the position of a place by
saying it was two hours east from the last, and then one and a quarter
hours north-west; but we now have exact distances. We have a map which
helps us to understand Bible narratives of personal journeys or the
march of armies. We can now see which route _must_ have been followed;
we can pursue step by step the Scripture events. We are certain now
that the Bible could not have been written in any other country under
heaven.

Before the Survey the Sea of Galilee was variously computed as being
from 300 feet to 600 feet below the Mediterranean: it is now fixed
at 682. The courses of the affluents of the Jordan are found to be
entirely different from those previously shown. Only four fords of the
Jordan were known and marked on the maps, whereas we now have more
than forty. Villages have had to be transferred from one side to the
other of the great boundary valleys. Scores and scores of Scripture
sites, wrongly placed or altogether lost, have been found and fixed.
And the finding of the sites has enabled the surveyors to trace
accurately the boundaries of tribes and provinces. How was it possible
to understand the Bible history unless we knew the situation of towns,
the boundaries of tribes, the fords and passes and valleys which were
open to foreign invaders? How could we understand it unless we knew
the routes of wayfarers and the way of commerce? These things have now
at last been ascertained, and with accuracy. When the base line which
was measured on the Jaffa plain was checked by a line measured on the
plain of Esdraelon, it was found to be perfectly satisfactory; and the
closing line when calculated in 1876 at Southampton had a margin of
only 20 feet, which is an invisible distance on the one inch scale. It
may be claimed for the Survey that the new discoveries are almost as
numerous as all those of former travellers put together; and nothing
so great has been done for the right understanding of the Old and New
Testaments since the translation of the Scriptures into the vulgar
tongue.

   [_Authorities and Sources (Western Palestine)_:--“Survey
   Memoirs of Palestine Exploration Fund.” “Tent Work in
   Palestine.” By Major Conder. “Palestine in its Physical
   Aspects.” Rev. Canon Tristram. “Sinai and Palestine.” By Dean
   Stanley. “Twenty-One Years’ Work in the Holy Land.” Published
   by the P. E. Fund. “Memoir on the Geology.” Dr Ed. Hull.
   “Mount Seir.” Dr Ed. Hull. “Introduction to the Survey.”
   Trelawney Saunders. “Quarterly Statements of P. E. Fund.”
   Smith’s “Dictionary of the Bible.” “_Rob Roy_ on the Jordan.”
   John Macgregor.]


                       11. _The East of Jordan._

It would be well if the topographical survey could be extended so as
to cover all the ground occupied by the tribes of Reuben and Gad, and
the half tribe of Manasseh. It is true indeed that the East of Jordan
is less intimately bound up with the Scripture narrative than the West,
yet still there are ninety-six places east of Jordan mentioned in
the Bible--Dr Selah Merrill estimates that there are two hundred and
forty--and it would be an advantage to have them all identified. On the
east side, also, the country is much more thickly strewn with ruins
than on the west; and although the so-called “giant cities” of Bashan
may not deserve that name, yet is the region full of Roman towns, of
Nabathean and Arab texts scrawled on the rocks, of Greek temples and
Greek inscriptions, and of dolmen groups yet older.

In the absence of detailed trigonometrical survey of the whole region,
the map published by the Palestine Exploration Society in 1890 is the
best that could be compiled from all sources. The sources available
were--Van de Velde’s map as a general basis; the route maps of later
travellers; the work of the American Palestine Exploration Society as
reported in their “Statements;” Major Conder’s survey of 500 square
miles in the land of Moab in 1881 and 1882; and lastly, surveys made by
Herr Schumacher in the Hauran and the Janlan.

_Bashan_: the territory of the half tribe of Manasseh. As an
illustration of the abundance of the ancient remains east of Jordan, Dr
Selah Merrill, the archæologist of the American Exploring Expedition,
says that every one who has visited _Kanawat_ is amazed at the number
and variety of the ruined buildings, castles, temples, churches,
convents, theatre, bath, palaces, reservoirs, underground apartments
or vaults, costly tombs, and still others which have never been fully
examined. Dr J. L. Porter found here what he calls a colossal head
of Astarte, sadly broken ... with the crescent moon (which gave to
this goddess the name _Karnaim_ or two-horned) still on her brow. Mr
Tyrwhitt Drake secured a stone at this place which was thought to be
part of an altar, upon two opposite sides of which were the features of
Baal and Astarte, boldly cut in high relief upon the closest basalt,
with foliage, showing the artistic hand.

One’s first impression is that all the antiquities are of Roman times
and date only from the early centuries of the Christian era. This is
indicated not only by the style of architecture but by the considerable
number of inscriptions, which form an almost continuous chain from
the first century to the fourth. They belong to the Emperors Marcus
Aurelius, Lucius Aurelius Verus, Commodus, Septimius Severus, Alexander
Severus, &c.

These Roman cities became converted to the religion of Christ, and then
not only were the sanctuaries of paganism transformed into Christian
sanctuaries, but new churches were erected adapted to the new worship;
houses, palaces, and tombs were built; even entire cities were founded.
At length all these Christian cities were abandoned at the same
time--probably at the epoch of the Mohammedan invasion--and since then
they have not been touched. Except that earthquakes have thrown to the
ground many of the walls and columns, they lack only beams and planks,
or they would be perfect edifices, which soon might be made habitable
again.

But how intensely interesting the exploration of the district becomes
when we learn that underneath these towns of Roman date are the
dwellings of the earlier inhabitants! For example, _Burak_ is a city
of the Hauran which has been identified with the episcopal city
Constantia, founded, it is supposed, or at least embellished, by
Constantine. But Rev. W. Wright tells us that while the houses seem
to stand on a mound of black earth, they are in reality built on the
foundations of houses of a more remote antiquity. In one place he
descended to a depth of 16 or 18 feet, to see some pottery which had
lately been discovered, and he found the walls at that depth formed
of enormous undressed and unsquared stones, unlike the stones of the
superstructure, which are small in size and have been better prepared
for the walls. “Nor will it be doubted” (he says) “that beneath that
raised mound are buried the remains of one of the ‘three-score cities’
that once existed in Bashan, and which still exist under changed
circumstances, sometimes under different names.”

At another place, called _Dra’a_, Dr S. Merrill desired to explore
the underground caves or chambers which were known to exist, and the
sheikh sent his son as a guide. They went through several chambers,
galleries, and avenues, and then entered a small room, and followed a
passage leading out of it that had been cut in the solid rock. Soon
they were obliged to go on their hands and knees, and after proceeding
about thirty yards the guide came upon a human skeleton, at which he
was so shocked that he refused to go any farther, and the party were
obliged to return. How the skeleton came there was a mystery: some wild
beast may have dragged a body to the place, or a murder may have been
committed, or some person may have been trying to explore the caverns
and failed to find his way out. _Dra’a_ ought to be a rich field for
excavations, because at least three cities exist there, one beneath
another. The present Arab buildings and heaps of filth are, for the
most part, on the top of a Greek or Roman city, as is evident from the
walls which are exposed in a multitude of places, and the masons’ marks
which appear on them. And the Roman town appears to rest on one still
older, in which bevelled stones were used. But whether there are two or
three cities above ground, there is certainly a large one beneath them,
entirely excavated in the rock on which the upper cities stand.

The underground dwellings at this place had been visited some years
before by Dr J. G. Wetzstein, and he also was prevented from making a
thorough exploration; for when his attendant’s light went out he was so
impressed with a sense of the danger they would be in if both lights
went out together, that he thought it prudent to retreat. But he had
seen a good deal. After passing a difficult passage he found himself
in a broad street which had dwellings on both sides of it, and whose
height and width left nothing to be desired. Farther along there were
several cross streets, and soon after they came to a market-place,
with numerous shops in the walls, exactly in the style of the shops
that are seen in Syrian cities. After a while they turned into a side
street, where a great hall attracted his attention, the roof formed of
a single slab of jasper, and supported by four pillars. Dr Wetzstein
speaks of this remarkable place as “old Edrei, the subterranean
labyrinthine residence of King Og.”

Herr Schumacher has also visited this underground city of _Dra’a_ or
_Ed Der’aah_, and describes it, giving plans, in his work, “Across the
Jordan.” He regards such cities as the work of the earliest inhabitants
of Hauran, the so-called giants of Scripture. He was assured by the
sheikh Naif, and by many others, that this underground city extends
below the whole of _Ed Der’aah_.

Although the chambers and passages were ventilated, the question
arises, why any people should choose to live in such gloomy seclusion
instead of in the light of day? Mr Schumacher’s conjecture is that
they did ordinarily live in the daylight, and that these subterranean
places were hollowed out in order to receive the population in time
of danger. They were thus prepared to stand a siege, as long as their
magazines were filled with food, their stables with cattle, and their
cisterns with water. If, however, the enemy had found out how to cut
off their supply of air, by covering up the air-holes, the besieged
would have been compelled to surrender or perish. Another circumstance
also might have proved disastrous--if armies of wasps found their way
into the underground city the inhabitants would be driven out. Some
writers think that this occurrence is actually spoken of in Exodus
xxiii. 28--“And I will send the hornet before thee, which shall drive
out the Hivite, the Canaanite, and the Hittite from before thee;” and
Deut. vii. 20--“Moreover the Lord thy God will send the hornet among
them, until they that are left, and hide themselves, perish from before
thee”--_they that are left, and hide themselves_!

Herr Schumacher and Mr Laurence Oliphant find many names and traditions
which lead them to regard the country of Western Hauran as probably
the land of Uz. “There was a man in the land of Uz whose name was Job”
(Job i.). The old village of _Sheikh Sa’ad_ is a spot which from the
most ancient times has been held sacred to the memory of Job (_Neby
Ayyub_). We find there the ruins of the Monastery of Job (_Deir
Ayyub_), much venerated by the ancient people of the Hauran. At the
south-eastern extremity of the long low hill upon which the village
is built, and elevated about 40 feet above the surrounding plain, is
the “Rock of Job,” which stands now in a mosque. Here, so says the
legend, Job sat when he was leprous, and received his friends. The rock
is a monolith of basalt, 7 feet high and about 4 feet broad, and on
its surface are some illegible letters. There may be no truth in the
legend; but it serves to show how closely the name of Job is associated
with this region.

About half a day’s journey due east from Bethshan is a place called
_Mahneh_, which several writers, on account of the similarity of name,
have been inclined to identify with Mahanaim, where Jacob met the
two companies of angels, and where David sojourned during Absalom’s
rebellion. A mound exists here, and Dr Tristram picked up some pieces
of old pottery, scattered about, so that it might be worth while to
excavate: but we must look elsewhere for Mahanaim.

Mahanaim must have been some little distance north of the Jabbok,
because Jacob came to it before he crossed that stream. It must have
been in or near the Jordan Valley, for Jacob, in his prayer at that
place, says, “With my staff I passed over this Jordan,” language which
would not have been used if the Jordan were not within sight. The city
was assigned to one of Solomon’s commissariat officers (1 Kings iv.
14), from which we may infer that it represented a district. These
conditions appear to point to _Khurbet Suleikhat_, a large ruined
city at the mouth of _Wady Suleikhat_, 9 miles north of the Jabbok.
If we fix Mahanaim here we can understand why the name is in the dual
form--the two Mahans or camps--for the ruins lie on both sides of the
stream which here runs down the _Wady Suleikhat_ into the Jordan.
_Khurbet Suleikhat_ is some 300 feet above the plain, and among the
foot-hills, in such a way that it overlooks the valley, while the
road running north and south along the valley passes nearly a mile
to the west of it. A watchman from a tower could see to the north a
considerable distance, also clear across the valley to the west, and
down the valley to the south a long stretch, nearly or quite to the
point where the Jabbok and the Jordan unite, at the foot of _Kurn
Surtabeh_.

We can now understand the account of the messengers who bore the news
of Absalom’s death to David. The battle between Joab and Absalom took
place a little to the south-east of Mahanaim. Josephus says that Joab
“put his army in battle array over against the enemy in the great
plain where he had a wood behind him” (Antiq. vii. 9, 8, and 10, 1-5).
Absalom’s men were routed, and fled through the forests and valleys,
pursued by David’s men. The battle was scattered over the face of all
the country (2 Sam. xviii. 8), and probably extended to the foot-hills.
The two messengers appear to start from some point on the hills, where
Joab stood on vantage ground. “The Cushite,” an Ethiopian slave of
Joab’s, attempted to go across over deep wadies and broken ground; but
Ahimaaz, who knew the country better, struck down to the Jordan Valley,
and ran by the way of the Plain (the _Kikkar_) where he had a level and
smooth road all the rest of the way. Consequently, although he started
second, he arrived first. David sat between the two gates at Mahanaim,
and the watchman went up to the roof of the gate unto the wall, whence
he descried the messengers approaching.

Succoth also was a city east of Jordan, for Jacob came to it before he
crossed the Jordan from the east, and Gideon passed it after he had
crossed the Jordan from the west (Judges vii. 4). From the account of
Jacob’s return it would seem to be at no great distance from Mahanaim.
But notwithstanding that Jacob had crossed the Jabbok southward before
he met Esau, and journeyed to Succoth after parting with Esau, there
is reason for placing Succoth north of the Jabbok. Jacob recrossed the
stream. The Jerusalem Talmud tells us that Succoth, one of the cities
“in the valley,” came to be called Darala; and just north of the Jabbok
we find _Deir ’Alla_, one of the most conspicuous mounds or _tells_
in the plain, 60 feet high, and covered with broken pottery of many
colours and qualities. The site was mapped by Warren in 1868.

The word Succoth means “tents,” and perhaps the place was named from
the tents of the Arabs so constantly seen there. The region about the
mouth of the Jabbok is fertile, with abundant grass and water, and is
very much frequented now by the powerful desert tribes for the purpose
of pasturing their flocks and herds. When Gideon, who crossed the
Jordan near _Beisan_, had followed the Midianites down the valley to
Succoth, it is said that “he went up by the way of them that dwell in
tents,” apparently some well-known route leading up the Jabbok Valley
to the eastern deserts.

A fair interpretation of the circumstances leads to the conclusion that
Penuel was not far east of Succoth. It was a fortified city, for it had
a tower, which Gideon threatened to break down; and was regarded by
Jeroboam as an outpost, useful in the defence of Shechem (1 Kings xii.
25). Dr Merrill finds that there is but one suitable site for it, and
that is at the mounds called the “Hills of Gold,” about 4 miles east
of Jordan, in the valley of the Jabbok. The mounds are very striking
objects; they are covered with ruins, and on the eastern side are the
remains of an ancient castle. The work is not Moslem, Christian, or
Roman; the stones are unhewn blocks, and appear to date from a remote
period.

A large district east and south-east of the Sea of Galilee was called
Decapolis, or the region of the Ten Cities. The name occurs frequently
in Josephus and other writers, and three times in the Gospels.
Immediately after the conquest of Syria by the Romans (B.C.
65), ten cities appear to have been rebuilt, partially colonised, and
endowed with peculiar privileges. One of the cities was Scythopolis,
west of the Jordan; the others included Gadara, Geraza, Philadelphia,
Pella, &c., all on the east. The region, once so populous and
prosperous, is now almost without inhabitants; and the few families
that do remain--in Scythopolis, Gadara, and Canatha--live amid the
crumbling ruins of palaces, and in the cavernous recesses of old tombs.

Herr Schumacher has explored Abila of the Decapolis (now _Tell Abil_),
and Gadara (at _Umm Keis_), and Pella (_Fahil_).

Pella--situated just opposite _Beisan_, on the other side of the
Ghor--is the city to which the Christian believers fled when Titus
advanced to besiege Jerusalem. Epiphanius says that “they removed
because they had been forewarned by Christ himself of the approaching
siege.” Seventy years later (A.D. 135) when Hadrian rebuilt
Jerusalem as a Roman city, and changed its name to Ælia, the Christians
again left it and sought refuge in this elegant city of Pella in the
Jordan valley. Dr Merrill is inclined to think that Christ himself
had been in Pella (for we know that he visited Perea), and met with
such favour and success as to make the city a fitting asylum for his
followers. Herr Schumacher, after describing a rock-cut chamber of
rectangular shape, having a ceiling cut in the shape of a cross vault,
with two pillars on the southern and northern walls, says, “It may
be accepted as beyond doubt that we have here a cave, once inhabited
by those Christian anchorites, who, in the beginning of the Christian
era and during the Jewish wars, found a refuge at Pella. The flooring
consisting of earth and remains of charcoal, as well as the plan of the
whole, has no sepulchral character, but rather that of a habitation;
the passages being used to secure air and afford a way of escape in
case of persecution, for these small caves, if their door entrance was
carefully shut, were hardly visible from below, and the passage still
less. The entire northern slope is honeycombed with such caves.”

The wonder is that Pella should ever have been forsaken, it is so
favoured in position. Even after the long summer drought, the springs
gushing out among the broken columns and ruins of former splendour
are abundant enough to make fertile all the neighbouring land, which,
situated on the upper level of the Ghor, and 250 feet below the sea,
enjoys, perhaps, the finest climate, from an agricultural point of
view, that can be found in Syria.

The capital of Perea was Gadara, a city mentioned in the Gospel
narrative of the demoniac who had his dwelling among the tombs. The
population of _Umm Keis_ may be about two hundred souls, and the people
cultivate tobacco, vegetables, and grain. Below the ground occupied by
the present village, many caves and ancient burial places have been
discovered. The ruins include a Roman theatre and what may be the
remains of a castle.

_Gilead._--The boundary of the tribe of Gad was some few miles north
of the Jabbok, for the territory included Mahanaim; while on the south
it extended to the Arnon. The region had belonged to the Ammonites;
and it was long before they were driven out, for even after Saul was
anointed King of Israel, Nahash the Ammonite besieged Jabesh Gilead and
sought to lay a hard condition of surrender upon the Israelites there
(1 Sam. xi.). This district is the land of Gilead or “Mount Gilead”
of the Bible. It is a good land for cattle, and would be prized by
agricultural people in any part of the world. “It is not to be wondered
at,” says Dr Merrill, “that the two and a half tribes were perfectly
willing to stay on the east of Jordan. Judea has no land to compare
with it; neither has Samaria, except in very limited portions. The
surface of the country is slightly rolling, but the fields are broad
and comparatively free from stone. Here common Arab trails broaden out
into fine roads. Here are rich pasture lands and luxuriant fields of
wheat and barley, and the ignorant Bedouin who own the soil point with
pride to the green acres that are spread out beneath the sun.”

_Amman_, called in the Bible Rabbath Ammon (Deut. iii. 11; 2 Sam. xi.
1, &c.), was the chief city of the children of Ammon fifteen hundred
years before Christ. Here the bedstead of Og, the king of Bashan, was
taken by Joab, David’s general (2 Sam. xi. xii.), and Uriah the Hittite
was killed in one of the sorties. Rabbath Ammon was rebuilt by Ptolemy
Philadelphus, king of Egypt, and its name changed to Philadelphia.
Again it was destroyed by the Saracens when they conquered Syria. The
stream of the Jabbok ran right through Rabbath Ammon, and it was called
the “City of Waters.” It was after Joab had taken the City of Waters
that he sent to David and suggested that he should come and capture the
citadel himself, lest all the glory should go to his servant.

Major Conder regards _Amman_ as the most important ruin surveyed in
Palestine, as regards its antiquarian interest, and the best specimen
of a Roman town that he visited, except the still more wonderful
ruins of Gerasa, which yield only to Baalbec and Palmyra among Syrian
capitals of the second century of our era. The Roman remains include
two theatres, baths, a street of columns, and remains of what was once
a very great temple on the highest part of the acropolis of the city.
Several noble families must have lived in the town, as shown by the
magnificent private tombs surrounding the city.

But the oldest remains visible at _Amman_ are the dolmens, of which,
with other rude stone monuments, there are some twenty in all. Next to
these come the old rock-cut tombs, which Conder supposes to be of the
early Hebrew period. But who knows whether there be not a buried city
underneath _Amman_? The whole region south of _Amman_, and also north
and west of it, abounds in ruins.

_Moab._--The country south of Gilead was given to the tribe of Reuben.
It was the land of the Moabites, and a land where Moabite kings
continued to reign, notwithstanding the rights of Reuben. From this
land came Ruth, to dwell at Bethlehem with Naomi, to marry Boaz, and be
held in memory by-and-bye as the ancestress of David. Perhaps it was on
account of Ruth that David found the king of Moab willing to give safe
asylum to his aged parents, while he himself braved the dangers of the
outlaw’s life (1 Sam. xxii. 3). Yet the time came when David fought
against the Moabites and conquered them, treating the captives with a
severity which makes us suspect that there had been some act of perfidy
or insult. It has been conjectured that the king of Moab betrayed the
trust which David reposed in him, and either killed Jesse and his wife
or surrendered them to Saul. We do not know.

The strong fortress of Moab was Kir-Haraseth, or Kir-Hareseth, or
Kir-Heres (2 Kings iii. 25; Isaiah xvi. 7, 11); and it was on the walls
of this city that King Mesha offered his son for a burnt-offering,
and by the moral effect thus produced turned the tide of battle. We
have reasonable ground for identifying Kir-Heres with the modern
_Kerak_, near the south-eastern part of the Dead Sea. The allied armies
marched round the southern end of the Dead Sea to reach it, instead
of crossing the Jordan. “No chain of evidence,” says Dr Tristram,
“can be less open to cavil than that which identifies Kerak with
Kir-Moab (Isaiah xv. 1) or Kir-Hareseth. It was the castle ‘Kir,’
as distinguished from the metropolis ‘Ar’ of the country, _i.e._,
Rabbath Moab, the modern _Rabba_.” The Targum translates the name as
“Kerakah.” The Crusaders mistook it for Petra, and gave to its bishop
that title, which the Greek Church has still retained, but the name in
the vernacular has continued unchanged. No wonder, as we look down from
the neighbouring heights upon it, that the combined armies of Israel,
Judah, and Edom could not take it, and that “in Kir-Haraseth left they
the stones thereof; howbeit the archers went about it and smote it,”
but to no purpose.

The position is so strong by nature that it would be seized upon as a
fortress from the very earliest times. The platform on which the city
is built is on a lofty brow, which pushes out like a peninsula and is
only connected with other ground by a narrow neck. Two deep _wadies_
flank it north and south, with steeply scarped or else rugged sides.
There have been originally only two entrances to Kerak, and both of
them through tunnels in the side of the cliff, emerging on the platform
of the town.

Another town--reckoned to Reuben in an ancient fragment of poetry,
but rebuilt by Gad (Num. xxi. 30, xxxii. 34,)--was Dibon. It is now
identified with _Dhiban_, on the Roman road, about 3 miles north of
the Arnon, a spot where there are extensive ruins. It is described by
Dr Tristram as being quite as dreary and featureless a ruin as any
other of the Moabite desolate heaps. “With its waterless plain,” he
says, “the prophecy is fulfilled--‘Thou daughter that dost inhabit
Dibon, come down from thy glory, and sit in thirst; for the spoiler
of Moab shall come upon thee, and he shall destroy thy strongholds’
(Jer. xlviii. 18). The place is full of cisterns, caverns, vaulted
underground storehouses, and rude semicircular arches. All the hills
about are limestone, and there is no trace of any basalt but what has
been brought here by man. Still there are many basaltic blocks among
the ruins, dressed to be used in masonry.”

It was among these ruins that the famous Moabite Stone was found in the
year 1868. It is a block of basalt measuring about 3½ feet by 2 feet,
and has upon its face thirty-four lines of writing in the character
known as Phœnician. As the language also is Phœnician--or probably
Moabite, though closely related to Phœnician, and certainly closely
related to Hebrew--there would have been no great difficulty in reading
the inscription; but, unfortunately, when the Arabs found that the
stone was valued by Europeans, they quarrelled about the possession
of it and broke it up. About two-thirds of the fragments, however,
were recovered and pieced together; besides which, a “squeeze” of the
whole had been hurriedly taken before it was broken, and from this it
was possible to fill in some of the gaps. The restored monument is now
preserved in the Louvre at Paris, and a plaster cast is to be seen in
the British Museum. The inscription shows that the monument was set
up by Mesha, king of Moab (nearly nine hundred years before Christ),
to record victories which he had gained and public works which he had
accomplished. It would appear that after the allied armies retired
from the siege of Kir-Haraseth, the fortune of war changed and went in
Mesha’s favour. The translation of the inscription is as follows:--

“I, Mesha, am the son of Chemosh-Gad, king of Moab, the Dibonite. My
father reigned over Moab thirty years, and I reigned after my father.
And I erected this stone to Chemosh at Korcha, a (stone of) salvation,
for he saved me from all despoilers, and made me see my desire upon
all my enemies, even upon Omri, king of Israel. Now they afflicted
Moab many days, for Chemosh was angry with his land. His son succeeded
him, and he also said, I will afflict Moab. In my days (Chemosh) said,
(Let us go) and I will see my desire on him and his house, and I will
destroy Israel with an everlasting destruction. Now Omri took the land
of Medeba, and (the enemy) occupied it in (his days and in) the days
of his son, forty years. And Chemosh (had mercy) on it in my days;
and I fortified Baal-Meon, and made therein the tank, and I fortified
Kiriathaim. For the men of Gad dwelt in the land of (Atar)oth from
of old, and the king (of) Israel fortified for himself Ataroth, and
I assaulted the wall and captured it, and killed all the warriors of
the wall for the well-pleasing of Chemosh and Moab; and I removed from
it all the spoil, and (offered) it before Chemosh in Kirjath; and I
placed therein the men of Siran and the men of Mochrath. And Chemosh
said to me, Go, take Nebo against Israel. (And I) went in the night,
and I fought against it from the break of dawn till noon, and I took
it, and slew in all seven thousand (men, but I did not kill) the women
(and) maidens, for (I) devoted them to Ashtar-Chemosh, and I took
from it the vessels of Yahveh, and offered them before Chemosh. And
the king of Israel fortified Jahaz and occupied it, when he made war
against me; and Chemosh drove him out before (me, and) I took from
Moab two hundred men, all its poor, and placed them in Jahaz, and took
it to annex it to Dibon. I built Korcha, the wall of the forest, and
the wall of the city, and I built the gates thereof, and I built the
towers thereof, and I built the palace, and I made the prisons for the
criminals within the walls. And there was no cistern in the wall at
Korcha, and I said to all the people, Make for yourselves, every man,
a cistern in his house. And I dug the ditch for Korcha by means of the
(captive) men of Israel. I built Aroer, and I made the road across the
Arnon. I built Beth-Bamoth, for it was destroyed; I built Bezer, for
it was cut (down) by the armed men of Dibon, for all Dibon was now
loyal; and I reigned from Bikran, which I added to my land, and I built
(Beth-Gamul) and Beth Diblathaim and Beth-Baal-Meon, and I placed there
the poor (people) of the land. And as to Horonaim, (the men of Edom)
dwelt therein (from of old). And Chemosh said to me, Go down, make war
against Horonaim, and take (it. And I assaulted it, and I took it, and)
Chemosh (restored it) in my days. Wherefore I made ... year ... and
I ...”

In 1881 Major Conder, aided by Lieutenant Mantell, was sent out to
begin the systematic survey of Eastern Palestine. The country at that
time was very much disturbed; but the party crossed the Jordan into
Moab, and for two anxious months laboured at very high pressure. After
measuring a base-line and connecting their triangulation with that west
of the river, they worked over 500 square miles in detail. And even
after attention was drawn to their presence they were able to extend
their work over a considerable area, and they came back from the desert
with their hands full of valuable results.

One of the most remarkable discoveries was the abundance of menhirs,
dolmens, and stone-circles. They are numbered by hundreds, whereas in
Judea and Samaria there are none, and in Galilee only half a dozen. Dr
Merrill and Herr Schumacher found them abundant also in the Jaulan and
the rest of the Hauran. According to Herr Schumacher, an examination of
many specimens in Eastern Jaulan makes it apparent (1) that the dolmens
are always built on circular terraces, which elevate them about 3 feet
above the ground; (2) that in most cases they are formed by six upright
and two covering slabs; (3) that the major axes of the dolmens all
run east and west; (4) that the western end of the dolmens is broader
than the eastern; (5) that the western end is often distinguished by
headings, one on each corner of the top slab; and (6) that they vary in
size from 7 to 13 feet in length. He finds it difficult to avoid the
conclusion that these dolmens were built originally as burial places.
The covered chamber, elevated above the ground, and shut in by slabs,
was the first beginning of a sarcophagus; and the body was laid facing
the rising sun, with its head in the west. On the other hand Major
Conder, who finds in Moab many rude stone monuments of a different
kind, bids us remember that stones may be placed on end for more than
one purpose. After examining seven hundred examples in Moab and Gilead,
he has come to the conclusion that the sepulchral theory is often quite
untenable, though we cannot deny that bodies were buried in such stone
chambers sometimes. In many cases in Moab it was certain that no mound
of earth had ever covered the stones; there was nothing but hard rock
to be found, and sometimes the structure was not large enough to cover
even the body of a child. We must turn to local superstitions in order
fully to understand the use of trilithons and dolmens. Wild as are the
legends, they preserve, in Conder’s opinion, what was once the religion
of the dolmen-building tribes. After making measured drawings of about
a hundred and fifty dolmens in Moab, it seemed to him that the purpose
of the builders was to produce a flat table-like surface, which they
perhaps used as an altar. True that the dolmens are often more numerous
in a confined area than we should expect altars to be, but we must
not forget the story of Balaam and Balak, in which seven altars are
built on the same mountain top, and again seven more on a neighbouring
mountain top. Then, as to the absence of such monuments in Judea and
Samaria, Conder suggests that they may very probably have once existed,
and may have been purposely destroyed. Israel was commanded to “smash”
the _menhirs_ of the Canaanites, to “upset” their altars, and to
destroy their images. These commands Josiah, the zealous king of Judah,
is recorded to have carried into practice.

Who built these structures? They are very likely the surviving work of
Canaanite tribes. Herr Schumacher assigns those of the Hauran to the
same period as the subterranean cities.

There is a curious archæological note in Deuteronomy, which speaks of
the bedstead of Og, the king of Bashan, a bedstead 9 cubits long by
4 cubits wide. The passage had very much exercised the ingenuity of
commentators, and some of them supposed it to refer to a sarcophagus of
basalt. The Bible indeed speaks of a bedstead of iron; but basalt is
a material which resembles iron in appearance, and which is actually
known by the name of iron among the Arabs, while a stone coffin might
allowably be spoken of as a bed or bedstead. But Conder says there is
no basalt at Rabbath, and thinks it doubtful if Og was likely to be
buried in a sarcophagus at all. He is disposed to render the words as
Og’s _strong throne_, instead of “iron bedstead.” A memory of Irish
dolmens suggested to him a possible connection between Og’s throne
and some rude stone monument which tradition might have indicated as
a giant’s seat, just as in Ireland dolmens are the “beds of Grain and
Diarmed,” and connected with legends of giants. It was, therefore,
very striking to find a single enormous dolmen standing alone in a
conspicuous position near Rabbath Ammon, and yet more striking that the
top stone measured 13 feet (or very nearly 9 cubits of 16 inches) by 11
feet in extreme breadth.

If we look for a coffin or a bedstead rather than a dolmen, it is very
striking to find that parallels exist both for bedsteads and coffins of
the same gigantic dimensions. Dr Erasmus Wilson, describing the coffins
and mummies found at _Deir-el-Bahari_, says that, “the coffin of Queen
Nefertari is gigantic in stature, measuring with its feathered crest
13 feet long. It is made of cloth-board and modelled into the shape
of a statue, resembling, with arms crossed upon the chest, one of
those architectural columns which are denominated Caryatides.” Still
more remarkable is the bedstead of the Babylonian god Bel, described
by Mr George Smith in his account of the “Temple of Bel.” After some
description of the principal buildings, he says, “In these western
chambers stood the couch of the god, and the throne of gold mentioned
by Herodotus, besides other furniture of great value. The couch is
stated to have been 9 cubits long and 4 cubits broad (15 feet by 6 feet
8 inches).” These are exactly the dimensions assigned to Og’s bedstead.

Before leaving Moab it was Major Conder’s privilege to stand where
Moses stood, and view the landscape on all sides. There can be no
doubt about the identification of Mount Nebo. It was ascertained by
Canon Tristram; it has been confirmed by Conder, who finds the field
of Zophim close by; and Sir Charles Warren discovered the ruins of the
ancient city of Nebo at its foot. Moreover, it retains the name _Neba_,
and from the summit you obtain the celebrated “Pisgah view” (Deut.
xxxiv. 1-3). Naphtali, Gilead, Ephraim, and Manasseh, Judah, and the
Negeb, or “dry land” south of Hebron, are all in sight, with the plains
of Jericho “unto Zoar.” But, according to Conder, the Mediterranean
Sea is not visible from Nebo, being hidden throughout by the western
watershed of Judea and Samaria. Dr Tristram says, in his “Land of
Moab,” “Carmel could be recognised, but we never were able to make out
the sea to the north of it; and though it is certainly possible that
it might be seen from this elevation, I could not satisfy myself that
I saw more than the haze over the plain of Esdraelon.” But even if the
waters of the “great sea” in the Bay of Haifa could be seen distinctly
from Mount Nebo, the fact would hardly be relevant, for Deut. xxxiv.
points rather to the sea south of Joppa. It is sufficient, however,
that from no other summit can you get so extensive a prospect as from
Mount Nebo.

Conder’s work was abruptly stopped. Even when the party went out in
1881 there was great excitement in the East. A Moslem Messiah was
expected to appear in the year 1300 of the Hegira, and the war in
Egypt was brewing. The British Government had served Conder with a
notice that any expedition he might take out would be at his own risk,
and they could not be responsible for the consequences. After fifteen
months, during which the work was carried on at great risks, the
Sultan heard that English captains were surveying the land, and sent
orders for them to cease. In the same year Mr Rassam’s researches in
Mesopotamia were stopped. Finally, Conder and his party left Syria on a
steamer crowded with refugees from the Alexandria massacres.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“East of the Jordan.” By Selah
   Merrill. London: Bentley & Son, 1881. “Across the Jordan.” By
   Gottlieb Schumacher. Bentley & Son, 1886. “The Jaulan.” By G.
   Schumacher, Bentley, 1888. “Abila,” “Pella,” and “Northern
   Ajlun.” By G. Schumacher. London: Palestine Exploration
   Society, 1888, 1889. “Palestine.” By Major Conder. London:
   George Philip & Son, 1889. “Heth and Moab.” By Major Conder.
   Bentley & Son, 1883. “The Land of Moab.” By Rev. Canon
   Tristram. London: John Murray, 1873. “Unexplored Syria.” By
   Burton and Drake. London: Tinsley Brothers, 1872.]



                             CHAPTER III.

                              JERUSALEM.


Ever since the days of David Jerusalem has been the chief city
of Palestine, and although so small a city now that it would go
conveniently into Hyde Park--and perhaps never much larger than at
present--it has been the theatre of great events, and it claims an
attentive study. Small as it was, it stood upon several hills, which
were more or less easy to defend by fortifications, and offered
some choice to the monarch desirous of building a palace, a tower,
or a temple. The variety of local features, of hill and ravine
and water-course, finds frequent mention in the history, and is
sometimes so much intertwined with the events related, that it becomes
necessary to look at the topography before we can hope to understand
the narrative. For instance, when David wrested the city from the
Jebusites:--

“David took the strong hold of Zion.... And David dwelt in the strong
hold, and called it the City of David. And David built round about from
Millo inward” (2 Sam. V. 7-9).

“So he took the Lower City by force, but the Citadel[20] held out
still.... When David had cast the Jebusites out of the Citadel, he
also rebuilt Jerusalem, and named it the City of David”--Josephus,
Antiquities, vii. 3, 1-2 (Whiston’s Translation).

Here we should like to know at least which part of Jerusalem was
called the City of David; because David built a house there, and most
of the kings of Judah were buried there.

Again, in 1 Kings i., “Adonijah slew sheep and oxen and fatlings by the
Stone of Zoheleth, which is beside En-Rogel,” and sought to get himself
proclaimed king. But when Nathan the prophet, and Bathsheba the mother
of Solomon, had acquainted David with the proceeding, David gave orders
to place Solomon upon the king’s mule, and “bring him down to Gihon,”
and proclaim him as king. There the trumpet was blown, the people piped
with pipes, and Adonijah and his guests heard the noise. Before we can
fully realise these scenes we must know all the localities, and how
they stood related to one another, and to the position of David’s house.

The Old Testament history is full of such local references, and so are
the Books of the Maccabees; and perhaps most of all, the chapters of
Josephus which describe the siege of Jerusalem by Titus. Let us then
try and make ourselves acquainted with the features of the ground, and
learn to apply the names to the proper localities.


                        1. _The City as it is._

_Its position._--Jerusalem is well described in Smith’s Dict. of the
Bible. It lies near the summit of the broad mountain ridge, or high,
uneven table-land which extends from the Plain of Esdraelon to the
desert of the south. This tract is everywhere not less than from
20 to 25 miles in breadth, and has a surface rocky and uneven. Its
height at Jerusalem is 2500 feet above the Mediterranean Sea; but it
continues to rise towards the south, until, in the vicinity of Hebron,
the elevation is nearly 3000 feet. The city occupies the southern
termination of a table-land which is cut off from the country round it
on the west, south, and east sides, by ravines more than usually deep
and precipitous. These ravines leave the level of the table-land, the
one on the west and the other on the north-east of the city, and fall
rapidly until they form a junction below its south-east corner. The
eastern one--the Valley of the Kedron, commonly called the Valley of
Jehoshaphat--runs nearly straight from north to south. But the western
one--the Valley of Hinnom--runs south for a time, and then takes a
sudden bend to the east until it meets the Valley of Jehoshaphat, after
which the two rush off as one to the Dead Sea. How sudden is their
descent may be gathered from the fact that the level at the point
of junction--about a mile and a quarter from the starting-point of
each--is more than 600 feet below that of the upper plateau from which
they commenced their descent. Thus while on the north there is no
material difference between the general level of the country outside
the walls and that of the highest parts of the city, on the other
three sides, so steep is the fall of the ravines, so trench-like their
character, and so close do they keep to the promontory, at whose foot
they run, as to leave on the beholder the impression of the ditch at
the foot of a fortress, rather than of valleys formed by nature.

  [Illustration: PLAN OF JERUSALEM

      _By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._]

The promontory thus encircled is itself divided by a longitudinal
ravine--called the Tyropœon Valley, running up it from south to north,
rising gradually from the south like the external ones, till at last it
arrives at the level of the upper plateau, dividing the central mass
into two unequal portions. Of these two, that on the west--the Upper
City of the Jews, the Mount Zion of modern tradition--is the higher and
more massive; that on the east--Mount Moriah--is at once considerably
lower and smaller, so that, to a spectator from the south, the city
appears to slope sharply towards the east. The central valley, at about
half-way up its length, threw out a companion valley on its left or
west side, which made its way up to the general level of the ground at
the present Jaffa Gate.

One more valley must be noted. It was on the north of Moriah, and
separated it from a hill on which, in the time of Josephus, stood a
suburb or part of the city called Bezetha, or the New-town. Part of
this depression is still preserved in the large reservoir with two
arches, usually called the Pool of Bethesda, near the St Stephen’s Gate.

All round the city are higher hills: on the east the Mount of Olives;
on the south the Hill of Evil Counsel, rising directly from the Vale
of Hinnom; on the west the ground rises gently to the borders of the
great wady; while on the north, a bend of the ridge connected with the
Mount of Olives bounds the prospect at the distance of more than a
mile. Towards the south-west the view is somewhat more open; for here
lies the Plain of Rephaim, commencing just at the southern brink of the
Valley of Hinnom, and stretching off south-west, where it runs to the
western sea.

This rough sketch of the _terrain_ of Jerusalem, which I take mainly
from Sir George Grove, will enable the reader to appreciate the two
great advantages of its position. On the one hand the ravines which
entrench it on the west, south, and east--out of which the rock slopes
of the city rose almost like the walls of a fortress out of its
ditches, must have rendered it impregnable on those quarters to the
warfare of the old world. On the other hand its junction with the more
level ground on its north and north-east sides afforded an opportunity
of expansion, of which we know advantage was taken, and which gave it a
remarkable superiority over other cities of Palestine, and especially
of Judah, which, though secure on their hill-tops, were unable to
expand beyond them.

The western side of the city is more than 100 feet higher than the
eastern; but the Mount of Olives overtops even the highest part of the
city by more than 150 feet.

_The Walls and Streets of the City._--Jerusalem is surrounded by
walls some 40 to 50 feet high, imposing in appearance but far from
strong. For the most part they were erected as they now stand by
Sultan Suleiman, in the year 1542, and they appear to occupy the site
of the walls of the middle ages, from the ruins of which they are
mostly constructed. On the eastern side, along the brow of the Valley
of Jehoshaphat, the section of the wall south of St Stephen’s Gate is
of far earlier date, and is constructed in part of massive bevelled
stones. A great stone at the south-eastern corner is estimated to
weigh more than one hundred tons; and this block is one of a course of
stones, 6 feet in thickness, which extends along the south wall for
600 feet, though not without gaps. The walls nearly resemble York and
other ancient cities in England, having steps at intervals leading up
to the battlemented breastwork; and the circuit of them, according
to Robinson and others, is something less than 2½ English miles. The
form of the city is irregular, the walls having many projections and
indentations; but it is easy to make out four sides; and these nearly
face the cardinal points.

There are at present five open gates in the walls of Jerusalem--two
on the south and one near the centre of each of the other sides. They
all seem to occupy ancient sites, and are by name (1) the Jaffa Gate,
or Hebron Gate, on the west, to which all the roads from the south and
west converge. (2) The Damascus Gate, or Gate of the Column, on the
north, from which runs the great north road, past the Tombs of the
Kings, and over the ridge of Scopus, to Samaria and Damascus. (3) St
Stephen’s Gate, or Gate of my Lady Mary, or Gate of the Tribes, on the
east, whence a road leads down to the bottom of the Kedron, and thence
over Olivet to Bethany and Jericho. (4) The Dung Gate, or Gate of the
Western Africans, on the south, and near the centre of the Tyropœan
Valley. A path from it leads down to the village of Siloam. (5) Zion
Gate, or the Gate of the Prophet David, on the summit of the ridge of
the hill now called Zion. Besides these, there are two gates now walled
up, one being the Gate of Herod, on the north side, about half-way
between the Damascus Gate and the north-east angle of the city; the
other the Golden Gate, in the eastern wall of the Haram. The Arabs
call this the Eternal Gate, and it is sometimes called the Gate of
Repentance.

About one-sixth of the area of the city is occupied by the Haram or
Sanctuary, on Mount Moriah, within which stands the great mosque,
called the Dome of the Rock, and where also there is ample breathing
space.

Jerusalem is not a fine city according to western ideas. It is badly
built, of mean stone houses: and its streets and lanes are narrow,
dirty, and ill-paved. There are, however, some beautiful bits of
architecture; there are the grand walls of the temple area; and there
is, above all, the intense interest of its Scriptural associations.

Entering the city by the Jaffa Gate we find on our right the citadel,
with the so-called Tower of David. The street right before us is now
called the Street of David, and descends eastward to the principal
entrance to the Haram. Another main street commences at the Damascus
Gate and traverses the city from north to south, passing near the
eastern end of the Church of the Holy Sepulchre, and through the
principal bazaar, and terminating a little eastward of the Zion Gate.
These two streets divide the city into four quarters. The north-east
is the Moslem quarter, the north-west the Christian quarter, the
south-west the Armenian, and the south-east the Jewish. The Church of
the Holy Sepulchre is, of course, in the Christian quarter, where also
we have the Latin Convent, very conspicuous from its lofty position
near the north-west angle of the city. In the Moslem quarter is the
Serai or palace, and most of the Consulates, and the beautiful little
Church of St Anne. The Armenian Convent, the largest building in the
city, occupies a noble site on the south-western hill. Near it, on
the north, is the English church. But by far the most remarkable and
striking building in this quarter of the city is the Citadel, whose
massive towers loom heavily over all around them. The Jewish quarter
has no structure of note with the exception of the new synagogues.

Jerusalem is not like Damascus, where the Moslem religion and oriental
customs are almost unmixed with any foreign element, but is a city in
which every form of religion and every nationality of east and west are
represented at one time. “So motley a crowd” (says Major Conder) “as
that which is presented daily in David Street and in the market-place
under David’s Tower, is perhaps to be found nowhere else. The chatter
of the market people, the shouting of the camel drivers, the tinkling
of bells, mingle with the long cry of the naked Santon, as he wanders,
holding his tin pan for alms, and praising unceasingly “the Eternal
God.” The scene is most remarkable in the morning, before the glare of
the sun, beating down on the stone city, has driven its inhabitants
into the shadow. The foreground is composed of a tawny group of camels,
lying down, donkeys bringing in vegetables or carrying out rubbish,
and women in blue and red dresses slashed with yellow, their dark
faces and long eyes (tinged with blue) shrouded in white veils, which
are fringed perhaps with black or red. Soldiers in black and Softas
in spotless robes are haggling about their change, or praying in
public undisturbed by the din. Horsemen ride by in red boots with red
saddles, and spears 15 feet long. The Greek Patriarch walks past on a
visit, preceded by his mace-bearers and attended by his secretary. Up
the narrow street comes the hearse of a famous Moslem, followed by a
long procession of women, in white “izars,” which envelop the whole
figure, swelling out like balloons, and leaving only the black mask
of the face-veil visible; their voices are raised in the high-pitched
tremulous ululation which is alike their cry for the dead and their
note of joy for the living. Next, perhaps, follows a regiment of sturdy
infantry marching back to the Castle, with a colonel on a prancing
grey--men who have shown their mettle since then, and fat, unwieldy
officers, who have perhaps broken down under the strain of campaigning.
Their bugles blow a monotonous tune, to which the drums keep time, and
the men tread, not in step, but in good cadence to the music. If it
be Easter the native crowd is mingled with the hosts of Armenian and
Russian pilgrims, the first ruddy and stalwart, their women handsome
and dark-eyed, the men fierce and dark; the Russians, yet stronger
in build and more barbarian in air, distinguished from every other
nationality by their unkempt beards, their long locks, their huge
fur caps and boots. Not less distinct are the Spanish, Mughrabee,
Russian, and German Jews, each marked by a peculiar and characteristic
physiognomy.”

Ten sects or religions are established in Jerusalem, and if their
various sub-divisions are counted they amount to a total of
twenty-four, more than half of which are Christian. The late Mr C. T.
Tyrwhitt Drake gives the different races and creeds as follows:--

    1. Abyssinians.
    2. Armenians: (_a_) Orthodox, (_b_) Catholic.
    3. Copts.
    4. Greeks: (_a_) Orthodox, (_b_) Catholic.
    5. Jews: (_a_) Ashkenazim, (_b_) Sephardim, (_c_) Karaite.
    6. Latin or Roman Catholics.
    7. Maronites.
    8. Moslems: _Sunni_,--(_a_) Shafii, (_b_) Hanefi, (_c_) Hambeli,
         (_d_) Maleki. _Shiaï_,--Metawili, &c.
    9. Protestants: (_a_) Church of England, (_b_) Lutheran.
    10. Syrians: (_a_) Jacobite, (_b_) Catholic.

All these sects have their churches, synagogues, monasteries, hospices,
which take up no inconsiderable portion of the square half mile of
space within the city walls. Yet the population of Jerusalem was
estimated at 20,000 in 1878, and there has been further influx since.
But many of the new comers build dwellings outside the walls, and there
is now quite a large suburb on the north-west.

_The Haram esh Sherif_, or Noble Sanctuary, on Mount Moriah, is a
large, open space, of peculiar sanctity in the eyes of all true
Moslems. Its surface is studded with cypress and olive, and its sides
are surrounded in part by the finest mural masonry in the world. At the
southern end is the Mosque El Aksa, and a pile of buildings formerly
used by the Knights Templars; nearly in the centre is a raised platform
paved with marble, and rising from this is the well-known Mosque,
Kubbet es-Sakhrah, with its beautifully proportioned dome. Within this
sacred enclosure stood the temple of the Jews; but all traces of it
have long since disappeared, and its exact position was a fiercely
contested question before the time of the recent explorations.

The Haram is a quadrangle of about 35 acres in area. The angles at the
south-west and north-east corners are right angles, and the south-east
angle is 92° 30´. The true bearing of the east wall is 352° 30´
(general direction). The length of the south wall is 922 feet on the
level of the interior. The west wall is 1601 feet long; the east wall,
1530 feet. The northern boundary for 350 feet is formed by a scarp of
rock 30 feet high, projecting at the north-west of the Haram.

The modern gateways giving entrance into the interior are eleven in
number: three on the north and eight on the west. Of the ancient
gateways there were two on the south, now called the Double and Triple
Gates; while east of the latter is the mediæval entrance, known as the
Single Gate, beneath which Colonel Warren discovered a passage. On the
east wall is the Golden Gate, now closed; and two small posterns in the
modern masonry are found south of this portal. On the west wall the
Prophet’s Gateway (sometimes called Barclay’s Gate) is recognised as
the southern of the two Parbar (or Suburban) Gates, mentioned in the
Talmud; while the Northern Suburban Gate appears to have been converted
into a tank, and lies immediately west of the Dome of the Rock. (This
is Tank No. 30, Ordnance Survey.)

  [Illustration: PLAN OF THE NOBLE SANCTUARY

  SHEWING THE RESULTS OF THE RESEARCHES OF

  Col. =C. W. Wilson R.E.= &c. Col. =C. Warren R.E.=

      _By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._]

The raised platform in the middle of the Haram enclosure has an area of
about 5 acres, and is an irregular quadrangle. The Kubbet es-Sakhrah,
or Dome of the Rock, on this platform, covers the sacred rock, which
rises 5 feet above the floor of the building, the crest being at the
level 2440 feet above the Mediterranean. The Dome of the Chain is
immediately to the east of the Kubbet es-Sakhrah.

The Jami’a el-Aksa, or “distant mosque” (that is, distant from Mecca),
is on the south, reaching to the outer wall. The whole enclosure of the
Haram is called by Moslem writers Masjid el Aksa, “praying-place of the
Aksa.”

Entering by the gate of the Cotton Bazaar we stand within the temple
courts. Before us are the steps which lead up to the platform where
shoes must be removed; for while the outer court, like the old court
of the Gentiles, is a promenade, the paved marble platform is a sacred
enclosure, not to be trodden except barefoot.

Over the outer arcade of the Dome of the Rock runs the great Cufic
inscription, giving the date of the erection of the building in 688
A.D. “The Dome of the Rock” (says Conder) “belongs to that
obscure period of Saracenic art when the Arabs had not as yet created
an architectural style of their own, and when they were in the habit of
employing Byzantine architects to build their mosques.”

From the bright sunlight we pass suddenly into the deep gloom of the
interior, lit with the “dim religious light” of the glorious purple
windows. The gorgeous colouring, the painted wood-work, the fine
marble, the costly mosaics, the great dome, flourished all over with
arabesques and inscriptions, and gilded to the very top--all this
splendour gleams out here and there from the darkness.

And in honour of what is this beautiful chapel built? A low canopy of
rich silk covers the dusty limestone ledge round which the “Dome of
the Rock” has risen. According to Arab tradition this Rock of Paradise
is the source of the rivers of Paradise and the Foundation-stone of
the world. From this rock Mohammed ascended to heaven (here is the
impression made by the hand of the angel Gabriel, who held the rock
down to prevent it from following the prophet), and this Rock is the
Place of Prayer of all the Prophets.

Even more mysterious than the Sacred Rock is the Sacred Well below it.
Descending a flight of steps at the south-east corner of the rock we
enter a cave, in the rocky floor of which is a circular slab of marble,
which returns a hollow sound when struck, but which is never uplifted.
The Arabs appear to regard it as the mouth of Hell, for they call it
the Well of Souls, and have a dread of the consequences if any evil
spirit should escape. It is a tradition that in the Temple the ark of
the covenant used to stand over this cave, and that it was afterwards
concealed in the cave, or below it, by Jeremiah, and still lies hidden
beneath the sacred rock.

The ground of the Haram enclosure is honeycombed with tanks, into some
of which the water finds its way by unknown channels. One of the tanks
is called the Great Sea, and would hold 2,000,000 gallons of water;
another would hold 1,400,000, and all the tanks together 10,000,000 of
gallons at the least. This would be more than a year’s supply for the
city in its best days, a valuable resource in times of siege.

_Solomon’s Stables._--Under the Haram area, at the south-eastern part,
are the vaults known as Solomon’s Stables--thirteen rows of vaults of
a variety of spans. They were used as stables by the Crusaders, and
the holes in the piers by which the horses were fastened may still be
seen. The name of Solomon’s Stables is supposed to have been given
by the Crusaders, who may, however, have been guided by some earlier
tradition. The vaults are in part ancient and in part a reconstruction,
probably about the time of Justinian (sixth century A.D.).

_The Jews’ Wailing Place._--Outside the Haram, on the west, and not
very far from the south-west corner, is the Wailing Place of the Jews.
From the Jaffa Gate we may reach it by going down David Street and
through the fruit bazaar, and then turning through a by-lane. The
Wailing Place is a narrow court, in which the temple rampart happens
to be free and exposed in the Jews’ quarter. Every Friday the court is
crowded with Jews who come to read and pray, and bemoan the condition
of their temple, their holy city, and their scattered people. The scene
is striking from the great size and strength of the mighty stones,
which rise without door or window up to the domes and cypresses above,
suggesting how utterly the original worshippers are cast out by men
of alien race and faith. Here we may see venerable men reading the
Book of the Law, women in their long white robes kissing the ancient
masonry, and praying through the crevices of the stones, Russian Jews,
Spanish Jews, German Jews, men, women, and children, with gray locks,
or blue-black hair, or russet beard, and dressed variously, according
to their country--strange and unique is the spectacle! “It reminds one
forcibly” (says Conder) “of the unchanged character of the Jews. After
nineteen centuries of wandering and exile they are still the same as
ever, still bound by the iron chain of Talmudic law, a people whose
slavery to custom outruns even that of the Chinese to etiquette, and
whose veneration for the past appears to preclude the possibility of
progress or improvement in the present.”

_Pools and Fountains of Jerusalem._--Jerusalem is at present chiefly
supplied with water by its cisterns. Every house of any size has one
or more of them, into which the winter rains are conducted by little
pipes and ducts from the roofs and courtyards. These private cisterns
are generally vaulted chambers with only a small opening at the top,
surrounded by stonework, and furnished with a curb and wheel. Many of
them are ancient.

But besides these covered cisterns in the houses and courts, there are
many large open reservoirs in and around the city. In the upper part
of the Valley of Hinnom, west of the city, is the _Birket el Mamilla_,
often called the Upper Pool of Gihon. Lower down in the same valley,
and not far from the south-western angle of the city wall, is the
_Birket es Sultan_, frequently called the Lower Pool. Because these
pools are clearly related to one another as upper and lower, it has
been usual to assume that they are upper and lower pools of Gihon,
which seem to be referred to in 2 Chron. xxxii. 30, and elsewhere. But
although the Sultan’s Pool has been called Gihon from the fourteenth
century downwards, it is known to have been constructed by the Germans
only two centuries before, and the word Gihon means a spring-head. From
the Sultan’s Pool we may ride down the deep valley, on the south bank
of which are the traditional Aceldama and the tombs of many Christian
pilgrims, till we come to _Bir Eyub_ (Joab’s Well), where the Valley
of Hinnom unites with the Valley of Kedron. The Crusaders, who were
never too well informed, identified Joab’s Well with the Biblical En
Rogel. From this place we ride northward to the junction of the Kedron
with the Tyropœon, and there, in a verdant spot, we find the Pool of
Siloam, with dry stone walls and a little muddy water. With the village
of Siloam on our right, we ride up the Kedron Valley some 300 yards,
and arrive at the Fountain of the Mother of Stairs, also called the
Virgin’s Fountain. Descending by a flight of sixteen steps we reach a
chamber, its sides built of old stones and its roof formed of a pointed
arch. Then going down fourteen steps more into a roughly hewn grotto,
we reach the water. _Mejr ed Deir_ states that the water of this
fountain was a great test for women accused of adultery; the innocent
drank harmlessly, but the guilty no sooner tasted than they died! When
the Virgin Mary was accused, she submitted to the ordeal, and thus
established her innocence. Hence the spring was long known as the
Fountain of Accused Women. Dr Robinson imagined that this was the true
Bethesda, because the water is considered to possess healing virtue,
and every day crowds of men and women, afflicted with rheumatism and
other maladies, descend the steps and wait for the moving of the
waters. The flow is intermittent--due, it is supposed, to a natural
syphon--and the waters rise suddenly, immersing the folks, fully
clothed, nearly up to the neck.

The water wells up in the cave, and when it has attained a height of 4
feet 7 inches runs away through a passage near the back, into a small
tunnel, and goes to supply the Pool of Siloam.

About 100 yards north-east of St Stephen’s Gate is the Pool of My Lady
Mary, outside the walls.

Within the city, on your left as you enter by St Stephen’s Gate, is the
_Birket Israil_, Pool of Israel, the traditional Pool of Bethesda (but
only so since the twelfth century). It is now a receptacle for ashes
and rubbish of all kinds; but it has at some time been used for water,
for Warren found the bottom lined with concrete 16 inches thick.

Sometimes the Virgin’s Fountain is spoken of as the only spring of
living water at Jerusalem, but it is possible, as suggested by Warren,
that another existed at the _Hammam esh-Shefa_, or Bath of Healing, in
the Tyropœon. The entrance to the fountain is by a narrow opening in
the roof of a house behind the bath.

We need only mention further the Pool of Hezekiah, a large reservoir
which lies in the centre of a group of buildings, in the angle made by
the north side of David Street and the west side of Christian Street.
It is stated that a subterranean conduit from the _Birket el Mamilla_
passes underneath the city wall near the Jaffa Gate, and supplies both
the Pool of Hezekiah and the cisterns of the citadel.

In ancient times water was brought into the city by two aqueducts, the
“low level” and the “high level,” but the course of the former can
alone be traced within the walls of the city. It crosses the valley of
Hinnom a little above the _Birket es Sultan_, and winding round the
southern slope of the modern Zion, enters the city near the Jewish
almshouses; it then passes along the eastern side of the same hill, and
runs over the causeway and Wilson’s Arch to the Sanctuary. The numerous
Saracenic fountains in the lower part of the city appear to have been
supplied by pipes branching off from the main, but the pipes are now
destroyed, and the fountains themselves are used as receptacles for the
refuse of the town. This aqueduct derived its supply from the Pools of
Solomon (near Bethlehem), from _Ain Etan_, and a reservoir in _Wady
Arûb_, and still carries water as far as Bethlehem; its total length
is over 14 miles, not far short of the length of the aqueduct which
Josephus tells us was made by Pontius Pilate.

The Pools of Solomon near the head of _Wady Urtas_ are three in number;
they receive the surface drainage of the ground above them and the
water of a fine spring known as the Sealed Fountain. The pools have
been made by building solid dams of masonry across the valley, and are
so arranged that the water from each of the upper ones can be run off
into the one immediately below it. The lower pool is constructed in a
peculiar manner, which appears to indicate that it was sometimes used
as an amphitheatre for naval displays; there are several tiers of seats
with steps leading down to them, and the lower portion of the pool,
which is much deeper than the upper, could be filled with water by a
conduit from one of the other reservoirs.

The “high level aqueduct,” called by the Arabs that of the Unbelievers,
is one of the most remarkable works in Palestine. The water was
collected in a rock-hewn tunnel 4 miles long, beneath the bed of _Wady
Byar_, a valley on the road to Hebron, and thence carried by an
aqueduct above the head of the upper Pool of Solomon, where it tapped
the waters of the Sealed Fountain. From this point it wound along the
hills above the valley of Urtas to the vicinity of Bethlehem, where
it crossed the watershed, and then passed over the valley at Rachel’s
Tomb by an inverted stone syphon, which was first brought to notice
by Mr Macneill, who made an examination of the water supply for the
Syria Improvement Committee. The tubular portion is formed by large
perforated blocks of stone set in a mass of rubble masonry; the tube
is 15 inches in diameter, and the joints, which appear to have been
ground, are put together with an extremely hard cement. The last trace
of this aqueduct is seen on the Plain of Rephaim, at which point its
elevation is sufficient to deliver water at the Jaffa Gate, and so
supply the upper portion of the city; but the point at which it entered
has never been discovered, unless it is connected in some way with an
aqueduct which was found between the Russian convent and the north-west
corner of the city wall.

The present supply of water is almost entirely dependent on the
collection of the winter rainfall, which is much less than has
generally been supposed, as, by a strange mistake, the rain-gauge was
formerly read four times higher than it should have been. According
to Dr Chaplin’s observations, the average rainfall during the years
1860-64 was 19·86 inches, the maximum being 22·975 inches, and minimum
15·0 inches.

In addition to Bir Eyûb, which has been described above, the
inhabitants draw water from the Fountain of the Virgin and the Hammam
esh-Shefa.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--Smith’s “Dictionary of the
   Bible.” “Survey Memoirs,” Jerusalem volume. “The Recovery of
   Jerusalem.” Sir Charles Warren. “Palestine.” Major Conder.
   “Modern Jerusalem.” C. F. Tyrwhitt Drake. “Walks about
   Jerusalem.” W. H. Bartlett. “Quarterly Statements of P. E.
   Fund.”]


     2. _The Sieges of Jerusalem, and the Fortunes of its Walls._

“In considering the annals of the city of Jerusalem,” says Mr W. Aldis
Wright, “nothing strikes one so forcibly as the number and severity
of the sieges which it underwent. We catch our earliest glimpse of it
in the brief notice of the first chapter of Judges, which describes
how ‘the children of Judah smote it with the edge of the sword, and
set the city on fire;’ and almost the latest mention of it in the New
Testament is contained in the solemn warnings in which Christ foretold
how Jerusalem should be compassed with armies, and the abomination of
desolation be seen standing in the Holy Place. In the fifteen centuries
which elapsed between these two points, the city was besieged no fewer
than seventeen times; twice it was razed to the ground, and on two
other occasions its walls were levelled. In this respect it stands
without a parallel in any city ancient or modern.”

The first siege appears to have taken place soon after the death of
Joshua. The men of Judah and Simeon “fought against it and took it, and
smote it with the edge of the sword, and set the city on fire” (Judges
i. 8). Josephus adds that the siege lasted some time, and that the part
of the city captured at last was “the lower,” but that the part above
them[21] was so difficult, by reason of its walls and from the nature
of the place, that they relinquished their attempt upon it. As long as
the strongest part of the city remained in the hands of the Jebusites
they practically had possession of the whole. The Benjamites followed
the men of Judah to Jerusalem, but they could not drive out the
Jebusites (Judges i. 21). A Jebusite city it remained until the days of
David.

Jerusalem was taken by David, _circa_ 1044 B.C. He took the
castle of Zion, which is the City of David, and dwelt in the castle (2
Sam. v. 6; 1 Chron. xi. 4). Then David built round about, from Millo
and inward, and Joab repaired the rest of the city.

As long as Solomon lived the visits of foreign powers to Jerusalem
were those of courtesy and amity; but with his death this was changed.
Rehoboam had only been on the throne four years when Shishak, king of
Egypt, invaded Judah, and advanced against the capital. Rehoboam opened
the gates to him, and Shishak did not depart without plundering the
temple and the palace. B.C. 886.

In the reign of Jehoram, the son of Jehoshaphat, the Philistines and
Arabians attacked Jerusalem, broke into the palace, spoiled it of all
its treasures, sacked the royal harem, and killed or carried off the
king’s wives and all his sons but one. This was the fourth siege.
B.C. 881.

Amaziah, king of Judah, victorious over the Edomites, was foolish
enough to challenge Jehoash, king of Israel. The battle took place
at Bethshemesh of Judah, 12 miles west of Jerusalem. Amaziah was
routed, and the victorious Jehoash, after the gates of Jerusalem had
been thrown open to him, broke down 400 cubits length of wall, from
the Corner Gate to the Gate of Ephraim. (This must have been at the
north-west part of the city walls, the favourite point of attack in
after times.) B.C. 857.

King Uzziah, after some campaigns against foreign princes, devoted
himself to the care of Jerusalem. He rebuilt the wall broken down by
Jehoash, and fortified it with towers. In Uzziah’s reign the city
suffered from an earthquake; a serious breach was made in the Temple,
and below the city a large fragment was detached from one of the hills
and rolled down the slope, overwhelming the king’s paradise or park.
B.C. 770.

The hill above En Rogel was called Ophel, and might be otherwise
described as the slope south of the Temple. The royal palaces were
there, and it was protected by a strong wall. We have no record of
the first erection of this wall; but Jotham, the son of Uzziah, built
much upon it, and also built the upper gateway to the Temple (2 Chron.
xxvii. 3). According to Josephus, he also repaired the city walls
wherever they were dilapidated, and strengthened them by very large and
strong towers. B.C. 740.

Before the death of Jotham the clouds of the Syrian invasion began to
gather, and they broke on the head of Ahaz, his successor. Rezin, king
of Syria, and Pekah, king of Israel, joined their armies and invested
Jerusalem (2 Kings xvi. 5). In a battle which took place outside the
walls Ahaz was defeated. This induced him to send to Assyria and
obtain help from Tiglath Pileser, whose vassal he became, and whose
sun-worship he adopted. B.C. 730.

And now approached the greatest crisis that had yet occurred in the
history of the city. Hezekiah reformed the worship and declined to be
a dependent on Assyria. Sennacherib had succeeded Tiglath Pileser, and
the dreaded Assyrian army approached. Hezekiah stopped the springs
round Jerusalem, repaired the walls of the city, breaking down houses
to get the material--even raised the wall in some places up to the
towers; and built a second wall at some exposed part, and strengthened
Millo (2 Kings xx. 20; 2 Chron. xxxii. 3-5, 30; Isaiah xxii. 10). On
this occasion it would appear that the city escaped, but at the cost of
the treasures of the palace and the temple. B.C. 700.

In the middle of the long reign of Manasseh Jerusalem was taken by
Assur-bani-pal, the grandson of Sennacherib, B.C. 650.

But Manasseh, in the latter part of his reign, sought to repair and
strengthen the city. He built a fresh wall, extending “from the west
side of Gihon-in-the-valley to the Fish Gate;” and he also continued
the works which had been begun at Ophel, and raised the structure to a
very great height. B.C. 640.

During the reign of Jehoiakim Jerusalem was visited by Nebuchadnezzar,
with the Babylonian army lately victorious over the Egyptians at
Carchemish, and it is thought that there must have been a siege, but we
have no account of it. Jehoiakim was succeeded by his son Jehoiachin,
and hardly had his short reign begun before the terrible army of
Babylon reappeared before the city, again commanded by Nebuchadnezzar
(2 Kings xxiv). Jehoiachin surrendered, and the city was pillaged.
Jehoiachin being carried off to Babylon, his uncle Zedekiah was made
king; but he was imprudent enough to seek the help of Pharaoh Hophra
of Egypt, and upon this Nebuchadnezzar marched to Jerusalem again and
began a regular siege. The walls and houses were battered by rams, and
missiles were discharged into the town. After some delays a breach
was made in the north wall, and the city suffered all the horrors of
assault and sack. Zedekiah had stolen out of the city on the south
side, but was pursued and overtaken. The Babylonians burnt the Temple,
the palace, and other public buildings, and threw down the city walls.
B.C. 577.

When Nehemiah obtained leave to return and rebuild the city of his
fathers he found heaps of disordered rubbish everywhere on the ground.
By his amazing zeal and energy he stirred up the people to work; and in
due time all the gates and walls were set up, on the old foundations.
B.C. 457.

       *       *       *       *       *

There is no need for us to pursue the history in detail.
Further stormy periods succeed.

                                                                   B.C.
      Ptolemy, son of Lagus takes Jerusalem,                       305.
      Antiochus the Great takes the city,                          219.
      Antiochus Epiphanes takes the city without siege,            170.
      Antiochus Eupator takes the city,                            163.
      Jonathan builds a new wall,                                  143.
      Simon takes the Akra citadel,                                139.
      Antiochus Sidetes besieges Jerusalem,                        134.
      Aretas, the Arab, besieges the city,                          65.
      Pompey takes the city,                                        63.
      Antipater rebuilds the walls,                                 58.
      Herod and Sosius take Jerusalem,                              37.

                                                                   A.D.
      Agrippa builds the third wall,                                43.
      Cestius Gallus attacks Jerusalem,                             66.
      Titus takes Jerusalem (fifteenth siege) and utterly
        destroys it,                                                70.
      Bar Cocheba revolts,                                         132.
      Bar Cocheba is expelled,                                     135.
      Rufus ploughs the temple site,                               135.
      Hadrian founds Ælia Capitolina,                              136.
      The Jews revolt and are excluded from the city,              339.
      Eudoxia rebuilds the walls,                                  450.
      Chosroes II. takes Jerusalem,                                614.
      Omar the Caliph takes the city,                              637.
      Caliph Moez takes possession of the city,                    969.
      Turkomans expel Egyptians from the city,                    1094.
      The Egyptians retake Jerusalem,                             1098.
      Crusaders take Jerusalem (nineteenth siege),                1099.
      Walls of Jerusalem repaired,                                1178.
      Saladin takes Jerusalem (twentieth siege),                  1187.
      Saladin repairs the walls of the city,                      1192.
      Melek el Muazzam dismantles the walls,                      1192.
      Frederic II. rebuilds the walls,                            1229.
      Daud, Emir of Kerak, destroys the walls,                    1239.
      Christians obtain Jerusalem by treaty,                      1243.
      Soliman the Magnificent builds walls,                       1542.
      Muhammed Aly takes Jerusalem (no siege),                    1832.
      The Fellahin seize Jerusalem,                               1834.
      Syria and Jerusalem restored to Turkey,                     1840.

In reflecting upon such a history as this, two things become very
clear; the first is that the details of the events would be much better
understood if we had an accurate map before us; the second is that the
events themselves--the successive destructions and rebuildings--must
have changed the city considerably from what it was. Even in the city
of London the floors of Roman dwellings are found 15 or 18 feet below
the present surface of the streets. In Jerusalem, we need not be
surprised to learn, the depth of _debris_ is much greater, and since
it has accumulated chiefly in the valleys, and very nearly obliterated
some of them, it has, of course, obscured the topography. An accurate
map of modern Jerusalem is in our hands, but it does not show us what
the ancient city was like. Therefore it is not sufficient to have this
modern map before us when we read the ancient history. We read in the
history that Zedekiah fled (from his palace) through the gate between
two walls and by the way of the king’s gardens; but in modern Jerusalem
there is no king’s palace or garden and no gate between two walls. The
history describes how Nehemiah rebuilt the wall, from the Sheep Gate to
the Tower of Meah, and thence to the Fish Gate, and the Old Gate, &c.,
but in modern Jerusalem we find no such places and names. We are still
worse off when we read in Josephus about Titus encamping within the
third wall, and then making a breach in the middle wall and encamping
in the middle city, and still having a wall between him and the Jews in
the Upper City: for the Jerusalem of to-day shows only one wall besides
the rampart of the temple. Naturally there has been much conjecture
concerning the ancient city, and the best authorities have differed
from one another in their ideas. It was with the hope of settling
the disputed questions as well as with the object of uncovering
antiquities, that the Palestine Exploration Society began the work of
excavation.

It has often been said that there is not a single topographical
question connected with ancient Jerusalem which is not the subject of
controversy. This is, however, rather overstating the case, for there
are points concerning which all authorities are in accord. First, as
regards the natural features of the site, it is agreed that the Mount
of Olives is the chain of hills east of the Temple Hill, and that the
valley beneath it on the west is the Brook Kedron. It is agreed that
the Temple stood on the spur immediately west of the Kedron, and that
the southern tongue of this spur was called Ophel. It is also agreed
that the flat valley west of this spur is that to which Josephus
applies the name Tyropœon, although there was a diversity of opinion as
to the exact course of the valley, which has now been set at rest by
the collection of the rock-levels within the city. It is also agreed
by all authorities that the high south-western hill (to which the name
Zion has been applied since the fourth century) is that which Josephus
calls the hill of the Upper City, or Upper Market Place.

The site of the Pool of Siloam is also undisputed, and the rock
Zoheleth was discovered by M. Clermont Ganneau at the present village
of _Silwan_. As regards the walls of the ancient city, all authorities,
except Fergusson, agree in placing the Royal Towers (of Herod) in the
vicinity of the present citadel, and all suppose the scarp in the
Protestant cemetery to be the old south-west angle of the city. The
Tyropœon Bridge--or stairway and arch--is accepted by all writers since
Robinson as leading to the royal cloisters of Herod’s temple, and all
plans of Herod’s temple start with the assumption that the south-west
angle of its courts coincided with the present south-west angle of the
Haram. All plans also agree in accepting the east wall of the Haram as
an ancient rampart of the city. We have thus various data to begin with
which must be considered as certain, because writers who differ on all
other points agree on these.[22]

The “other points” upon which writers have differed may be stated as
follows:--

1. What was the extent of the city on the north before the destruction
of A.D. 70?

2. What was the line of the second wall, which bounded the city on the
north, in those early times before there was any third wall, or any
need of one?

3. What was the line of the south wall in Nehemiah’s time, and again in
the time of the siege by Titus?

4. Which is the true Mount Zion or City of David?

5. On what spot did the Temple itself stand within the Haram enclosure;
and what were the limits of its courts, first in Solomon’s day, and
secondly, after they were enlarged by Herod?

6. Does the Church of the Holy Sepulchre stand upon the true site of
Calvary?

7. What is the probable site of the royal sepulchres where David and so
many other kings lie buried?

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--Smith’s “Dictionary of the
   Bible.” “Survey Memoirs,” Jerusalem volume.]


                    3. _Excavations at Jerusalem._

In the beginning of 1867 Lieutenant Warren, R.E. (now Colonel Sir
Charles Warren), began his work of excavation in Jerusalem, assisted by
several corporals of sappers, and employing native Arabs as labourers.
Scores of shafts were sunk through the accumulated rubbish, and were
always carried down to the natural rock. In cases where the miners came
upon artificial structures--arches, aqueducts, cisterns, or other works
of man--they were carefully explored and measured, and plans of them
made to scale. It was considered important to examine the underground
masonry of the Temple rampart; but as the walls are regarded as
sacred, and it was desirable not to offend the susceptibilities of the
inhabitants, this was accomplished by sinking shafts at a distance
from the wall and driving lateral galleries. Sometimes when an
unsympathising Turkish official came to inspect the works, a twist was
given to the rope as he descended, and so, having lost his bearings,
he could not be sure that he gazed upon the foundations of the Temple
when they were really shown to him. The work was continued until the
year 1870, and the results are recorded in the Jerusalem volume of the
Memoirs. Let us now glance at some of the more striking discoveries on
all the four sides of the Haram.

  [Illustration:

      SPRING STONE OF ROBINSON’S ARCH.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

_In the Tyropœon Valley._--On the west side of the Haram, about 39
feet from the south-western angle, a great stone is seen projecting
from the wall. Dr Robinson, the American traveller, believed it to be
the spring-stone of an arch--perhaps the first arch of a bridge going
to the Upper City--but others took a different view, and the question
could only be settled by excavation. The span of the arch, as deduced
from the curve of the spring-stone, should be about 42 feet. At that
distance from the wall Warren discovered the pier of the arch, resting
on the rock at a depth of 42 feet. It is 12 feet 2 inches in thickness,
52 feet 6 inches in length (the spring-stone above ground is 50 feet)
and is constructed of long drafted stones, similar to those in the
wall, one of them being over 13 feet in length and weighing ten tons.
Three courses of stones were in place on the eastern side and two on
the western.

To the west of the pier is a rock-hewn channel, close to the pier, with
a perpendicular scarp below the pier of 4 feet; and on the east side of
the pier the rock is scarped down nearly perpendicularly for a depth of
about 18 feet.

  [Illustration:

      ROBINSON’S ARCH (SECTION.)

     (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

But nearly on a level with the base of the pier, on the east side, a
pavement extends from the pier to the Haram wall; and on this pavement
rest the fallen voussoirs of the arch. Below the pavement is a mass of
_debris_, and in the bottom of the space is an aqueduct cut in the rock
nearly 12 feet deep, arched over, but with the roof crushed in at one
place by the voussoirs of a more ancient arch.

Following the aqueduct to the south we presently come to a pool or
cistern, 16 feet in diameter; and beyond this the channel turns the
corner of the Haram and ends to-day in a drain. Following the aqueduct
to the north it brings us to another pool, and presently to a third,
this third one being partly underneath the wall of the Haram. The
channel was evidently intended to supply the city with pure water, for
after the _debris_ had accumulated, shafts were made from the pavement
before spoken of, to allow of buckets being let down.

The chief explorers, Warren and Conder, whose matured opinion is given
in the Jerusalem volume of the Memoirs, find “no grounds for supposing
that the roadway over Robinson’s Arch led up to the Upper City, either
by steps or by a bridge; it was probably one of the suburban entrances
spoken of by Josephus. There may have been other arches in continuation
of Robinson’s Arch, but there is no indication of this existing on the
ground.”

  [Illustration:

      WILSON’S ARCH.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

Proceeding from Robinson’s Arch up the valley, we come to the Gate of
the Chain, a chief entrance to the Haram. The street running westward
from it is the Street of the Chain, and would bring us, with one little
elbow, into David Street, whence we go straight to the Jaffa Gate. But
in front of the Gate of the Chain it is found that the Street of the
Chain passes over a fine arch (now called Wilson’s Arch) 42 feet in
span, like Robinson’s Arch lower down. From an old book, called “La
Citez de Jherusalem,” we learn that the street coming south from the
Damascus Gate to the Dung Gate used to pass under this arch in the
Middle Ages. The road passing over the arch is about 80 feet above the
rock. But the rock under the western pier is 10 feet higher than under
the Noble Sanctuary, and the lowest point in the valley is about 16
feet west of the Sanctuary wall. Westward of the pier the Street of the
Chain rests upon a Causeway, made up of a complication of structures
difficult to describe. There is a long passage or tunnel running along
under the street, which for convenience is called the “Secret Passage.”
North of this run two parallel rows of vaults, which are broken up by
more recent work, apparently Saracenic. But when the vaults were made
they interfered at one place with a very ancient chamber of drafted
stones, the “Ancient Hall,” which has all the appearance of being one
of the oldest buildings in Jerusalem. A shaft was sunk in the floor of
the chamber to a depth of 11 feet 6 inches, through rough masonry as
hard as a wall, but without finding rock. With regard to the Secret
Passage, an Arabic writer, Mejr ed Din, says that the Street of David
is “so named from a subterranean gallery which David caused to be made
from the Gate of the Chain to the Citadel called the Mihrab of David.
It still exists, and parts of it are occasionally discovered. It is
solidly vaulted.” It would, however, be unsafe to accept the Arab
writer’s opinion as to the date and use of the passage.

As touching the original contours of the ground, it appears from the
excavations in the Tyropœon that two valleys descend, one from the
Damascus Gate, the other from near the Jaffa Gate, and that they were
originally very deep, giving the lower part of the north-western hill a
rounded and gibbous form. The accumulation of rubbish at Wilson’s Arch
is 80 feet, at Robinson’s Arch it is still more, and the true bed of
the valley passes under the Haram and comes out on the south side at a
distance of 90 feet from the south-west angle. There is a steep scarp
from the Upper City down to the present Tyropœon, and thence the rock
shelves down to the ancient valley bed.

  [Illustration:

      SOUTH WALL OF NOBLE SANCTUARY.

      (_By permission of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

_On the Ophel Hill._--Ophel is the southern slope of Mount Moriah;
and as we stand on the slope, looking northward, we face the south
wall of the Noble Sanctuary. Right in the middle of it is the Triple
Gate, from which the surface of the ground shelves down 22 feet to the
south-east angle, while westward it maintains its level. Yet really,
in that western part (hidden from us just now by the wall of the city)
the true bed of the Tyropœon runs out, and the depth of soil or rubbish
is 85 feet. At the Triple Gate itself the rock is found about 2 feet
below the sill; but at the south-east angle again we should have to
sink a shaft 80 feet deep to find it. Thus the original surface of
Ophel is all covered up, and its true contour disguised. Buried in the
rubbish Warren has found the Wall of Ophel, abutting on the wall of the
Sanctuary at the south-east angle. It is about 12 feet wide at the
top and 15 feet at the bottom; it runs southward for 76 feet, and then
makes a bend to the west, in which direction it extends for 700 feet,
and there ends abruptly. At the bend it is strengthened by a projecting
tower, and below the bend there are several towers, one standing out
very prominently. (_See_ Plan of Haram Area, p. 212.)

  [Illustration: DEEP SHAFT AT SOUTH-EAST ANGLE OF HARAM.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

The whole space of ground within this wall, wherever the spade was put
in, proved to be rich in antiquities of various dates. One of the most
interesting discoveries was that of a cavern with fullers’ vats, close
to the traditional spot where St James was thrown over the Temple wall
and despatched by a fuller’s baton.

  [Illustration: JAR HANDLES FROM SOUTH-EAST ANGLE.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]


  [Illustration: VASE FOUND AT S.-E. ANGLE.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

_At the South-Eastern Angle._--At this corner the wall stands about
70 feet high above the ground. At a height of 22 feet we observe the
great stone which is estimated to weigh more than one hundred tons;
and the courses below that have the appearance of being ancient work.
But we still have to go 78 or 80 feet beneath the surface to find the
foundations of the wall. It appears that the lowest or foundation
course is partially sunk in the rock at the angle. When the builders of
the Temple came to work here, they found upon the rock an accumulation
of 8 or 10 feet of fat mould, abounding in potsherds. This they cut
through in order to lay their foundation stones on the solid rock. In
the red earth were found fragments of pottery and fat-lamps, which
probably are of the earliest type of lamp used in Jerusalem. Resting
on the red earth was a layer of broken pottery, and in this was found
a rusty nail, some charred wood, and several jar handles. Some of
these last had well-defined figures impressed on them, resembling in
some degree a bird, but believed to represent a winged sun or disc,
possibly the emblem of the Sun god. On each handle, above and below the
wings, are some Phœnician letters, corresponding in one case to LMLK
ZPH, and in the other to LK SHT. At 3 feet east of the angle a hole
was discovered scooped out of the rock, and in it was found a little
earthen jar, standing upright as though it had been purposely placed
there.

  [Illustration:

      MASONS’ MARKS, S.-E. ANGLE.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

More interesting still, Warren discovered on some of the lower stones
near the south-east angle a number of marks in red paint, with two
or three characters also inscribed with the chisel. The late Emanuel
Deutsch declared them to be partly letters, partly numerals, and partly
special masons’ marks, exactly corresponding to some which he found
on the substructures of the harbour of Sidon, and the very oldest
ruins in the city of Tyre. As we know from the Bible that Solomon
employed Phœnician masons to build the Temple, this discovery was
thought at first to prove the Solomonic age of this part of the wall.
But further reflection warns us that it is not of itself sufficient;
the old alphabet might be but little changed in the days when Herod
rebuilt the Temple, and the forms of masons’ marks might be the same
with Phœnicians and with Romans. As, however, they appear to be quarry
signs, they seem to imply that the stones were shaped at the quarry,
and not upon the ground, and thus support the Scripture statement that
the Temple was erected without sound of axe or hammer. The same may
be said of the marginal drafts or bevels, which on some stones are
carried all round, on some round three sides, or only two, and exhibit
no pattern or design when we look at the wall as a whole. The quarry
whence the stones appear to have been brought is called the Cotton
Cavern; its entrance is outside the walls, east of Damascus Gate, and
it extends under the north-eastern part of the city for more than
a quarter of a mile. The cavern was not unknown in the time of the
Sultans, but it was afterwards lost sight of, until in the year 1852,
a dog scratching away the earth and stones, again uncovered the mouth
of it. In this quarry we go over ground covered with chips, we see some
blocks of stone in the rough, and others cut, and some only partially
severed from the rock. We see also the places where lamps rested to
give light to the workers. But in the fat mould at the angle of the
wall we do not find any stone chippings.

_In the Kedron Valley_ there is an accumulation of nearly 100 feet of
loose stone chippings and other _debris_, lying against the wall of the
Sanctuary, covering all the western side of the valley, and resting at
its eastern part upon the slope of Olivet. The true bed of the Kedron
is 40 feet west of its present surface bed. On the west side of the
true bed was found a masonry wall, 3 feet thick; and at intervals,
as the rock rises other walls are encountered, built apparently for
supporting terraces.

  [Illustration:

      EAST WALL OF NOBLE SANCTUARY.

      (_By permission of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

From the south-east angle the foundation of the wall rises, to about
the middle of the eastern side, and then falls again, down to the
Golden Gate and beyond. The construction of the Golden Gate is still a
vexed question; it is possibly a reconstruction of comparatively late
date, but it stands on the ancient foundations of a gateway, which
in some measure correspond with those of the Triple Gate. North of
the Golden Gate the rock still falls, and the depth of rubbish in the
depression is in the deepest part 125 feet. Yet the wall is built up
from the bottom, and is carried across the depression to the higher
rock surface north of it. It extends beyond the north-east angle of the
Haram without showing any break at that point; and this seems to favour
the idea that a break may be found more to the south, where the Haram
terminated before Herod enlarged its area. In fact the masonry north
of the Golden Gate is of a rougher sort than that south of it. But it
is impossible to examine the buried portion of the east wall at all
points, because a Mohammedan cemetery covers the ground, and excavation
among the graves is forbidden. It was only by sinking shafts at a
distance from the wall, and employing a method of laborious tunnelling,
that the depth of the foundations could be ascertained. Warren’s work
hereabout has been pronounced by Sir Charles Wilson to be without a
parallel in the history of excavation. “In one shaft alone no less than
600 feet run of shaft and gallery was excavated.”

If we might only explore freely within this cemetery Warren is
confident that we should come upon those huge stones--20 cubits long
and 6 cubits thick--which Solomon laid down on this side when he
built the temple (Josephus, Ant. xx. 9,7). One would suppose that the
present north-east angle, added by Herod, was of much later date than
the south-eastern; yet here again “Phœnician” masons’ marks are found.
Masons’ marks, however, may have a tendency to remain the same through
many ages. It is a curious fact that the red paint with which they were
put on has “run” in one instance, while still wet, and the trickling is
_upwards_ as the stone stands in the wall. This shows that the marking
was done before the stone was placed, and very likely at the quarry.

_North of the Haram enclosure._--The excavations just referred to were
sufficient to show that a deep valley once existed to the north of the
Temple, as described by Josephus, in “Antiquities” xiv. 4, 2 and “Wars”
i. 7, 3, where he states that Pompey found it a difficult business to
fill it up. This valley commences to the north of the city wall, passes
down west of the Church of St Anne, and runs into the Kedron, past
the Sanctuary wall, at a distance of 145 feet south of the north-east
angle. The great reservoir, called the _Birket Israil_, which extends
along the northern side of the Sanctuary for 360 feet, lies across this
valley. It is 126 feet wide and 80 feet deep. The west wall of the
reservoir is rock, and the east wall is partly rock and partly masonry;
while the south wall of the pool is at the same time the north wall of
the Sanctuary.

The excavations on all sides of the Sanctuary, and the examination
of the cisterns within the enclosure, show that Mount Moriah was
originally somewhat pear-shaped in contour, the rock shelving off on
all sides from the summit, which is now under the Dome of the Rock. At
the north-western corner, however, the rock was high, and there was a
narrow neck which joined this hill to Bezetha and made it a sort of
peninsula in form. This neck has been artificially cut through.

_The Tunnels from the Virgin’s Fountain._--From the Virgin’s Fountain,
about 320 yards south of the Triple Gate, and on the eastern side of
Ophel, a tunnel has been excavated through the hill to the Pool of
Siloam. The distance between these two places is not much more than 300
yards, but the tunnel winds about and its length is 1708 feet (or 569
yards). Robinson and others had been through it, and found it difficult
to traverse, for it is necessary to go part of the way crawling on
hands and feet. Colonel Warren, accompanied by Serjeant Birtles and
a fellah, patiently explored it, taking compass bearings at every
turn, and giving us at last an accurate plan of it. It was no easy
work crawling in three or four inches of water, recording observations
with pencil and paper, and carrying candles at the same time. Nor
was the business unattended with danger, for the flow of water being
intermittent, and an unexpected flow occurring while they were in the
tunnel, it proved very difficult to keep their mouths above water.

An inscription within this tunnel escaped the notice of all explorers
until lately, and was not detected even by Warren.

  [Illustration: PLAN OF THE SILOAM TUNNEL.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

The present Pool of Siloam measures about 55 feet, north and south by
18 feet east and west, and is about 20 feet deep. At the north end an
archway, 5 feet wide, appears, leading to a small vault, 12 feet long,
in which is a descent from the level of the top of the pool to the
level of the channel supplying it. In the year 1880 one of the pupils
of Herr Conrad Schick, the architect of the Church Missionary Society,
while climbing down fell into the water, and on rising to the surface
noticed the appearance of letters on the wall of the rock. The rock
had been smoothed so as to form a tablet about 27 inches square, which
contains six lines of writing on its lower portion. The inscription
is about 5 yards from the mouth of the channel, and is on the right
hand of an explorer entering from the Siloam end. It could hardly be
read at first, because a deposit of lime had formed over it. Dr Guthe
removed this by washing the tablet with a weak solution of hydrochloric
acid. Major Conder, with the aid of Lieutenant Mantell, expended
much labour and patience in taking a “squeeze,” sitting for three
or four hours cramped up in the water in order to obtain a perfect
copy, and repeating the experience in order to verify every letter.
Conder’s squeezes were the basis of the earliest correct representation
published in Europe. Professor Sayce, who had already visited the
tunnel and made a provisional translation of the text, was now enabled
to improve it; and the following is the translation:--

“1. (Behold the) excavation! Now this is the history of the excavation.
While the excavators were still lifting up

“2. The pick, each towards his neighbour, and while there were yet
three cubits to (excavate, there was heard) the voice of one man

“3. Calling to his neighbour, for there was an _excess_ (?) in the rock
on the right hand (and on the left?). And after that on the day

“4. Of excavating the excavators had struck pick against pick, one
against another,

“5. The waters flowed from the spring to the pool for a distance of
1200 cubits. And (part)

“6. Of a cubit was the height of the rock over the head of the
excavators.”[23]

The meeting of the two parties of excavators near the middle of the
tunnel accords with Warren’s discovery of two false cuttings, one on
either side, at a distance of 900 feet from the Siloam end.

The inscription is in ancient characters, very much resembling those on
the Moabite Stone, but possessing certain peculiarities. It is probably
the oldest bit of Hebrew writing on stone that we possess, and opens
out a new chapter in the history of the alphabet. It gives the first
monumental evidence of the condition of civilisation among the Hebrews
in the days of their kings; and altogether it is the most important
discovery of the kind since the finding of the Moabite Stone.

Major Conder says that the general impression resulting from an
examination of the conduit is that it was the work of a people whose
knowledge of engineering was rudimentary. It is well known that in
mining it is very difficult to induce the excavator to keep in a truly
straight line, the tendency being to diverge very rapidly to one side.
It is possible that this is the real reason of the crooked run of the
canal; but another reason may have been the comparative hardness of
the strata met in mining at a uniform level through a hill, with beds
having a considerable dip. It will, however, be observed, that, after
passing the shaft, the direction of the tunnel changes to a line more
truly directed on the Virgin’s Fountain. The excavators from the Siloam
end became aware, probably by the impossibility of seeing a light at
the head of the mine, when standing at the mouth of the tunnel, that
they were not going straight, and the only means they had of correcting
the error consisted in making a shaft up to the surface to see where
they had got to. After ascertaining this they went straight for about
140 feet, and then diverged gradually to the left; but their general
direction, nevertheless, agrees roughly with that of the rock contour,
which may be due to following a particular seam of rock.

  [Illustration:

      SHAFTS DISCOVERED AT THE VIRGIN’S FOUNTAIN.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

It is recognised by Colonel Warren that the tunnel running southward
to the Pool of Siloam was not the first tunnel excavated in connection
with the Virgin’s Fountain. A channel had previously been made from the
Virgin’s Fountain due west, for a distance of 67 feet, into the heart
of the hill, and there communicated by a shaft and corridors with the
surface. When the longer tunnel came to be made the engineers wisely
availed themselves of the channel already existing, and began their
new excavation at a distance of 50 feet from the Virgin’s Fount. The
priority of the channel running due west to the shaft appears to be
undoubted; and it is clear that whatever mistakes of direction might be
made by unscientific engineers when they had got some distance into the
hill, they never would _begin_ by working due west from the Virgin’s
Fount when their object was to make a channel south-south-west to
Siloam Pool.

At the bottom of the shaft, which is 67 feet due west, Warren found the
rock scooped out into a basin 3 feet deep, for the water to lie in, and
at the top of the shaft an iron ring to which the rope of the bucket
could be tied. The shaft was 40 feet in height, and then the space
began to open out westward into a great cavern, there being a sloping
ascent at an angle of 45°, covered with loose stones of about a foot
cube. Warren says it was ticklish work ascending, for the stones all
seemed longing to be off, and one starting would have sent the mass
rolling, himself with it, on top of the serjeant, all to form a mash
at the bottom of the shaft. After ascending about 30 feet they got on
to a landing. The cave now opened out to south-west and north-west.
Following it in the latter direction they arrived at a passage 40
feet long, at the far end of which was a rough wall. Creeping through
a hole in this they ascended a steep staircase for 50 feet, passed
another wall, and found themselves in a vaulted chamber. The exit at
last was on the Hill of Ophel, a few feet from the ridge, and almost
certainly, some writers maintain, within the ancient walls. The object
of the cuttings was to get a supply of water from within; and perhaps
the piles of loose stones which were found in the long passage were
intended to be thrown down the shaft if an enemy should attempt to
ascend it. In the passage were found three glass lamps of curious
construction, placed at intervals as if to light the way; and in the
vaulted chamber a little pile of charcoal as if for cooking, one of
these lamps, a cooking dish glazed inside, for heating food, and a jar
for water. Evidently the place had been used as a refuge.

A similar arrangement for closing the entrance to a spring, and using
a secret passage from the hill above, has lately been discovered at
_El Jib_ (ancient Gibeon),[24] and only a few years ago at ’_Amman_
(Rabbath Ammon). In connection with the latter, Conder quotes Polybius
to the effect that when Antiochus the Great besieged the forces of
Ptolemy Philopater, at _Amman_, in 218 B.C., the garrison
held out until a prisoner revealed a secret communication with a water
supply outside the walls.

_Difficulties of the Work._--It is impossible to read the detailed
accounts of Warren’s work at Jerusalem without feeling an admiration
for the courage and patience of the explorers, and without being
sometimes amused at the ludicrous predicaments into which they
occasionally got. They have been jammed in aqueducts, wedged in chasms,
and walled up behind falling heaps of _debris_. They have had to go
down ladders too short for reascending, to squeeze down apertures that
have taken the skin off the shoulders, and have been half drowned in
cisterns at the bottom. In the Tyropœon the soil is so soaked with
sewage that it poisons the flesh wherever it touches a scratch. In the
Kedron Valley the soil is so loose that it rushes into the galleries,
almost flowing like a fluid, and drives the men out. In the Siloam
tunnel they more than once ran the risk of being drowned. In the Ophel
shaft a loose stone, weighing eight cwt., threatened momentarily to
fall upon their heads. Once when the Arab labourers had gone down a
shaft, where the ancient bed of the Tyropœon runs out, 90 feet from
the south-west angle, they had descended 79 feet when they came upon
a stone slab. They began breaking it up with a hammer, when presently
the pieces fell in, the hammer disappeared, and the men, in terror lest
they should fall into unknown depths, rushed to the surface, sought out
the serjeant, and assured him that they had found the bottomless pit!
The awful depth proved to be just 6 feet more to the solid rock!

Warren had often to dig in people’s gardens, or to mine under their
houses, or sink shafts near to their sacred places, and it required
much tact to deal with the prejudices of the Mohammedans, and to
satisfy all claims for compensation. In the neighbourhood of Jerusalem
a piece of garden ground may belong to one man, be rented by another,
while a dozen people claim an interest in the crops that grow upon
it. Sometimes Warren’s labourers have been dragged before the judges
and threatened with imprisonment, or told that they shall be sent to
do forced labour on the Jaffa Road. When Warren was working at the
Virgin’s Fountain there was much commotion among the people of Siloam.
Work was to be resumed in the morning; but one cantankerous sheikh,
taking it into his head that Englishmen had no business out of their
own country, effectually stayed proceedings by sending a bevy of
damsels to the Fount to wash. On one occasion a Turkish officer of
Engineers, dressed in full uniform, approached, in no friendly spirit,
to examine one of the shafts. If he had chosen to give an adverse
report the work would have been stopped. He knew that Warren was in
command, but he marched magnificently past him without deigning to
notice him, and was going straight for the head of the shaft. But
Warren passed on rapidly before him, threw over the ladder which some
lady visitors had been using, blew out the light, and descended by a
rope. The Turk, hearing a crash, and seeing Warren disappear in the
darkness, was afraid that something terrible had occurred, which he did
not wish to be responsible for, and lost no time in turning his steps
away. But, after all, when we consider that the Sanctuary at Jerusalem
is as sacred to the Mohammedans as the precincts of Westminster Abbey
to ourselves, it is marvellous how much Sir Charles Warren succeeded in
effecting, and with how little friction he did it.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Quarterly Statements of P. E.
   Fund.” “Recovery of Jerusalem.” Sir C. Warren. “Tent Work in
   Palestine.” Major Conder.]


                       4. _Jerusalem as it was._

_The Hills and Valleys._--Sir Charles Warren was the first to point
out the necessity of ascertaining the depth of the rock below the
present surface, in as many places as possible, and of referring all
the measurements to one fixed datum, the level of the sea. In the study
of the ancient topography the original appearance of the ground is the
first consideration, for although a certain amount of soil may always
have existed, still the ancient surface must have conformed far more
closely to that of the rock than does the present.

To this work very great attention has been given, first by Warren
himself, in his exploration of numerous tanks and sinking of scores
of shafts; next by Herr Schick, who, in his professional capacity of
architect, has measured the position when sinking foundations for
houses in every quarter of Jerusalem. Contours had also been given
in the Ordnance Survey conducted by Sir C. Wilson in 1864. At length
Conder was able to take all the data and send home a plan of rock
levels for the entire city. From this he also prepared a reduced
shaded sketch of the original rock site of the town. The sketch
is here reproduced, and by the help of it the reader will find it
comparatively easy to understand Josephus’s description, as well as
the reconstruction of the ancient city which will be attempted in this
section.

Josephus says--“The city of Jerusalem was fortified with three walls,
on such parts as were not encompassed with unpassable valleys, for in
such places it had but one wall. The city was built upon two hills,
which are opposite to one another, and have a valley to divide them
asunder, at which valley the corresponding rows of houses on both
hills end. Of these hills that which contains the Upper City is much
higher and in length more direct. Accordingly it was called the Citadel
(φρούριον) by King David, but it is by us called the Upper
Market Place. But the other hill, which was called Akra, and sustains
the Lower City, is curved on both sides (ἀμφίκυρτος).[25]
Over against this was a third hill, but naturally lower than Akra, and
parted formerly from the other by a broad valley. However, in those
times when the Maccabees reigned, they filled up that valley with
earth, and had a mind to join the city to the temple. They then took
off part of the height of Akra, and reduced it to be of less elevation
than it was before, that the temple might be superior to it. Now the
Tyropœon Valley, as it was called, and was that which we told you
before distinguished the hill of the Upper City from that of the Lower,
extended as far as Siloam.” (Wars, v. 4, 1.)

  [Illustration:

      ROCK SITE OF JERUSALEM.

      (_By favour of the Palestine Exploration Fund._)]

In the next section Josephus tells us that as the city grew more
populous it crept beyond its old limits, “and those parts of it that
stood northward of the temple and joined that hill to the city, made it
considerably larger, and occasioned that hill, which is in number the
fourth, and is called _Bezetha_ (or New City), to be inhabited also.
It lies over against the Tower of Antonia, but is divided from it by a
deep valley, which was dug on purpose, and that in order to hinder the
foundations of the Tower of Antonia from joining to this hill.”

When we read these descriptions in the light of our plan, things become
tolerably plain. The south-western hill was the Upper City--a large
flat-topped hill surrounded with deep valleys, and having a level of
about 2550 to 2500 feet above the sea. The eastern hill is known to
be the Temple Hill, which is number three in Josephus’s description.
Bezetha (number four) is distinctly described as the hill north of the
Temple Hill, and only divided from it at one point by an artificial
cutting. The explorers have found this cutting, carried through a
narrow neck of high ground, at the north-western corner of the Haram.
Thus there is no room to question that “the second hill, which was
called Akra and sustained the Lower City” is the hill projecting down
from the north-west like a promontory, gibbous in its form. The Upper
City was divided from Akra “by a broad valley,” now partly filled up,
which was called the Tyropœon Valley, and beginning near the Jaffa
Gate, “extended as far as Siloam Fountain.” The summit of Akra is not
more than 2480 feet above sea level--considerably lower than the Upper
City--and looks lower than it is, because the whole site of Jerusalem
is tilted up from the west like an inclined plane, and because the
valleys about the Upper City are deeper. Josephus says the Akra hill
used to be higher, and sustained the Macedonian fortress called the
Akra, which dominated the Temple. Being so near and so high, it
enabled the garrison to look down into the Temple courts. They used
also to run out and molest the Jews who were passing from the Upper
City into the Temple by the western gate (Joseph. Ant. xii. 9, 3; 1
Macc. i. 36; and Warren in “Transactions of the Society of Biblical
Archæology,” vii. 314).

The Macedonian fortress was a thorn in the side of Jerusalem until
Simon Maccabæus captured it and demolished it. At the same time he cut
down the top of the hill itself; and perhaps it was with the material
so obtained that he filled up the valley between Akra and the Temple.
By the filling up of this valley, which it is convenient to call the
Asmonean Valley, the two hills were joined together; and it would not
be surprising if the terms “Akra” and “Lower City” soon after began to
have an extended meaning, and to embrace all the buildings on both the
hills which were now united into one.

Having now a definite conception of the original lie of the ground,
and knowing the four hills of Jerusalem by name and location, we can
proceed to plant a few of the ancient buildings in their proper places.

_The Temple of Solomon._--We have already seen reason for placing the
Temple over the very summit of Moriah; but we must now make our reasons
quite conclusive, and also show the limits of the Temple courts.

In the first place the summit of the mountain is the natural position
for the Temple, rather than any position on the slope. The rock called
the Sakhrah and the Foundation-stone of the World has been sacred
from time immemorial. It seems to be referred to in Isaiah xxviii.
16--“Behold, I lay in Zion for a foundation a stone, a tried stone,
a precious corner (stone), of sure foundation.” Ezekiel also, with
Josephus and the Talmud, all agree in placing the temple on the summit
of the mountain (Ezek. xliii. 12).

As remarked by Dr Chaplin,[26] the question whether the “stone of
foundation” was a portion of the solid rock or a movable stone is one
of considerable interest in connection with the topography of the
Temple. If the former, it will be easy to fix with all but absolute
certainty its position, and from it as a starting-point, to lay down
the sites of the temple, altar, and courts with no more uncertainty
than the uncertain value of the cubit renders inevitable. The use
of the word _Eben_ would imply that it was a movable stone, but its
(supposed) history, as given by the Rabbis, quite removes it from the
category of ordinary stones, and represents it as the centre or nucleus
from which the world was founded. The _Toldoth Yesu_ represents it as a
movable stone, and states that King David, when digging the foundation
of the temple, found it “over the mouth of the abyss” with THE
NAME engraved upon it, and that he brought it up and placed it in
the Holy of Holies. “On the whole” (says Dr Chaplin) “it is difficult
to come to any other conclusion than that the stone which the Rabbis
write about was a portion of rock projecting three finger-breadths
upwards from the floor of the Holy of Holies, covering a cavity which
was regarded as the mouth of the abyss, reverenced as the centre and
foundation of the world, and having the ineffable name of God inscribed
upon it.”

The statements made in the Talmud and repeated over and over again
with great accuracy by Rabbinic writers, supply us with the following
precise information: (1) The stone of foundation (in other words, the
solid rock) was the highest point within the Holy of Holies, projecting
slightly above the floor, and from it the rock sloped downwards on
all sides. (2) A “solid and closed foundation,” 6 cubits high, was
made all round the house in order to raise the floor to (within
three finger-breadths of) its summit. On the eastern side this solid
foundation was covered by steps leading down to the court, 22 cubits
below the summit on that side. We must agree with Dr Chaplin that the
summit of the Sakhrah under the great Dome of the Rock is the only spot
in the whole enclosure which answers to these data.

The Holy House, with its courts, was not in the centre of the
enclosure, but had a position north-west of the centre. The altar
court was at a lower level than the Holy House; and lower still, by
successive descents, were the court of Israel, the court of the women,
and the court of the Gentiles. The courts being in terraces one above
another, and the Holy House at the summit, the temple was a far more
conspicuous object than is the Dome of the Rock at the present day.

The Talmud describes the Temple area as 500 cubits square. The prophet
Ezekiel says “it had a wall round about, the length five hundred and
the breadth five hundred, to make a separation between that which
was holy and that which was common” (xlii. 20). Then we are told by
Maimonides, the learned Jewish writer, that “the men who built the
second temple, when they built it in the days of Ezra, they built it
like Solomon’s, and in some things according to the explanation in
Ezekiel.”

Taking then the centre of the Sakhrah as the centre of the Holy of
Holies, and allowing ourselves to be guided by the Talmud measurements,
which are given with great exactitude, we shall not be far wrong if we
draw the boundaries as follows:--On the north, the northern limit of
the present platform, the line of which if continued eastward would
cut the east wall of the Haram a little north of the Golden Gate.
The platform is raised 12 feet above the present general surface of
the Haram enclosure. One day when the rain had loosened a stone near
the north-eastern corner of the platform and revealed the existence
of vaults, Warren went down and took measurements; and it appears
that the northern end of the platform consists of rock which has been
scarped away perpendicularly. On the south the boundary would come to
within a few feet of the entrance of El Aksa mosque, and would fall
short of the south wall of the Haram by 300 feet. On the east and west
the boundaries would fall a little way within the present walls of the
Haram. We may reasonably conclude that the present east and west walls
of the Haram either represent walls of the Temple enclosure, or else
were built a little without them, as retaining walls for gradually
accumulating _debris_.

When the Temple of Solomon was destroyed, with all the buildings that
surrounded it, the _debris_ would be piled up in the courts. Probably
it would never be thought worth while to remove it all from the lower
courts, but rather to cover it over and lay a neat pavement on the
surface. Spaces and corners where the rubbish was less gathered would
be filled in or built up to complete the levelling; and as the rubbish
increased, both within and without the walls, after successive sieges,
the walls themselves were further built up, to keep them of sufficient
height. It never was intended in the first instance, to build walls
up from the foundation and make them 150 feet high. By successive
changes, the result of calamities as much as the fruit of improvement,
the terraced mountain grew to be an elevated plateau, such as the
Haram enclosure is at the present day. Josephus says that when Herod
rebuilt the Temple he extended the area of the courts and made it twice
as large as it was before. With that, however, we need not concern
ourselves while we are seeking to restore the city of Old Testament
times.

_Solomon’s Palace_ we find reasons for placing south of Solomon’s
Temple, on the slope of the terraced mountain, with its south-eastern
angle coinciding with the present south-eastern corner of the Haram.
Those deep-buried stones with the Phœnician masons’ marks upon them
may be the very foundation stones of the palace. The palace was a
great work, and occupied thirteen years in building. It was necessary
to build up at this corner, but as soon as a level was reached that
permitted the work to be carried through from east to west, the
six-feet course was laid as the true base for the more splendid
superstructure. This six-feet course extends for 600 feet westward
from the south-east angle, and gives us the limit in that direction.
Northward we are limited by the courts of the temple to 300 feet. This,
then, is where Sir Charles Warren places Solomon’s palace, and these
are the dimensions he assigns to it. Mr James Fergusson had already
been led, from architectural reasons, to consider it an oblong of 550
feet by 300. The level of the six-feet course is 60 feet below the
summit of the mountain. A patient examination of the wall led Warren
to the conclusion that all below this great course is old work, and
that the walls of the Haram generally correspond to the description of
Josephus, in whose day the great wall of Solomon still existed.

The Temple and the palace being thus located, there is left, beyond
the west end of the palace, a plot of ground, 300 feet square, not
enclosed at the time we are speaking of, although at the present day
it forms the south-western corner of the Sanctuary and has the mosque
El Aksa covering it. But the great depression of the Tyropœon Valley
falls just there, and it would not be raised and enclosed until a late
day. Warren says, in the “Recovery of Jerusalem”: “Our researches show
that the portion of the wall to the west of the Double Gate is of a
different construction to, and more recent than that to the east. This
is a matter of very great importance, and, combined with other results,
appears to show the impossibility of the Temple having existed at the
south-west angle, as restored by Mr Fergusson and others. The only
solution of the question I can see, is by supposing the portion to the
east of the Double Gate to have formed the south wall of Solomon’s
palace, and that to the west to have been added by Herod when he
enlarged the courts of the Temple.”

Before this addition was made the south wall was but 600 feet in
length. The Triple Gate stood in the middle of it, and as we have seen,
it is exactly on the ridge of the hill. The sill is 38 feet below the
present level of the Sanctuary, and from the gate three avenues ascend
gently to the Sanctuary floor. May they not represent “the way by which
Solomon went up to the House of the Lord”?

_The Wall of Ophel_, as already described, has been discovered by
Warren, and abuts against the south-eastern angle of what we are now
prepared to regard as Solomon’s palace.

_The Tower of Antonia._--Josephus tells us that the tower which
Herod built and named in honour of Antony stood on a rock 50 cubits
high, at the north-west corner of the Temple. The rock was separated
from Bezetha by a cutting made on purpose, yet the tower was so near
to Bezetha that it adjoined the New City. At the same time it was
so near to the Temple that the south-eastern turret overlooked the
Temple courts, while passages from the tower led to the west and north
cloisters. This description is precise enough. As Conder says, there is
just such a rock fortress in the north-west part of the Haram. It is a
great scarp, with vertical faces on the south and north, standing up
40 feet above the interior court, and separated from the north-eastern
hill of Jerusalem by a ditch 50 yards broad, in which are now the Twin
Pools--the Bethesda of St. Jerome. This block of rock is “the top of
the hill” spoken of by Josephus, and occupies a length of 100 yards
along the course of the north wall of the Haram. No other such scarp
exists in or near the enclosure of the High Sanctuary. Can we then
hesitate to place Antonia here?

Herod, after all, only repaired and strengthened this tower, for it had
been built by Hyrcanus and passed under the name of Baris before being
renamed Antonia, and even Hyrcanus was not the first at this work (page
265).

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Quarterly Statements of P. E.
   Fund.” “The Recovery of Jerusalem.” Sir C. Warren. “The Works
   of Josephus.”]


                 5. _The Walls and Gates of the City._

“Even stone walls,” says Mr Lewin, “cannot fail to awaken some degree
of interest, when it is remembered that upon the result of the inquiry
depends the question, Where was Calvary? and where the Holy Sepulchre?”
If we desire to understand Old Testament events as well as those of the
Gospels we shall take some interest in the question of the correct line
of the walls. The walls were perambulated by Nehemiah’s two companies
on the Thanksgiving Day; certain of the gates are mentioned by name
in connection with events of the history; and our reading of the
narrative will gain in vividness if we can follow the events like those
acquainted with the ground.

_The First Wall, or Wall of the Upper City._--Josephus says there were
three walls; but as the third or most northerly was not built until
A.D. 43, we will leave it out of account for the present. We
shall endeavour to fix the lines of the walls and the positions of the
gates as they were in Nehemiah’s time, and then we shall have those of
still earlier date, for Nehemiah only repaired walls and gates which
had been thrown down, and did not build afresh.

Beginning at the remarkable neck of land near the present Jaffa Gate a
wall ran eastward along the northern brow of the hill, and in the line
of the Causeway, and ended at the west cloister of the Temple. This
was the north wall of the Upper City. That city had a wall all round
it; and on the west, south, and east the wall simply followed the brow
of the hill. From the Jaffa Gate it ran southward (facing westward)
along the brink of the Valley of Hinnom, by Bethso (the Hebrew term
for Dung place) to the Gate of the Essenes. At the south-west corner
of the hill an escarpment of the rock was noticed by Robinson; was
further traced by Mr Maudslay, who in 1872 found there a tower, reached
by rock-cut steps; and is clearly marked in Conder’s plan. From this
corner the wall faced the south for a while, and then, according to
Josephus, made a bend above Siloam; and this must have been, as Mr
Lewin points out, a bend up the Tyropœon Valley, along the edge of the
High Town (to the Causeway), and then back again along the edge of the
Low Town on Ophel (until it joined the Wall of Ophel discovered by
Warren). The wall from Siloam, we learn from Josephus, bending there,
faced to the east at Solomon’s Pool, and holding on as far as the
place called Ophla, joined the eastern cloister of the Temple.[27] The
eastern cloister of the Temple--_i.e._, the south-eastern angle of the
enclosure--was, in Josephus’s day, coincident with the south-east angle
of Solomon’s palace of earlier time; and the city wall which joined it
was the Wall of Ophel itself.

According to this description Solomon’s Pool was in the Tyropœon
Valley, between the two walls of the High Town and the Low Town.
Probably at a very early period many houses were built in this valley,
and it became an intramural suburb. In view of war it would be deemed
necessary to protect it; and for its defence the most obvious plan
would be to build a dam or a wall athwart the valley. Such a work would
greatly strengthen the city itself, by preventing all access up the
valley, especially if the mound or wall was aided by a castle at the
Ophel end of it. We shall see reason to believe that the dam and the
castle were built and were called Millo and the House of Millo. The
suburb thus became immured in the city, but continued to be called the
Suburb; and we read that the west wall of the Temple enclosure had
two gates leading to the Suburb (Josephus, “Antiquities” xv. 11, 5; 1
Chron. xxvi. 16, the gate Shallecheth).

The course of the first wall as thus described by Josephus does not
appear to differ much from its course in Nehemiah’s time; and in all
essentials it seems to be the wall of David’s day, preserved upon
the old foundations. Josephus indeed states as much in the following
passage:--“Now of these three walls, the old one was hard to be taken,
both by reason of the valleys and of that hill on which it was built,
and which was above them. But besides that great advantage as to the
place where they were situated, it was also built very strong; because
David and Solomon and the following kings were very zealous about this
work.”

  [Illustration: SCHICK’S LINE OF SECOND WALL.]

_The Second Wall._--The description of the second wall, given by
Josephus, is short, and may be quoted entire: “It took its beginning
from that gate which they called Gennath, which belonged to the first
wall; it only encompassed the northern quarter of the city, and reached
as far as the tower Antonia.”

The necessity for this wall arose as follows. Through the increase of
the population a suburb had sprung up, not only in the upper reach of
the Tyropœon Valley, but on the hill beyond it. On the spur of this
hill, which projected toward the Temple, stood the Akra fortress,
but north-west of the fortress the ground was high and open, and
unprotected by any deep valley. To protect this suburb it was necessary
to carry a wall across the saddleback, sweeping round from the corner
of the High Town to the north-west corner of the eastern hill; and
this was probably done as early as David’s day.

There is not now much difficulty in finding approximately the position
of the gate Gennath, the starting point of this wall. We observe on
Conder’s plan of the rock site that a narrow ridge runs north and
south, immediately east of the Tower of David, and separates as a
shed the broad head of the Tyropœon from the western valley. The
Tyropœon deepens very suddenly, and any wall carried across it would
of necessity be commanded by the ridge to the west of it. The only
sensible course for the builders was to carry the wall along the ridge
itself, on ground commanding all without it. Exactly along this ridge,
at its western side, a wall was discovered in the year 1885, during the
rebuilding of the Greek Bazaar. At a depth 15 feet below the present
street Dr Merrill found two layers of stone, and at some points three,
still in position; and the stones were of the same size and character
as the largest of the stones in the Tower of David opposite. Broken
Roman pottery was found in these excavations, and a stone ball, such
as the Romans used in warfare. The discovery of these foundations
enables us to lay down the second wall for a distance of 40 or 50
yards, with accuracy.[28] Thus we know where the wall began, and where
it ended. Its intermediate course can only be ascertained by arguments
of probability, and by mapping every bit of ancient wall uncovered in
connection with building operations and the making of drains. Upon the
true course of this wall depends the answer to the question whether
the site of the Church of the Holy Sepulchre was without the city or
within. We are contented here to adopt the line of wall arrived at by
Herr Conrad Schick, who has studied the question on the ground, who
is acquainted with every bit of ancient wall that has come to light,
and has a reason for every twist and turn and every gate and tower
here represented. It will be seen by his plan that he does not stop at
the Tower of Antonia, but continues his line of wall so as to defend
the northern and eastern sides of the Temple. This is required by
Nehemiah’s descriptions. But when Herod enlarged the Temple courts, if
not before, these portions of the wall would be interfered with--the
northern portion would be removed, the eastern portion had perhaps
become buried--and so Josephus is silent about them.

With the course of the walls thus definitely marked out, it becomes
possible to follow the descriptions in the Book of Nehemiah, and to
identify the towers and gates and places there mentioned.

_Nehemiah’s Night Ride to Survey the Ruins._--Jerusalem had been
destroyed by Nebuchadnezzar’s general, and although the Chaldeans
entered by a breach on the north side, they afterwards burnt the palace
and every great house, and brake down the walls of Jerusalem round
about (2 Kings xxv. 4). Nehemiah returned from the captivity to rebuild
the city of his fathers, and prudently decided to make first a quiet
survey of the extent of the destruction.

In chapter ii. 13, we read, “I went out by night by the Valley Gate,
even towards the dragon’s well, and to the Dung Gate.” This Valley
Gate was at or near the Gennath Gate, at the head of the Tyropœon
Valley, and at the same time close to the Valley of Hinnom. It could
not be far from the present Jaffa Gate. The Dung Gate--Josephus’s
“Bethso”--comes between the Jaffa Gate and the south-west corner of the
city; a position also required by chap. iii. 13. “Then I went on to
the Fountain Gate and to the King’s Pool.” The Fountain Gate would be
a convenient exit from the city to a path leading down to Siloam Pool;
The King’s Pool (_el-Berekath_) was probably Solomon’s Pool, mentioned
by Josephus as being by the east face of the old wall. In after
times it would be called in Scripture the King’s Pool, because it was
appropriated and used by Solomon’s successors, just as Solomon’s Palace
is called the king’s house in Neh. iii. 25. This pool would be within
the protected suburb. Nehemiah continues, “But there was no place for
the beast that was under me to pass.” Why? Because here we have two
walls in a narrow space, and the destruction of both of them had filled
the valley with _debris_. “Then I went up by the brook (_nachal_, the
Kedron) and viewed the wall: and I turned back and entered by the
Valley Gate, and so returned.”

_The Rebuilding of the Walls and Gates._--Nehemiah decides that the
walls can be and shall be rebuilt; and he parcels out the work among
forty-six of the principal people, who each have their retainers.
The work is sacred, and is appropriately begun by the high priest,
who naturally selects a spot near the Temple--the Sheep Gate of the
city wall, which would seem to have been about midway between the
north-eastern and north-western corners of the temple area of that
time. The description of the repairs takes us westward, or to the
left, and carries us all round the city to the same point again. “Then
Eliashib the high priest rose up with his brethren the priests, and
they builded the Sheep Gate; they sanctified it, and set up the doors
of it; even unto the tower of Hammeah[29] they sanctified it, unto the
tower of Hananel.” These two towers, we may suppose, with Mr Lewin and
Herr Schick, already occupied the site of the future Antonia. In fact
they were parts of the Baris or Castle where Nehemiah himself intends
to reside (Neh. ii. 8, where the Hebrew word is the _Birah_).

After these towers of the Baris the various gates and places come
before us in the following order:--

The Fish Gate, placed in Herr Schick’s plan where the first main line
of street ran out into the country.

The Old Gate, where the next main line of street ran out. It is where
these two roads cross one another that we get, at a later period, the
Damascus Gate set up. Streets running direct towards a city wall seem
to demand a gate in that wall to complete their usefulness.

Next we have the Throne of the Governor-beyond-the-River. This, like
the preceding, is some structure occurring in the course of the wall.
In chap. ii. 7, 9, the phrase “beyond the river” seems to mean westward
of the Jordan, where the district was governed by a viceroy of the
king of Assyria. The viceroy lived or had lived in Jerusalem,[30] and
his castle appears to have come into the line of the second wall, in
the part which is south-east of the Church of the Holy Sepulchre, and
perhaps exactly at the re-entering angle.

The Broad Wall, which is named next, was not necessarily broad in
itself. Open spaces, such as we should name Squares, were in Jerusalem
called Broads. There was one such broad space south of the Temple water
gate, on Ophel, in which the people sometimes assembled (Neh. viii.
1; Ezra x. 9). There seems to have been another near one of the city
gates, where Hezekiah addressed the people, alarmed at the approach of
Sennacherib (2 Chron. xxxii. 6). Sennacherib would approach the city
on the north-west, and the people were very likely gathered by the
Valley Gate discussing the matter, in an open space afterwards utilised
by the construction of the “Pool of Hezekiah.” The “Broad” wall might
be so called from running along one side of this broad space. It
perhaps started from the second wall at the point which Nehemiah’s
description has now reached, and extended southward to the wall of the
high town, and so constituted an inner line of defence. Nothing is said
of repairing it: perhaps it had not been thrown down; or, as an inner
wall, Nehemiah neglects it for the present, as he does also the north
wall of the Upper City. At any rate the description carries us beyond
it. At the north-west angle of the second wall there was a Corner Gate
(2 Kings xiv. 13; 2 Chron. xxv. 23), which is called also the Gate that
Looketh. A gate here would command a view of the city walls as far as
the Fish Gate on the one hand and the Valley Gate on the other. But
this gate also is passed over in the present description.

We have next the Tower of the Furnaces, probably west of the “Pool of
Hezekiah.” The word may mean hearths furnaces, ovens, or altars; but we
cannot say to what it related.

And then we come to the Valley Gate, which we have already seen must
have been near the present Jaffa Gate, and probably was exactly where
the present David Street passes the end of the wall discovered, by the
Greek Bazaar, in 1885. Unless a gate existed there, the street would
lose half its use. Yet there is Herr Schick’s alternative, that the
name was given to a gate south-west of the Citadel, and opening on to
the Valley of Hinnom.

In verse 13, from the Valley Gate it is “1000 cubits on the wall to the
Dung Gate.” This forbids any identification with the present dung gate,
in the Tyropœon, and fixes within a little the position of _Bethso_.

In verse 15, Shallun, who repairs the Fountain Gate, repairs also “the
wall of the Pool of Shelah by the king’s garden.” Allow that Shelah is
Siloam, yet this need not be a wall running down to Siloam--if we were
to take that line we should go wrong all the rest of the way--it is
the transverse wall in the same valley above. Through a gate in this
wall the Pool of Siloam would be conveniently reached from the Suburb;
and this would be the “Gate between two walls,” through which Zedekiah
fled away (2 Kings, xxv. 4; Jer. xxxix. 4; lii. 7). The wall was by
the king’s garden (_le_ = by or near). Shallun pursues his work along
the transverse wall eastward “unto (_ad_) the Stairs (_maaloth_) that
go down from the City of David.” So the City of David includes Ophel,
and the Stairs descend the Ophel slope westward into the bed of the
Tyropœon.

  [Illustration: NEHEMIAH’S SOUTH WALL, ACCORDING TO GEORGE ST CLAIR.

  ⁂ The contour lines represent successive steps of ten feet. The
      height at the Triple Gate is 2379 feet.

                              REFERENCE.

      Suggested line of wall -- -- --
         1 Valley gate.
         2 Dung gate.
         3 Fountain gate.
         4 King’s pool.
         5 Wall of Pool of Shelah.
         6 King’s Gardens.
         7 Stairs of the City of David.
         8 Sepulchres of David.
         9 The Pool that was made.
        10 House of the mighty.
        11 Turning of the wall.
        12 The Armoury.
        13 Turning of the wall.
        14 House of Eliashib.
        15 Turning of the wall.
        16 The Corner.
        17 Turning of the wall.
        18 Tower at King’s house. (Tower that standeth out.)
        19 Water gate.
        20 Tower that lieth out.
        21 Great Tower that lieth out.
        22 Wall of Ophel.
        23 Horse gate.
        24 Houses of priests.
        25 Gate Miphkad.
        26 Ascent of the corner.
        27 Going up of the wall.
        28 House of David.
        29 Gate between two walls.
        30 Gate of the Guard (2 Kings, xi. 19).
        31 Gate of the Guard (Neh. xii. 39).]

Verse 16, “After him repaired Nehemiah, the son of Azbuk, unto the
place over against (_neged_ = in front of) the sepulchres of David.”
The wall of the Pool of Shelah was an offshoot from the wall of the
High Town, so the writer returns and continues his description of
the wall of the High Town. Nehemiah, the son of Azbuk, takes up the
repairs at the Fountain Gate and works northward. He comes over against
the royal sepulchres, which are therefore on the Ophel side of the
Tyropœon, a little north of the Stairs. The entrance would have to be
low down in the valley bed to be outside the wall which protects Ophel
on the west; but there is no reason why it should not be low down. The
only doubt we need have is whether the spot marked in the plan is quite
far enough north. In either case the excavations for royal tombs were
so extensive as at length to approach the south wall of the Temple,
perhaps even to touch the wall (at a point now under the mosque El
Aksa). This is complained of by the prophet Ezekiel as a desecration.
“The house of Israel shall no more defile my holy name, neither they,
nor their kings, by their whoredom, and by the carcases of their kings
in their death; in their setting of their threshold by my threshold,
and their door-post beside my door-post, and there was but the wall
between me and them” (Ezek. xliii. 7, 8).

Nehemiah, the son of Azbuk, continues working northward “unto the
pool that was made” (_berekah_, probably the “king’s pool” of ii. 14,
and the “reservoir between two walls” of Isaiah xxii.). He goes on
“unto the house of the mighty men.” If this is the house of the king’s
bodyguard, the men of war mentioned in 2 Kings xxv. 4, we shall find
that they are conveniently placed about midway between the armoury and
the king’s house.

In the remaining short space on the west side of the Tyropœon we have
no less than four bands of workers, indicating that the destruction
had been very great, as indeed Nehemiah found it to be when there was
no possibility of his beast getting along; and the next indication of
locality is in

Verse 19, “the turning” of the wall, “over against the ascent to the
armoury.” The armoury, therefore, was in or near the north-eastern
angle of the suburb.

Verse 20. We are now carried from “the turning” of the wall by the
armoury, southward, “unto the door of the house of Eliashib, the high
priest;” and we are not surprised to find his house here, for we are
close alongside the Temple courts. The workers come _unto_ the door of
Eliashib’s house, which thus seems to project westward, so as to be
quite near to the line of wall; but they only come _over against_ the
less important houses which follow.

Verse 24. The sixth worker down this side comes to “the turning” of
the wall and “unto the corner.” The turning is not the same as the
corner; the Hebrew language uses different words for a re-entering and
a salient angle. Each of the two turnings at the causeway (vv. 19, 20)
is called a _miqtzoa_ (= a re-entering angle); but now, in v. 24, they
come to a _miqtzoa_ and to a _pinneh_ (= a projecting angle). It is to
be observed that we should not have such angles at this part but for
the vacant square which Warren’s examination of the masonry compelled
him to leave--the wall for 300 feet each way from the south-west
corner of the Haram being more recent than the rest.

The first salient angle is passed over because the worker who begins
north of it continues his labours till he comes south of it, and so its
mention is not necessary in defining the work done. (In like manner, in
vv. 6-8, the Gate of Ephraim is passed by without mention, although,
according to xii. 38, 39, it existed between the Broad Wall and the Old
Gate; and the Corner Gate, which we know existed, is passed over by
Nehemiah.)

Verse 25. The mention now of another re-entering angle might perplex
us, only that the same verse speaks of a “tower standing out from the
king’s upper house,” and this may easily afford the angle.

Verse 26. We are now fairly on the Hill of Ophel, and accordingly the
workers who have been set to labour here are “the Nethinim dwelling
in Ophel.” There is also mention in v. 31 of a house of the Nethinim
near the northern end of the east wall--still outside the Temple
precincts.[31]

As soon as the Nethinim of Ophel get far enough south to look beyond
the projecting tower and see the Triple Gate, they are stated to be
over against the Water Gate. Lewin says that “the Water Gate proper was
that of the inner Temple, to the south of the altar, and led down to
the great southern gate of the outer Temple, which was probably also
called the Water Gate.” The Nethinim find themselves at the same time
looking eastward, or their wall facing toward the sun-rising. They are
also over against the tower that standeth out. This is not the tower
mentioned in the previous verse as projecting from the king’s house,
but may perhaps be the one at the bend of the Ophel wall, discovered by
Warren.

Verse 27. Where the Nethinim cease their work it is taken up by the
Tekoites, who presently come “over against the great tower that
standeth out,” namely, the large tower which Warren found. This
identification struck Warren himself, and he mentions it in the
“Recovery of Jerusalem,” p. 295. It now wanted but a little extension
of the work to complete the junction with the Wall of Ophel, at the
point where Warren found that wall to end abruptly, and the narrative
tells us that the Tekoites effected the junction.

Verse 28. The Ophel Wall being in good repair, is no more referred
to; but the next thing mentioned is the Horse Gate. As Warren could
not find any gate in the Ophel Wall, the Horse Gate must have been
north of it; and here it would be at a point convenient for entrance
to Solomon’s Stables, which would be under the palace, and perhaps
under the present vaults known as Solomon’s Stables. There is a depth
of about 100 feet of unexplored rubbish between the floor of Solomon’s
Stables and the rock at the south-eastern angle. The true stables may
lie buried in this rubbish.

“Above the Horse Gate repaired the priests, every one over against
his own house.” These houses of priests are in a position exactly
corresponding with the house of Eliashib and others on the west side.
The expression “over against,” implies that the city wall which is
being repaired stands removed from the priests’ houses, which border
the Temple courts, and it would be eastward of the present Haram wall.
Herr Schick draws it so.

Verse 29. An East Gate is referred to (_Mizrach_), not to be confounded
with the Gate Harsith, the so-called East Gate of Jeremiah xix. 2 in
the Authorised Version. It may be the Shushan Gate, which, according to
the Talmud, stood over against the east front of the Temple.

When we come over against the Golden Gate--which Nehemiah calls the
Gate Miphkad--we are just where Warren’s tunnelling work was arrested
by a massive masonry barrier--probably a part of the ancient city
wall--50 feet east of the Haram wall. The wall was built of large
quarry-dressed stones, and was so thick that a hole made into it for
5 feet 6 inches did not go right through. A few feet north of the
Golden Gate the wall began bending north-west, as though following
the contour of the hill; and Warren was also led to suspect that the
wall is a high one, extending upward through the _debris_ to near the
surface, since immediately above it, in the road, there are some large
roughly-bevelled stones lying in the same line.[32]

In Nehemiah’s description we are now immediately at “the ascent of the
corner” (_pinneh_, a projecting angle). There is no corner now visible
at the surface immediately north of the Golden Gate, and no ascent from
a depth. But we have seen already that the northern cloister of the
Temple would strike the east wall of the Haram a little north of the
Golden Gate, and consequently here would be the _corner_ of the Temple
courts. We have also seen that the rock now shelves down to the north,
for the valley from Herod’s Gate came out here, and at 300 feet north
of Golden Gate the rubbish is 125 feet in depth, so that from this low
ground there would be an _ascent_ in turning west. The wall itself
would go up, ascending toward the ridge of the hill. There is no more
likely spot for the elbow of the wall than that marked by the little
building called the Throne of Solomon. The great depth of the valley
here gave fearful height to the corner tower; and eastern imagination
would be not unlikely to suggest that only Solomon or the demons could
have built it.

Having reached “the ascent of the corner,” one more band of workers
brings us to the Sheep Gate, where the description began.

_The Route of the Processionists._--Chapter xii. affords striking
confirmation of the foregoing positions. At the dedication of the
walls two companies start from the Valley Gate and go opposite ways to
meet in the Temple. Presumably the Valley Gate was chosen to afford
journeys of about equal length; and this is another indication that the
wall did not go down to Siloam. The party going south pass the Dung
Gate, and reach the Fountain Gate. And now which way will they go? The
wall has been repaired right ahead of them, and also the wall turning
north, and they will have to choose between two routes. The Revised
Version says they went “by (_ad_) the Fountain Gate and straight
before them,” and ascended _by_ the Stairs of the City of David at
the going up of the wall (not _by_ this time, nor really “at,” but
“_in_”--_ba-maaleth le-chomah_, _i.e._, _in_ the stairway of the wall
_by_ the Stairs of David--a different stairway from the Stairs of the
City of David, which descended into the valley bed).

Their way up these stairs and beyond carried them “above the house of
David, even unto the Water Gate.” The house of David here is close by
the king’s garden of iii. 15; and its position on the slope of the hill
suggests a reason for calling Solomon’s palace the king’s upper house
(or high house, iii. 25). Some say “the house of David” means David’s
tomb; but if that be so, it only confirms the position which I am led
to assign to the tomb. Observe also that the position required for the
Water Gate here is again that of the present Triple Gate, the same as
in iii. 26.

It deserves particular attention that the processionists pass quickly
from the Stairs of David to the Water Gate, whereas in the rebuilding,
these two places are very wide apart, because the bend of the wall
is followed. In iii. 15, we have the Sepulchres, the Pool, the House
of the Mighty, four more bands of workers, the turning of the wall,
the armoury, the house of Eliashib, the turning, the corner, and the
outstanding tower--all between the point over against the Stairs of
David and the Water Gate; but none of these things come in the route
of the processionists. This is easy to understand if the wall makes a
bay up the Tyropœon, for then the short cut in the text corresponds
with the short cut in the plan; but it can hardly be made intelligible
on any plan which omits this bay and carries the wall down to Siloam.

A superficial objection may be raised that the detour up the valley and
_viâ_ the causeway, avoided by the processionists, would be avoided
by Nehemiah in repairing the walls, for why should he do more than
repair the short transverse wall, when his object was speed? My reply
would be that his object was strength and safety as well as speed. The
transverse wall was no sufficient protection by itself, there being
an easy approach up the valley, but it was valuable as an addition to
the inner walls. Besides, Nehemiah had workers enough to be engaged at
all these parts at once, so that the completion of the work was not
at all delayed by repairing the two north-and-south walls of the bend
simultaneously with the cross wall, and indeed with the walls all round
the city.

The second company, with whom was Nehemiah, started from the Gate of
the Valley simultaneously with the first; and the earliest note of
their progress is that they pass the Tower of the Furnaces and reach
the Broad Wall. We now, of course, meet with the places in the reverse
order to that in which we made their acquaintance, in following the
builders from east to west. The order then was--

    Sheep-Gate.
    Tower of the Meah.
    Tower of Hananel.
    Fish Gate.
    Old Gate.
    Broad Wall.
    Tower of the Furnaces.

Passing these now, in reverse order, we find the Gate of Ephraim
noticed, between the Broad Wall and the Old Gate. I incline to place
the Gate of Ephraim at the junction of several streets near the
north-east corner of the Muristan, and I will give two reasons. (1)
Taking the wall as drawn by Schick, a principal street of the city
going west abuts upon the wall at that point and requires a gate.
(2) A Corner Gate existed, apparently at the north-western angle of
the second wall, west of the Broad Wall; the distance between the
Corner Gate and the Gate of Ephraim was 400 cubits (2 Kings xiv. 13;
2 Chron. xxv. 23); and the place now proposed for the Gate of Ephraim
corresponds to that distance. It may be that the tower of this gate was
the throne of the governor, the viceroy of the Assyrian king.

Nehemiah’s company having at length reached the Sheep Gate entered the
Temple courts and stood still in the Gate of the Guard.

Thus the two companies stood on the north and south sides of the altar,
and rendered thanksgiving to God, for that an unbroken wall once more
protected Jerusalem.

The line of wall being established, with the positions of David’s
house, the gate between two walls, &c., we are confirmed in our
conclusion that the City of David was the eastern hill and included
Ophel. We see whereabouts the royal sepulchres are likely to be found
by future excavation. We gain something immediately by being able to
follow step by step the work of Nehemiah. And this is not all, for we
obtain fresh light upon the history of the house of David at various
points.

      [_Authorities and Sources_:--The author himself is responsible
   for the views of Jerusalem topography set forth in this
   volume. The reader who wishes to consult other writers may
   find the following references useful:--“Jerusalem, a
   Sketch.” By Thomas Lewin. “Siege of Jerusalem.” Thomas Lewin.
   “Antient Jerusalem.” Joseph Francis Thrupp. “The Recovery of
   Jerusalem.” Sir Charles Warren. Trans. Soc. Bib. Archæol.,
   vol. vii. (“Site of the Temple.” By Sir C. Warren). “The Holy
   City.” Rev. George Williams. “The Holy Sepulchre and the
   Temple.” James Fergusson, F.R.S. “Murray’s Handbook of Syria
   and Palestine.” (Dr Porter). “Quarterly Statements of the
   P.E. Fund” (numerous papers).]


            6. _Incidents of the History better realised._

_The Taking of Jerusalem by David_:--The king and his men went to
Jerusalem against the Jebusites, who felt so secure in their stronghold
that they mocked David by putting the lame and the blind upon the
walls as defenders. Nevertheless, “David took the stronghold of Zion;
the same is the City of David ... and David dwelt in the stronghold
and called it the City of David” (2 Sam. v.). The stronghold here
spoken of is not that which is now called the tower of David, near the
Jaffa Gate, nor is the Zion here spoken of the south-western hill.
The parallel statement in Josephus is that David “took the Lower City
by force, but the Akra held out still.” Joab, however, scaled the
fortress, the Jebusites were cast out of the Akra, and then David
rebuilt Jerusalem, renamed it the City of David, and dwelt there
(Antiq. vii. 3. 1 & 2). It is not the High Town which is here spoken
of but the Akra; and in the place where Josephus gives a general
description of the city he tells us that Akra was the hill of the Lower
City, while the Upper City was called by King David the _Phrourion_,
that is, the _hill-fort_ or _watch-post_.

It would seem that in those early days the south-western hill was not
yet inhabited, or at any rate was not yet enclosed by a wall, although
a garrisoned watch-tower stood upon it. The highest hills are not
always deemed the best positions for a citadel or castle. It was not
so at Athens, and it is not so in Edinburgh. The Jebusite population
of Jerusalem was mostly clustered on the eastern hill. In 1879 Sir
Charles Warren said: “The strongest point, to my mind, in favour of
Ophel having been the ancient site of the Jebusite city is the fact
of the one spring of water being found there. I have carefully noted
the manner in which the Kaffirs have located themselves close to water
in their various strongholds, and I think that unless there were very
urgent reasons, the Jebusites would have located themselves near what
is now called the Virgin’s Fountain.”

But while the eastern hill was Zion,[33] the Akra was the stronghold
of its owners and defenders, their castle occupying an advantageous
promontory defended by valleys and ditches. A castle or fort so
situated, could not, however, stand a siege, unless it possessed a
secret supply of water; and Warren has spoken of the Virgin’s Fountain
as the only spring. But there is some mystery about the _Hammam esh
Shefa_, and many, including Warren himself, are inclined to believe
it may be connected with a spring. The water is stated to be clear
and free from the impurities of rain water, and the supply is never
exhausted. The position of this “well” is in the Tyropœon Valley, in
a line between Akra and the Dome of the Rock. The entrance to the
fountain is by a narrow opening, but the shaft soon expands to about
12 feet square. At the bottom is an excavated chamber on one side, and
a passage on the other. The passage expands into a vault, beyond which
the channel becomes crooked and irregular. It appears that an ancient
conduit enters the vault at the extremity of the horizontal passage,
but its direction and source are unknown. May not some conduit have
enabled the besieged garrison of the Akra fort to draw water from this
source?

A few years ago the Rev. F. W. Birch, arguing on the supposition that
it was the city on Ophel which Joab captured for David, suggested that
he found his way into it by the secret tunnels and shafts from the
Virgin’s Fountain. That Ophel might be captured by surprise in that
way seems likely; only it was not Ophel that Joab had to capture, but
Akra. The Lower City had all been taken, except that the Akra held out
still. If its garrison obtained water from the _Hammam esh Shefa_, may
not Joab have effected an entrance from _that_ spring? He did not have
to _get up to_ a “_gutter_,” nor yet to a “water course,” but to “reach
them by the aqueduct” (_B’Tzinnor_).

_David’s flight and exile; the Spies._--David at first dwelt in the
stronghold (the Akra fort), but we afterwards find references to a
house which he had and which was on the Ophel slope. We have had
evidence of this in the Book of Nehemiah, and we find confirmation in
such passages as 1 Kings viii. 1-6, where the ark is _brought up_ out
of the City of David into the temple (and 2 Sam. xxiv. 18; 1 Kings ix.
24). When David decided to flee from Jerusalem because of the rebellion
of Absalom, he would go down the stairs of the City of David, pass out
by the Gate between two walls, and go through his own garden grounds;
and then, as we are told, he passed over the Kedron, ascended Olivet,
and went down to Jericho and over the Jordan.

But he left friends behind him at his house, and it was arranged that
two sons of the priests should act as spies and bring him news (2 Sam.
xvii.). They waited outside the city, at En Rogel, and a wench went and
told them. En Rogel is now identified with the Virgin’s Fountain; and
it would not be a bad place for the spies to hide in, seeing that its
passages were dark, and communicated both with the hill and the valley.
The maid servant, descending the staircases from above, might take a
pitcher or a bucket to draw water, and so escape suspicion; the spies
below on receiving the message, could hie away over the mountain to the
Jericho road and Jordan.

The evidence that the Virgin’s Fountain is En Rogel will increase
upon us as we proceed; but one reason may be stated here. En Rogel is
etymologically the Spring of the Fuller, and was so called, no doubt,
because fullers washed clothes at the place; but it may also be made
to mean the Spring of the Steps, because fullers trode the clothes
with their feet, and hence got their name (from _Regel_, the _foot_,
and metaphorically a _step_). The Virgin’s Fountain is now called by
the Arabs, _Ain Umm ed Deraj_, “Fountain of the Mother of Steps,” a
designation commonly supposed to refer to the two flights of steps
which lead down to it, but which may be derived by tradition from “En
Rogel.” The steps were not always there. The explorers of Jerusalem
say, “The pool seems originally to have been visible in the face of a
cliff, and the vault and steps are modern. Possibly the original exit
of the water was down the Kedron Valley.”

_Adonijah’s Banquet at the Stone of Zoheleth._--After Absalom’s death
David returned to Jerusalem. But by-and-bye he grew old and infirm,
and then there were speculations and plots about the succession to the
throne. Adonijah thought to gain favour by assuming royal state and
showing princely generosity. He set up chariots and horsemen, and fifty
men to run before him; and he slew sheep and oxen and fatlings by the
stone of Zoheleth, which is beside En Rogel. Abiathar the priest was
at the banquet, and Joab the veteran general; all was going merrily,
and the guests shouted, “God save King Adonijah!” (1 Kings i.) But
news of these proceedings was carried to David at his house on Ophel.
Bathsheba came in and told him what was occurring, and reminded him of
his oath that Solomon her son should sit upon the throne. While the
queen was yet speaking, Nathan the prophet was announced, who confirmed
the story, and inquired anxiously who was to reign. Then David called
for Zadok and Nathan, the priests, and Benaiah, the soldier, chief of
the king’s bodyguard, to go with them as the representative of force,
and indeed to take his men, and said, “Cause Solomon my son to ride
upon mine own mule, and bring him down to Gihon (_i.e._, Siloam Pool),
anoint him there, and blow the trumpet, and say, God save King Solomon.
Then ye shall come up after him, and he shall come and sit upon my
throne; for he shall be king in my stead.” This was done, and all the
people said, “God save King Solomon!”

We shall realize these events better when we look at the position of
Zoheleth, the discovery of which was one of the happy results of M.
Clermont Ganneau’s investigations in 1870. Nearly in the centre of
the line along which stretches the village of Siloam there exists a
rocky plateau surrounded by Arab buildings, which mask its true form
and extent: the western face, cut perpendicularly, slightly overhangs
the valley. Steps rudely cut in the rock enable one to climb it, not
without difficulty, and so to penetrate directly from the valley to the
midst of the village. By this road, troublesome, and even dangerous,
pass habitually the women of Siloam, who come to fill their vessels
at the so-called Virgin’s Fountain. Now this passage and this ledge
of rock in which it is cut are called by the fellahin, “Ez Zehweile,”
which means “a slippery place,” or perhaps “the serpent stone.” This
was M. Ganneau’s discovery, and he knew at once the bearings of it, in
helping to fix En Rogel at the Virgin’s Fountain, and the king’s garden
somewhere in its neighbourhood. Perhaps the discovery would have been
made earlier, only that the village of Siloam, owing to the turbulence
of its inhabitants, is almost unvisited by Europeans.

Adonijah’s feast, then, was being held at the foot of this cliff, about
70 yards across the valley from En Rogel. Solomon’s party could not
be seen because the rising ground of Ophel came between. But when the
anointing had taken place at the Pool of Siloam, and the party were
going back up the Tyropœon toward David’s house, the people piped their
music and shouted their joy till the earth rang again. The attention
of Joab was attracted by the sound of the trumpet, and he enquired,
“Wherefore is this noise of the city being in an uproar?” The truth was
learned, and then Adonijah’s guests were afraid, and rose up and went
every man his way.

_Solomon’s Change of Residence._--Solomon would at first live in the
house of his father David, which was near the stairs which went down to
the valley bed. “And Solomon made affinity with Pharaoh, king of Egypt,
and took Pharaoh’s daughter and brought her into the City of David,
until he had made an end of building his own house,” &c. (1 Kings iii.
1). “And Solomon was building his own house thirteen years.” “He made
also a house for Pharaoh’s daughter” (close to his own house) (1 Kings
vii. 1. 8). “And Solomon brought up the daughter of Pharaoh out of the
City of David unto the house that he had built for her: for he said,
My wife shall not dwell in the house of David, king of Israel, because
the places are holy, whereunto the ark of the Lord hath come” (2 Chron.
viii. 11). This incidental mention that he brought her up accords well
with the relative positions of the two palaces--David’s lower down
the slope of Ophel, the new one higher up. The same remark applies to
bringing up the ark from David’s house to the Temple.

_The Building of Millo._--David having taken the stronghold of Zion
improved his new capital by building “round about, from Millo and
inward” (2 Sam. v. 9). What Millo was, or where it was located, has
been one of the great puzzles of Jerusalem topography. It seems,
however, to have been the great dam athwart the Tyropœon Valley. It
is possible that even the Jebusites had hit upon the device and had
constructed a dam in some rude fashion, and named it by a word of
their own language, which afterwards clung to it. Sir G. Grove, in
the “Dictionary of the Bible,” conjectures that it was the Jebusites
who first built Millo, because it is difficult to assign a meaning to
the word in Hebrew, while the Canaanites of Shechem also had a Millo
(Judges ix. 6, 20), and because David seems to find it existing and not
to build it. The statement that David built from Millo and _inward_
suits very well the identification of Millo with the great dam which
was the outer defence of the Tyropœon, and to a great extent of Zion
itself. It is not unlikely either that the House of Millo was a castle
on the Ophel Hill, close to the eastern end of the dam, and that this
was adopted by David as a residence. He may also have strengthened both
the castle and the dam. This view of mine has now been adopted by Herr
Schick. (See _Quarterly Statement_, January 1892, p. 22.)

But it was Solomon who so strengthened this work as to deserve the
credit of having constructed it. It was one of the great works for the
accomplishment of which he made a levy upon all parts of the kingdom
(1 Kings ix. 15). The nature of the work is indicated in 1 Kings xi.
27--“Solomon built Millo (and so) closed up the fissure (or cleft)
of the city of David his father:” either the two expressions relate
to the same work, or the two works are closely associated together.
Accordingly, before the work can be begun, Pharaoh’s daughter must
vacate the house of Millo. She came up “out of the City of David unto
her house which Solomon had built for her: then did he build Millo” (1
Kings ix. 24). The Israelites employed upon the work were the children
of Joseph, and their superintendent was Jeroboam, an Ephraimite,
probably already acquainted with the similar work at Shechem (1 Kings
xi. 28). It is stated in the Septuagint that Jeroboam completed the
fortifications at Millo, and was long afterwards known as the man
who had “enclosed the City of David.” The work was so well done that
Jerusalem was never again attacked from this side, although previously
this side was found the most vulnerable, both by David and by the
children of Simeon and Judah in earlier time.

If we are to find a Hebrew etymology for the name Millo, it seems to be
a noun formed in the usual way by prefixing the letter M to the Aramæan
verb _l’va_, equivalent to the Hebrew _lavah_,[34] having the meaning
to wind or twist, and used to describe stairways as well as serpents
and garlands. A dam across the Tyropœon would require the construction
of two stairways at least, one from the bed of the Tyropœon to the top
of the dam on the Ophel side, and one from the High Town down to the
dam on the west.

_The Death of Athaliah._--This incident affords indications of locality
in beautiful agreement with Nehemiah. When this queen-mother heard
that her son, the king, had been killed by Jehu, she snatched at the
sovereignty for herself, and her policy was to slay all the seed
royal. But one little child escaped, carried off by its nurse, and
they were secreted in the Temple by Jehoiada, the high priest. In the
seventh year Jehoiada assembled the chiefs of the people in the Temple,
produced the little child Joash, stood him upon the platform (or by
the pillar) appropriated to the kings, and said, This is the rightful
heir! The chiefs shouted their joy, when Athaliah heard the noise and
rushed into the Temple to learn the cause. That she should hear so
readily and find such easy access to the Temple, accords well with the
supposition that she was living in Solomon’s palace, close adjoining
the Temple, as Warren places it. When Athaliah saw the state of things,
she cried--“Treason, treason!” But she found no friends there. The
priest said, “Have her forth--slay her not in the house of the Lord! So
they made way for her; and she went to the entry of the Horse Gate to
the king’s house; and they slew her there” (2 Chron. xviii. 15; 2 Kings
xii. 16). It is implied in this narrative that the Horse Gate was not
only by the king’s house, but that it was also the nearest point which
could be considered fairly beyond the sacred precincts; and this is in
full agreement with the position which we have assigned it.

In the context of the passages just quoted we find that Joash is
carried “by the way of the Gate of the Guard into the king’s house.”
This gate must, of course, have been on that side of the palace
adjoining the Temple courts; it was probably due north of the Water
Gate (_i.e._, the Triple Gate), and it thus again accords with Neh.
iii. 25, where the tower standing out from Solomon’s house is said to
be “by the court of the guard.” The court of the guard may very well
have extended from the Water Gate without to the Gate of the Guard on
the Temple side of the palace. From Neh. xii. 39, it appears that there
was a corresponding Gate of the Guard at the corresponding point on the
north side of the altar.

_The Assassination of Joash._ When Joash grew to man’s estate he made
changes which displeased his people; and the short statement is that
his slaves slew him on his bed, “at the House of Millo, that goeth down
to Silla” (2 Kings xii. 20, combined with 2 Chron. xxiv. 25). This has
been generally regarded as obscure, and some have supposed Silla to
be the same as M’sillah, a stairway at the west gate of the Temple,
north of Wilson’s Arch (1 Chron. xxvi. 16). But it is more naturally
the stairway at Millo itself. Joash was living at Beth Millo, David’s
house, and when he heard of the conspiracy he designed to flee down the
stairs and through the Gate between two walls; but being a sick man he
was being carried on a litter, as Lewin remarks, and while going down
Silla,--not while going down _to_ Silla, for there is no preposition
here in the Hebrew text--the assassins killed him.

_The Wall destroyed by Jehoash_, king of Israel, when he came against
Amaziah of Judah, extended from the Gate of Ephraim unto the Corner
Gate, 400 cubits (2 Kings xiv. 13; 2 Chron. xxv. 23). We can now, by
aid of Herr Schick’s plan of the second wall, and our previous study of
Nehemiah, see exactly this piece of wall, south of the Church of the
Holy Sepulchre, and running east and west.

_The Towers built by Uzziah_ were intended to strengthen the city just
in this part where it had been found to be vulnerable. He “built towers
in Jerusalem at the Corner Gate, at the Valley Gate, and at the turning
of the wall, and fortified them” (2 Chron. xxvi. 9). The “turning”
here spoken of is a re-entering angle, and not improbably that one
south-east of the Church of the Sepulchre, where we find the “Throne of
the Governor” in later time.

In the days of Ahaz, the grandson of Uzziah, Jerusalem was threatened
by the allied forces of Rezin, king of Syria and Pekah, king of Israel.
Ahaz and his people were greatly perturbed, and needed a message of
advice and encouragement The word of the Lord came to Isaiah, in the
Temple, saying, “Go forth now and meet Ahaz, at the end of the conduit
of the upper pool, in the highway of the Fuller’s Field” (Isaiah vii.
3). The upper pool here spoken of is believed to be the Virgin’s
Fountain, where we find one end of a conduit which connects it with the
lower pool at Siloam. But if this is what is meant, why is the spot
not described shortly and plainly as En-Rogel, by which name it was
already known? (1 Kings i. 9). Surely it is not the pool itself which
is meant but the end of a conduit, or channel, or passage belonging to
it--the end of a passage, yet not a termination in any pool. That is
to say, it refers to the top of the shaft and stairway on the Ophel
Hill, which had been lost so long until re-discovered by Warren. This
entrance was of course known to Isaiah, and known to the king, being
close by the king’s gardens. Ahaz would reach it by going out through
the Gate between two walls, and was probably accustomed to walk there
frequently. The place spoken of is not really stated to be “_in_ the
highway of the Fuller’s Field:” in the Hebrew text the word _in_ is not
found, and the passage might be rendered--“The end of the channel of
the upper pool, the staircase of the Fuller’s Field.” This is an exact
description of the top of the shaft on the Ophel Hill.

Here, then, we have another interesting note of locality: it appears
that the Fuller’s Field was on Ophel, and Warren’s shaft was in it. We
cannot but recall the statement of Josephus that St James was martyred
by being thrown over the outer wall of the Temple enclosure, and that
“a fuller took the club with which he pressed the clothes, and brought
it down on the head of the Just one.” It is reasonable to infer that
fullers were at work not far from the spot where St James fell. On the
slope of the Ophel Hill Sir Charles Warren discovered a cavern which
was apparently used by the fullers, for it contained vats or troughs
cut in the rock. In the earth above the cave is a drain, which is of
course more modern; and yet here were found glass and pottery, supposed
to be early Christian.

In the days of Hezekiah, the son of Ahaz, the stairway shaft in the
Fuller’s Field is spoken of again, and in a way that quite confirms
our previous conclusions. Sennacherib, while besieging Lachish, sent
his Tartan and his Rabshakeh with a strong force against Jerusalem,
as an easy prey. The Assyrian officers pitched their camp at the
north-west of the city, on the high ground, which was ever after known
as the “Camp of the Assyrians.” But, seeing the strength of the city,
they made no assault upon it; they sought a conference with Hezekiah
to induce him to surrender. Learning where his palace was, that is,
David’s house, on the slope of Ophel, they came and “stood at the
passage of the upper pool, which is at the staircase of the Fuller’s
Field” (2 Kings xviii. 17). There they called to the king, and when
Hezekiah, consulting his dignity, deputed his Prime Minister, his
Secretary, and his Recorder to represent him, these officers spoke
from the top of the wall. The circumstances may seem to require that
the wall should extend a little more southward than the wall found
by Warren, but they seem to be good evidence that the Ophel shaft
was outside the wall, and that the king’s house was within shouting
distance of the shaft, or at any rate that the Assyrian generals
thought so.

Jerusalem was not taken at this time; but in expectation of a siege,
Hezekiah had made great defensive preparations. For one thing he
gathered many labourers and choked up all the fountains outside the
city and stopped the flow of the brook (2 Chron. xxxii. 3). He stopped
the upper spring of the waters of Gihon and brought them straight down
on the west side of the City of David (2 Chron. xxxii. 30). He gathered
together the waters of the lower pool; he made a reservoir between the
two walls for the water of the old pool; he made a pool and a conduit
and brought water into the city (Isaiah xxii. 9, 11; 2 Kings xx. 20).
It is probable that most of these statements relate to the same piece
of work, and that work the making of Siloam Pool and the tunnel to
bring water to it from the Virgin’s Fountain. There had been an “old
pool” of Siloam, which is clearly traceable south-east of the present
one, and this was the “lower pool of Gihon;” while the Virgin’s Fount
was the “upper pool” or the “upper spring of the waters of Gihon.”
The water had previously flowed from the one to the other, by an open
channel down the Tyropœon Valley--a channel which has been struck at
some points--and this was “the brook that flowed through the midst of
the land.” The lower pool and the waters of Siloah were referred to
by Isaiah in the previous reign (that is, he speaks of the waters of
Siloah that go softly, viii. 6, and he implies a lower pool by speaking
of the upper pool). It is reasonably argued by Dr Chaplin[35] that
Siloah and Gihon were identical, and that the terms applied not only to
the spring or pool but to the canal that joined them. We may assent to
this if we keep in mind that the open canal existed before the rock-cut
tunnel. The only difficulty we have is in thinking of the new Siloam
as a reservoir between the two walls, and in understanding the use of
making the tunnel if Siloam was to be outside the city. Some writers,
therefore, suppose that the first wall of the city actually bent round
Siloam on the southward side.

Hezekiah, besides these hydraulic works, built up all the wall that was
broken down, and raised it up to the towers; and the other wall without
(which it is just possible was south of Siloam Pool, only, even in that
case, there is a great dam across the fissure to the north of it);
and being so solicitous about this part of the city, he “strengthened
Millo, the city of David” (2 Chron. xxxii. 5).

In the days of King Josiah we have mention of the prophetess Huldah,
and it is stated that she lived in Jerusalem, in the _Mishneh_ (or
Second Quarter). The word means second in order or in dignity, and in
the case of brothers the younger. It appears to designate that part of
the city which lay in the Asmonean Valley, a part inferior to Zion in
dignity, and younger as an inhabited district, because originally a
suburb outside the walls which encircled the hills.

_The Capture of Jerusalem and Flight of Zedekiah._--Not to multiply
incidents, let us come now to the last king of Judah--Zedekiah. In his
day Nebuchadnezzar came up against the city, and pitched his camp,
as all had done before him, against the northern quarter. The event
to be expected in such a case is described in Zeph. i. 10. There is
first a noise from the Fish Gate at the head of the Asmonean Valley.
Of consequence there is next a howling from the Second Quarter of
Jerusalem, for the forcing of the Fish Gate has brought the invaders
into the northern “suburb.” Next, the alarm having spread, there is
a crashing from the hills on either side. Howl ye inhabitants of
Macktesh--the “Hollow,” the southern Suburb, where dwelt the men of
Tyre which brought in fish and all manner of ware (Neh. xiii. 15), and
after whom the Valley was probably named--howl ye, for all the merchant
people are undone, all they that were laden with silver are cut off.

Nebuchadnezzar’s generals effected an entrance at the middle gate of
the north wall; and Zedekiah, as soon as he knew of it, fled away by
night with his bodyguard. Whether living in Solomon’s house or David’s,
his way would be down the Stairs of the City of David into the bed of
the Tyropœon; and then we are distinctly told that he fled by the way
of the Gate between the two walls, which was by the king’s garden (2
Kings xxv. 4; Jer. xxxix. 4; lii. 7). His plan was to take the route
which David had taken when he fled from Absalom. Josephus says “that he
fled out of the city through the fortified ditch” (Antiq. x. 8, 2)--a
statement which quite supports our idea that the deep hollow “Suburb”
was defended by a transverse wall or dam.

_Jeremiah’s Prophecy._--In order to encourage the people during the
captivity, Jeremiah predicts that Jerusalem shall be again inhabited
and its borders extended. The measuring line is to go forth over
against it upon the hill Gareb (probably the later Bezetha, north-west
of the Temple) and shall compass about to Goath (this seems to be a
sweep round the north-western, western, and south-western parts of
the city); and the whole valley of the dead bodies and of the ashes
(_i.e._, Topheth, the broad junction of the present Hinnom and Tyropœon
Valleys), and all the fields (eastward) unto the Brook Kedron (and then
northward), unto the corner of the Horse Gate toward the east shall be
holy unto the Lord (Jer. xxxi. 28). This reference again confirms the
position we have assigned to the Horse Gate.

Zechariah also describes Jerusalem in its length and breadth. It is
to be lifted up and inhabited from Benjamin’s Gate (the east gate of
the temple in Ezekiel’s plan, Ezek. xlviii. 32), unto the place of the
first gate (the first gate of the city, a gate near the north-east
corner--as the Hebrew language reads from right to left, so goes the
numbering here), unto the Corner Gate. This is from east to west; the
north and south extremes named by Zechariah are the Tower of Hananel
(same position as Antonia) and the king’s wine-presses (which we may
guess to be southward of the king’s garden).

_The Locality of the King’s Garden_ is an important point in Jerusalem
topography. M. Clermont Ganneau inclines to place it on the eastern
side of Ophel; but his reason seems to be insufficient. The great
eastern valley of Jerusalem, so commonly called the Kedron, is
divided by the fellahin of Siloam into three parts, and the middle
part--extending from the south-east angle of the Haram to the junction
of valleys a little north of Joab’s well--they call _Wady Fer’aun_,
or “Pharaoh’s Valley.” M. Ganneau believes that this signifies, in
their minds, simply the _Valley of the King_, and is equivalent
to the King’s Garden.[36] M. Ganneau might claim in his favour the
statement of Josephus that Adonijah’s feast, “by En Rogel,” took place
near the fountain that was in the king’s paradise (or park).[37] But
the paradise or park was something different from the garden, and
Josephus does not use the word paradise to describe the king’s gardens
in which Uzziah was buried, but the word _kepois_.[38] It is worth
notice also that if the Virgin’s Fountain was in the king’s park, it
was almost certainly outside the city. Again, the fact that the royal
park included within it the spring of water makes it probable that the
shaft in connection with it was on the royal property also, for the
kings would hardly allow the free use of a spring which they deemed
their own. And then, if the shaft was on the royal grounds (although
that part was still traditionally called the Fuller’s Field) it would
be natural that Isaiah should find king Ahaz walking there.

Amos prophesied in the days of Uzziah, “two years before the
earthquake” (Amos i. 1). This earthquake, although not noticed in the
history, was of a terrible character, and the people fled before it
(Zech. xiv. 5). As Josephus tells the story, it was just as Uzziah was
entering the Temple that the building suddenly started asunder; the
light flashed through, and at the same moment the leprosy rushed into
the king’s face. The hills around felt the shock, and a memorial of
the crash was long preserved in a large fragment, or landslip, which,
rolling down from the western hill, was brought to rest at the base
of the eastern hill, and there obstructed not only the roads but the
paradises of the kings. Josephus says that this occurred at the place
called Eroge, and Dean Stanley is confident that he means En Rogel;[39]
but here again it is necessary to notice that it is the king’s
paradises which are spoken of and not the king’s gardens.

It is quite clear that the king’s gardens were near the Gate between
two walls, as mentioned in the account of Zedekiah’s flight; and it
seems certain that the Gate between two walls was in the Tyropœon.

_7. Sieges of Jerusalem understood by the topography._--The capture
of Jerusalem by David, the investment of it by Sennacherib, and
the overthrow of it by Nebuchadnezzar have already been described.
Time would fail me to go into detail concerning all the sieges that
followed; and probably a brief treatment of two or three will be
sufficient for the reader. We desire to show how much clearer the
history becomes in the light of modern survey and investigation; and
for this purpose a few examples are enough.

Jerusalem on three sides was protected by deep ravines, and an enemy,
looking up, saw the brow of every hill surmounted by high walls. At
first he might imagine the Tyropœon Valley was accessible from the
south, since the dam or transverse wall was lower in position than
the walls which it joined together; but no doubt the dam or wall was
strongly built. Even if he could get within it, there was the Causeway
in front and walls on either side, and he would only be in what
Josephus calls a fortified ditch. The assailants of Jerusalem--who
doubtless knew their business--always chose to assault it from the high
ground north and north-west. The king’s palace, therefore, on Ophel was
about the last place which an enemy could reach, and not until he had
broken through two or three walls.

When Pompey advanced against Jerusalem (B.C. 64), the population was
divided. The party of Hyrcanus opened the gates to him; but the party
of Aristobulus retired to the Temple, breaking down the bridge which
communicated with the city. This may have been an arch on the site
of the present Wilson’s Arch. Pompey, having sent a garrison into the
city itself, laid siege to the Temple, purposing to assault it from the
north. He “filled up the ditch on the north side of the Temple.” That
would be the artificial cutting at the north-west corner. He filled
up the valley also, Josephus tells us (Wars, i. 7, 3), “and indeed
it was a hard thing to fill up that valley, by reason of its immense
depth, especially as the Jews used all the means possible to repel them
from their superior station.” This is the valley which Warren found,
crossing the present Haram area, falling away from the north side of
the platform to a depth of 200 feet, and passing out into the Kedron
north of the Golden Gate. Probably it was only partially filled up at
this time. Pompey then erected towers upon the bank which he had made,
and brought engines to bear; but it was not until the third month of
the siege that he made himself master of the Temple.

In B.C. 37, Herod, like all preceding generals, pitched his
camp on the north side (Josephus, Wars, i. 17, 9). The Jews in this
warfare made mines--perhaps in the ground banked up by Pompey--and
surprised the Romans by sudden sorties from below. But the first wall
was captured in forty days--(Antiq. xiv. 16, 2. This was of course
the wall which we know as the second)--and the Lower City being thus
taken, the Jews retired into the Upper City and into the Temple. The
Upper City was taken by storm after fifteen days more. But here the
destruction ceased. Herod was going to reign in Jerusalem, and did not
wish to do more damage than was inevitable in the capture of the city.
He sought to save the Temple, and only some of the cloisters about it
got burnt down.

Afterwards, to ingratiate himself with the Jews, Herod rebuilt the
Temple, and enlarged the precincts of it. It would seem that Solomon’s
palace had been destroyed by Nebuchadnezzar’s generals and never
rebuilt. Herod’s own palace was in the High Town. The area formerly
occupied by Solomon’s palace was now taken into the Temple precincts,
the south-west corner was raised up from its low level and added also;
and along this southern front was built a royal cloister, 100 feet
high. To make an approach to this cloister from the west, Robinson’s
Arch was erected, and if there was no viaduct from the western hill
there must have been a staircase to ascend from the valley. On the
north side also the Temple precincts were enlarged, by taking in the
ground which Pompey had raised to a higher level. The Baris or castle
in which Nehemiah had lived was reconstructed and strengthened, renamed
Antonia, and connected with the Temple.

In another quarter Herod strengthened the city very much. The reader
will have noticed that while it was a usual thing with assailants to
attack the north wall, and take the Lower City as a preliminary to
assaulting the Upper City, yet there was one spot where the Upper
City might be approached at once from the outside. This was by the
Valley Gate, and was owing to the fact that the second wall started
from the Gennath Gate to go northward, whereas the wall of the Upper
City was prolonged westward. Herod determined to strengthen this part
of the city all the more because his own palace was in this part; so
he built three strong towers, which he named Hippicus, Phasaelus, and
Mariamne. Hippicus was at the outer angle; the base of it remains, and
is the foundation of the north-west tower of the present citadel, which
measures 45 feet square. Phasaelus remains, and is the one conspicuous
object on the right hand as the traveller enters the Jaffa Gate. It is
70 feet by 56 feet, and is solid to the height of 60 feet; the stones
are bevelled, like those round the Haram, and do not appear ever to
have been disturbed. The site of Mariamne is less certain, but it
probably corresponded with the third tower which we see marked in
almost every plan of the so-called Castle of David.

The Jerusalem of Herod’s day was the Jerusalem which Jesus Christ would
be familiar with.

In the year 43 A.D., Agrippa built a third wall, to enclose
the suburban dwellings which had sprung up on the north. This third
wall began at the tower Hippicus, went northward, and had a tower
called Psephinus at its north-west angle, then passed eastward “over
against” the monuments of Helena, queen of Adiabene (the so-called
“Tombs of the Kings,” half a mile out, on the great north road), then
passed by the caverns of the kings, bent southward at the tower of the
north-eastern corner, and finally joined the old wall at the valley
“called the Valley of Kedron” (Josephus, Wars, v. 4, 2). “The city
could no way have been taken if that wall had been finished in the
manner it was begun.” But Agrippa “left off building it when he had
only laid the foundation, out of the fear he was in of Claudius Cæsar.”
The wall was 10 cubits wide, and was afterwards raised as high as 20
cubits, above which it had battlements and turrets. In the course of
the third wall, according to Josephus, there were ninety towers, as
compared with sixty in the first; and the whole compass of the city
was 33 furlongs. He also says that the ninety towers were 200 cubits
apart; but this would make the third wall alone more than 5 miles in
length, and so we judge that some mistake has crept into the text.
Therefore we shall venture to take the present north wall of the
city as representing Agrippa’s wall, notwithstanding that the entire
circumference would then be less than 33 furlongs. There seems to be
no sufficient evidence for going beyond the present wall. It is a wall
which begins at the tower Hippicus, by the Jaffa Gate. The position of
the great corner tower Psephinus seems to be indicated by the ruined
castle called _Kalat Jalud_ (Giant’s Castle), just within the present
north-west angle. The Damascus Gate is “over against” the so-called
Tombs of the Kings, for a spectator standing at the Tombs would look
down directly upon that gate. The “royal caverns” we may identify with
the Cotton Cavern, the quarry whence the kings of Judah obtained the
stone for the great buildings of the city. The entrance to them is in
the face of the scarped rock, about 300 feet east of the Damascus Gate,
and the city wall runs right across the entrance. At the north-east
corner of the present wall we find the tower which Josephus assigns
to that point--“the most colossal ruins after those at the north-west
corner.” A trench cut in the rock at the foot of the eastern wall is
deflected here, passes round the corner, and goes west; it does not go
any further north as we might expect it to do if the wall ever extended
further north. And then the wall from the north-east corner is brought
southward and joins the Haram wall, the junction not being at the
north-east angle of the Haram, but much nearer to the Golden Gate, at
the deep valley which Pompey began to fill up. We have to bear in mind
that this third wall had been built before the siege of Jerusalem by
Titus, in A.D. 70.

Titus began by investing the city on the north and the west. The place
he selected for his attempt on the outer wall was just west of the Pool
of Hezekiah, because there the wall of the High Town was not covered by
the second wall, and he thought to capture the third wall and then at
once assault the first.

When Titus had taken the outer wall he encamped in the north-west
part of the city between the second and third walls; and at the same
time extended his line from the “Camp of the Assyrians” to the Kedron
Valley. His attempt to storm the High Town at the uncovered portion of
the wall failed because of the strength of Herod’s towers. He then made
an attempt on the Temple platform from the north, but failed because
the valley there was deep and the Temple was strongly fortified. He
had hoped, when he took the Wall of Agrippa, to be able to assault
Antonia from the north, without taking the second wall; but it now
appeared to him that that castle might best be assaulted on the west.
These considerations induced him to attack the second wall. After
some effort, a breach was made, and the Romans entered the middle
city. They were once driven out by the Jews, and kept out for a time;
but by-and-bye they gained entrance again, and then, made wise by
experience, they demolished the second wall, or the northern part of
it, and so were able to keep their ground.

Antonia was now assaulted on its western side; but the business was
difficult, and the struggle was long. The mounds which the Romans cast
up were undermined by the Jews and destroyed. The mines, however,
weakened the outer wall of the castle, and that fell also. The Romans
were filled with hope; but the Jews had foreseen the event, and had
run up another wall behind. The courage of the Romans was damped by
the sight of this second wall. But a few days after, they scaled
it by a night surprise, and at the same time forced their way into
Antonia through the mine under the wall. The Jews, in a panic, rushed
away into the Temple, where they were able to defend themselves as in
a fortress. But fighting now took place daily, until at length the
northern cloisters of the Temple were burnt down, the inner Temple was
assaulted, and eventually the whole fabric was reduced to ashes.

The Jews were now crowded in the Upper City, and confined to that.
Titus held a parley with them across the bridge above the Xystus--that
is, at Wilson’s Arch--offering them terms. But they declined his
conditions, and so the siege had to go on. The Ophel quarter was now
plundered and burnt; and then a grand effort was made against the
Upper City. Mounds were thrown up, and the assault was delivered
simultaneously from several points--on the west, by Herod’s palace, on
the north-west part of the town a little east of the tower Phasaelus,
and on the north-east at the Xystus, which extended from Wilson’s Arch
southward. The strong city at last fell, and its walls and buildings
were razed to the ground.

We know that it rose again from its ashes, and has had an eventful
history since; but it is not our purpose to follow its fortunes farther.

In seeking to understand the descriptions given by Josephus, writers
have been much puzzled by his mention of a ravine “called the Kedron
ravine.” It could not well be the Kedron Valley itself, or it would
hardly be spoken of in this way; besides which, we are told that the
eastern portion of Agrippa’s wall joined the old wall at the ravine
called Kedron. This would be too indefinite a note of place if the wall
and the ravine ran parallel with one another. Moreover, the north-east
angle of the Temple cloisters was built over the said ravine, and
the depth was frightful (Wars, vi. 3, 2). The depth was frightful at
the angle, rather than at the eastern side. There could be no right
understanding of the references, until Sir Charles Warren’s labours
showed that a deep valley crosses the Haram north of the Golden Gate,
and contains within it the Birket Israil. It was only a “so-called
ravine” to Josephus, because the western portion had been filled up by
Pompey, and the eastern mouth was cut across by the Wall of Agrippa.
Warren’s discovery of this ravine, and demonstration of its depth, is
a glorious instance of the value of excavation work in questions of
Jerusalem topography.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--The Works of Josephus. “Siege of
   Jerusalem.” Thomas Lewin. “Jerusalem, a Sketch.” Thomas Lewin.]



                              CHAPTER IV.

         GOSPEL HISTORY IN THE LIGHT OF PALESTINE EXPLORATION.


                     1. _Christ in the Provinces._

In New Testament times Palestine was a Roman province, and its
divisions were no longer tribal. East of Jordan were the districts of
Perea Batanæa, Trachonitis, Auranitis, Paneas, and Gaulonitis. In this
chapter, however, we have to do chiefly with Western Palestine. On this
side the central position was held by Samaria, with Galilee north of
it, Judea south, and in the extreme south Idumea.

The Samaritans were not pure Hebrews in blood, and not purely Jewish
in their worship. When the ten tribes of Israel had been crushed,
and their principal families carried into captivity, the Assyrian
conquerors brought men from Cuthah, Sepharvaim, and other places in
the far east, and set them down in Samaria. Of various nationalities
themselves, these people intermarried with the poorer Jews who had been
left behind, and so their descendants were of mixed blood. Naturally
also, there was at first some admixture of religious beliefs and
practices, and some confusion of dialects (2 Kings, xvii.).

But eventually the various elements of the population coalesced, and
the Samaritans settled down as a people, speaking a language allied to
that of the Jews, and accepting the Books of Moses as their guide. But
they rejected all the later books excepting Joshua, and claimed that
Mount Gerizim was the place where it had always been intended that the
Temple of Jehovah should be built. In the days of Ezra and Nehemiah the
co-operation of the Samaritans in rebuilding Jerusalem and the Temple
had been refused, and at no later period would the Jews consent to have
friendly dealings with the Samaritans.

Nehemiah had seen the evils resulting from mixed marriages, and the
contaminating influence of foreign merchants in Jerusalem. In later
days, when Greek literature and Greek manners were spreading over
Syria, the more zealous of the Jews contended earnestly against the
corrupting innovations. The day when the Seventy Elders translated the
Law into Greek for king Ptolemy was pronounced accursed--a day of evil,
as when Israel made for itself a golden calf. The patriotic struggle
of the Maccabees was all intended to get rid of foreign influence, and
keep God’s chosen people separate. The Pharisees were a party who by
their very name claimed to be “separated,” and made it their object
to resist the slightest departure from the requirements of the Jewish
Law. Their ideas and tenets came to be generally accepted by the Jews
of Judea; and hence in the days of Christ Jerusalem was a centre of
exclusiveness, bigotry, and ceremonialism.

The Jews of Galilee, cut off from their brethren of the south by the
interposition of Samaria, could seldom visit the Temple at Jerusalem;
they saw little of the sacrifice of bulls and goats, and learned to
worship in synagogues in a plainer way. They were in contact with the
northern nations, made alliance with Phœnicia, and did business with
men of many nationalities in the fishing towns of the Lake of Tiberias.
It is possible that through their intercourse with foreigners, a part
of their district was called “Galilee of the Gentiles;” and they seem
to have become so different in their dialect or pronunciation that
when a man from Galilee opened his mouth in Jerusalem, his speech
betrayed him. The Galileans derived at least one advantage from their
intercourse with foreigners; it made them less exclusive, and prepared
them in a degree for a religion which should be addressed to Jew and
Gentile alike. Jesus Christ, when he began his ministry, did not
address crowds in Jerusalem, nor seek disciples from among the Scribes
and Pharisees, but came into the towns of Galilee, and called fishermen
from their humble occupation.

The prophecy in Micah led the Jews to look to Bethlehem Ephrathah as
the destined birth-place of the Messiah; and it was made an objection
to the claims of Jesus of Nazareth that his home was in Galilee.

Bethlehem is a long white town on a ridge, with terraced olive groves,
at a distance of 6 miles from Jerusalem. Here, enclosed within the
walls of the Greek convent, is the venerable Church of the Nativity,
now parcelled out among the Greek, Latin, and Armenian monks, who
house together from necessity in different quarters of the convent.
The church, built by Helena, the mother of Constantine, is one of the
oldest in the world; and the cave beneath it under the choir is the
traditional Cave of the Nativity. It is mentioned by Justin Martyr
in the second century; and Origen, in the fourth, says that “there
is shown at Bethlehem the cave where He was born, and the manger
in the cave.” It is the only sacred place, as far as I know (says
Conder), which is mentioned before the establishment of Christianity
by Constantine; yet it is remarkable that Jerome found it no longer
in possession of the Christians. “Bethlehem,” he says, “is now
overshadowed by the grove of Tammuz, who is Adonis; and in the cave
where Christ wailed as a babe the paramour of Venus now is mourned.”

Mr Bartlett, in his “Walks about Jerusalem,” deems the identification
of the spot at variance with probability, since, although it may
occasionally happen that caverns are used as stables in Palestine, this
one is deeper underground than would be convenient for such a purpose.
When we consider, in addition, the tendency of the monks to fix the
scene of remarkable Scriptural events in grottoes, perhaps from the
impressiveness of such spots, the presumption against the site appears
almost conclusive.

Palestine exploration was hardly likely to throw any light on this
question, which is to be elucidated rather by a study of the causes
which led to a confusion between the traditions relating to Christ and
the legends told of Tammuz.

The people of Bethlehem are better fed, better dressed, better off in
most respects than the people of other small towns in Palestine. The
women are remarkable for their beauty, and they wear a peculiar kind
of head-dress, adorned with rows of silver coins. It is believed that
at the time of the Crusades a good deal of intermarriage took place
between Europeans and the women of Bethlehem. The population now is
chiefly Christian.

If we attempt to follow Joseph and Mary, returning from Egypt and
taking at first the road for Bethlehem, but changing their course when
they hear that Archelaus reigns, and withdrawing into the parts of
Galilee (Matt. ii. 23), we may suppose that they make their way to the
river Jordan, cross by the ford near Jericho, journey on the eastern
side and so avoid Samaria, and then, re-crossing by the ford near
Bethshan, make their way to Nazareth.

Nazareth, the town in which Jesus was brought up, is also without any
Jewish inhabitants at the present day; the population is about six
thousand, of whom one-third are Moslem, while two-thirds are Christians
of the Latin, Greek, and other churches. Unfortunately they bear an
evil character for their turbulence.

In Nazareth we are shown what purports to be the workshop of Joseph
the carpenter, but we know that this is a modern appropriation, a
Latin chapel, built only in 1859. We are asked to look at the _Mensa
Christi_, a block of rock, rudely oval, 10 feet across and 3 feet high,
in a church built in 1861, but we have no confidence that Jesus and
his disciples used it as a table. Making a stronger claim is the house
in which the Holy Family lived, or what remains of it, for the legend
says that the upper storey or the outer room was carried away by angels
through the air, and after lengthy travels was set down on the wooded
hill-top of Loretto in Italy. It is a rock-cut grotto under the high
altar of the Latin church. A wall of separation makes two chambers
of it, the outer being called the Grotto of the Annunciation, and
the inner the Grotto of St Joseph. The shaft of a red granite pillar
hanging through the roof is believed to be miraculously suspended over
the very place where the angel Gabriel stood to deliver his message.
From the inner chamber--that of St Joseph--a narrow passage, with
seventeen steps, leads up obliquely to the inmost part of the cave, a
chamber of irregular shape, traditionally supposed to be the Virgin’s
kitchen.

Escaping from these places we inquire for that synagogue in which
Jesus received instruction when a youth, and “stood up to read” on a
memorable occasion after he had become a public teacher. But there are
no Jews in Nazareth, and so there is no need of a synagogue now. The
Greek Catholics, indeed, tell us that their chapel, in the main street,
occupies the very site of the synagogue; but we find no remains of
synagogue architecture. It occurs to us that there is one site, at all
events, the features of which could hardly be destroyed or altered,
namely, the “brow of the hill on which the city stood,” and from which
the Nazarenes intended to precipitate the great Teacher after that
scene in the Synagogue. But when we have been guided to the “brow,”
although we see before us a fearful descent of about 1000 feet--which
old Maundeville calls “the Leap of the Lord”--we observe that it is 2
miles from the town; and we cannot understand how it can be the brow of
the hill on which the city stood.

In this general uncertainty of things are our explorers able to do
anything for us? Yes, some little, for they are men who use their eyes,
and they point out that high up above the present town are numerous old
cisterns and tombs. The cisterns would certainly be in close proximity
to the dwellings of the people, the ancient Nazareth must therefore
have stood higher on the slope; and so the “brow of the hill” was
probably one of the cliffs now above the town.

Conder also points out that the Virgin’s Fountain of Nazareth--also
called the Fountain of the Annunciation--should be one of the most
surely identified places. There is but one spring in the town, and
Mary must necessarily have drawn water from it like other women. The
Greeks have built their church at the place, and declare it to be the
scene of the Annunciation. Their church is dedicated to St Gabriel, and
even the Latins admit that it stands on the site where the angel first
became visible. “As in the eighth century, so now, the spring is under
the floor of the church, which is itself half subterranean. The water
is led to the left of the high altar, past a well-mouth, by which it
is drawn up for pilgrims, and so by a channel to the masonry fountain,
where it comes out through metal spouts under an arched recess broad
enough for fifteen women to stand side by side. A pool is formed below
at the trough, and here the constant succession of the Nazareth women
may be seen all day filling their great earthenware jars, standing
ankle-deep in water, their pink or green-striped baggy trousers tucked
between their knees; their heads are covered, if Moslems with the
moon-shaped tire, if Christians with a gay handkerchief or the hair
plaited in long tails. A negress in blue here and there mingles with
the crowd, which is chattering, screaming, gossiping, and sometimes
fighting.

“The people of the town are remarkable for the gay colouring of their
dresses, and the Christian women for their beauty. Many a charming bit
of colour, many a shapely figure set off by picturesque costume, many a
dark eye and ruddy cheek have I seen in the streets or by the spring.
This beauty is peculiar to the Christians of Bethlehem and Nazareth.”

Jesus lived at Nazareth until the time arrived for entering upon his
public work. The immediate occasion which called him forth from the
carpenter’s shop was the news that John the Baptist had begun preaching
in the wilderness of Judea. The work of the Palestine explorers has
thrown important light on the movements and mission stations of John
the Baptist.

John appears to have begun his public work at the great ford of the
Jordan near Jericho; and there went out to him Jerusalem and all Judea
to be baptized. The Jordan at this part is a brown, rapid swirling
stream, about 20 yards across, fringed with a jungle of tamarisk and
cane and willow, in which the leopard and the wolf find a hiding place.
The tradition which says that Jesus was baptized here is at least as
old as the fourth century; the Greek and the Latin churches agree in
regard to it, and at the present day pilgrims from all churches resort
to this spot to bathe in the sacred waters.

Our explorers see no reason to doubt this tradition, and a difficulty
which did exist they have been enabled to remove. It is stated in the
fourth Gospel (John i. 28), that John was baptizing in Bethabara beyond
Jordan, when Jesus came to him; that the Baptist bare testimony to
Christ during two days, and on the third day Jesus was minded to go
into Galilee and was present at Cana at the marriage feast. Hostile
critics of the fourth Gospel, taking the traditional scene of John’s
baptizing near Jericho--where Bethabara has usually been placed on
the maps--asserted that Jesus would have a journey of 80 miles to
accomplish in a single day to reach Cana of Galilee, and that the feat
is of course impossible. But there is really no assertion that it
was done or attempted. It is only a tradition of the fourth century
which fixes Bethabara so far south, or says that Jesus was baptized
at Bethabara. A position near Upper Galilee would suit the narrative
better as the site of Bethabara. Now the surveyors in the course of
their work marked all the fords of the Jordan, and collected all the
names. The following winter, when Major Conder was looking through the
list in order to prepare an index, he was struck with the presence of
the word _Abara_. He saw at once that the house or station at this
place would be Beth-Abara, which had thus been discovered unwittingly.
He looked it out upon the map, and found it to be one of the principal
fords of the Jordan, just above the place where the Jalud river,
flowing down the Valley of Jezreel and by Beisan, debouches into
Jordan. The distance thence to Cana would only be 22 miles. The fourth
Gospel does not say that Jesus was baptized at Bethabara, and so this
new discovery does not disturb that part of the tradition which fixes
the baptism near Jericho. Jesus, after being baptized, retired into the
wilderness, and when he returned to the world he found that John had
removed to the more northerly station, and thither he followed him. As
Jesus began to make disciples at Bethabara, the events of John i. must
have occurred after the Temptation, and so indeed they are placed in
the Gospel Harmonies (see Smith’s “Dictionary of Bible,” p. 721).

The Revised Version reads “Bethany beyond Jordan,” instead of
Bethabara, and this is the reading of the oldest manuscripts. It is
gratuitous to suppose any confusion with Bethany near Jerusalem.
“Bathania” was a well-known form (used in the time of Christ) of the
old name Bashan, a district in Peræa or the country beyond Jordan;
and perhaps, as Conder suggests, the original reading was “Bethabara
in Bethany beyond Jordan.” We must agree with him, too, that this
identification of Bethabara is one of the most valuable discoveries
resulting from the survey.

That John the Baptist did move from one station to another in pursuance
of his mission is shown again by the statement that after these things
John was baptizing in Ænon near to Salim, because there was much water
there (John iii. 23). Where was Ænon? It used to be assumed that it
was of course near the desert of Judea where John first preached. But
surely it would be unnecessary to tell us that there was enough water
to baptize with in the Jordan, whereas if abundance of water could be
found anywhere else in Palestine it would be somewhat remarkable. Now
such abundance is found almost in the heart of Samaria. The traveller
who rides across from the town of Samaria, passing behind Ebal, or
who follows the stony road in the magnificent gorge east of the same
mountain, finds himself gradually descending to the springs which lie
at the head of the great _Far’ah_ valley, the open highway from Shechem
to the _Damieh_ ford of the Jordan. It was up this valley that Jacob
drove his flocks and herds from Succoth to Shalem near Shechem. It
was along the banks of the stream that the “garments and vessels” of
the hosts of Benhadad were strewn as far as Jordan. It was here also
that Israel, returning from captivity (according to the Samaritans),
purified themselves before going up to Gerizim to build the temple.
But the place possesses a yet higher interest as the probable site
of “Ænon near Salem” where John was baptizing, and where a question
arose between John’s disciples and a Jew about purifying (John ii.
25). The phrase “much water” might fairly be translated many waters
or many springs, and in an open valley here the springs are found.
The waters gush out over a stony bed and flow down rapidly in a fine
stream. The supply is perennial, and a continual succession of little
springs occurs along the bed of the valley, so that the current becomes
the principal western affluent of Jordan south of the Vale of Jezreel.
About 4 miles north of the head springs is a village called ’_Ainun_,
and about 3 miles south another village called _Salem_. So here we
have “Ænon near Salem,” and in between the two villages the two great
requisites for the baptism of a multitude, namely, an open space in
which the crowd could stand, and abundance of water. There are indeed
other places called Salem scattered up and down the country, but none
of them has an Ænon near to it; and there is one other place called
Ænon, but it has no Salem near to it, besides which, it is away near
Hebron, in a district quite out of the question.

It would appear, then, that John began baptizing, in the first
instance, near Jericho, and made his appeal to Jerusalem and all Judea;
that next, remembering the other great section of the Jews in Galilee,
he removed to Bethabara in the north; and further, because the reformed
religion was not to be for the Jews alone, he entered Samaria itself
and baptized at Ænon.

At the head-springs of Ænon we are only about 5 miles from Jacob’s
Well. Conder and others consider the identity of Jacob’s Well beyond
question, because Jewish and Samaritan tradition, Christian and
Mohammedan tradition all agree about it. The identity is further
supported by the proximity of Joseph’s Tomb, about 600 yards north of
it, a tomb venerated by the members of every religious community in
Palestine. A Christian church was built round Jacob’s Well before the
year 383 A.D., and destroyed before Crusading times, only the vault
or crypt remaining. The ruins covered up the well and hid it altogether
some few years ago; but Captain Anderson, of the Palestine Exploration
Fund, removed them and descended by a rope. The Arabs allowed the rope
to twirl and slip, so that Anderson went into a swoon, from which he
was awakened by the shock of striking the bottom. He measured the well
and found it 7½ feet in diameter and 75 feet deep. Anciently it must
have been deeper, for some of the ruins have fallen into it, and every
passing traveller throws in a stone to hear it fall. The question
arises, why there should be any well at this spot at all, seeing that
the valley (between Ebal and Gerizim) abounds in streams of water, and
there is one stream only 100 yards from the well itself? The answer
given is that the man who dug the well had no right to use the streams;
he was a stranger in the land, and felt the need of a supply of water
upon his own property.

Jacob’s Well is one of the few spots undoubtedly rendered sacred by the
feet of Christ. When the Pharisees had heard that Jesus was baptizing
more disciples than John, Jesus left Judea for Galilee, “and he must
needs pass through Samaria. So he cometh to a city of Samaria called
Sychar, near to the parcel of ground that Jacob gave to his son Joseph,
and Jacob’s Well was there. Jesus, therefore, being wearied with his
journey, sat thus by the well. It was about the sixth hour. There
cometh a woman of Samaria to draw water,” &c. (John iv. 1-7). This
woman, we suppose, came from Sychar; but an unaccountable confusion
has grown up between Sychar and Shechem. If the woman had come from
Shechem she would have to carry her pitcher a mile and a half to the
well, passing abundant streams on the way--an apparently needless
trouble. But the early Christians used to place Sychar a mile east of
Shechem, and our explorers agree with Canon Williams and others in
identifying it with the village of ’Askar, which stands within sight
of the well, about half a mile distant, on the slope of Ebal. Yet the
Crusaders confounded Sychar with Shechem, misleading everybody who
came after; the error lasting to our own time, and reappearing even in
carefully-written books.

The question arises, why Jesus on this occasion must needs go through
Samaria? It has been customary to reply that it was because Samaria
lay right across his path in going from Judea to Galilee. But this
does not satisfy us when we know that it was a frequent thing to cross
the Jordan and travel by the eastern route, because the Jews had no
dealings with the Samaritans. I was one day reading the Gospel of St
John very carefully in order to compare notes with a friend, and I was
struck with the meaning implied in Christ’s expression, “One soweth
and another reapeth.” Jesus says to his disciples, “Say not ye, there
are yet four months and then cometh the harvest.” We judge that he
is pointing to the rich cornfield, where the valley opens out into
the Plain of _Mukhnah_; he remarks that the corn is not ripe yet, and
the harvest is not due. Yet he says, “Behold! Lift up your eyes and
look on the fields, that they are white already unto harvest. He that
reapeth receiveth wages and gathereth fruit unto life eternal.” He is
now referring to the spiritual harvest: the people are flocking out
of the town to listen to his teaching, they are favourably disposed
and ready to be converted. Now, why should they be so ready to listen,
seeing that the Jews had no dealings with the Samaritans? Christ
himself supplies the answer when he says, “Herein is the saying true,
‘One soweth and another reapeth. I sent you to reap that whereon ye
have not laboured; others have laboured, and ye are entered into their
labour.’” He cannot mean that he is sowing seed now, by his preaching,
for his disciples to reap a harvest of conversions by-and-bye, for he
says, “The fields are white already unto harvest. Lift up your eyes and
look!” He recognises the truth that sowing and reaping are separated by
an interval of time, though at the Harvest-home sower and reaper may
rejoice together, as those who have laboured at different seasons for
the same result. Some Teacher, therefore, has been sowing seed among
these Samaritans before Christ came to Jacob’s Well; and who is that
likely to have been but John the Forerunner, when he preached at Ænon,
and the people of Sychar went to be baptized at the “many waters”? In
the light of this reading we may understand how the woman of Samaria
so soon grasps the fact that the Jewish stranger at the well is the
Christ that John had said was to come after him. If we read the chapter
again we shall see how it was through John’s baptizing at Ænon that
circumstances arose which made Jesus decide to go through Samaria.

It was while John was yet at Bethabara that Jesus went to Cana of
Galilee to the wedding feast. There are two rival sites for Cana: one
is the ruin of _Kanah_, about 8 miles north of Nazareth, the supposed
site in Crusading times; the other is the village of _Kenna_, about 4
miles north-east, which was the accredited site before the Crusaders
arrived. The traveller is shown the water-pots at either place. It
is difficult in the present instance to decide between rival claims,
but the opinion of most writers is in favour of _Kefr Kenna_, and our
explorers lean to that, partly for the reason that it is on the high
road between Nazareth and Tiberias.

Travelling eastward to Tiberias we see a little way off the road on our
left hand a hill of rather peculiar form; it looks as though it might
be the crater of a volcano, with two stunted horns, one at either end.
This is called the _Horns of Hattin_, and is noted in history as being
the place where the Crusaders received their last crushing defeat at
the hands of Sal-a-din, the great Saracen general, in the year 1187.
But it is still more interesting to us as being the place where Christ
preached the Sermon on the Mount. The tradition which makes _Kurn
Hattin_ the Mount of Beatitudes is of Latin origin, and not older than
the twelfth or thirteenth century; but the place is so well adapted for
the delivery of a discourse to a large multitude, that in this case we
may well believe it was correctly chosen by those who first selected
it. When we are at the spot we have no difficulty in reconciling the
seemingly inconsistent statements of St Matthew, who says that the
sermon was preached on the mount, and St Mark, who says that Christ
came down from the mount, and preached in the plain. Sitting on one of
the peaks or “horns” aforesaid, Jesus might begin his discourse to his
disciples, and when a larger crowd began to gather, might descend to
the base of the peak, while still remaining on the mountain of Hattin.

From Hattin we are soon at Tiberias, a town once beautiful and famous,
but now notorious for the filth of its streets and the activity of
its vermin. The Arabs say that the king of the fleas holds his court
there. Josephus tells us that the city was built by Herod Antipas,
and named in honour of the Emperor Tiberius. It was therefore a new
city in Christ’s day, and probably at first inhabited only by Romans,
Antipas himself having a palace there, adorned with figures of animals,
“contrary to the Jewish law.” Moreover, as it was built on the site
of an ancient burial ground, it would be regarded by the Jews as a
polluted and forbidden locality. These circumstances, taken together,
may account for the fact that Jesus Christ does not appear ever to have
entered the city.

The former greatness of Tiberias is indicated by the extent of the
walls, 12 feet in thickness, which have been traced by Dr Selah
Merrill and by Herr Schumacher for a distance of 3 miles, on the south
side. In the course of the wall is an old castle on the summit of a
hill, 1000 feet above the town. An aqueduct, 9 miles long, brought pure
water from a distance, whereas the present inhabitants are content
to drink of the waters of the lake. Looking about in the town we
notice some traces of its former grandeur; here a magnificent block of
polished granite from Upper Egypt, there a hunting scene carved on the
surface of a hard black lintel of basalt, besides old buildings, and
broken shafts and columns half buried in rubbish.

From Tiberias we go north, and after a ride of 3 miles reach Medjel,
which represents the Magdala of Christ’s time, and is known wherever
the New Testament is read as the home of Mary Magdalene. The village
is insignificant, being only a collection of huts and hovels; the
people are poor and degraded, and their children half naked. Travellers
approaching the place are greeted by the howling of dogs, which rush
out as though they would devour them.

Tiberias and Medjel are the only places now inhabited about the lake,
and the visitor is impressed with a sense of deadness and desolation.
Yet the lake is beautiful, and upon its shores there were in Christ’s
time no less than nine cities, while numerous villages dotted the
plains and hills around. All the surrounding region was highly
cultivated, and the lake itself was covered with fishing boats. There
are no more than half a dozen boats now--made at Beyrout, or some other
seaport town, and brought hither on the backs of camels--but the lake
still swarms with fish. When a revolver was fired into the water at
random several fishes were killed and floated on the surface.

The lake is surrounded by hills, except at the south end, where it
touches the Jordan Valley. These hills are at such a distance from
the water as to leave a belt of land, generally level, all round it,
which at some points broadens out into large plains, such as those of
Gennesaret and Bathia. Medjel, already mentioned, is at the southern
end of the charming Plain of Gennesaret, about which Josephus goes into
ecstasies on account of its exceeding great fertility. He speaks of
the palms and figs, olives and grapes that flourished there, and the
fish for which its streams were far-famed. The plain is but 3 miles
long by 1 mile wide, and it now looks neglected; but it might be made
a little paradise again, for the soil is as fertile as ever. “As we
journey towards the northern end” (says Dr Merrill) “we observe on our
left a strange sight. The mountain appears to have parted asunder and
left a great chasm, the walls of which are perpendicular, and full of
caves, which, not long before the birth of Christ, were occupied by
robbers, whom Herod the Great had much difficulty in subduing. Along
the bottom of that chasm, ran, in Christ’s time, the main road from
Cana of Galilee, Nazareth, Tabor, and the region of the south-west, to
the north end of the lake, and thence to Damascus. Christ would pass
along this road in going down from Nazareth to Capernaum.”

It was probably in the Plain of Gennesaret that the multitude stood on
the land while Jesus put off in a boat to be free from the pressure of
the crowd while he addressed them (Mark iv. 1). In this neighbourhood,
also, no doubt, was spoken the parable of the net cast into the sea.

Of all the nine cities then about the lake we should like to recover
especially the sites of Capernaum and Bethsaida. Before the Exploration
we had to be content with the vague statement that Capernaum was
somewhere north of Tiberias. We are now able to point to two sites,
and say that Capernaum was one or other of these, while these two
places are but 2½ miles apart. One of these places is _Tell Hum_, at
the head of the lake, about 2 miles west of the point where the Jordan
enters the lake. Here we have ruins indicating the former existence of
a town hardly smaller than Tiberias; we find a regular cemetery, and
within an enclosure we have the remains of a synagogue. Besides the
synagogue ruins the argument in favour of this site is found in its
name: _Tell_ means a heap, such as the place has become, and _Hum_ is
the abraded form of the name Nahum. Tradition said that the prophet
Nahum lived and died here, and indeed his grave was pointed out as
late as the fourteenth century. The village of Nahum would be _Kefr
Nahum_ in Hebrew; Khafarnaum, as Josephus has it; Capernaum as we are
familiar with it. Sir Charles Wilson is in favour of this site. On
the other hand, Major Conder is in favour of _Khan Minyeh_, 2½ miles
from _Tell Hum_, along the shore southward, and right in the corner
of the Plain of Gennesaret. Here, again, we have evidences of the
former existence of a town, although we have no synagogue ruins. The
name of the place, in this case also, supplies a strong argument. It
appears that the Jews, who looked upon Capernaum as the home of Christ
and the headquarters of his followers, called the disciples “Sons of
Capernaum;” they also nicknamed them Diviners or Sorcerers--in their
language, _Minai_, a name often appearing in the Talmud. Khan Minyeh,
then, would seem to be the town of the Minai or Sorcerers, the early
Jewish converts to Christianity; and their mother town was Capernaum.
An objection might seem to lie against Khan Minyeh because of its
situation in the plain, while it is said of Capernaum, “And thou,
Capernaum, shalt thou be exalted unto heaven? thou shalt go down unto
Hades” (Matt. xi. 23). Such an expression might be interpreted morally;
but if it is to be understood literally, then there is the suggestion
that the town was not entirely in the plain, but spread over the rocky
promontory to the north-east. Rev. Henry Brass explored this promontory
in the spring of 1890, and on the highest part, about 242 feet above
the lake, found “the remains of a fortification--possibly the station
of the Roman Centurion (Matt. viii. 5)--and here and there traces
of buildings, but everywhere broken pottery, showing that there was
formerly a large population. The ruins of the Khan at the junction of
the roads from Cæsarea, Jerusalem, and Perea with the great Roman road
leading north to Damascus, probably mark the very spot where Matthew
sat at the receipt of custom; and the outlying rocks at the foot of
the cliff, to this day the favourite resort of fish, indicate the spot
where Peter would naturally go to cast his hook (Matt. xvii. 27).”[40]

Before quite dismissing Capernaum from our minds, let us inquire about
the site of Bethsaida. The name signifies House of Fisheries, and it is
recorded that Bethsaida was on the lake and had the Jordan running past
it. Before we go further let us recall what occurred after the feeding
of the five thousand.

Jesus constrained his disciples to enter into the boat, and to go
before him unto the other side to Bethsaida. This is St Mark’s account
(Mark vi. 45). St John, speaking of the same event, says that the
disciples entered into a boat, and were going over the sea unto
Capernaum (John vi. 17). It would appear, therefore, that Bethsaida
and Capernaum were in the same direction, looking across the lake
from the place where the disciples embarked. On the morrow, when the
multitude which had been fed found that Jesus and his disciples had
gone away, they engaged some small boats which had come from Tiberias,
and crossed over to Capernaum, seeking Jesus. They must have had some
ground for believing he had gone away in that direction: at any rate,
at Capernaum, “on the other side of the sea,” they found him, and so
we cannot doubt that the boat had landed him at Capernaum, or near it.
When, therefore, two Evangelists tell us that they came to the shore
at Gennesaret, and moored the boat there (Matt. xiv. 34; Mark vi. 53),
it seems plain that Capernaum itself was in the land of Gennesaret,
as it would be if situated at Khan Minyeh. And yet, considering that
the disciples had been instructed to go “unto the other side, to
Bethsaida,” and perhaps only deviated a little through the stress of
the storm, and landed at Capernaum, we can hardly doubt that Bethsaida
was close by. In fact the ruins at _Tell Hum_ may very well mark
the site of Bethsaida, especially as their position agrees with the
descriptions of early travellers who place Bethsaida north-east of
Capernaum. For example, Willibald (A.D. 722) says, “And thence
(from Tiberias) they went round the sea, and by the village of Magdalum
to the village of Capernaum, where our Lord raised the prince’s
daughter. Here was a house and a great wall, which the people of the
place told them was the residence of Zebedæus and his sons John and
James. And thence they went to Bethsaida, the residence of Peter and
Andrew, where there is now a church on the site of their house. They
remained there that night, and next morning went to Chorazin, where our
Lord healed the demoniac, and sent the devil into a herd of swine. Here
was a church of the Christians.” They afterwards went on to the sources
of the Jordan at Banias.[41]

Chorazin, 2 miles north-west of _Tell Hum_, is called _Kerazeh_, a name
easily confounded with _Khersa_, in the Gadarene country east of the
lake; and this mistake Willibald appears to make.

The question is much discussed whether there were not two Bethsaidas;
and those who believe there were, call the second one “Bethsaida
Julias,” and place it on the eastern side of the Jordan, not far from
the north end of the lake. Josephus says that Bethsaida was a village
raised to the dignity of a town by Philip the Tetrarch, who rebuilt
it and changed its name to Julias in honour of the daughter of the
Emperor. Philip built himself a tomb there, and was buried there.

The question between _Tell Hum_ and _Khan Minyeh_ as the site of
Capernaum has been made to turn partly on the presence of synagogue
ruins at the former place and their absence from the latter. But this
can have little or nothing to do with the decision, for the best
judges believe that the synagogues date only from the second century
A.D.

Nevertheless, the existence of synagogue ruins in Galilee is a very
interesting fact; and it is probable that those erected in the second
century would be modelled after the pattern of those which preceded
them and in which Christ, in so many instances, read and taught. The
synagogue ruins at _Tell Hum_ are a shapeless heap, but the stones
have been carefully examined and measured, and it becomes possible
theoretically to reconstruct the building. Similar ruins are found at
seven or eight other places in Galilee, and some of them--especially
those at _Kefr Birim_--are in a better state of preservation. (_See_
Frontispiece.) Examination shows that the Jewish synagogues were not
the plain barn-like structures some people had imagined. The building
faced the south, looking towards Jerusalem, the holy city. Four rows
of columns ran from one end to the other, dividing the building into
five aisles. At Kefr Birim one synagogue was furnished with a porch.
A smaller building, at a little distance from the village, has two
lambs sculptured on the lintel of the door, and beneath them is an
inscription in Hebrew. The inscription has been thus read by Renan,
“Peace be to this place, and upon all the places of God. Joseph
the Levite, the son of Levi, put up this lintel. A blessing rest
upon his work.” At the synagogue ruins of _Nebartein_, north-east of
_Safed_, on the lintel of the main entrance, is a representation of
the seven-branched candlestick, similar to those in the catacombs at
Rome and on the rocks in the wilderness of Sinai. Here, again, is an
inscription in Hebrew. During the excavations at _Tell Hum_ synagogue
a lintel of one of the side entrances was found, and on its face a
vase--perhaps the pot of manna--and on either side a rod or reed. Along
the head is a scroll of vine leaves and grapes. The dimensions of this
synagogue were 74 feet 9 inches by 56 feet 9 inches. The material was
white limestone, brought from a distance, while the stone used at
Kerazeh was the hard black basalt of the neighbourhood.

As already remarked, _Kerazeh_ (Chorazin), north-west of _Tell Hum_,
has sometimes been confounded with _Khersa_, which was on the eastern
side of the lake. Khersa is Gergesa, where Christ was met by the two
demoniacs coming out of the tombs (Matt. ix. 1). It is situated on the
left bank of _Wady Semakh_, and at the point where the hills end and
the plain stretches out towards the lake. Sir C. Wilson is of opinion
that there is only one spot where the herd of swine could have run
down a steep place into the lake. It is a place about a mile south of
Khersa, where the hills, which everywhere else on the eastern side are
recessed from a half to three-quarters of a mile from the water’s edge,
approach within 40 feet of it, and _there_ do not end abruptly but
descend in a steep, even slope. Some time after Sir C. Wilson’s survey,
the eastern coast was carefully examined by Mr Macgregor in his canoe,
and he came to exactly the same conclusion.

A difficulty has arisen with regard to this locality in consequence
of the different readings in the three Gospels. In Matthew Christ is
said to have come into the country of the Gergesenes; in Luke and John
into that of the Gadarenes. The old MSS. do not give any assistance
here, but the similarity of the name Khersa to that of Gergesa is, as
Dr Thomson points out, in “the Land and the Book,” a strong reason for
believing that the reading of Matthew is correct; and we have also
the testimony of Eusebius and Origen that a village called Gergesa
once existed on the borders of the lake. Perhaps the discrepancy may
be explained by supposing that Gergesa was under the jurisdiction of
Gadara. Gadara itself, now _Umm Keis_, is a good two hours’ distance
from the lake, else here we find rock-hewn tombs which are actually
occupied by fellahin, while there do not appear to be any such at
Khersa. To meet the difficulty which might be felt from the absence
of tombs at Khersa, Sir C. Wilson has suggested that the demoniacs
may have lived in a tomb built above ground, like one still existing
at _Tell Hum_, a rectangular building, capable of holding a large
number of bodies, and which appears to have been whitewashed within
and without. It is possibly this description of tomb to which our Lord
refers in Matt. xxiii. 27, where he compares the Scribes and Pharisees
to “whited sepulchres,” beautiful in outward appearance, but within
“full of dead men’s bones.”

Dr Merrill, speaking of Chorazin, Bethsaida, Capernaum, and other
places now desolate by the Lake of Galilee, remarks that the contrast
between the present and the former condition of this region is painful
to one who knows its history. Nevertheless, he says, “this region is to
me one of the most sacred and delightful on earth. No place that men
have consecrated brings me so near to Christ as a day spent in walking
and meditating on these lonely shores.”

“Christ also visited Perea, the country east of the Jordan. Doubtless
he followed the main road to the hot springs on the Yarmuk, and
thence to the beautiful city of Gadara, on the mountain above them.
He may have gone a little farther east, past _Capitolias_ and
_Dium_, cities belonging to the Decapolis, and turned south through a
densely populated region to Geraza, whence, by one of the two routes
before indicated, he would return to the valley after his mission
had been accomplished. It was in Perea that the ‘seventy disciples’
were commissioned to labour, and their welcome and success must have
been unusual, for it is reported of them that they ‘returned again
with joy, saying, Lord, even the devils are subject to us through
thy name’ (Luke x.). The connection of our Saviour with this region
opens up an interesting field of inquiry. He may have foreseen that
in its rich cities, and among its throngs of human beings, his Gospel
was soon to triumph in a remarkable manner, for it is true that in
Bashan, a country which we are now accustomed to speak of as a desert,
Christianity, in the early centuries of our era, had one of its most
important strongholds.”

Jesus Christ at one time, either for quietness or for safety, went away
into the borders of Tyre and Sidon, and there entered into a house and
would have no man know it (Mark vii. 24). A similar reason may have led
him to visit Cæsarea Philippi (ancient Paneas and Dan) at the extreme
north-east corner of the Holy Land, where the Jordan springs forth a
full-grown stream, under the slopes of Hermon. It is generally accepted
now that Hermon, and not Tabor, was the Mount of the Transfiguration
(Luke ix. 29). Hermon was once _Shenir_, the “Shining,” a name made
appropriate by its cap of snow; and some writers imagine a connection
between this and the raiment that became white and dazzling.

There is one remarkable natural peculiarity of Hermon still to be
noticed (says Conder) namely, the extreme rapidity of the formation of
cloud on the summit. In a few minutes a thick cap forms over the top
of the mountain, and as quickly disperses and entirely disappears. In
the accounts of our Lord’s transfiguration, we read that whilst staying
at Cæsarea Philippi, he retired with his disciples to “a high mountain
apart,” and there can be but little doubt that some part of Hermon, and
very probably the summit, is intended. From the earliest period the
mountain has been a sacred place; in later times it was covered with
temples; to the present day it is a place of retreat for the Druzes.
This lofty solitary peak seems wonderfully appropriate for the scene of
so important an event; and in this connection the cloud formation is
most interesting, if we remember the cloud which suddenly cleared away,
when they found “no man any more, save Jesus only, with themselves”
(Mark ix. 8).

After these things it occurred, as Christ and his disciples “were on
the way to Jerusalem, that he was passing through the midst of Samaria
and Galilee” (Luke xvii. 11). Some critics have cited this text as a
proof that St Luke was ignorant of the country about which he wrote.
Seeing that Galilee is north of Samaria, they think that a journey from
north to south should rather be described as a passing through the
midst of Galilee and Samaria. Moreover, they point out that, according
to Matt. xix. 1 and Mark x. 1, Jesus did not pass through Samaria
at all, but crossed the Jordan, and travelled by the eastern route.
Notwithstanding the neatness of this indictment, it is easy to show
that St Luke’s statement may be perfectly correct. Jesus intended to
go up to Jerusalem to the feast, and as he did not share the Jewish
prejudice against the Samaritans, he contemplated going through
Samaria. He sent some of the disciples before him to prepare his way,
and they entered into a Samaritan village; but they could not succeed
in obtaining accommodation, because the object of the Master was to
go through to Jerusalem (Luke ix. 52). The chronic feeling of enmity
between Samaritans and Jews was naturally stirred into greater heat by
the sight of pilgrims going up to the festival; for then the question
was revived whether men ought to worship at Jerusalem or Mount Gerizim.
Being refused a passage through Samaria, and yet still intent upon
going up to Jerusalem, Jesus Christ would turn eastward, and journey
along the border, which led straight to the Bethabara ford of the
Jordan. Travelling thus, with Samaria on his right hand and Galilee on
his left, it is surely not incorrect to say that he was passing through
the midst of Samaria and Galilee; or, as we have it in the margin of
the Revised Version, he passed _between_. It seems to have been at one
of the border villages that he was met by ten lepers, one of whom was
a Samaritan (Luke xvii. 12); and where would he be more likely to find
Jewish and Samaritan lepers in one group than on the border line of the
two provinces? He is following this line eastward, and accordingly,
when Matthew and Mark say that he crossed the Jordan and came into the
borders of Judea, by the eastern route, it is in perfect accordance
with the statement in Luke. In further confirmation, we read in Luke
xviii. 35, as well as in the other Evangelists, that the route taken
brought Jesus through Jericho. To approach Jerusalem from Jericho was
a matter of course with the pilgrims from Galilee who had travelled by
the eastern route.

The Jericho road was the scene of the parable of the Good Samaritan. “A
certain man went down from Jerusalem to Jericho.” The actual descent
would be about 3000 feet; and every expression of that kind in the
Scriptures, as of “going down” or “going up,” is always true to the
features of the ground. The man “fell among thieves.” So likely a
district is it, that in the days of the Crusaders nine knights banded
themselves together to defend pilgrims going down this dangerous pass:
and hence arose the Order of Knights Templars. “There came by a priest
and a Levite.” Jericho was a sacerdotal city, and priests and Levites
were continually passing and repassing between Jericho and Jerusalem.
In going down the Jericho road the traveller has often a wide prospect
on either side; but it is, for all that, a mountain pass, with no way
of escape if one were attacked; and the Bedawin, whose black tents may
be seen in the distance, are the very fellows to attack the traveller
now, if they dared.

The road up from Jericho brings us past Bethany--a village now of about
forty small dwellings--and over the Mount of Olives, to Jerusalem.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Tent Work in Palestine.”
   Major Conder. “The Sea of Galilee.” Sir Charles Wilson. (In
   vol., “Recovery of Jerusalem.”) “East of Jordan.” Dr Selah
   Merrill. “Survey Memoirs.” Vol. of Special Papers. “Quarterly
   Statements of P. E. Fund.” “Galilee in the time of Christ.” Dr
   Selah Merrill. “Twenty-One Years’ Work in the Holy Land.” P.
   E. Fund.]


                      2. _Christ in the Capital._

The Jerusalem of Christ’s day was the city as it existed in the days
of Herod the Great. East and west it was no wider than at present;
southward it covered the high south-western hill and a good part of the
slope of Ophel; northward the third wall was not yet built, but there
were suburban buildings outside the second. The Temple area had been so
enlarged by Herod as to include all, or nearly all, the present Noble
Sanctuary; and there were approaches from the west, one of which led
over Robinson’s Arch. A main street from the Valley Gate led eastward
to the Temple, passing over Wilson’s Arch. Another main street, running
north and south, passed under Wilson’s Arch and Robinson’s Arch, and
led to a gate in the south wall. In the north-western part of the High
Town was Herod’s palace, with the three strong towers near the Valley
Gate which defended it. The Tower of Antonia occupied the site of the
present Turkish barracks, north-west of the Temple; and when Pontius
Pilate was governor he occupied it. Westward of the city the _Birket
Mamilla_ existed as a reservoir of water, and supplied the palace and
towers: but the _Birket es Sultan_, or so-called Lower Pool of Gihon,
had not been made. The Pool of Siloam was well known, and of course the
spring-head which supplied it. The traditional Pool of Bethesda did not
exist, but the true Bethesda--now buried under ruins--exhibited its
five porches, and was in favour as a healing fountain. For the rest we
may say that although all the valleys were deeper than they are now,
the streets and bazaars probably followed in most instances the lines
which they still preserve, and were just as narrow as they are at
present.

In the High Town, called in Josephus’ day the Upper Market Place, there
would be an open space somewhere, actually used for a market; and here,
we may conjecture, Jesus would sometimes teach. The very circumstances
of the spot would suggest the parable of the Labourers, some of whom
stood idle till the eleventh hour. Christ also taught in the ample
spaces of the Temple courts (John vii. 14); and in the last days of his
ministry, at any rate, used to retire from the city before the gates
were closed at sunset (Luke xxi. 37). Whether he ever lodged within the
city we cannot tell, but that he had no home there and no friend in
whose house he was sure of a welcome, may perhaps be inferred from the
fact that a guest-chamber had to be engaged when he desired to eat the
Passover (Mark xiv. 12).

_The Pool of Bethesda._--It is not doubted that when Christ told the
blind man to “Go, wash in the Pool of Siloam,” he was sending him to
the very pool which still bears that name. About the Pool of Bethesda,
“by the sheep _gate_” (John v.), there has not been the same assurance
and unanimity. The traditional pool occupies what was once a valley
north of the Temple; but as the valley itself was there when Titus
sought to attack the Temple from the north, we judge the pool to be a
later construction. The two arches at the western end of it, with their
staircases now buried in rubbish, are not the same as “five porches.”
Again, several writers have supposed that the so-called Virgin’s
Fountain might be the true Bethesda, because it is an intermittent
spring, and because the modern Jews believe the water of this pool to
be a sure cure for rheumatic complaints. They often go in numbers, men
and women together, and stand in their clothes in the pool, waiting for
the water to rise. But the Virgin’s Fountain is too far away from the
Sheep-gate to be the pool which the Evangelist refers to.

It was pointed out some years ago by M. Clermont Ganneau that the Pool
of Bethesda should be sought near the Church of St Anne, where an
old tradition has placed the house of the mother of Mary, calling it
_Beit hanna_, “House of Anne.” This expression is exactly identical
with _Bethesda_, both expressions signifying _House of Mercy_, or
_Compassion_.[42] This anticipation has been verified; for in the
year 1888 the ancient pool of Bethesda was found a short distance
north-west of the present Church of St Anne. Certain works carried on
by the Algerian monks laid bare a large tank or cistern cut in the
rock, to a depth of 30 feet, and Herr Schick recognised this as the
Pool of Bethesda. It is 55 feet long from east to west, and measures
12½ feet in breadth. A flight of twenty-four steps leads down into the
pool from the eastern scarp of rock. Herr Schick, who at once saw the
great interest of this discovery, soon found a sister-pool, lying end
to end, 60 feet long, and of the same breadth as the first. The first
pool was arched in by five arches, while five corresponding porches ran
along the side of the pool. At a later period a church was built over
the pool by the Crusaders, and they seem to have been so far impressed
by the fact of five arches below, that they shaped their crypt into
five arches in imitation. They left an opening for getting down to
the water; and further, as the crowning proof that they regarded the
pool as Bethesda, they painted on the wall of the crypt a fresco
representing the angel troubling the water of the pool.

All this appears to agree very well with what Eusebius says in his
“Onomasticon,” concerning a pool which he calls Bezatha--“a pool at
Jerusalem, which is the _Piscina Probatica_, and had formerly five
porches, and now is pointed out at the twin pools there, of which one
is filled by the rains of the year, but the other exhibits its water
tinged in an extraordinary manner with red, retaining a trace, they
say, of the victims that were formerly cleansed in it.” Here we have
a sheep pool, in which the sacrificial victims used to be washed, and
close by it (so that they constituted twin pools) a second, which must
have been intermittent, the very character attributed to those waters
which, at a certain season, were troubled.[43] Eusebius gives no clue
to the situation of the twin pools, but the Bordeaux pilgrim, who
visited Jerusalem in A.D. 333, after speaking of two great
pools at the side of the Temple, one on either hand as he entered
Jerusalem from the east side (apparently at St Stephen’s Gate), refers
to the twin pools as being more within the city. They “have five
porches” (he says), “and are called Bethsaida. Here the sick of many
years were wont to be healed. But these pools have water which, when
agitated, is of a kind of red colour.”

There had been a disposition in recent years to identify these twin
pools with two souterrains or tunnels existing under the Convent of
the Sisters of Sion at the north-west corner of the Haram area, but
that fancy is now dissipated. The manner in which most of the previous
speculations have been set aside by the actual discovery of the Pool of
Bethesda is an instructive testimony to the value of excavation work in
Jerusalem.

_A Tablet from Herod’s Temple._--Josephus, in his “Antiquities of the
Jews,”[44] after describing the cloisters of the Temple and the Court
of the Gentiles, goes on to describe the inner court, and the middle
wall of partition which divided Jews from Gentiles. He says, “Thus was
the first enclosure; in the midst of which, and not far from it, was
the second, to be gone up to by a few steps. This was encompassed by
a stone wall for a partition, with an inscription which forbade any
foreigner to go in under pain of death.” Again, in his work on the
“Wars of the Jews,”[45]--“When you go through these first cloisters,
unto the second court of the Temple, there was a partition made of
stone all round, whose height was three cubits. Its construction was
very elegant; upon it stood pillars, at equal distances from one
another, declaring the law of purity, some in Greek, and some in Roman
letters, that no foreigner should go within the sanctuary,--for that
second court of the Temple was called the Sanctuary, and was ascended
to by fourteen steps from the first court.”

In the year 1871, M. Clermont Ganneau had the good fortune to discover
one of these pillars or tablets, partly buried in the foundations
of a building not far from the Haram area. It bears the following
inscription in Greek, in seven lines:--

    ΜΗΘΕΝΑΑΛΛΟΓΕΝΗΕΙΣΠΟ
    ΡΕΥΕΣΘΑΙΕΝΤΟΣΤΟΥΠΕ
    ΡΙΤΟΙΕΡΟΝΤΡΥΦΑΚΤΟΥΚΑΙ
    ΠΕΡΙΒΟΛΟΥΟΣΔΑΝΛΗ
    ΦΘΗΕΑΥΤΩΙΑΙΤΙΟΣΕΣ
    ΤΑΙΔΙΑΤΟΕΞΑΚΟΛΟΥ
    ΘΕΙΝΘΑΝAΤΟΝ

The translation is:--“No stranger is to enter within the balustrade
round the Temple and enclosure. Whoever is caught will be responsible
to himself for his death, which will ensue.”

M. Clermont Ganneau remarks that the episode in the Acts of the
Apostles (xxi. 26, _et seq._) throws great light on this precious
inscription and receives light from it. Paul, after purification,
presents himself in the Temple; the people immediately rise against
him, because certain Jews of Asia believed that Paul had introduced a
Gentile--Trophimus of Ephesus--and had thus polluted the sacred place.
They are about to put him to death when the Tribune commanding at Fort
Antonia intervenes and rescues him. The people demand of the Tribune
the execution of the culprit, _i.e._, the application of the law.

This inscription, and probably this very stone, was almost certainly
seen and read by Christ; and it would be likely to impress him
painfully with the exclusive spirit of the Jews. It certainly could not
meet with the approval of the Teacher who preached to Samaritans at
Jacob’s Well, and laboured more in the half-Gentile town of Capernaum
than in Nazareth, defending his course by quoting the example of Elijah
who went to Sarepta a city of Zidon. Christ declared himself the Light
of all the World, and the Shepherd who had other sheep not of the
Jewish fold. It was the work of Christ, before it became the work
of Paul, to break down the middle wall of partition between Jew and
Gentile. There can hardly be a question, then, that the sight of this
inscription would intensify his desire to see this Temple destroyed
and the Jewish ritual abolished, that he might rear upon its ruins a
spiritual temple for all nations.

At the beginning of the week of his passion, Jesus Christ came up the
steep ascent from Jericho, the road bringing him at last to Bethany.
One night he halted in the village, as of old; the village and the
desert were then all alive, as they still are once every year at the
Greek Easter, with the crowd of Paschal pilgrims moving to and fro
between Bethany and Jerusalem. In the morning he set forth on his
journey. Three pathways lead, and probably always led, from Bethany
to Jerusalem; one, a long circuit over the northern shoulder of Mount
Olivet, down the valley which parts it from Scopus; another, a steep
foot-path over the summit; the third, the natural continuation of the
road by which mounted travellers always approach the city from Jericho,
over the southern shoulder, between the summit which contains the Tombs
of the Prophets and that called the Mount of Offence. “There can be no
doubt” (says Dean Stanley) “that this last is the road of the entry of
Christ, not only because, as just stated, it is, and must always have
been, the usual approach for horsemen and for large caravans, such as
then were concerned, but also because this is the only one of the three
approaches which meets the requirements of the narrative which follows.

“Two vast streams of people met on that day. The one poured out from
the city, and as they came through the gardens whose clusters of palm
rose on the south-eastern corner of Olivet, they cut down the long
branches, as was their wont at the Feast of Tabernacles, and moved
upwards towards Bethany, with shouts of welcome. From Bethany streamed
forth the crowds who had assembled there on the previous night, and
who came testifying to the great event at the sepulchre of Lazarus.
The road soon loses sight of Bethany.... Gradually the long procession
swept up and over the ridge, where first begins ‘the descent of the
Mount of Olives towards Jerusalem.’ At this point the first view is
caught of the south-eastern corner of the city.... It was at this
precise point that the shout of triumph burst forth from the multitude,
Hosanna to the Son of David!... Again the procession advanced. The
road descends a slight declivity, and the glimpse of the city is again
withdrawn behind the intervening ridge of Olivet. A few moments,
and the path mounts again, it climbs a rugged ascent, it reaches a
ledge of smooth rock, and in an instant the whole city bursts into
view.... Immediately below is the valley of the Kedron, here seen in
its greatest depth as it joins the valley of Hinnom, and thus giving
full effect to the great peculiarity of Jerusalem, seen only on its
eastern side--its situation as of a city rising out of a deep abyss. It
is hardly possible to doubt that this rise and turn of the road, this
rocky ledge, was the exact point where the multitude paused again, and
‘He, when he beheld the city, wept over it.’ Nowhere else on the Mount
of Olives is there a view like this.”[46]

On one of those last days the Great Teacher, leaving the city a little
before sunset, sat on one of the rocky banks of Olivet, over against
the Temple. The mountain rises 150 feet above the level of the city;
the city has the appearance of being tilted up on its western side, so
that from the mountain you can look down into its streets. The Temple
courts would be in the foreground, with Solomon’s Porch on the eastern
side. Perhaps the 80 feet of rubbish which now rests against the wall
had not yet half accumulated; and in that case the stones which Solomon
laid down would be still visible--blocks 20 cubits long by 6 cubits
thick, and extending a length of 400 cubits. The disciples had been
calling their Master’s attention to the goodly stones and buildings of
the Temple, as they came along, and he had declared that they would one
day be thrown down; and now, sitting on Olivet he prophesies the end of
the age.

From the Mount of Olives it was but a short way to Bethany, to spend
the night. A wild mountain-hamlet, perched on its broken plateau of
rocks, Bethany is screened by a ridge from the view of the top of
Olivet. The modern name of the village--El-Azarieh--connects it with
Lazarus, whose traditional house and grave are still exhibited, as well
as the traditional house of Simon the leper. The welcome which awaited
Christ in the home of Mary and Martha and Lazarus must have been very
grateful after the day’s teaching and turmoil in the noisy city.

It is hopeless to try and identify in Jerusalem the house or the street
in which the disciples made ready the Passover for their Master. The
Garden of Gethsemane, which was visited afterwards, may probably have
been at or near the place which is now pointed out on the slope of
Olivet.

When Christ was brought before Pilate it would be at the Tower of
Antonia, north-west of the Temple, on the site now occupied by the
Turkish barracks.

Outside the barracks, on the north side, is the street now called the
_Via Dolorosa_, because tradition says that Christ passed along it in
going from the Judgment Hall to the place of crucifixion, marked now by
the Church of the Holy Sepulchre.

  [Illustration: OUTLINE PLAN OF JERUSALEM.

      1 North wall of Upper City, probable course.
      2 Second wall, so drawn as to exclude the Church of the Holy
          Sepulchre.
      3 Second wall, including the Church.
      4 Church of the Holy Sepulchre.
      5 Pool of Hezekiah.
      6 Citadel.
      7 Dome of the Rock (Site of the Temple).
      8 Haram-area or Noble Sanctuary.
      9 Tower of Antonia, now Turkish Barracks.
      10 Birket-Israel (Traditional Bethesda.).
      11 Jaffa Gate.
      12 Via Dolorosa.]

_The True Site of Calvary._--The question has been much debated whether
the Church of the Holy Sepulchre occupies the true site of Calvary or
not. We know that Jesus suffered and was buried at some spot outside
the city, for it was “as they came out” that they found Simon of
Cyrene, and compelled him to go with them to bear the cross. The Church
of the Holy Sepulchre is almost in the heart of the present city; but
we have to remember that at the date of the crucifixion the third wall
was not yet built. The first question to be settled is the course of
the second wall, and the point whether it included the site of the
church or not. In this connection the discovery of a portion of the
second wall, running north-west, along by the Greek Bazaar, was very
important: only it was not followed far enough to remove all doubt.
If we adopt Herr Schick’s line for the second wall, the Church of the
Sepulchre would be outside: but this is not enough. If the site were
within the second wall it could not be Calvary; if it was outside the
wall it may be Calvary or may not. The Church is closer to the wall
than we should expect the place of execution to be; and unless Calvary
were further away there would hardly seem to be reason enough for
pressing Simon of Cyrene into service to carry the cross.

But another discovery must be mentioned which has some bearing on
the question. A little way east of the church, on a piece of ground
belonging to the Russians, the excavators passed through the remains
of some bazaars which were known to have existed there in the middle
ages, and below these they came upon a Byzantine pavement, which
appears to be the one laid down by Constantine around the buildings
which he erected. Thus it becomes morally certain that the Church of
the Holy Sepulchre stands on the spot where Constantine built his
church, believing it to be Calvary. But between the days of Christ and
the days of Constantine there was time and room for mistake to arise.
Jerusalem was destroyed in the year 70, the Christians did not return
to it until eighty years after, and by that time it might be difficult
to identify the sacred sites. When Constantine came to build his
church he found the site occupied by a temple of Venus, a circumstance
which may argue the traditional sacredness of the site, but scarcely
the tradition that it had been the Jewish place of execution. Major
Conder says he could devoutly wish that the site may turn out not to be
genuine, because it is disgraced by the scenes that occur there.

Passing through the doorway we enter the vestibule, in which is
the Stone of Unction, a slab of marble which is devoutly kissed by
pilgrims. Passing round it to the left, the rotunda of the church is
reached; to the right a narrow passage with small chapels runs behind
the apses of the Greek church, and here a flight of steps leads down
to the subterranean Chapel of Helena with its picturesque lighting and
heavy eighth century basketwork capitals. Beneath this, again, is the
dark cave so suggestively named the Chapel of the Invention of the
Cross. The rotunda is well lighted with a dome light blue in colour,
and covered with golden lilies and arabesques. In the centre rises the
old Chapel of the Sepulchre, dark and gloomy, of marble discoloured by
age, surmounted by a queer cupola of Italian taste, and ornamented all
along the top with gilt nosegays and modern-framed pictures. Stooping
to enter, we pass into the vestibule or Chapel of the Angel, walled
with marble slabs, and thence into the inner Chapel of the Sepulchre
itself, where the darkness is only relieved by the glowing lamps over
the altar on the tomb. The most impressive portion of the church is,
however, the nave east of the rotunda, belonging to the Greeks, with
its great screen in front of the three eastern apses. The floor is
unoccupied, save by the short column marking the “centre of the world.”
The dome above is poor, rudely whitewashed, and painted in fresco; but
the glory of the place consists in the large screen and the panelling
of the side walls.[47]

On Sundays the Christians of various churches--Greek, Latin, Armenian,
Coptic--hold their services simultaneously, under the dome and in the
side chapels which open off it. On one occasion when I was present
the Greek patriarch was preaching under the dome of the rotunda, at
the east end of the Chapel of the Sepulchre, when suddenly the Latins
struck up their instrumental music and singing, drowning the preacher’s
voice. I was prepared to sympathise with the Greeks, when presently
they formed a procession and marched round the rotunda, passing right
through a little band of Copts who were engaged in their own way of
worship at the west end of the Chapel of the Sepulchre. This want of
consideration for the members of other churches seemed so calculated
to lead to quarrels that I was not surprised to find a hundred Turkish
soldiers drawn up in front of the church to keep the peace. This was
a fortnight before Easter. At Easter time itself, when the so-called
miracle of the “holy fire” is enacted, and Christians of all churches
struggle with one another to be the first to light their tapers at
the sacred flame, quarrels do actually arise, and the place is a
pandemonium. Woe to the owner of the taper first lit; it is snatched
from him, and extinguished by having a dozen others thrust into it.
Strong men struggle with one another, and even delicate women and old
men fight like furies. We may well join with Conder in wishing that the
evidence may finally prove Calvary to have been somewhere else.

For some years past a site has been coming into favour, outside the
present north wall, not far from the Damascus Gate. Here is a rounded
knoll with a precipice on the south side of it, containing a cave
known to Christians as Jeremiah’s Grotto, from the tradition that
Jeremiah lived in it and composed his Lamentations there. When this
knoll is looked at from the south-east, especially from the southern
shoulder of the Mount of Olives, it appears to many observers to bear
a striking resemblance to a huge skull. As long ago as 1871, Mr Fisher
Howe of Brooklyn proposed the identification, in a little book called
“The True Site of Calvary,” published in New York.[48] Dr Chaplin and
Major Conder have given additional probability to it by bringing into
prominence the Jewish tradition which regards this knoll as the place
of public execution. When the death was by stoning, the condemned
person was hurled from the top of the cliff, which is about 50 feet
high, and if he was not killed by the fall, stones were cast at him
till he died. The place was called the House of Stoning, and Christian
tradition has regarded it as the place of the martyrdom of Stephen.
The circumstance that Jesus Christ was put to death in the Roman
manner, being crucified and not stoned, makes little difference to the
argument for the site of Calvary, since there is no reason to suppose
that Jerusalem possessed two places of execution. It may be added that
the surface of the knoll is now used as a Mohammedan burial ground;
and this may also have been its character in Jewish times. About 200
yards west of the Grotto, Conder made the interesting discovery of an
indisputably Jewish tomb judged to belong to the centuries immediately
preceding the Christian era. It would be bold to hazard the suggestion
that this is the very tomb in which the body of Christ was laid--the
new tomb in the garden belonging to Joseph of Arimathea--yet its
position so near the old place of execution is certainly remarkable.
“Thus,” says Conder, “to ‘a green hill far away, beside a city wall,’
we turn from the artificial rocks and marble slabs of the monkish
chapel of Calvary.”

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Tent Work.” Major Conder. “The
   Recovery of Jerusalem.” Colonels Warren and Wilson. “Sinai
   and Palestine.” Dean Stanley. “Walks about Jerusalem.” W.
   H. Bartlett. “Quarterly Statements of Palestine Exploration
   Fund.”]



                              CHAPTER V.

                      MESOPOTAMIA AND THE BIBLE.


                             1. _Assyria._

MESOPOTAMIA--“the Land between the Rivers”--is a tract of
country nearly 700 miles long, and from 20 to 250 miles broad, enclosed
between the Euphrates and the Tigris, and extending from the mountains
of Armenia to near the Persian Gulf. It is for the most part a vast
plain, but is crossed near its centre by a range of hills running
almost east and west-from Hit on the Euphrates, famous for its bitumen
pits, to Samarah on the Tigris. North of this line the country, though
dry and bare, is undulating, and rises occasionally into mountains,
while south of it the region is flat and consists of rich, moist,
alluvial land, formed by the rivers themselves. This land of alluvium
was Babylonia, and its capital Babylon; the country north of it was
Assyria, with its capital Nineveh. But the extent of both countries
varied from time to time, according to the power of various monarchs
and their successes in war.

The beginnings of the Assyrian and Babylonian empires are lost in
obscurity, and no records exist among the people themselves accounting
for their origin. Yet the account given in the Bible agrees so well
with what is known from the records that there can be no reasonable
doubt that in it there is a true history of the rise of these two
nations, which were in after time to wield the power of the then known
world. This Biblical account, borne out and amplified as it is by the
late discoveries, forms one of the most interesting and instructive
links in the history of the human race and its progress in civilisation.

“Taking, then, the account as it stands in the Bible,”[49] says Mr
Budge, “it appears that the descendants of Ham, the third son of Noah,
were Cush, Mizraim, Phut, and Canaan. The lands of Cush and Mizraim
have hitherto been identified with Ethiopia and Egypt respectively;
Phut was regarded as doubtful, and Canaan was the country with which
we are so well acquainted from the frequent occurrence of the name in
the Bible. The identification of the first-named and most important
of these districts, the land of Cush, has been regarded by many as
unsatisfactory: for Nimrod, judging from the names of towns said to
have been founded by him, could hardly have been an Ethiopian, though,
according to the Bible story, he was a descendant of Cush.”

Amongst the treasures of the Assyrian excavations there has luckily
been found a tablet, giving, in a list of the nations, &c., along the
Taurus range of mountains, a country bearing the name of Kusu, the same
word as is used in the inscriptions to denote the country of Ethiopia;
and from this and from other sources it is clear that two countries
of this name were known to the people of the ancient world, the one
being Ethiopia and the other Cappadocia or its immediate neighbourhood.
It seems therefore likely that Nimrod and his followers, for some
reason unrecorded, left his home in the land of Cush or Cappadocia,
and journeying in a south-easterly direction, came to the land of
Sumer or Shinar. There meeting perhaps with the Semitic population of
the country, he did not go any farther, but settled there with his
followers, and built Babylon, and Birs Nimroud, the supposed Tower of
Babel.

In course of time the new comers began to mingle with the original
(Semitic) inhabitants of the country, and both races were obliged,
for the purpose of trade and intercourse, to learn each other’s
language, so that there must have been for several hundreds of years
two tongues in use at the same time in Mesopotamia, and it was not
until the twelfth or even perhaps the tenth century before Christ, that
the Akkadian was entirely supplanted by the language of the Semitic
Babylonians. The Norman invasion in England is a case parallel to the
above, but with this difference, that whilst the invasion of England
by the Normans was a conquest, the entry of these people (afterwards
known as Akkadians and Sumerians) into Babylonia seems to have been
otherwise; and the Babylonian language, therefore, while admitting very
many Akkadian and Sumerian words, has not suffered, with regard to the
grammatical forms, to the same extent as the English language.

The entry of the Akkadians into Babylonia was the beginning of
civilisation in that country, for they brought with them, along with
their religion, their legends and traditions, their laws, their art,
building knowledge, agricultural skill, and that great civiliser of
nations, the art of writing. From this union of the intellectual
Akkadian race and the warlike Babylonians arose the two nations of whom
both tradition and history have preserved the record, as having been
the mightiest of the nations of the ancient world, namely, Babylonia
and Assyria, of whom so many tales are told, and whose power and high
civilisation amongst the barbarism of the early ages of the world made
so great an impression during the time of their supremacy.

After the mingling of these two races, but long before the Akkadian
language had died out, the Babylonians, as they will be henceforth
called, sent out colonies northwards and founded the great cities of
Assyria--Ninua (Nineveh), Resin, Kalhu (Calah), Assur, &c.

The religion of the Assyrians was derived from Babylonia, and remained
very similar to that of the latter country. Both countries worshipped
the same deities, but the Assyrians made some changes in the system,
especially in introducing the worship of Assur. Assur was worshipped
as “king of the gods,” “father of the gods,” “the deity who created
himself.” Among the other principal gods of the Assyrians were Nebo,
the god of writing; Merodach, or Bel, a companion deity to Nebo;
Shamas, the Sun-god, and Sin, the Moon-god; Ishtar, corresponding to
Venus; Nergal and Ninip, gods of hunting; Vul, the storm god, Anu, king
of heaven, and Hea, the lord of the under world.

The government of Assyria was monarchical, and the power of the king
was absolute, though in practice his rule was tempered by the advice of
counsellors. The commander-in-chief of the army was called the Tartan,
and here was also a high officer called the Rabshakeh (2 Kings xviii.
17). Judges decided cases in the gate of the temple or the palace, and
there was an appeal from them to the governor or king. The priests were
a privileged class; they lived on the revenues of the temples and the
offerings of worshippers. The Assyrian months were lunar, and the 7th,
14th, 21st, and 28th days were Sabbaths of rest: extra work and even
missions of mercy were forbidden, certain foods were not to be eaten,
and the king was not to ride in his chariot. The laws of the country
resembled in many respects those of Israel: a father was supreme in his
household, and a husband had the power of divorcing his wife. Slavery
was in vogue, and whole families were sometimes sold together. Various
trades were practised, including weaving, dyeing, manufacture of iron
goods, copper, and bronze goods, sculpture, and building, &c. But the
most remarkable feature of Assyrian civilisation was their literature
and libraries of clay tablets, and it is to these that we owe most of
our present knowledge of this great people.

Before the days of Moses there was friendly intercourse, as we have
seen, between Mesopotamia and Egypt. In later ages Assyria and Egypt
were frequently at war with one another. The hostile armies were
obliged to march through Palestine; and it became very difficult for
the kings of Israel and Judah to look on with equanimity and preserve a
strictly neutral attitude. Yet if they favoured one of the great powers
they of course gave umbrage to the other; besides which, Assyria, in
the days of its power, could hardly brook to leave any small kingdom
independent. At length Samaria was conquered, and its inhabitants
deported, by Shalmaneser or by Sargon; and afterwards Judea also, by
Nebuchadnezzar.

Speaking of the captivity of Israel in Babylonia as a providential
event, a great German writer, Lessing, says,--“When the child, by dint
of blows and caresses had come to years of understanding, the father
sent it at once into foreign countries, and here it recognised at once
the good which in its father’s house it had possessed but not been
conscious of.”[50] Again he says,--“The child, sent abroad, saw other
children, who knew more, who lived more becomingly, and asked itself in
confusion, why do I not know that too? why do I not live so too? ought
I not to have been taught and admonished of all this in my father’s
house?”

It is because of this sojourn abroad of the Jews, and the influence
of other nations upon them, that the exploration of these eastern
countries is a matter of such importance to Bible students. In Assyria,
Babylonia, and Egypt we get into by-paths of Bible history, and the old
records when unearthed, read sometimes like new chapters of the Bible.

The land of Mesopotamia, not inaptly called a graveyard of empires and
nations, is now neglected and desolate, under Turkish misrule. “The
monotony of the landscape would be unbroken” (says Zénaïde A. Ragozin)
“but for certain elevations and hillocks of strange and varied shapes,
which dot the plain in every direction; some are high and conical
or pyramidal in form, others are quite extensive and rather flat on
the summit, others again long and low, and all curiously unconnected
with each other or with any ridge of hills. This is doubly striking
in Lower Mesopotamia or Babylonia, proverbial for its excessive
flatness. The few permanent villages, composed of mud-huts or plaited
reed-cabins, are generally built on these eminences; but others are
used as burying-grounds, and a mosque, the Mohammedan house of prayer,
sometimes rises on one or the other. The substance of these mounds
being rather soft and yielding, their sides are still furrowed in many
places with ravines, worn by the rushing streams of rain-water. The
rubbish washed away lies scattered on the plain, and is seen to contain
fragments of bricks and pottery, sometimes inscribed with arrow-headed
characters; in the ravines themselves are laid bare whole sides of
walls of brickwork and pieces of sculptured stone.”

The Arabs never thought of exploring these curious heaps. Their
law forbids them to represent the human form either in painting or
sculpture, lest it should lead the ignorant into idolatry. They are
superstitious, and look on relics of ancient statuary with suspicion
amounting to fear, and connect them with magic and witchcraft. It is
therefore with awe not devoid of horror that they tell travellers of
underground passages in the mounds, haunted not only by wild beasts,
but by evil spirits, strange figures having been dimly perceived in
the crevices. Better instructed foreigners have long ago assumed that
within these mounds must be entombed whatever ruins and relics may be
preserved of the great cities of yore.

The first European whose love of learning was strong enough to make
him disregard difficulty and expense, and use the pick-axe upon these
mounds, was an Englishman named Rich. This was in 1820: but Mr Rich was
not very successful, and it was literally true that up to 1842, “a
case 3 feet square enclosed all that remained, not only of the great
city Nineveh, but of Babylon itself.” In 1842 M. Botta, a French Consul
stationed at Mosul on the Tigris, began to dig, and after fruitless
labour at the mound of Kouyunjik, opposite Mosul, was directed by a
native to Khorsabad, and there, on cutting a trench, entered a hall
lined all round with sculptured slabs, representing battles, sieges,
and similar events. A new and wonderful world was suddenly opened, and
he walked as in a dream. The discovery created an immense sensation
in Europe, and the spirit of research and enterprise was effectually
aroused.

  [Illustration: MAP of the ASSYRIAN EMPIRE AND SURROUNDING COUNTRIES

      _London; Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co._

      _F.S. Weller, F.S.G.S._]

The investigation was soon taken up by Mr Austen Henry Layard, our own
countryman, and the objects found were brought to the British Museum,
which now boasts a splendid collection. After getting over preliminary
difficulties--the interesting story of which may be found in his
volumes on “Nineveh and its Remains”--Mr Layard obtained a grant of
money from the Museum, with full licence from the Turkish Government,
and then succeeded in organizing a band of Arabs to work willingly and
well, and from that moment made new discoveries every day.

One morning, as he was going to the scene of operations--they were
digging in the mound of Nimroud--two Arabs galloped up to him, and
said, “Hasten, O Bey, hasten to the diggers, for they have found Nimrod
himself! Wallah, it is wonderful, but it is true; we have seen him with
our eyes! There is no God but God!” What they had seen was a sculptured
human head, which, upon removing more earth, was seen to belong to a
winged quadruped--one of those colossal “bulls” since deposited at the
British Museum. A “bull” we say, but really a monster with the body of
a bull (sometimes the body of a lion), the head of a man, and the wings
of an eagle--the Assyrian idea of the cherubim. Many of these objects
were surrounded by writing in the curious cuneiform or arrow-headed
character.

  [Illustration: WINGED HUMAN-HEADED BULL. (N.-W. Palace,
  Nimrod.)]

Besides these so-called bulls, Mr Layard found obelisks of black
basalt, with figures in low relief representing tribute being
brought to the Assyrian kings. On the black obelisk in the British
Museum--found in the central mound of Nimroud, amid the ruins of
Shalmaneser’s palace--occurs the name and figure of Jehu, king of
Israel, as bringing tribute to Shalmaneser II. (about B.C.
842). “I have received the tribute of Jehu, the son of Omri; silver,
gold, bowls of gold, chalices of gold, cups of gold, pails of gold,
lead, sceptres for the hand of the king, (and) spear-shafts.” The
mistake indeed is made of calling him “Jehu, son of Omri;” Jehu sat
upon the throne of Omri, but he was a usurper and not of Omri’s
house. The tribute bearers on this obelisk carry golden cups and
goblets, bars of the precious metals, and other valuable things.
Rev. H. G. Tomkins, speaking of these Assyrian sculptured portraits
of Jehu and his princes, says they have “strong aquiline features,
and that peculiar shrug or quirk of the nostril which gives a shrewd
and sinister look to many a Jew of London streets. In drawing one of
these familiar faces from the monument, I was ready to believe that it
belonged to a lineal ancestor of the London ‘Clo’ men.’ The bag falling
down the stooping back deepened this impression.”[51]

  [Illustration: BLACK OBELISK.]

In addition to these things Mr Layard brought home a large number of
alabaster slabs sculptured with battle scenes, lion hunts, and the
representation of sacred trees to which winged figures are making
mysterious offerings. It was the custom of these Assyrian kings to have
the halls and chambers of their palaces lined with plain alabaster
slabs, and after each new victory to have the story engraved in a
separate room, so that in one chamber we get an account of a battle
in Babylonia, in another the story of the siege of Lachish near the
Philistine country, and so on.

But the reader--who has no doubt visited the British Museum and looked
at all these things--may perhaps ask why we repeat the familiar story.
It is in order to give completeness to the picture, and also to induce
young visitors to the Museum to look _into_ things as well as look at
them. Where did the antiquities come from? How have the inscriptions
been deciphered? What do they say? Although many of them were brought
to the Museum years ago, the writing was not immediately read; the
process of decipherment is still going on, and hardly a year passes
without startling discoveries being made in the Museum itself. In the
year 1872 Mr George Smith there, taking up a clay tablet that had been
neglected, deciphered the inscription, and found it to be the Chaldean
story of the Flood. In 1873, going out to Assyria for the purpose,
he actually discovered the missing portion of the tablet. Such facts
are intensely interesting to the student of the Scriptures, and they
attract us to give a portion of our attention to the legends and the
literature of the Assyrians and the Chaldeans.

Nineveh, we read, was a city of three days’ journey. It actually
extended 20 miles in length by 10 miles in breadth, and was surrounded
by a great wall upon which three chariots could be driven abreast.[52]
Within this circumference great mounds exist, as those referred to
at Nimroud, Khorsabad, and Kouyunjik. Within these mounds have been
discovered six palaces and three temples; although only one of these
buildings--the palace of Sennacherib, at Kouyunjik--is in a decent
state of preservation. The restoration of this structure by Mr J.
Ferguson, the architect, prefixed as an illustration to Layard’s
“Nineveh,” shows it to have been a very magnificent pile. A second
palace found at Kouyunjik belonged to Assurbanipal, the grandson of
Sennacherib.

  [Illustration: SENNACHERIB BEFORE LACHISH.]

Sennacherib himself we are familiar with through the Bible. He was that
monarch who so terrified the good king Hezekiah, when he sent him a
blasphemous message and threatened to come and destroy Jerusalem. What
the Jews of Jerusalem had to fear if he should come they knew too well;
and we know now, for Sennacherib had been besieging Lachish (2 Kings
xviii.; Isaiah xxxvi.) in Palestine, and we have recovered the record
of that siege. It is inscribed on one of the bulls discovered at the
largest of the royal buildings, and shows the monarch seated on his
throne, while the writing around him says, “I, Sennacherib, the great
king, the king of Assyria, seated on the throne of judgment before
Lachish, I give permission for the slaughter.” Before him are the
miserable captives, having rings fixed into their noses or lips, with
bridles attached, so that their heads may be held facing forward while
the king puts out their eyes with a pointed instrument. Captives are
there having their tongues torn out, others being stripped naked and
flayed alive, while human heads are piled up into pyramids.

All these tortures the Jews themselves had to fear if Sennacherib
should take Jerusalem. It was doubtless a day of terrible suspense in
the Holy City, and a night in which few dared go to sleep. But the
early morning brought the tidings that the army of Sennacherib was
destroyed, that the angel of the Lord had gone forth and slain in the
camp of the Assyrians a hundred four score and five thousand men. We
knew the Scripture story of the deliverance, but we can realise it
better now when we have the record of the siege of Lachish, and know
what fate threatened the Jews of Jerusalem.

Moreover, we have recovered Sennacherib’s own account of this very
campaign, in which he tells us that he had taken forty-six fenced
cities in Judea, and that he shut up Hezekiah in Jerusalem “like a bird
in a cage.” He forbears to tell us why he failed to capture the bird;
he glosses over the disaster which befell his army; and he seems even
to misrepresent the facts by declaring that, after this, Hezekiah sent
him splendid presents to Babylon, for the presents of Hezekiah were
sent before this, when Sennacherib was down by Lachish, and sent with
the hope of buying him off, which there was no need to do after his
retreat.

A great difficulty in the Book of the Prophet Isaiah is also
satisfactorily cleared up by these inscriptions. Sennacherib, coming
from the Philistine country to Jerusalem, would have to travel from the
south-west, whereas, in an earlier chapter, Isaiah had told us that the
Assyrian invader came down from the north, that he captured Carchemish
in his way, and conquered Damascus, and took Samaria, and then, after
crossing the gorge at Michmash, encamped at Nob, outside Jerusalem on
the north. Moreover, the prophet intimates, he is likely to take the
city; whereas, in the later chapter, he says, “He shall not take it,
nor so much as shoot an arrow against it.” It was a great difficulty,
and it appeared to be a contradiction; but it is now satisfactorily
explained, for we find from the Assyrian inscriptions that there
had been an earlier campaign, conducted by Sargon, the father of
Sennacherib, ten years before, and that he it was who actually came by
the northerly route, and did capture Carchemish, &c., on his way. There
can be no doubt that if we read the 10th chapter of Isaiah with Sargon
in our minds, and not Sennacherib, all difficulty disappears.

In the 20th chapter of Isaiah there is an incidental mention of this
Sargon, “In the year that the Tartan (_i.e._, the commander-in-chief)
came unto Ashdod, when Sargon, the king of Assyria, sent him,” &c.;
and for twenty-five centuries this had been the only evidence that
any such monarch had lived. Not unnaturally the evidence was thought
insufficient--this isolated reference standing like a doubtful fossil
in old-world rocks--and many historians and critics wished to identify
Sargon with Shalmaneser, Sennacherib, or Esarhaddon. Some said that
Isaiah had made a mistake. But Nineveh is disinterred, and it turns
out that Sargon was a very great king, and not even the first of that
name, for there had been two Sargons, heroes of antiquity, before him.
M. Botta finds at Khorsabad the palace of Sargon; and it appears that
he was the successor of Shalmaneser, he was the father of Sennacherib,
and he reigned for seventeen years. Among the treasures which Mr George
Smith recovered from the ruins of Nineveh is the royal seal of Sargon,
with his name and date.

As soon as Sargon ascended the throne he prosecuted the Syrian war with
vigour, keeping up the siege of Tyre, storming the city of Samaria,
and subduing the whole country of Israel. The kingdom of Samaria was
put an end to, the people being carried into captivity and spread over
the northern provinces of the Assyrian empire and in the cities of the
Medes. It appears to be Sargon who is referred to in 2 Kings xvii. 6,
and xviii. 11 (although the passages had hitherto been understood of
Shalmaneser), where “the king of Assyria” took Samaria and carried
Israel away, placing in their cities men from Babylon, from Cuthah,
from Avva and Hamath and Sepharvaim.

In the eleventh year of Sargon the people of Ashdod in Philistia
deposed the ruler whom Sargon had placed over them, and set up a man
named Yavan, whose chief recommendation was his hostility to Assyria.
Yavan made league with Hezekiah, king of Judah, with Moab, and with
Edom, and led the Philistines to revolt. The leaguers sent an embassy
to Egypt, asking aid, and Pharaoh held out encouragements, but did not
give any assistance when the hour of danger came. Sargon, learning of
the revolt, came to Palestine; Yavan fled into Egypt, the rebellion
collapsed, and the cities of Ashdod and Gimtu were taken by the
Assyrians. Yavan ultimately delivered himself up to the king of Meroe,
or Ethiopia, who bound him and sent him in chains to Sargon.

The expedition against Ashdod took place in B.C. 711, during
the reign of Hezekiah, king of Judah, and is the one referred to in the
twentieth chapter of Isaiah, where the prophet denounces the conduct
of Egypt. The way in which Isaiah speaks of the Egyptians and the
Ethiopians, in this and other chapters, is remarkably justified by the
account given in the Assyrian inscriptions. Egypt is described in the
annals of Sargon as a weak power, always stirring up revolts against
Assyria, and unable to help or shield the revolters. “In those days”
(remarks Mr George Smith, from whose larger work we are here quoting)
“Egypt was truly a broken reed. The account which Sargon gives of the
turning of the fountains and water-courses to protect the city of
Ashdod strikingly parallels the similar preparations of Hezekiah (2
Chron. xxxii.); and it is a curious fact that Hezekiah’s preparations
had been made only two years before, according to the ordinary
chronology.”

As remarked by Mr St Chad Boscawen, the political significance of the
embassy of Berodach Baladan (2 Kings xx. 12) is at once apparent when
viewed in the light of the monumental inscriptions; and the atmosphere
of intrigue, rebellion, and stern vengeance is very clearly apparent in
the writings both of the Hebrew and the Assyrian scribe. It was this
embassy, in B.C. 712, which brought about the invasion of
Judea and the siege of Jerusalem in B.C. 711, by Sargon. The
prophecies of Isaiah (chapters x. and xi.), so long unsolved mysteries,
are now found to be clear and detailed records of this lost incident in
Oriental history.

“Sargon” claimed descent from an ancient hero named Bel-bani; and he
assumed the name of an old Babylonian monarch--Sargon of Agadé, who was
worshipped as a demi-god--but his own name was not really Sargon. When
he stormed the city of Samaria, he carried away, he tells us, 27,000 of
the Israelites into captivity. The kingdom of Samaria was suppressed,
and those Israelites who were not deported were placed under an
Assyrian governor. Thus the Bible account of the captivity of the ten
tribes is confirmed. And as to Judah, when we come to the Babylonian
annals of the conquest by Nebuchadnezzar, we find confirmation of the
statement that he destroyed Jerusalem, and carried the inhabitants of
that city into captivity.

These, then, are some instances of the light that is being thrown upon
the Scriptures by these Assyrian writings--of the manner in which
the Bible narrative is being filled out and illustrated with new and
copious details, and on the whole, as all critics are bound to say, is
being confirmed in its statements.

Besides Ahab and Omri, Jehu and Hezekiah, the cuneiform tablets mention
Menahem, Pekah, and Hoshea, kings of Israel; and Azariah, Ahaz, and
Manasseh, kings of Judah. Ahaz is called Jehoahaz, his name, like so
many more, being compounded with the name of Jehovah; and it would
seem that on account of his perversion to foreign worship the Bible
writers would not use the Lord’s name in such association. Further,
the kings of Assyria and Babylon spoken of in the Bible come before us
again in the cuneiform texts, with many particulars of their warlike
expeditions,--Sennacherib, Esarhaddon, Shalmaneser, Tiglath-Pileser,
Nebuchadnezzar, &c. Tiglath-Pileser, we find, was not the first of
that name, for there had been a monarch so designated as early as
1300 B.C. In fact the real name of the later king was Pul or
Pulu, and it is doubtful whether he was the rightful heir; but when
he ascended the throne (in B.C. 745) he took the name of the
earlier conqueror, a circumstance which led the Bible writer to suppose
there were two kings. [S. A. Strong, in “Records of the Past.” New
Series. Vol. v.]

The other palace found at Kouyunjik belonged, as stated before, to
Assurbanipal. He was the Sardanapalus of Greek writers and was a
great conqueror. His date is about 640 B.C. Mr Rassam, the
native co-worker with Mr Layard, was fortunate enough to discover
Assurbanipal’s library--the library of the Assyrian kings. The “books”
of the Assyrians differed very much from our own. They used to take
a tablet of clay, to write upon it with an iron stylus, bake it into
terra cotta, and then place the record on the library shelf. These clay
tablets were more durable than leaves of paper or rolls of parchment,
and the Assyrian records, covered up more than two thousand years ago,
are in many cases so well preserved that scholars can read them.

As progress was made in deciphering the inscriptions, it was found
that new and remarkable light was being obtained regarding the history
and civilisation of half-forgotten empires. Collections of inscribed
tablets had been made by Tiglath-Pileser II. (B.C. 745), who
had copied some historical inscriptions of his predecessors. Sargon,
the father of Sennacherib (B.C. 722), had increased this
library by adding a collection of astrological and similar texts; and
Sennacherib himself (B.C. 705) had composed copies of the
Assyrian canon, short histories, and miscellaneous inscriptions to
add to the collection. Sennacherib also moved the library from Calah,
its original seat, to Nineveh, the capital; and Esarhaddon, the son
of Sennacherib, added numerous historical and mythological texts. All
the inscriptions of the former kings, however, were nothing compared
to those written during the reign of Assurbanipal, the grandson of
Sennacherib, who not only recorded the events of his own reign, but
collected literature from other countries, and caused translations to
be made of Babylonian records which were then ancient. Thousands of
inscribed tablets were collected and copied, and stored in the royal
library at Nineveh; and it is this royal library which has been found.

The amount of Assyrian literature now in our possession is more
than equal to the entire contents of the Old Testament. It includes
religion, astronomy, mythology, history, geography, natural history,
royal decrees and private letters, legal decisions and deeds of sale,
lists of tributes and taxes, precepts for private life, &c. Among
the sacred legends are stories of the Creation and the Deluge. These
narratives did not originate with the Assyrians, for they received
their religious system by inheritance from the Babylonians. But neither
did they originate with the Babylonians; for we learn from their own
records that this learning and these traditions were brought into their
country by the Akkadians.

Assurbanipal, when he made raids into Babylonia and captured a city,
would carry off the sacred writings to enrich the royal library at
Nineveh. When they were brought to Nineveh they were copied by the
priests, and they were sometimes translated into the Assyrian tongue,
although Assyrians who professed to be well educated used to learn the
Akkadian language, much as English boys learn Latin, or theological
students study Hebrew and read the writings in the original. It is
very interesting to find that these old Assyrians and these ancient
Chaldeans had their own version of the Creation, the Deluge, the
Building of Babel, &c., which they venerated as being ancient even
then, and regarded as most sacred.

The Chaldean narratives differed in minor particulars from those in
the Bible. The Chaldean Deluge, for instance, lasted only seven days,
instead of the greater part of a year; the vessel was not an ark, but a
ship, of proper ship shape, with a pilot on board to navigate it, and
other people on board besides the family of Noah. The Chaldean Noah,
when the waters were subsiding, sent out not only a raven and a dove,
but a swallow as well; and in the end of the event he was translated
that he should not see death; and this in the Bible does not occur to
Noah, but to Enoch. Nevertheless, with these and other differences, we
have the grand fact that the cycle of narratives preserved in the early
chapters of Genesis are not mere ingenious inventions on the part of
Hebrew writers, but had their parallel in early Chaldea. The key to
their exact meaning is for the present lost; but we may hope that it
will be recovered, and then there will be an end to the controversy
between Geology and Genesis.


                            2. _Babylonia._

Babylonia comprehended the country from near the Lower Zab to the
Persian Gulf, about 400 miles long; and from Elam, east of the Tigris,
to the Arabian Desert, west of the Euphrates, an average breadth of 150
miles.

Its history begins very early, for one of its kings--Sargon of
Accad--is believed to have reigned in 3800 B.C. The circumstance to
which we owe the discovery of this remarkable fact is thus related
in Dr Sayce’s “Hibbert Lectures”: “The last king of Babylonia,
Nabonidos, had antiquarian tastes, and busied himself not only with
the restoration of the old temples of his country, but also with
the disinterment of the memorial cylinders which their builders and
restorers had buried beneath their foundations. It was known that the
great temple of the Sun-god at Sippara, where the mounds of Abu-Hubba
now mark its remains, had been originally erected by Naram-Sin,
the son of Sargon, and attempts had been already made to find the
records which, it was assumed, he had entombed under its angles. With
true antiquarian zeal Nabonidos continued the search, and did not
desist until, like the dean and chapter of some modern cathedral,
he had lighted upon ‘the foundation stone’ of Naram-Sin himself.
This foundation-stone, he tells us, had been seen by none of his
predecessors for 3200 years. In the opinion, accordingly, of Nabonidos,
a king who was curious about the past history of his country, and whose
royal position gave him the best possible opportunities for learning
all that could be known about it, Naram-Sin and his father, Sargon I.,
lived 3200 years before his own time, or 3750 B.C.”

The date is so remote and so contrary to all our preconceived ideas
regarding the antiquity of the Babylonian monarchy, that it was not
received without hesitation; but it appears to be supported by other
evidence, and is now generally accepted. It is believed, indeed, that
the monuments found at _Tell-lo_, including statues of diorite, a
material foreign to Babylonia, are earlier still, and must be regarded
as pre-Semitic.

It may be asked, what interest can we have in people and things so
remote? the Babylonians and their religion have long since perished,
and have no influence upon the world of to-day. To this it is replied
that through the providential circumstances of the Captivity the Jews
were brought into contact with the Babylonians; the Jewish religion
in its turn influenced Christianity, and all Christians should be
concerned to know what the Jews learned in their exile. In the view of
Hebrew prophets the Jews were “sent into foreign countries” to receive
education and discipline; the Assyrian conqueror was the rod of God’s
anger (Isaiah x. 5), and the Babylonish exile was the punishment meted
out to Judah for its sins. The captives who returned again to their
own land came back with changed hearts and purified minds, intent upon
re-establishing Jerusalem as the home of a righteous people. And they
had done something more than learn to abominate idolatry, they had been
led to weigh the value of the religious beliefs and practices of the
nations they had lived with during seventy years.

But it was not only through the Babylonian exile that the religious
ideas of the Babylonian and the Jew came into contact with each
other. “It was then, indeed” (says Dr Sayce), “that the ideas of the
conquering race were likely to make their deepest and most enduring
impression; it was then, too, that the Jew for the first time found the
libraries and ancient literature of Chaldea open to his study and use.”
But old tradition had already pointed to the valley of the Euphrates
as the primeval cradle of his race. We all remember how Abraham, it is
said, was born in Ur of the Chaldees, and how the earlier chapters of
Genesis make the Euphrates and Tigris two of the rivers of Paradise,
and describe the building of the tower of Babylon as the cause of the
dispersion of mankind. Now the Hebrew language was the language not
only of the Israelites, but also of those earlier inhabitants of the
country whom the Jews called Canaanites and the Greeks Phœnicians. Like
the Israelites, the Phœnicians held that their ancestors had come from
the Persian Gulf and the alluvial Plain of Babylonia. The tradition is
confirmed by the researches of comparative philology. Their first home
appears to have been in the low-lying desert which stretches eastward
to Chaldea--in the very region, in fact, in which stood the great city
of Ur, the modern Mugheir.

The earliest known kings of Shumir resided in Ur, and besides that,
it was the principal commercial mart of the country. For, strange as
it may appear, when we look on a modern map, and observe the ruins
150 miles from the sea, Ur was then a maritime city, with harbour and
docks. Through the accumulation of alluvium brought down by the two
great rivers, the Babylonian territory has steadily increased from age
to age, and the waters of the Gulf have been pushed back. There was, in
early times, a distance of many miles between the mouths of the Tigris
and Euphrates, and Ur lay very near the mouth of the latter river. The
platform of the principal mound which marks the site is faced with a
wall 10 feet thick, of red kiln-dried bricks, cemented with bitumen.
The mound has something of the shape of a pear, and measures about 2
miles in circumference. This mound representing the town, the suburban
district is full of graves of all ages, showing the long period through
which the city flourished.

It appears from the inscriptions found at Ur that the city was devoted
to the worship of the Moon-god Sin, frequently called “the god Thirty,”
in allusion to his function as the measurer of time by months. Here
stood the great temple of the god, which was partially explored by Mr
K. Loftus--a temple built in stages, of which two remain. The bricks of
the temple are inscribed with the name of Ur-Bagas, its founder, the
first monarch of united Babylonia of whom we know. Some of the hymns
used in the ritual service of the temple, or at any rate composed in
honour of the god, were obtained by Assurbanipal, and translated by
his scribes out of the Akkadian language into the Assyrian. One of them
begins thus:--

“Lord and prince of the gods who in heaven and earth alone is supreme!

“Father Nannar, Lord of the firmament, prince of the gods!

“Father Nannar, Lord of heaven, mighty one, prince of the gods!

“Father Nannar, Lord of the moon, prince of the gods!”

It was from a city where such hymns were repeated in praise of the
Moon-god that Abraham was called to rise up and go forth. With Terah,
his father, and a tribe of servants and adherents, he started for new
lands.

The distance from Ur of the Chaldees to Haran in northern Mesopotamia
was considerable, but it lay along the line of the river and by the
common route of travel. It is remarkable that Haran, like Ur, was a
city of the Moon-god, who appears at one time to have taken primary
rank among the Babylonians. Nabonidos restored the temple at Haran,
and it is thus that he celebrates the event:--“May the gods who
dwell in heaven and earth approach the house of Sin, the father who
created them. As for me, Nabonidos, king of Babylon, the completer
of this temple, may Sin, the king of the gods of heaven and earth,
in the lifting up of his kindly eyes, with joy look upon me month by
month at noon and sunset: may he grant me favourable tokens, may he
lengthen my days, may he extend my years, may he establish my reign,
may he overcome my foes, may he slay my enemies, may he sweep away my
opponents. May Nin-gal, the mother of the mighty gods, in the presence
of Sin, her loved one, speak like a mother. May Samas and Istar, the
bright offspring of his heart, to Sin, the father who begat them, speak
of blessing. May Nuzku, the messenger supreme, hearken to my prayer and
plead for me.”

There would seem to be as much reason for Abraham to leave Haran as
there was for his leaving Ur; and the Bible actually represents the
stay in Haran as only a stage in the migration. Canaan was the land
which God had “told him of;” and there, building altars successively
at Shechem and Bethel and in the oak-grove of Mamre, he realized that
the Lord could be approached in every place by those who worshipped in
spirit and in truth.

Terah and Abraham had come out of Chaldea with a large family and
numerous following. “For years,” says Ragozin, “the tribe travelled
without dividing, from pasture to pasture, over the land of Canaan,
into Egypt and out of it again, until the quarrel occurred between
Abraham’s herdsmen and Lot’s, when Lot chose the Plain of the Jordan
and Abraham remained in the centre of the country. After the battle
of four kings against five, in the Vale of Siddim, when Lot was taken
prisoner, Abraham pursued the victorious army, now carelessly marching
homewards, with its long train of captives and booty, and produced a
panic among them by a sudden and vigorous onslaught. Not only was Lot
rescued, with his women folk and his goods, but all the captured goods
and people were brought back too. Chedorlaomer, of whom the spirited
Bible narrative gives us so life-like a sketch, lived, according to the
most probable calculations, about 2200 B.C. In the cuneiform
inscriptions he is called Khudur-Lagamar; and among the few vague forms
whose blurred outlines loom out of the twilight of those dim ages, he
is the second with any flesh and blood reality about him, probably the
first, conqueror of whom the world has any authentic record.”

It is supposed that the “Amraphel, king of Shinar,” who marched with
Khudur-Lagamar as his ally, was no other than a king of Babylon, one
of whose names has been read Amarpal, while “Ariokh of Ellassar” was
an Elamite, Eriaku, brother or cousin of Khudur-Lagamar and king of
Larsam. At Larsam the Elamite conquerors had established a powerful
dynasty, closely allied by blood to the principal one, which had made
the venerable Ur its headquarters.

Babylon was a very ancient city of Babylonia, and is first mentioned
in the inscriptions of Izdhubar,[53] a mythical hero, whose name is
connected with the Chaldean story of the Flood. It remained for some
centuries of secondary importance, but became at length the capital
of the country. The native name, Bab-ilu, signifies the Gate-of-God,
corresponding to Beth-el, the House of God, in the land of Palestine.
According to Herodotus, the city stood in a broad plain, and was an
exact square, measuring 15 miles each way. It was surrounded, he says,
by a broad and deep moat, full of water, behind which rose a wall 50
royal cubits in breadth and 200 in height. In digging the moat the
alluvial clay was at once made into bricks and baked in kilns; and with
these the walls were built, the cement being hot bitumen. “On the top,
along the edges of the wall, they constructed buildings of a single
chamber, facing one another, leaving between them room for a four-horse
chariot to turn. In the circuit of the wall are a hundred gates of
brass, with brazen lintels and side-posts.”

The broad stream of the Euphrates passed through the city, dividing
it into two parts, and the centre of each division was occupied by a
fortress. In the one stood the palace of the kings, surrounded by a
wall of great strength and size; in the other was the sacred precinct
of Jupiter Belus, a square enclosure, 2 furlongs each way, with gates
of solid brass. “In the middle of the precinct,” says Herodotus, “there
was a tower of solid masonry, a furlong in length and breadth, upon
which was raised a second tower, and on that a third, and so on up to
eight. The ascent to the top is on the outside, by a path which winds
round all the towers.... On the topmost tower there is a spacious
temple, and inside the temple stands a couch of unusual size, richly
adorned, with a golden table by its side. Below, in the same precinct,
there is a second temple, in which is a sitting figure of Jupiter, all
of gold.” Other historians make the circuit of the city from 45 to 48
miles, instead of 60; and it is hardly necessary to say that modern
writers question both its extent and the height of its walls.

The god whom Herodotus calls Jupiter-Belus was Bel-Merodach. Babylon
was called “the dwelling-place of Bel” and the “town of Marduk.” The
temple of Bel is represented by the ruin of Babil, a mound on the
eastern side of the stream. Some writers believe this to be the site
of the Tower of Babel. Others, including Sir Henry Rawlinson, have
identified the Babel tower with the ruin of Birs Nimroud, the ancient
Borsippa, on the western side of the river. Birs Nimroud is one of the
most imposing ruins in the country, standing in the midst of a vast
plain, with nothing to break the view. Sir H. Rawlinson excavated at
the site, and discovered that the tower was built in seven stages, the
material being brickwork on an earthen platform. The first stage was an
exact square, 272 feet each way, and 26 feet high, the bricks blackened
with bitumen. The higher stages were of course successively smaller,
but they were not placed in the centre of those on which they rested,
but considerably nearer to the south-western end which constituted the
back of the building. The bricks of the lowest stage being blackened,
those of the second stage were orange-coloured, of the third red, the
fourth it is supposed were plated with gold. Seven colours were used,
emblematic of the planets, and the building was called the Temple of
the Seven Spheres. On the seventh stage there was probably placed the
ark or tabernacle, which seems to have been again 15 feet high, and
must have nearly covered the top of the seventh story. This temple was
sacred to Nebo, the Babylonian Mercury, the inventor of the alphabet,
“the writer,” “the prophet,” “the author of the oracle.” Assurbanipal
is never weary of telling us, at the end of the documents which his
scribes had copied from Babylonian originals, that Nebo and Tasmit had
given him broad ears, and endowed him with seeing eyes, so that he had
written and bound together and published the store of tablets, a work
which none of the kings who had gone before him had undertaken, even
the secrets of Nebo!

From receptacles at the corners of the stages above described, Sir H.
Rawlinson obtained inscribed cylinders, stating that the building was
the Temple of the Seven Planets, which had been partially built by a
former king of Babylon, and having fallen into decay, was restored and
completed by Nebuchadnezzar. It was at Birs Nimroud that Mr Hormuzd
Rassam found a leaf of metal with some writing on it, which proved to
be a dedication by Nebuchadnezzar to the god Nebo for his restoration
to health. If this relates to Nebuchadnezzar’s recovery from his
madness, it is an interesting confirmation of the story in the Book of
Daniel.

“The secrets of Nebo” referred to by Assurbanipal, were astronomical
records and other writings stored up in Nebo’s temple. The religion
of the Babylonians was based on a study of the heavenly bodies, and
was so intimately connected with astronomy that it was necessary
for the priests to be astronomers. There were observatories at the
principal temples; observations of the heavens were regularly made,
and naturally the records were preserved in the temple chambers, and
became the nucleus of large libraries. It was the good fortune of Mr
Rassam to discover one of the most important of these libraries, at
Abu Hubba--about 30 miles south-east from Bagdad--on one of the canals
branching eastward from the Euphrates. Abu Hubba proves to be the
ancient Sippara, the Biblical Sepharvaim, whence some of the people
were taken, to re-people Samaria after the ten tribes of Israel were
carried away. The Hebrew name being in the dual form, and signifying
the two Sippars, we look for duality in the ruins, and we find them
actually on the two sides of the stream. Sippara, we knew from Berosus,
was a great seat of sun-worship; the temple of the god Shamas was here,
and it was here that Xisuthrus, the Chaldean Noah, was said to have
buried the records of the antediluvian world. The explorations of Mr
Rassam have restored to us the remains of the Sun-god’s temple.

The citadel occupies the southern portion of the _enceinte_, and its
highest point on the south-west face was once on the banks of a stream,
either the Euphrates itself or a broad canal communicating with the
river. The trenches excavated in the mound soon struck the walls of a
building, and by following the line of this wall the outer face of a
large square edifice was uncovered. Trenches and shafts sunk in the
interior showed that within the outer rampart there were more than
one hundred chambers ranged round a central court. In the central
portion of the mound an important pair of chambers were found, and in
the centre of one of them a large brick altar platform, about 30 feet
square, upon which it was evident that the altar of burnt-offering
had stood, for there were charred fragments about. The axis of this
chamber was north-east and south-west, and at the north-east end a
doorway was found, leading into a smaller chamber, the floor of which
was paved with a material resembling asphalt. Under this floor Mr
Rassam discovered a terra cotta box containing three inscribed records,
namely, a stone tablet with a sculptured panel, representing the
worship of the Sun-god, and two cylinders. The cylinders were found
to bear inscriptions of Nabonidos, king of Babylon, B.C. 555,
recording the restoration of this temple in the year B.C.
550; and the stone tablet bore a long and important record of the
restoration of the temple by Nabu-abla-iddina, king of Babylon, whose
date may be given as about B.C. 852. Above the figure of the
Sun-god on this tablet were the words--“The statue of the Sun-god--the
great lord--dwelling in the House of Light, which is within the city of
Sippara.” But the statue and other objects of value had been removed.
From the cylinder of Nabonidos, as previously stated, we learn that the
temple had been restored by Naram-Sin, the son of Sargon I., in the
year 3750 B.C. It was of very great interest to find in the
lower strata of the temple area a small ovoid of pink and white marble,
bearing an inscription of Sargon I., of such archaic character as to
appear to confirm this date.

The temple was called by many titles--as, “Palace of the God,” “High
Place,” “Dwelling of the God,” “Resting-Place of the God,”--and,
among others, the “House of God,” in Akkadian, E-Din-gira, in Semitic
Babylonian, Bit-ilu, in Hebrew, Bethel.

The city of Akkad or Agadé, built by Sargon I., seems to have been a
part of the double Sippara, and here Sargon founded the celebrated
library which contained among its treasures a great work on astronomy
and astrology, in seventy books. Around this nucleus other writings
aggregated, and the temple of Shamas became the great record office
of the state. Mr Rassam found at Abu Hubba some thousands of tablets
relating to fiscal, legal, and commercial transactions; and it would
thus appear that all documents of this character were preserved by
the priests. A remarkable example of the careful preservation of the
writings committed to their charge was furnished in the course of the
excavations. On the south-east side of the large quadrangle was a
smaller square, in which were a series of chambers, evidently offices
of the temple. In one of these over 30,000 tablets were found stored.
They were packed by Mr Rassam as he found them, and removed to England
without any disturbance of their order; and when the cases came to be
examined it was found that the majority of the tablets were arranged
chronologically. Ranging as these tablets did from B.C. 625
to B.C. 200, they must have lain for nearly 2000 years quite
undisturbed in the ruins.

A Babylonian temple was also the court of justice, and as the Jewish
Sanhedrim met in the temple at Jerusalem, so did the council of the
grey-haired ones meet in the courts of Chaldean temples to answer
judgment. Dr Oppert has translated some contracts and legal decisions
relating indubitably to captive Jews who had been carried to Babylon
after the destruction of Jerusalem. One of the most interesting of them
is a law-suit commenced by a Jewish slave named Barachiel in order to
recover his freedom. The case was as follows:--Barachiel--who bears the
same name as the father of Elihu in the Book of Job (xxxii. 2-6),--had
been the property of a wealthy person named Akhi-nuri, who had sold him
to a widow of the name of Gaga, about 570 B.C. He remained
in the house of this lady as a slave, with the power of liberating
himself by paying a sum equal to his _peculium_ or private property,
which he had been allowed to acquire, like a slave in ancient Rome; but
it seems that he was never fortunate enough to be able to afford the
sum of money required. He remained with Gaga twenty-one years, and was
considered the _res_ or property of the house, and as such was handed
over in pledge, was restored, and finally became the dowry of Nubti,
the daughter of Gaga. Nubti gave him to her son and husband in exchange
for a house and some slaves. After the death of the two ladies he was
sold to the wealthy publican, Itti-Marduk-baladh, from whose house
he escaped twice. Taken the second time, he instituted an action in
order that he might be recognised as a free-born citizen, of the family
of Belrimanni; and to prove that he was of noble origin he pretended
that he had performed the matrimonial solemnities at the marriage of
his master’s daughter, Qudasa, with a certain Samas-mudammiq. Such a
performance, doubtless, implied that the officiating priest was of free
birth, and no slave or freed-man was qualified to take part in it.

The name Barachiel, says Dr Oppert, is evidently that of a Jew.
He is called “a slave of ransom;” that is to say, not a slave who
has already purchased his freedom, but a slave who was allowed by
special laws to employ his private fortune in the work of liberating
himself. He professes to have been the “joiner” of the hands of bride
and bridegroom at a wedding which must have taken place before the
thirty-fifth year of Nebuchadnezzar’s reign, when he still belonged to
the house of Akhi-nuri, “the seller of the slave,” as he is called at
the end of the text.

The judges, after perusing all the evidence, do not find any proofs
that Barachiel was a man of free birth, and accordingly say to
him:--“Prove to us that you are the descendant of a noble ancestor.”
Thereupon Barachiel confesses that he is not free-born, but has twice
run away from the house of his master; as, however, the act was seen
by many people, he was afraid, and said he was the son of a noble
ancestor. “But I am not free-born,” he confesses, and then gives an
account of the events of his life. The judges decided that Barachiel
should be restored to his condition as a slave of ransom.[54]

Such a story as this serves to show what the life of many an Israelite
may have been during the Captivity.


                   3. _How the Writings were Read._

To the ordinary visitor to the British Museum, looking at the cuneiform
inscriptions--nothing but arrowhead characters variously grouped--it
seems wonderful that they should constitute a language, and incredible
that they should be read. The question is often asked, “How can we
trust the translations put before us? How do we know that they are any
more than guesses?” It may be well, therefore, to relate how the key
to the lost character was obtained, and how the decipherment proceeded
until now the translation of narrative texts can be made with as much
certainty as translations from the Hebrew of the Old Testament.

  [Illustration: BEHISTUN SCULPTURE.]

The clue was obtained from the Behistun inscriptions, through the
energy of Sir Henry Rawlinson; and the records of the successive steps
of the discovery will be found in the _Journal of the Asiatic Society_,
in the _Quarterly Review_ for March 1847, and in such popular works
as Mr Vaux’s “Nineveh and Persepolis.” Edwin Norris and others had
laboured, and the process of deciphering cuneiform texts was already
well advanced when Sir Henry Layard and Mr Rassam discovered such
abundant treasures in the mounds on the Tigris. The inscriptions
which are now known to record the personal history of Darius, the
son of Hystaspes, are almost always in three forms of the cuneiform
character, which may be described as Persian, Median, and Assyrian, and
were addressed to different races of his subjects. The most extensive
monument of the kind is found on a rock escarpment at Behistun, on the
frontiers of Persia, a place on the high road from Babylonia to the
further east. The rock is almost perpendicular, and rises abruptly
from the plain to the height of 1700 feet, an imposing object which
must always have attracted the attention of travellers. It was known
to the Greeks, who erected on the top of it a temple to Zeus; and it
had probably been sacred to Ormazd, the supreme deity of the Persians.
High up on the face of this rock, 300 feet above the plain, there are
two tablets, one of them containing sculptured figures and nearly a
thousand lines of cuneiform character. The sculptured portion of the
rock represents a line of nine persons united by a cord tied round
their necks, and having their hands bound behind their backs, who are
approaching another of more majestic stature, who, holding up his right
hand in token of authority, treads on a prostrate body. His countenance
expresses the idea of a great king or conqueror, and behind the king
stand two guards with long spears in their hands.

The reign of Darius was disturbed by many revolts, and the
insurrectionary attempts of many impostors and pretenders. It is these
impostors who are represented as prisoners in the sculpture, and over
the head of each figure we find his name and description. The first
one, the prostrate figure, is “Gomates, the Magian, an impostor,” who
said, “I am Bartius, the son of Cyrus; I am the King,” and so on. The
inscription is by far the largest and most important record which has
been preserved of the greatness of Darius, and of the Persian state and
system. The lines over the monarch himself would read in English as
follows:--

“I am Darius the king, the great king, the king of kings, the king of
Persia, the king of the (dependent) provinces, the son of Hystaspes,
the grandson of Arsames, the Achæmenian,” &c.

It will be noticed here how the word king is repeated; as the
inscription proceeds the name Darius is repeated also. A German
scholar, Professor Grotefend, had observed that such inscriptions
generally begin with three or four words, one of which varies while
the others do not. He suspected that the word which changes would be
the king’s name--as different inscriptions would relate to different
kings--and that the other words gave the king’s titles. He felt
convinced that a word which was constantly repeated signified “king,”
and conjectured that when two kings were mentioned they were probably
father and son. Finding that the names of Cyrus and Cambyses would
not suit, because no two names in the inscription he was dealing with
commenced with the same letter, he tried others. Cyrus and Artaxerxes
seemed equally inapplicable, because of their unequal length, the
two names he was dealing with being of six letters each. The only
names remaining were those of Darius and Xerxes; and these on further
comparison appeared to agree so exactly with the characters that he
did not hesitate at once to adopt them. Having thus found out more
than twelve letters, among which were precisely those composing the
royal title, the next business was to give these names their original
Persian form, in order that by ascertaining the correct value of each
character, the royal title might be deciphered. From the “Zendavesta”
of Anquetil du Perron, M. Grotefend found that the Greek form Hystaspes
was originally represented in Persian by Gustasp, Kishtasp, or
Wistasp. The first seven letters of this name were at once discovered,
while a comparison of all the royal titles led him to the conclusion
that the three last formed the inflection of the genitive singular,
corresponding to the Latin Hystaspis. Thus did Grotefend proceed step
by step, his ingenuity and perseverance being beyond all praise.
Meantime Sir Henry Rawlinson, although stationed in Persia and cut
off in a great degree from the results of European scholarship, was
devoting himself with ardour to the study of the Behistun inscription,
and making independent progress.

It turned out that of the three forms of arrow-headed character in
this class of inscriptions the Persian was the easiest to decipher,
being an alphabetic language, and that the other two were not purely
alphabetic. Still, a sure clue was obtained, and the key being
applied by an increasing number of investigators, the Median and the
Assyrian in the course of time yielded up their secrets. At length,
in 1857, to put the method of decipherment to a test, the inscription
of Tiglath-Pileser I. was submitted to four eminent Assyriologists,
namely, Sir H. Rawlinson, Dr Oppert, Mr Fox Talbot, and Dr Hincks, who
made translations of it independently, and sent them, under seal, to
the secretary of the Royal Asiatic Society. When they were opened and
compared it was found that they exhibited a remarkable resemblance
to one another, much greater, in fact, than could have been the case
if the method of decipherment had not been sound. Since 1857 immense
advances have been made, until now, as Dr Sayce confidently declares,
it is possible to translate an ordinary Assyrian text with as much ease
and certainty as a page of the Old Testament.

   [_Authorities and Sources_:--“Assyrian Discoveries.” By
   George Smith. “The Chaldean Genesis.” By George Smith.
   “Ancient History from the Monuments: Assyria.” By George
   Smith. “Ancient History from the Monuments: Babylonia.” By
   Rev. Dr A. H. Sayce. “Nineveh and its Remains.” H. A. Layard.
   “Nineveh and Persepolis.” W. S. W. Vaux. “Guide to the
   Kouyunjik Gallery.” British Museum. “The Story of the Nations:
   Assyria.” By Zénaïde A. Ragozin. “The Story of the Nations:
   Babylonia.” Zénaïde A. Ragozin. “Hibbert Lectures.” Dr A. H.
   Sayce. “Records of the Past.” “Transactions of the Society of
   Biblical Archæology.” Smith’s “Dictionary of the Bible.” “From
   Under the Dust of Ages.” St Chad Boscawen.]



                    THE VANDALISM OF THE ORIENTALS.


It seems to be quite providential that the calamities of cities and
the burial of treasures of art and knowledge should result in their
preservation, and contribute to the education of the world. It is
remarkable also that the explorers of the buried cities of the East
should be the Christian nations of the West, and that such a wealth
of discovery should enrich this nineteenth century. Through the
catastrophe which overwhelmed Pompeii, and preserved it under volcanic
ashes for 1700 years, we have become better acquainted with the private
life of the Romans than would have been possible by any other means.
The fugitive from Pompeii, in the hurry of escape, abandoned articles
of intrinsic value, and could not pause or stoop to pick them up;
yet they were saved from the hand of the robber that they might give
instruction to the world many centuries afterwards. The golden diadems,
ear-rings, and bracelets which Dr Schliemann found in a great silver
vase on the supposed site of Troy had been packed in the greatest
haste, and the fair owner, unable to return to them, no doubt gave them
up for lost; but she was an instrument in the hand of Providence, and
knew not what she did. By the recovery of the Assyrian royal library,
we are being informed concerning the religion and mythology, as well as
the history, of early nations, about whom we knew too little through
the ordinary channels of history. Think of Assurbanipal’s librarian at
Nineveh speculating on the ultimate destiny of the records under his
care! How could he guess that when the empire was passed away, its
kings forgotten, its gods put aside as mythical inventions, there would
come scholars from beyond the pillars of Hercules and learn to decipher
its records?

How disappointing is it, then, to all lovers of knowledge, as well
as to all students of Bible antiquities, to know that, now, when the
existence of these treasures is known, there is too little enterprise
in our people to go and reap the harvest of them; and while we wait
they are being carelessly or wantonly destroyed! One explorer tells
of an Arab who found an entire black statue, and because it was too
heavy to carry away bodily, broke off its head and carried that away
first. Palaces and temples, when unearthed, are used as quarries for
the building stone. Limestone slabs, covered with precious sculptures
and inscriptions, are burnt for the sake of the lime. Decaying mounds
of bricks, because they contain nitre, are carted off as manure for the
fields! The following are a few instances of the vandalism which seems
to be defeating the apparent intention of Providence.

The beautiful sanctuaries “erected by Amenhotep III. in the island of
Elephantine, which were figured by the members of the French expedition
at the end of the last century, were destroyed by the Turkish governor
of Assouan in 1822.”--_Professor Maspero._

The great Sphinx at Gizeh.--“The nose and beard have been broken off by
fanatics.”--_Professor Maspero._

Sebakh diggers ply their occupation in the midst of the mounds of the
ancient city of Thebes. “_Sebakh_, signifying ‘salt,’ or ‘saltpetre,’
is the general term for that saline dust which accumulates wherever
there are mounds of brick or limestone ruins. This dust is much valued
as a manure or ‘top-dressing,’ and is so constantly dug out and carried
away by the natives, that the mounds of ancient towns and villages are
rapidly undergoing destruction in all parts of Egypt.”--_Miss Amelia B.
Edwards._

“Prisse d’Avennes relates that when he visited, in 1836, Behbeit el
Hagar, the site of the old Heb, in the Sebennyte nome, near the present
city of Mansoorah, he went away disgusted, seeing the regular trade
that was carried on in the most beautiful sculptures of the ruined
temple, which was besides used as a quarry by the inhabitants of the
spot.”--_M. Naville._

“When the sheikh on whose land I was excavating became reassured as to
the object of my researches, he told me that some twenty years ago a
great number of inscribed stones were unearthed on that spot [site of
Goshen]; but since that time they had disappeared, most of them having
been used for building purposes. The great number of broken pieces
which are built into the walls of the houses prove that the sheikh
spoke the truth.”--_M. Naville._

“At Babel there are four wells scientifically built. When Mr Rassam
cleared one of them of _debris_ he came to water at the bottom. Each
stone is 3 feet in thickness, is bored, and made to fit the one below
it so exactly that you would imagine the whole well was hewn out of the
solid rock. Yet the Arabs break up these stones for the sake of making
lime.”--_Transactions of the Society of Biblical Archæology_, viii. 185.

“In 1815 Lady Hester Stanhope conducted excavations at Ascalon, and
found a colossal statue of a Roman emperor, thought possibly to have
been that of Augustus, erected by Herod. It was unfortunately broken
up by the workmen in search of treasure supposed to be concealed
within.”--Conder’s “_Syrian Stone-lore_.”

“At Cæsarea a broad street has been laid out (by the recent immigrants
from Bosnia) which passes directly over the remains of the Roman temple
built by Herod in honour of Cæsar and of Rome (the finely dressed white
stone being turned to good account by the colonists), and over the
Crusaders’ Cathedral, the foundations and walls of which also furnish
splendid building material.”--“_Quarterly Statement_ of Palestine
Exploration Fund,” July 1884.

“I pointed out that while the objects underground would keep a few
years longer, the march of civilisation was rapidly erasing all records
of the past above ground. The ancient ruins were being burnt into lime,
the old names were giving way to modern appellations, and the records
of the past were disappearing.”--_Colonel Sir Charles Warren._

“Of Memphis there is at present hardly a trace left; and other great
cities known to ancient travellers have disappeared with their
monuments. Mummy cases and coffins with most interesting inscriptions
have for centuries been used as fuel. And innumerable manuscripts
have suffered the same fate.... The tombs are convenient abodes for
Arab families, who destroy the paintings and inscriptions either by
the dense smoke of their fires or by actually pulling down walls. I
was taken to see the ‘Lay of the Harper,’ one of the most interesting
remains of Egyptian poetry, which was published a few years ago by Dr
Dumichen, but we found the walls on which the poem was written a mere
heap of ruins. But the vandalism of European and American travellers
is most fatal to the monuments. There is, or rather was, a famous
picture at Beni-hassan, which was formerly thought to represent Joseph
presenting his brethren to Pharaoh. An English lady has been heard to
request her guide to cut out for her the face of Joseph!”--_P. Le Page
Renouf._


               TURNBULL AND SPEARS, PRINTERS, EDINBURGH.


FOOTNOTES:

[1] From “Records of the Past.” New Series, vol. ii.

[2] See Bishop Butler’s “Sermon on the Character of Balaam.”

[3] Rev. H. G. Tomkins argues that he was a Semite, though in close
contact with the Hittites.--“Journal of the Anthropological Institute,”
November 1889.

[4] Major Conder, in the “Journal of the Anthropological Institute,”
August 1889.

[5] See the authorities given in “Rawlinson’s Historical Illustrations
of the Old Testament.”

[6] Dyer’s “Pompeii.”

[7] Exod. xxix. 22; Levit. vii. 32, viii. 25, ix. 21; Num. xviii. 18.

[8] See Sayce’s “Fresh Light from the Monuments,” p. 139.

[9] “Records of the Past,” New Series, vol. ii.

[10] Brugsch, “History of Egypt,” vol. ii.

[11] May it not perhaps have been a new name given to Bubastis, after
rebuilding?

[12] M. Naville, whose excavations at Tell Basta have shown that
Bubastis was a very large city, and a favourite resort of the king and
his family, thinks it quite possible that, at the time we are speaking
of, the king was at Bubastis and not at Zoan.

[13] Gesenius gives the meaning, “rush, reed, seaweed;” and in Exod.
ii. 3, Moses is said to have been laid in an ark of _souph_ or reeds.

[14] In this paraphrase I render one of the _vavs_ by “then” instead
of “and.” This will be allowed me. What will be objected to is the
assumption that Lasha is Laish, especially as Lasha contains a
different radical, the _ayin_ (לָשַׁע). But the passage in Genesis
may give an archaic spelling; and as Lasha signifies “the breaking
through of waters,” it is eminently descriptive of the source of the
Jordan at Dan. To place Lasha in the south-east of Palestine, as is
done in Smith’s “Dictionary of the Bible,” is to charge the description
in Genesis with being defective, for how are the limits of a people
defined by tracing two sides of an irregular quadrangle?

[15] Josephus: “Wars,” iii. 10. § 8.

[16] “Twenty-one years’ Work in the Holy Land.”

[17] For an account of the “Book of Jasher,” see the “Literary Remains
of Emanuel Deutsch.”

[18] Little Hermon is really a misnomer for the conical hill of Duhy
just north of the Valley of Jezreel. The mention of Tabor and Hermon
together in Psalm lxxxix. 12, has misled those who did not realize that
Tabor would be in the same line of vision with Mount Hermon, for many
observers in the south.

[19] See the chapter on Jerusalem.

[20] _Greek_ “Akra.”

[21] ἡ καθύπερθεν αὐταῖς

[22] “Survey Memoirs.”

[23] This is Dr Sayce’s improved translation, in “Records of the Past,”
Second Series, vol. ii. The inscription has since been cut out and
stolen.

[24] “Quarterly Statement,” Jan. 1890.

[25] Might mean arched, or gibbous, or humped. Conder understands it
“rising to a peak.” Q. S. Oct. 1873.

[26] “Quarterly Statement,” January 1876.

[27] “Wars,” v. 4. 2.

[28] “Quarterly Statement,” Jan. 1886.

[29] In the Authorised Version it is Meah, in the Revised Version
Hammeah. It might be translated Tower of the Hundred.

[30] Ezra iv. 16, 20; v. 3, 6; vi. 6, 8, 13; viii. 36.

[31] The Nethinim were but servants of the Levites.

[32] “Recovery of Jerusalem,” pp. 155-9.

[33] Zion is only called Moriah as the hill of vision (2 Chron. iii. 1).

[34] The resemblances are better seen in the Hebrew.

[35] “Quarterly Statement,” April, 1890.

[36] “Quarterly Statement,” Jan.-March 1870.

[37] Antiq., vii. 14, 4.

[38] Antiq., ix. 10. 4.

[39] “Sinai and Palestine,” chap. iii.

[40] “Quarterly Statement,” July, 1890.

[41] “The Recovery of Jerusalem,” p. 284.

[42] “Quarterly Statement,” 1872, p. 116.

[43] It would be legitimate to read “by the sheep-pool” instead of “by
the sheep-gate.”

[44] xv. 11. 5.

[45] v. 5. 2.

[46] “Sinai and Palestine.”

[47] Conder’s “Tent Work.”

[48] See a paper by Rev. Charles S. Robinson, in the _Century
Magazine_, November, 1888.

[49] Genesis x. 6.

[50] Lessing: “Education of the Human Race.”

[51] “Journal of the Anthropological Institute,” February, 1889.

[52] It is right to say that some writers are not convinced that
Nineveh was 60 miles round. They regard Nimroud, Kouyunjik, &c., as so
many separate cities.

[53] Or Gilgames. (See _Academy_, Nov. 8th, 1890.)

[54] “Records of the Past.” New Series, Vol. i.



      *      *      *      *      *      *



Transcriber’s note:

1. Obvious spelling, printers’ and punctuation errors have been
silently corrected.

2. Where appropriate, both hyphenated and non-hyphenated words have
been retained as in the original.

3. Where appropriate, original spelling has been retained.

4. Superscripts are represented using the caret character, e.g. D^r.

5. In chapter 3, for the numbered subsections, the number 4 was
incorrectly stated as 5. This has been corrected.





*** End of this LibraryBlog Digital Book "Buried Cities and Bible Countries" ***

Copyright 2023 LibraryBlog. All rights reserved.



Home